1990—2007年大学英语四级真题
发布人:基础部管理员  发布时间:2023-04-28   浏览次数:10

PowerPlusWaterMarkObject619891月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷19 / 835

19891月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a line through the centre.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. There fore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) He lent her his extra pen.

 B) He was afraid of losing his pen.

 C) He offered her a pencil.

 D) He said he didn’t have any extra ink.C

 2.A) The teacher reviewed a previous lesson.

 B) The teacher taught a new lesson.

 C) The teacher postponed the class until Friday.

 D) The teacher made the students write in class.A

 3.A) It’s going to attract a lot of students.

 B) It’s going to be a lot of fun.

 C) It’s going to require a lot of reading.

 D) It’s going to work out quite well.C

 4.A) She agrees to lend him the car.

 B) She offers him the car.

 C) She refuses to lend him the car.

 D) She is pleased to lend him the car.A

 5.A) To the beach.

 B) To a movie theatre.

 C) To a play.

 D) To a restaurant.D

 6.A) Policeman and driver.

 B) Policeman and thief.

 C) Teacher and pupil.

 D) Director and actress.A

 7.A) He is often late for meals.

 B) He is expecting a letter from abroad.

 C) He wrote to his family last month.

 D) He is anxious to go back home.B

 8.A) He is modest.

 B) He is satisfied.

 C) He is proud.

 D) He is upset.D

 9.A) Europe.

 B) Here.

 C) Canada.

 D) California.C

 10.A) The train is crowded.

 B) The train is late.

 C) The train is on time.

 D) The train is out of order.B

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) The crust.

 B) The ground.

 C) The plate.

 D) The boundary.A

 12.A) Two.

 B) Seventy.

 C) Seven.

 D) Twelve.C

 13.A) The east coast of North America.

 B) The west coast of North America.

 C) The middle of the Atlantic Ocean.

 D) The middle of the Pacific Ocean.B

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) They want to attract attention.

 B) It is fashionable to wear such clothes.

 C) The appear respectable in such clothes.

 D) Riding a motorcycle makes one dirty.D

 15.A) It is efficient.

 B) It is exciting.

 C) It is convenient.

 D) It is dangerous.D

 16.A) If he always wears protective clothing.

 B) If he can see everything around him clearly.

 C) If he is very careful.

 D) If he has a lot of defenders.C

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) He was struck by lightning.

 B) He had a car accident.

 C) He was very old.

 D) He fell down in his yard.B

 18.A) His wife.

 B) A clock.

 C) A tree.

 D) Lightning.B

 19.A) Hiding under a tree.

 B) Entering the house.

 C) Driving a car.

 D) Lying on the ground.A

 20.A) A fall from the tree.

 B) The unexpected return of his wife.

 C) Another flash of lightning.

 D) Another heavy blow.D

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 reading passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 More than 30,000 drivers and front seat passengers are killed or seriously injured each year. At the speed of only 30 miles per hour it is the same as falling from a third-floor windows. Wearing a seat belt saves lives; it reduces your chance of death or serious injury by more than half.

 Therefore drivers or front seat passengers over 14 in most vehicles must wear a seat belt. If you do not, you could be fined up to 50. it will not be up to the drivers to make sure you wear your belt. But it will be the driver’s responsibility to make sure that children under 14 do not ride in the front unless they are wearing a seat belt of some kind.

 However, you do not have to wear a seat belt if you reversing your vehicle; or you are making a local delivery or collection using a special vehicle; or if you have a valid medical certificate which excuses you from wearing it. Make sure these circumstances apply to you before you decide not to wear you seat belt. Remember you may be taken to court for not doing so, and you may be fined if you cannot prove to the court that you have been excused from wearing it.

 21.This text is taken from ________.

 A) a medical magazine

 B) a police report

 C) a legal document

 D) a government information bookletD

 22.Wearing a seat belt in a vehicle ________.

 A) reduces road accidents by more than half

 B) saves lives while driving at a speed up to 30 miles per hour

 C) reduces the death rate in traffic accidents

 D) saves more than 15,000 lives each yearC

 23.It is the driver’s responsibility to ________.

 A) make the front seat passenger wear a seat belt

 B) make the front seat children under 14 wear a seat belt

 C) stop children riding in the front seat

 D) wear a seat belt each time he drivesB

 24.According to the text, which of the following people riding in the front dos not have to wear a seat belt?

 A) Someone who is backing into a parking space.

 B) Someone who is picking up the children from the local school.

 C) Someone who is delivering invitation letters.

 D) Someone who is under 14.A

 25.For some people, it may be better ________.

 A) to wear a seat belt for health reasons

 B) not to wear a seat belt for health reasons

 C) to get valid medical certificate before wearing a seat belt

 D) to pay a fine rather than wear a seat beltB

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 If you want to stay young, sit down and have a good think. This is the research finding of a team of Japanese doctors, who say that most of our brains are not getting enough exercise—and as a result, we are ageing unnecessarily soon.

 Professor Taiju Matsuzawa wanted to find out why otherwise healthy farmers in northern Japan appeared to be losing their ability to think and reason at a relatively early age, and how the process of ageing could be slowed down.

 With a team of colleagues at Tokyo National University, he set about measuring brain volumes of a thousand people of different ages and varying occupations.

 Computer technology enabled the researchers to obtain precise measurements of the volume of the front and side sections of the brain, which relate to intellect (智能) and emotion, and determine the human character. (The rear section of the brain, which controls functions like eating and breathing, does not contract with age, and one can continue living without intellectual or emotional faculties.)

 Contraction of front and side parts—as cells die off—was observed I some subjects in their thirties, but it was still not evident in some sixty- and seventy-year-olds.

 Matsuzawa concluded from his tests that there is a simple remedy to the contraction normally associated with age—using the head.

 The findings show in general terms that contraction of the brain begins sooner in people in the country than in the towns. Those least at risk, says Matsuzawa, are lawyers, followed by university professors and doctors. White collar workers doing routine work in government offices are, however, as likely to have shrinking brains as the farm worker, bus driver and shop assistant.

 Matsuzawa’s findings show that thinking can prevent the brain from shrinking. Blood must circulate properly in the head to supply the fresh oxygen the brain cells need. “The best way to maintain good blood circulation is through using the brain,” he says, “Think hard and engage in conversation. Don’t rely on pocket calculators.”

 26.The team of doctors wanted to find out ________.

 A) why certain people age sooner than others

 B) how to make people live longer

 C) the size of certain people’s brains

 D) which people are most intelligentA

 27.On what are their research findings based?

 A) A survey of farmers in northern Japan.

 B) Tests performed on a thousand old people.

 C) The study of brain volumes of different people

 D) The latest development of computer technology.C

 28.The doctor’s test show that ________.

 A) our brains shrink as we grow older

 B) the front section of the brain does not shrink

 C) sixty-year-olds have the better brains than thirty-year-olds

 D) some people’s brains have contracted more than other people’sD

 29.The word “subjects” in Paragraph 5means ________.

 A) something to be considered

 B) branches of knowledge studied

 C) persons chosen to be studied in an experiment

 D) any member of a state except the supreme rulerC

 30.According to the passage, which people seem to age slower than the others?

 A) Lawyers.

 B) Farmers.

 C) Clerks.

 D) Shop assistants.A

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 On June 17, 1744, the officials from Maryland and Virginia held a talk with the Indians of the Six Nations. The Indians were invited to send boys to William and Mary College. In a letter the next day the refused the offer as follows:

 We know that you have a high opinion of the kind of learning taught in your colleges, and that the costs of living of our young men, while with you, would be very expensive to you. We are convinced that you mean to do us good by your proposal; and we thank you heartily. But you must know that different nations have different ways of looking at things, and you will therefore not be offended if your ideas of this kind of education happen not t be the same as yours. We have had some experience of it. Several of our young people were formerly brought up at the colleges of the northern provinces: they were taught all your sciences; but, when they came back to us, they were bad runners, ignorant of every means of living in the woods… they were totally good for nothing.

 We are, however, not the less obliged by your kind offer, though we refuse to accept it; and, to show our grateful sense of it, if the gentlemen of Virginia will send up a dozen of their sons, we will take care of their education, teach them in all we know, and make men of them.

 31.The passage is about ________.

 A) the talk between the Indians and the officials

 B) the colleges of northern provinces

 C) the educational values of the Indians

 D) the problems of the Americans in the mid-eighteenth centuryC

 32.The Indians’ chief purpose in writing the letter seems to be to ________.

 A) politely refuse a friendly offer

 B) express their opinion on equal treatment

 C) show their pride

 D) describe Indian customsA

 33.According to the letter, the Indians believed that ________.

 A) it would be better for their boys to receive some schooling

 B) they were being insulted by the offer

 C) they knew more about science than the officials

 D) they had a better way of educating young menD

 34.Different from the officials’ view of education, the Indians though ________.

 A) young women should also be educated

 B) they had different goals of education

 C) they taught different branches of science

 D) they should teach the sons of the officials firstB

 35.The tone of the letter as a whole is best described as ________.

 A) angry

 B) pleasant

 C) polite

 D) inquiringC

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 In what now seems like the prehistoric times of computer history, the earth’s postwar era, there was quite a wide-spread concern that computers would take over the world from man one day. Already today, less than forty years later, as computers are relieving us of more and more of the routine tasks in business and in our personal lives, we are faced with a less dramatic but also less foreseen problem. People tend to be over-trusting of computers and are reluctant to challenge their authority. Indeed, they behave as if they were hardly aware that wrong buttons may be pushed, or that a computer may simply malfunction (失误).

 Obviously, there would be no point in investing in a computer if you had to check all its answers, but people should also rely on their own internal computers and check the machine when they have the feeling that something has gone wrong.

 Questioning and routine double-checks must continue to be as much a part of good business as they were in pre-computer days. Maybe each computer should come with the warning: for all the help this computer may provide, it should not be seen as a substitute for fundamental thinking and reasoning skills.

 36.What is the main purpose of this passage?

 A) To look back to the early days of computers.

 B) To explain what technical problems may occur with computers.

 C) To discourage unnecessary investment in computers.

 D) To warn against a mentally lazy attitude towards computers.D

 37.According to the passage, the initial concern about computers was that they might ________.

 A) change our personal lives

 B) take control of the world

 C) create unforeseen problems

 D) affect our businessesB

 38.The passage recommends those dealing with computers to ________.

 A) be reasonably doubtful about them

 B) check all their answers

 C) substitute them for basic thinking

 D) use them for business purposes onlyA

 39.The passage suggests that the present-day problem with regard to computers is ________.

 A) challenging

 B) psychological

 C) dramatic

 D) fundamentalB

 40.It can be inferred from the passage that the author would disapprove of ________.

 A) investment in computers

 B) the use of one’s internal computer

 C) double-check on computers

 D) complete dependence on computers for decision-makingD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four Choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single time through the centre.

 41.Mary’s score on the test is the highest in her class; she ________ have studied very hard.

 A) may

 B) should

 C) must

 D) ought toC

 42.________ that the trade between the two countries reached its highest point.

 A) During the 1960’s

 B) It was in the 1960’s

 C) That it was in the 1960’s

 D) It was the 1960’sB

 43.He suggested ________ to tomorrow’s exhibition together.

 A) us to go

 B) we went

 C) we shall go

 D) we goD

 44.No agreement was reached in the discussion as neither side would give way to ________.

 A) the other

 B) any other

 C) another

 D) otherA

 45.With agreement was reached I the discussion as neither side would give way to ________.

 A) mustn’t go

 B) wouldn’t go

 C) oughtn’t to go

 D) shouldn’t have goneD

 46.If you want ________ you have to get the fund somewhere.

 A) that the job is done

 B) the job done

 C) to have done the job

 D) the job that is donB

 47.There is more land in Australia than the government knows ________.

 A) what to do with

 B) how to do

 C) to do with it

 D) to do itA

 48.It’s no use ________ me not to worry.

 A) you tell

 B) your telling

 C) for you to have told

 D) having toldB

 49.I have two boys but ________ of them likes sweets.

 A) both

 B) neither

 C) either

 D) noneB

 50.Only by shouting at the top of his voice ________.

 A) was he able to make himself hear

 B) he was able to make himself hear

 C) he was able to make himself heard

 D) was he able to make himself heardD

 51.________ such a good chance, he planned to learn more.

 A) To be given

 B) Having been given

 C) Having given

 D) GivingB

 52.If it ________ too much trouble, I’d love a cup of tea.

 A) isn’t

 B) wasn’t

 C) weren’t

 D) hadn’t beenA

 53.My sister’s professor had her ________ her paper many times before allowing her to present it to the committee.

 A) rewritten

 B) to rewrite

 C) rewrite

 D) rewritingC

 54.silver is the best conductor of electricity, copper ________ it closely.

 A) followed

 B) following

 C) to follow

 D) being followedB

 55.They are considering ________ before the prices go up.

 A) of buying the house

 B) with buying the house

 C) buying the house

 D) to buy the houseC

 56.She was glad that her success would ________ for the women who would follow.

 A) make things easier

 B) make it easier

 C) be easier

 D) be easier to makeA

 57.They will have it finished in ________.

 A) three quarter of an hour time

 B) three quarters of an hour time

 C) three quarter of an hour’s time

 D) three quarters of an hour’s timeD

 58.A Dream of the Red Chamber is said ________ into dozens of languages in the last decade.

 A) to have been translated

 B) to translate

 C) to be translated

 D) to have translatedC

 59.He went ahead ________ all warnings about the danger of his mission.

 A) in case of

 B) because of

 C) regardless of

 D) prior toC

 60.We object ________ punishing a whole group for one person’s fault.

 A) against

 B) about

 C) to

 D) orC

 61.Jack is good, kind, hard-working and intelligent; ________; I can’t speak too highly of him.

 A) as a result

 B) in a word

 C) by the way

 D) on the contraryB

 62.The man to whom we handed the forms pointed out that they had not been ________ filled in.

 A) consequently

 B) regularly

 C) comprehensively

 D) properlyD

 63.I shall have companion in the house after all these ________ years.

 A) single

 B) sole

 C) alone

 D) lonelyD

 64.After a long and exhausting journey, they arrived ________.

 A) till the last

 B) at last

 C) by the end

 D) at the endB

 65.None of the servants were ________ when Mr. Smith wanted to send a message.

 A) available

 B) attainable

 C) approachable

 D) applicableA

 66.I can’t ________ what that object is.

 A) make up

 B) make over

 C) make out

 D) make forC

 67.I want to buy a new tie to ________ this brown suit.

 A) go into

 B) go after

 C) go with

 D) go byC

 68.The newest satellite can ________ a thousand telephone conversations and a colour TV program at the same time.

 A) carry

 B) extend

 C) bring

 D) takeA

 69.I can ________ some noise while I’m studying, but I can’t stand loud noises.

 A) come up with

 B) catch up with

 C) put up with

 D) keep up withC

 70.When the whole area was ________ by the flood, the government sent food there by helicopter.

 A) cut away

 B) cut down

 C) cut up

 D) cut offD

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 In recent years, more and more foreigners are involved in the teaching programs of the United States. Both the advantages and the disadvantages __71__ using faculty (教师[总称]) from foreign countries __72__ teaching positions have to be __73__, of course. It can be said that foreign __74__ that makes the faculty member from abroad an asset (财富) also __75__ problems of adjustment, both for the university and for the individual.

 The foreign research scholar usually isolates __76__ in the laboratory as a means of protection; __77__, what he needs is to be fitted __78__ a highly organized university system quite different from __79__ at home. He is faced in his daily work __80__ differences in philosophy, arrangements of courses and methods of teaching. Both the visiting professor and his students __81__ background in each other’s cultures. Some __82__ of what is already in the minds of American students is __83__ by the foreign professor. While helping him to __84__ himself to his new environment, the university must also __85__ certain adjustments in order to __86__ full advantage of what the newcomer can __87__. It isn’t always known how to make __88__ use of foreign faculty, especially at smaller colleges. This is thought to be a __89__ where further study is called __90__. The findings of such a study will be of value to colleges and universities with foreign faculty.

 71.A) with

 B) for

 C) of

 D) atC

 72.A) in

 B) on

 C) for

 D) withinA

 73.A) thought

 B) measured

 C) balanced

 D) consideredD

 74.A) situation

 B) circumstance

 C) background

 D) conditionC

 75.A) carries

 B) creates

 C) emerges

 D) solvesB

 76.A) himself

 B) oneself

 C) him

 D) oneA

 77.A) otherwise

 B) moreover

 C) however

 D) alsoC

 78.A) into

 B) by

 C) to

 D) withA

 79.A) those

 B) which

 C) what

 D) thatD

 80.A) toward

 B) with

 C) to

 D) atB

 81.A) have

 B) possess

 C) need

 D) lackD

 82.A) concept

 B) feeling

 C) plan

 D) intelligenceA

 83.A) ordered

 B) asked

 C) insisted

 D) requiredD

 84.A) place

 B) adapt

 C) put

 D) directB

 85.A) remain

 B) keep

 C) make

 D) causeC

 86.A) take

 B) make

 C) do

 D) beA

 87.A) show

 B) afford

 C) express

 D) offerD

 88.A) powerful

 B) creative

 C) imaginary

 D) advancedB

 89.A) scope

 B) range

 C) field

 D) districtC

 90.A) on

 B) for

 C) upon

 D) atB

19891月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.A

3.C

4.A

5.D

6.A

7.B

8.D

9.C

10.B

11.A

12.C

13.B

14.D

15.D

16.C

17.B

18.B

19.A

20.D


Part II


21.D

22.C

23.B

24.A

25.B

26.A

27.C

28.D

29.C

30.A

31.C

32.A

33.D

34.B

35.C

36.D

37.B

38.A

39.B

40.D


Part III


41.C

42.B

43.D

44.A

45.D

46.B

47.A

48.B

49.B

50.D

51.B

52.A

53.C

54.B

55.C

56.A

57.D

58.C

59.C

60.C

61.B

62.D

63.D

64.B

65.A

66.C

67.C

68.A

69.C

70.D


Part IV


71.C

72.A

73.D

74.C

75.B

76.A

77.C

78.A

79.D

80.B

81.D

82.A

83.D

84.B

85.C

86.A

87.D

88.B

89.C

90.B


19891月四级听力原文

Section A

 Example:

 M: Is it possible for you to work late, Miss Grey?

 W: Work late? I suppose so, if you really think it’s necessary.

 Q: Where do you think this conversation most probably took place?

 1.W: Could you lend me a pen? Mine has just run out of ink.

 M: I’m afraid I don’t have an extra one. Would a pencil do?

 Q: How did the man respond to the woman’s request?

 2.W: What did you do in class today?

 M: The teacher went over last Friday’s lesson.

 Q: What did the teacher do?

 3.W: It looks like the English course is going to be a lot of work.

 M: Didn’t you see the reading list is enormous?

 Q: What did they think of the English course?

 4.M: Can I use your new car, Auntie?

 W: Yes, of course, if you drive it carefully.

 Q: What’s the aunt’s answer?

 5.M: The Golden Lion sounds like a nice place to eat.

 W: Ok, let’s go there. I hear that they have a complete menu and a warm atmosphere.

 Q: Where are the man and woman going?

 6.M: Why didn’t you stop when we first signaled?

 W: I’m sorry. Will I have to pay a fine?

 Q: What is the probable relationship between the man and the woman?

 7.M: I haven’t heard from my family since last month.

 W: Don’t worry, Bill. Overseas mail is often slow.

 Q: What can we learn about the man from the conversation?

 8.W: Jack, how are you doing with your paper?

 M: I’ve written and rewritten it so many times that I wonder when I can finish it.

 Q: What can we learn about the man?

 9.M: Has George returned from Europe yet?

 W: Yes, but he had been only here for three days before his company sent him to Canada.

 Q: Where is George now?

 10.W: Excuse me. Do you know when the train will arrive?

 M: I’m sorry. The train is behind schedule. You have to wait another twenty minutes.

 Q: What do we learn from this conversation?

Section B

 Passage 1

 The earth is composed of several layers. The top layer of the earth is called the earth’s crust. The earth’s crust is divided into seven sections. These sections are called plates.

 When two plates push against each other, or when two plates rub against each other, an earthquake will occur. An earthquake causes the ground above the plate to shake. The shaking is caused by the motion of two plates.

 Earthquakes are likely to happen at the boundaries of the earth’s plates. Each of these plates is about 70 kilometers thick. Let’s take a look at the general boundaries of one of these seven major plate.

 Take the North American plate for an example. The left boundary of this plate is the west coat of North America and the east boundary of this plate is through the middle of the Atlantic Ocean. That is, this plate extends from the west coast of North America to the middle of the Atlantic Ocean.

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.What is the top layer of the earth called?

 12.How many major sections is the earth’s crust divided into?

 13.Which of the following is the left boundary of the North American plate?

 Passage 2

 Nowadays motorcycling is fast becoming one of America’s most popular sports. However, there are several things about motorcycling that the average citizen dislikes. Motorcyclists frequently look dirty; in fact, there are dirty. On the road there is little to protect them from mud, insects, and bird droppings. For practical reasons they often dress in old clothing which looks much less respectable than the clothing of people who ride in cars. For the same reason motorcyclists usually wear dark colors.

 Of course the danger of motorcycling also helps account for many people’s low opinion of the sport. Its defenders, however, claim that careful cyclists are in less danger than is commonly believed. A cyclist must drive s if everybody around him wanted to kill him. He must pay careful attention to his driving. From that point of view, a man on a motorcycle is safer than a man in a car.

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.Why do motorcyclists often dress in old and dark clothing?

 15.What is the average citizen’s opinion about motorcycling?

 16.How can a motorcyclist be safer than a car driver?

 Passage 3

 Robert Edwards was blinded in an automobile accident nine years age. He was also partially deaf because of old age. Last week, he was walking near his home when a thunder-storm approached. He took shelter under a tree and was struck by lightning. He was knocked to the ground and woke up some 20 minutes later, lying face down in water below a tree. He went into the house and lay down in bed. A short time later, he awoke; his legs couldn’t move and he was trembling, but, when he opened his eyes, he could see the clock across the room in front of him. When his wife entered, he saw her for the first time in nine years. Doctors confirm that he has regained his sight and hearing apparently from the flash of lightning, but they are unable to explain the reason. The only possible explanation offered by one doctor was that, since Edwards lost his sight as a result of a hard blow in a terrible accident, perhaps the only way it could be restored was by another blow.

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.What caused Robert Edwards’s blindness?

 18.Which was the first thing that he saw after being struck by lightning?

 19.What was Edwards doing when he was struck by lightning?

 20.What caused Edwards to regain his sight according to one of the doctors?

19901月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a line through the centre.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. There fore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) The man wants to go to Los Angeles.

 B) The man wants to go to San Francisco.

 C) There are no flights to Los Angeles for the rest of the day.

 D) There are two direct flights to Los Angeles within the next two hours.A

 2.A) He enjoys writing home every week.

 B) He never fails to write a weekly letter home.

 C) He doesn’t write home once a week now.

 D) He has been asked to write home every week.C

 3.A) Because she has got an appointment.

 B) Because she doesn’t want to.

 C) Because she has to work.

 D) Because she wants to eat in a new restaurant.C

 4.A) The teacher postponed the meeting.

 B) There won’t be a test this afternoon.

 C) The students will be attending the meeting.

 D) The students will take an English test this afternoon.B

 5.A) On the whole, she liked the film.

 B) She didn’t see the film.

 C) The film was very exciting.

 D) The film wasn’t as good as she’d expected.D

 6.A) Around 5:00.

 B) Around 3:00.

 C) At 2:00.

 D) At 1:00.B

 7.A) He had to work overtime.

 B) He was held up in traffic.

 C) His car ran out of gas.

 D) He had a traffic accident.B

 8.A) John Smith isn’t in right now.

 B) John Smith can’t come to the phone right now.

 C) John Smith doesn’t want to speak to the caller.

 D) The caller dialed the wrong number.D

 9.A) Yesterday.

 B) Three days ago.

 C) Two days ago.

 D) Early last week.C

 10.A) She got up later than usual.

 B) The bus was late.

 C) She forgot she had classes.

 D) Her clock was slow.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) 4,000 years ago.

 B) 3,000 years ago.

 C) 2,000 years ago.

 D) 1,000 years ago.A

 12.A) The small bowl was put above the large bowl.

 B) The large bowl was put above the small bowl.

 C) The small bowl was put inside the large bowl.

 D) The large bowl consisted of two equal parts.A

 13.A) Horsemen.

 B) Brass doors.

 C) Drops of water.

 D) Metal balls.D

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) They are the most attractive women in Britain.

 B) They are the most popular film stars.

 C) They are the first women news announcers on British television.

 D) They appear almost every night in TV plays.C

 15.A) At 10 in the evening.

 B) At 9 in the evening.

 C) At 9 in the morning.

 D) At 10 in the morning.A

 16.A) People still talk a lot about it.

 B) Fewer people watched Susan’s programme from then on.

 C) Anna’s photographs appeared frequently in newspapers.

 D) The number of viewers of her programme that day increased by millions.D

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) It is completely flat.

 B) It has few rivers.

 C) It has many large lakes.

 D) It is hilly.D

 18.A) The soil has been overworked.

 B) The climate is cold.

 C) The weather is too dry.

 D) The soil is sandy.A

 19.A) By raising cattle.

 B) By working on farms.

 C) By working in factories.

 D) By raising sheep.C

 20.A) At school.

 B) From their parents.

 C) From books.

 D) In factories.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 reading passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Oceanography has been defined as “The application of all sciences to the study of the sea”.

 Before the nineteen century, scientists with an interest in the sea were few and far between. Certainly Newton considered some theoretical aspects of it in his writings, but he was reluctant to go to sea to further his work.

 For most people the sea was remote, and with the exception of early intercontinental travelers or others who earned a living from the sea, there was little reason to ask many questions about it, let alone to ask what lay beneath the surface. The first time that question “What is at the bottom of the oceans?” had to be answered with any commercial consequence was when the laying of a telegraph cable from Europe to America was proposed. The engineers had to know the depth profile (起伏形状) of the route to estimate the length of cable that had to be manufactured.

 It was to Maury of the US Navy that the Atlantic Telegraph Company turned, in 1853, for information on this matter. In the 1840s, Maury had been responsible for encouraging voyages during which soundings (测声) were taken to investigate the depths of the North Atlantic and Pacific Oceans. Later, some of his findings aroused much popular interest in his book The Physical Geography of the Sea.

 The cable was laid, but not until 1866 was the connection made permanent and reliable. At the early attempts, the cable failed and when it was taken out for repairs it was found to be covered in living growths, a fact which defied contemporary scientific opinion that there was no life in the deeper parts of the sea.

 Within a few years oceanography was under way. In 1872 Thomson led a scientific expedition (考察), which lasted for four years and brought home thousands of samples from the sea. Their classification and analysis occupied scientists for years and led to a five-volume report, the last volume being published in 1895.

 21.The proposal to lay a telegraph cable from Europe to America made oceanographic studies take on ________.

 A) an academic aspect

 B) a military aspect

 C) a business aspect

 D) an international aspectC

 22.It was ________ that asked Maury for help in oceanographic studies.

 A) the American Navy

 B) some early intercontinental travelers

 C) those who earned a living from the sea

 D) the company which proposed to lay an undersea cableD

 23.The aim of the voyages Maury was responsible for in the 1840s was ________.

 A) to make some sounding experiments in the oceans

 B) to collect samples of sea plants and animals

 C) to estimate the length of cable that was needed

 D) to measure the depths of the two oceansD

 24.“Defied” in the 5th paragraph probably means “________”.

 A) doubted

 B) gave proof to

 C) challenged

 D) agreed toC

 25.This passage is mainly about ________.

 A) the beginnings of oceanography

 B) the laying of the first undersea cable

 C) the investigation of ocean depths

 D) the early intercontinental communicationsA

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Normally a student must attend a certain number of courses in order to graduate, and each course which he attends gives him a credit which he may count towards a degree. In many American universities the total work for a degree consists of thirty-six courses each lasting for one semester. A typical course consists of three classes per week for fifteen weeks; while attending a university a student will probably attend four or five courses during each semester. Normally a student would expect to take four years attending two semesters each year. It is possible to spread the period of work for the degree over a longer period. It is also possible for a student to move between one university and another during his degree course, though this is not in fact done as a regular practice.

 For every course that he follows a student is given a grade, which is recorded, and the record is available for the student to show to prospective employers. All this imposes a constant pressure and strain of work, but in spite of this some students still find time for great activity in student affairs. Elections to positions in student organizations arouse much enthusiasm. The effective word of maintaining discipline is usually performed by students who advise the academic authorities. Any student who is thought to have broken the rules, for example, by cheating has to appear before a student court. With the enormous numbers of students, the operation of the system does involve a certain amount of activity. A student who has held one of these positions of authority is much respected and it will be of benefit to him later in his career.

 26.Normally a student would at least attend ________ classes each week.

 A) 36

 B) 20

 C) 12

 D) 15B

 27.According to the first paragraph an American student is allowed ________.

 A) to live in a different university

 B) to take a particular course in a different university

 C) to live at home and drive to classes

 D) to get two degrees from two different universitiesB

 28.American university students are usually under pressure of work because ________.

 A) their academic performance will affect their future careers

 B) they are heavily involved in student affairs

 C) they have to observe university discipline

 D) they want to run for positions of authorityA

 29.Some students are enthusiastic for positions in student organizations probably because ________.

 A) they hate the constant pressure strain of their study

 B) they will then be able to stay longer in the university

 C) such positions help them get better jobs

 D) such positions are usually well paidC

 30.The student organizations seem, to be effective in ________.

 A) dealing with the academic affairs of the university

 B) ensuring that the students observe university regulations

 C) evaluating students’ performance by bringing them before a court

 D) keeping up the students’ enthusiasm for social activitiesB

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Do you find getting up in the morning so difficult that it’s painful? This might be called laziness, but Dr. Kleitman has a new explanation. He has proved that everyone has a daily energy cycle.

 During the hours when you labor through your work you may say that you’re “hot”. That’s true. The time of day when you feel most energetic is when your cycle of body temperature is at its peak. For some people the peak comes during the afternoon. For others it comes in the afternoon or evening. No one has discovered why this is so, but it leads to such familiar monologues (自言自语) as: “Get up, John! You’ll be late for work again!” The possible explanation to the trouble is that John is at his temperature-and-energy peak in the evening. Much family quarrelling ends when husbands and wives realize what these energy cycles mean, and which cycle each member of the family has. You can’t change your energy cycle, but you can learn to make your life fit it better. Habit can help, Dr. Kleitman believes. Maybe you’re sleepy in the evening but feel you must stay up late anyway. Counteract (对抗) your cycle to some extent by habitually staying up later than you want to. If our energy is low in the morning but you have an important job to do early in the day, rise before your usual hour. This won’t change your cycle, but you’ll get up steam (鼓起干劲) and work better at your low point.

 Get off to a slow start which saves your energy. Get up with a leisurely yawn and stretch. Sit on the edge of the bed a minute before putting your feet on the floor. Avoid the troublesome search for clean clothes by laying them out the night before. Whenever possible, do routine work in the afternoon and save tasks requiring more energy or concentration for your sharper hours.

 31.If a person finds getting up early a problem, most probably ________.

 A) he is a lazy person

 B) he refuses to follow his own energy cycle

 C) he is not sure when his energy is low

 D) he is at his peak in the afternoon or eveningD

 32.Which of the following may lead to family quarrels according to the passage?

 A) Unawareness of energy cycles.

 B) Familiar monologues.

 C) A change in a family member’s energy cycle.

 D) Attempts to control the energy cycle of other family members.A

 33.If one wants to work more efficiently at his low point in the morning, he should ________.

 A) change his energy cycle

 B) overcome his laziness

 C) get up earlier than usual

 D) go to bed earlierC

 34.You are advised to rise with a yawn and stretch because it will ________.

 A) help to keep your energy for the day’s work

 B) help you to control your temper early in the day

 C) enable you to concentrate on your routine work

 D) keep your energy cycle under control all dayA

 35.Which of the following statements is NOT TRUE?

 A) Getting off to work wit a minimum effort helps save one’s energy.

 B) Dr. Kleitman explains why people reach their peaks at different hours of day.

 C) Habit helps a person adapt to his own energy cycle.

 D) Children have energy cycles, too.B

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 We find that bright children are rarely held back by mixed ability teaching. On the contrary, both their knowledge and experience are enriched. We feel that there are many disadvantages in streaming (把…按能力分班) pupils. It does not take into account the fact that children develop at different rates. It can have a bad effect on both the bright and the not-so-bright child. After all, it can be quite discouraging to be at the bottom of the top grade!

 Besides, it is rather unreal to grade people just according to their intellectual ability. This is only one aspect of their total personality. We are concerned to develop the abilities of all our pupils to the full, not just their academic ability. We also value personal qualities and social skills, and we find that mixed-ability teaching contributes to all these aspects of learning.

 In our classrooms, we work in various ways. The pupils often work in groups: this gives them the opportunity to learn to co-operate, to share, and to develop leadership skills. They also learn how to cope with personal problems as well as learning how to think, to make decisions, to analyze and evaluate, and to communicate effectively. The pupils learn from each other as well as from the teacher.

 Sometimes the pupils work in pairs; sometimes they work on individual tasks and assignments, and they can do this at their own speed. They also have some formal class teaching when this is appropriate. We encourage our pupils to use the library, and we teach them the skills they need in order to do this efficiently. An advanced pupil can do advanced work: it does not matter what age the child is. We expect our pupils to do their best, not their least, and we give them every encouragement to attain this goal.

 36.In the passage the author’s attitude towards “mixed-ability teaching” is ________.

 A) critical

 B) questioning

 C) approving

 D) objectiveC

 37.By “held back” (Line 1) the author means “________”

 A) made to remain in the same classes

 B) forced to study I the lower classes

 C) drawn to their studies

 D) prevented from advancingD

 38.The author argues that a teacher’s chief concern should be the development of the student’s ________.

 A) personal qualities and social skills

 B) total personality

 C) learning ability and communicative skills

 D) intellectual abilityB

 39.Which of the following is NOT MENTIONED in the third paragraph?

 A) Group work gives pupils the opportunity to learn to work together with other.

 B) Pupils also learn to develop their reasoning abilities.

 C) Group work provides pupils with the opportunity to learn to be capable organizers.

 D) Pupils also learn how to participate in teaching activities.D

 40.The author’s purpose in writing this passage is to ________.

 A) argue for teaching bright and not-so-bright pupils in the same class

 B) recommend pair work and group work for classroom activities

 C) offer advice on the proper use of the library

 D) emphasize the importance of appropriate formal classroom teachingA

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four Choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single time through the centre.

 41.The bridge was named ________ the hero who gave his life for the cause of the people.

 A) after

 B) with

 C) by

 D) fromA

 42.There were no tickets ________ for Friday’s performance.

 A) preferable

 B) considerable

 C) possible

 D) availableD

 43.It wasn’t such a good dinner ________ she had promised us.

 A) that

 B) which

 C) as

 D) whatC

 44.They decided to chase the cow away ________ it did more damage.

 A) unless

 B) until

 C) before

 D) althoughC

 45.________ student with a little common sense should be able to answer the question.

 A) Each

 B) Any

 C) Either

 D) OneB

 46.All ________ is a continuous supply of the basic necessities of life.

 A) what is needed

 B) for our needs

 C) the thing needed

 D) that is neededD

 47.________ with the size of the whole earth, the highest mountain does not seem high at all.

 A) When compared

 B) Compare

 C) While comparing

 D) ComparingA

 48.________ she first heard of the man referred to as a specialist.

 A) That was from Stephen

 B) It was Stephen whom

 C) It was from Stephen that

 D) It was Stephen thatC

 49.If these shoes are too big, ask the clerk to bring you a smaller ________.

 A) suit

 B) set

 C) one

 D) pairD

 50.Many new ________ will be opened up in the future for those with a university education.

 A) opportunities

 B) necessities

 C) realities

 D) probabilitiesA

 51.He must have had an accident, or he ________ then.

 A) would have been here

 B) had to be here

 C) should be here

 D) would be hereA

 52.It was essential that the application forms ________ back before the deadline (截止日期).

 A) must be sent

 B) would be sent

 C) be sent

 D) were sentC

 53.We ________ our breakfast when an old man came to the door.

 A) just have had

 B) have just had

 C) just had

 D) had just hadD

 54.The rain was heavy and ________ the land was flooded.

 A) consequently

 B) continuously

 C) constantly

 D) consistentlyA

 55.The children went there to watch the iron tower ________.

 A) to erect

 B) be erected

 C) erecting

 D) being erectedC

 56.The engine ________ smoke and steam.

 A) gives up

 B) gives in

 C) gives away

 D) gives offD

 57.The manager promised to keep me ________ of how our business was going on.

 A) to be informed

 B) on informing

 C) informed

 D) informingC

 58.Don’t ________ this news to the public until we give you the go-ahead.

 A) release

 B) relieve

 C) relate

 D) retainA

 59.She never laughed, ________ lost her temper.

 A) or she ever did

 B) nor did she ever

 C) or did she ever

 D) nor she ever didB

 60.The goals ________ he had fought all his life no longer seemed important to him.

 A) after which

 B) for which

 C) with which

 D) at whichB

 61.I should like to rent a house, modern, comfortable and ________ in a quiet neighborhood.

 A) all in all

 B) above all

 C) after all

 D) over allB

 62.________ we have finished the course, we shall start doing more revision work.

 A) For now

 B) Now that

 C) Ever since

 D) By nowB

 63.What you have done is ________ the doctor’s orders.

 A) attached to

 B) responsible to

 C) resistant to

 D) contrary toD

 64.John regretted ________ to the meeting last week.

 A) not going

 B) not to go

 C) not having been going

 D) not to be goingA

 65.They ________ in spite of the extremely difficult conditions.

 A) carried out

 B) carried off

 C) carried on

 D) carried forwardC

 66.Mrs. Brown is supposed ________ for Italy last week.

 A) to have left

 B) to be leaving

 C) to leave

 D) to have been leftA

 67.My camera can be ________ to take pictures in cloudy or sunny conditions.

 A) treated

 B) adjusted

 C) adopted

 D) remediedB

 68.A new technique ________, the yields as a whole increased by 20 per cent.

 A) wording out

 B) having worded out

 C) having been worded out

 D) to have been worded outC

 69.Children who are over-protected by their parents may become ________.

 A) hurt

 B) damaged

 C) spoiled

 D) harmedC

 70.When Mr. Jones gets old, he will ________ over his business to his son.

 A) take

 B) hand

 C) think

 D) getB

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 The United States is well-known for its network of major highways designed to help a driver get from one place to another in the shortest possible time. __71__ these wide modern Roads are generally __72__ and well maintained, with __73__ sharp curves and many straight __74__, a direct route is not always the most __75__ one. Large highways often pass __76__ scenic areas and interesting small towns. Furthermore, these highways generally __77__ large urban centres which means that they become crowded with __78__ traffic during rush hours, __79__ the “fast, direct” way becomes a very slow route.

 However, there is __80__ always another route to take __81__ you are not in a hurry. Not far from the __82__ new “superhighways”, there are often older, __83__ heavily traveled roads which go through the countryside. __84__ of these are good two-lane (双车道) roads; others are uneven roads __85__ through the country. These secondary routes may go up steep slopes, along high __86__, or down frightening hillsides to towns __87__ in deep valleys. Through these less direct routes, longer and slower, they generally go to places __88__ the air is clean and the scenery (风景) is beautiful, and the driver may have a __89__ to get a fresh, clean __90__ of the world.

 71.A) Although

 B) Because

 C) Since

 D) ThereforeA

 72.A) stable

 B) splendid

 C) smooth

 D) complicatedC

 73.A) little

 B) few

 C) much

 D) manyB

 74.A) selections

 B) separations

 C) series

 D) sectionsD

 75.A) terrible

 B) possible

 C) enjoyable

 D) profitableC

 76.A) to

 B) into

 C) over

 D) byD

 77.A) lead

 B) connect

 C) collect

 D) communicateB

 78.A) large

 B) fast

 C) light

 D) heavyD

 79.A) when

 B) for

 C) but

 D) thatA

 80.A) yet

 B) still

 C) almost

 D) quiteC

 81.A) unless

 B) if

 C) as

 D) sinceB

 82.A) relatively

 B) regularly

 C) respectively

 D) reasonablyA

 83.A) and

 B) less

 C) more

 D) orB

 84.A) All

 B) Several

 C) Lots

 D) orD

 85.A) driving

 B) crossing

 C) curving

 D) travelingC

 86.A) rocks

 B) cliffs

 C) roads

 D) pathsB

 87.A) lying

 B) laying

 C) laid

 D) liedA

 88.A) there

 B) when

 C) which

 D) whereD

 89.A) space

 B) period

 C) chance

 D) spotC

 90.A) view

 B) variety

 C) visit

 D) virtueC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition about What Would Happen If There Were No Power in three paragraphs. You are given the first sentence or part of the first sentence of each paragraph. Your part of the composition should be no less than 100 words, not including the words given. Remember to write clearly. You should write this composition on the Composition Sheet.

 1.Ever since early this century, electricity has become an essential part of our modern life.

 2.If there were no electric power.

 3.Therefore.

19901月四级参考答案

Part I


1.A

2.C

3.C

4.B

5.D

6.B

7.B

8.D

9.C

10.A

11.A

12.A

13.D

14.C

15.A

16.D

17.D

18.A

19.C

20.B


Part II


21.C

22.D

23.D

24.C

25.A

26.B

27.B

28.A

29.C

30.B

31.D

32.A

33.C

34.A

35.B

36.C

37.D

38.B

39.D

40.A


Part III


41.A

42.D

43.C

44.C

45.B

46.D

47.A

48.C

49.D

50.A

51.A

52.C

53.D

54.A

55.C

56.D

57.C

58.A

59.B

60.B

61.B

62.B

63.D

64.A

65.C

66.A

67.B

68.C

69.C

70.B


Part IV


71.A

72.C

73.B

74.D

75.C

76.D

77.B

78.D

79.A

80.C

81.B

82.A

83.B

84.D

85.C

86.B

87.A

88.D

89.C

90.C


19906月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a line through the centre.

Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. There fore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Every day.

 B) Every other day.

 C) Every week.

 D) Every other week.B

 2.A) Saturday morning.

 B) Saturday afternoon.

 C) Sunday morning.

 D) Sunday afternoon.D

 3.A) The unsmiling faces.

 B) The sun.

 C) The Londoners.

 D) The weather.D

 4.A) Maria’s friends don’t call her very often.

 B) Maria doesn’t like to talk on the phone with her friends.

 C) Maria likes to talk on the phone with her friends.

 D) Maria doesn’t have any friends.C

 5.A) The chemistry book.

 B) The English book.

 C) The math book.

 D) The history book.A

 6.A) Hold the phone.

 B) Make another call.

 C) Pay the manager a visit.

 D) Ask the woman to find Mr. White for him.B

 7.A) He will pay a visit to Prof. Wang.

 B) He will congratulate Prof. Wang.

 C) He is ready to help Prof. Wang.

 D) He will tell Prof. Wang the good news.C

 8.A) To take a bus.

 B) To make a phone call.

 C) To do shopping.

 D) To give them to the woman.A

 9.A) Listening to the radio.

 B) Reading a newspaper.

 C) Watching television.

 D) Watching a sports game.B

 10.A) He hasn’t seen any movie for a long time.

 B) The movie he saw was “Gone with the Wind”.

 C) It is one of the best movies he has ever seen.

 D) He likes seeing movies very much.C

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) Go and visit friends.

 B) Have a dinner together with friends.

 C) Go around making new friends.

 D) Play jokes on friends.D

 12.A) For seven hundred years.

 B) For several decades.

 C) For several hundred years.

 D) For seventy years.C

 13.A) A new means of transportation from London to Australia.

 B) A newly-published newspaper in London.

 C) A non-existent island in the Pacific.

 D) A new kind of Italian noodle.D

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) More than nine million.

 B) About half a million.

 C) More than five million.

 D) About two and a half million.A

 15.A) It is for students of the same community only.

 B) It only offers a two-year basic course.

 C) It only trains students to be office managers.

 D) It only accepts students rejected by universities.B

 16.A) One who is staying in that state as a writer.

 B) One whose home is in that state.

 C) One who has been in the army.

 D) One who has been in health services.B

 17.A) Community colleges in the U.S.

 B) The number of high school graduates.

 C) Higher education in the U.S.

 D) The difference between private and state universities.C

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) He had to get a job.

 B) He was afraid of failure.

 C) He wanted to join the Army.

 D) He wasn’t interested in studying.A

 19.A) Attending patients.

 B) Repairing machines.

 C) Driving taxis.

 D) Delivering letters.D

 20.A) She encouraged him.

 B) She was disappointed.

 C) She expressed doubt.

 D) She was shocked.A

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 reading passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 You are a German living in Berlin. One day you’re walking down the street, minding your own business, when suddenly a stranger approached with a smile on his face. After stopping you, he holds a small electronic device close to his face and speaks slowly into it, saying, in English: “Can you tell me where I can buy some sauerkraut?” What should you do? (a) Run away; (b) Call the police; or, (c) Listen closely for the device to say, in German, “Konnen Sie mir bitte sager, which Sauerkraut Kaufen Kann?”

 The most appropriate response would be (c) because the person in front of you is only a tourist trying to enjoy himself. The device is said to he the world’s first portable transistor—a hand-held microcomputer that—at the same time converts one spoken language into another.

 The four-pound battery-operated product is called the Voice, and it is the creation of Advanced Products and Technologies an American electronics company. When the Voice is introduced in the United States in late April—at a price of $1,500—it will be capable of converting spoken English into Italian, German, French and Spanish. The product comes with separate cartridges (盒式储存器) for each of the four languages, which can be changed when the user travels from one country to another. The item will be sold in Europe soon after the U.S. Introduction, with cartridges that covert Italian, German, French and Spanish into English.

 The Voice uses a microchip (微型集成块) and artificial Intelligence to translate Languages. It is started by voice command and produces voice output through a built-in speaker. Then the user makes a statement or asks a question, the Voice immediately repeats what has been said in another Language.

 21.The stranger holding the Voice seems to be ________.

 A) asking for some information

 B) greeting the German

 C) amusing himself

 D) practising his GermanC

 22.The German sentence “Konnen Sie Kann?” means ________.

 A) “Why don’t you ask the policeman.”

 B) “Would you listen closely for the device to say?”

 C) “Can you say it again, please?”

 D) “Can you tell me where I can buy some sauerkraut?”D

 23.The word “speaker” in the last paragraph refers to ________.

 A) the person who speaks to the device

 B) a component part of the Voice

 C) the person who speaks German

 D) the speech produced by the VoiceB

 24.Which of the following is NOT TRUE?

 A) The voice is an invention of an electronics company.

 B) The voice is a hand-held translator.

 C) The voice is new product in wide use.

 D) The voice is mainly a microcomputer.C

 25.The Voice can translate ________.

 A) from German into any of the other four languages mentioned

 B) from and into English by using the same cartridges

 C) between any two of the above-mentioned languages

 D) from English into any of the other four languages or the other way roundD

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Computers may one day turn night into day—with good old, natural sunlight.

 Colossal computer-controlled mirrors, thousands of feet across, may one day orbit the earth, reflecting sunlight onto a darkened United States.

 Some Scientists say that 16 of these mirrors, each about a half mile across, could aim their reflected light at one area on the earth that was about 200 miles by 300 miles. That much light would equal about 56 moons.

 The mirrors would be so high that they could catch the sun’s light as it was shining on the other side of the earth. The mirrors could orbit—thousands of miles high—at the same speed as the earth turns on its axis (). That way, the mirrors would always be over the same spot.

 The aluminum-coated (涂铝的), plastic mirrors could be folded up and packed into a spaceship, according to the scientists. Once released a few hundred miles in space, the mirrors, powered by a solar-powered engine, could mark the rest of the trip into space on their own.

 The scientists say that the computer-controlled mirrors could also be made to tilt (倾斜) slowly, so the reflected sunlight would sweep slowly along the surface of the earth. For example, as night fell, the mirrors could be tilted to light up Boston. Later on, as darkness spread slowly westward. Chicago, for example, then San Francisco could be lit up. The reflected sunlight would allow these cities to save up electricity. And in emergencies, such as power-failures, the mirrors could light up the affected area.

 What no one knows yet is what effect this artificial daytime would have on plants, animals, and humans. Would it confuse some animals and harm plants that are used to regular day-night cycles? The scientists recommend that studies be done to find out what had effects there might be.

 26.The word “colossal” in Line 3 most likely means ________.

 A) nuclear-powered

 B) orbiting

 C) giant

 D) spinningD

 27.Which of the following is NOT TRUE of the mirrors?

 A) They would be made of plastic and coated with aluminum.

 B) They could be launched directly into space.

 C) They would stay in the same position over the earth.

 D) They could reflect sunlight to a large area on the earth.B

 28.The reflected light should sweep slowly along the surface of the earth because the mirrors ________.

 A) would be operated by solar-powered engines

 B) would orbit thousands of miles high to catch the sun’s light

 C) could move around the earth at the same speed as the earth turns on its axis

 D) could be made to adjust their anglesD

 29.The purpose for turning night into day is to ________.

 A) confuse animals and plants

 B) light up more cities

 C) save energy and deal with emergencies

 D) enable people to work longer hoursC

 30.The writer of this passage ________.

 A) gives an objective account of the mirrors

 B) seems to be much worried about the effect of the mirrors

 C) is in favour of the wide use of the mirrors

 D) suggests that artificial daylight is harmful to living beingA

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 As supplier of most of the food we eat and of raw materials for many industrial processes, agriculture is clearly an important area of the economy. But the industrial performance of agriculture is even more important than this. For in nations where the productivity of farmers is low, most of the working population is needed to raise food and few people are available for production of investment goods or for other activities required for economic growth. Indeed, one of the factors related most closely to the per capital income (人均收入) of a nation is the fraction of its population engaged in farming. In the poorest nations of the world more than half of the population lives on farms. This compares sharply with less than 10 per cent in Western Europe and less than 4 per cent in the United States.

 In short, the course of economic development in general depends in a fundamental way on the performance of farmers. This performance in turn, depends on how agriculture is organized and on the economic environment, or market structure, within which it function. In the following pages the performance of American agriculture is examined. It is appropriate to begin with a conversation of its market structure.

 31.This passage is most probably ________.

 A) a news item

 B) part of an introduction of a book

 C) part of a lecture

 D) an advertisementB

 32.What is most important to agriculture is ________.

 A) the amount of food it produces

 B) the per capital income of farmers

 C) its industrial performance

 D) the production of investment goodsC

 33.The word “this” in Line 4 refers to ________.

 A) the provision of food and raw materials

 B) the productivity of farmers

 C) the production of investment goods

 D) the economy as a wholeA

 34.The performance of farmers essentially determines ________.

 A) the size of the working population

 B) the organization of agriculture

 C) the market structure

 D) the general development of economyD

 35.This passage will most probably be followed by a discussion of ________.

 A) the structure of American farming population

 B) the market structure of American agriculture

 C) the various functions of American agriculture

 D) the organization of American agricultureB

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 Before 1945, hardly anyone outside of New Mexico had ever heard of Alamogordo. In 1960 its population numbered 21,723. Ever since 1898, when the town had been built by the Southern Pacific Railroad, Alamogordo had been a lonely town. The land around it was largely desert, and largely empty.

 Because it was isolated and because the weather was almost always clear and peaceful, a spot of desert near Alamogordo was chosen as the last site for the first atomic bomb ever exploded. The secret name of the test was Zeo.

 At dawn on July 16, 1945, the atomic bomb was set off. Observers agreed that they had witnessed something unlike anything ever seen by men before, a huge, colorful fireball, more brilliant than the sun flashing as it rose for miles into the air. Never before had men released so much power at one time, nor had any nation ever possessed weapon as terrible and destructive as the atomic bomb.

 For several weeks, the test was kept secret. When an atomic bomb was dropped from an American plane on Hiroshima, Japan, newspapers and radio stations all over America told of the test of the bomb in New Mexico. Almost everybody was amazed to learn where the bomb had been made and tested; the deserts of the Southwest had hidden the secret well.

 When news of the atomic bomb and its destructiveness was announced, people all over the world wondered what other new weapons were being prepared in the New Mexico desert. Some people doubted that the secret of making atomic bombs could be kept from other countries. Some even doubted the wisdom of using so powerful a weapon. But no one doubted that a new kind of war—and a new kind of world—had begun at Alamogordo, one summer morning in 1945.

 36.What is the main topic of this passage?

 A) The secret of Alamogordo.

 B) A new kind of war.

 C) The destructive force of the first atomic bomb.

 D) The selection of the test site for the first atomic bomb.A

 37.Which of the following is the main reason for choosing Alamogordo as the test site?

 A) It always had an enjoyable climate.

 B) It was connected to other cities by a railway.

 C) Its location would hide the secret well.

 D) It was situated in southwestern New Mexico.C

 38.When was the atomic bomb dropped on Hiroshima?

 A) As soon as the secret was revealed

 B) At dawn on July 16, 1945

 C) Immediately after the test

 D) Several weeks after the testD

 39.After the first atomic bomb explosion, everybody agreed that ________.

 A) it was wise to choose Alamogordo as the test site

 B) man had entered the age of nuclear warfare

 C) it was not wise to use such a powerful weapon

 D) it was not possible to keep the technology of making atomic bombs secretB

 40.The tone of this passage is one of ________.

 A) anxiety

 B) satisfaction

 C) encouragement

 D) fearB

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four Choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single time through the centre.

 41.The boy’s father bought him a large toy train ________.

 A) which to play with

 B) to play with it

 C) to play with

 D) at which to playC

 42.________ you poor record in school, we think you should study harder.

 A) In view of

 B) In charge of

 C) In spite of

 D) In case ofA

 43.There are more than fifty proposals ________ at the conference.

 A) discussed

 B) to be discussed

 C) discussing

 D) having been discussedB

 44.Police have ________ to the public to come forward with any information which might help them in their inquiries.

 A) urged

 B) claimed

 C) appealed

 D) calledC

 45.I am sorry I ________ your glasses off the desk when I was wiping it.

 A) drew

 B) hit

 C) struck

 D) knockedD

 46.Why don’t you have a night out? It would take your ________ off your worries.

 A) cares

 B) heart

 C) head

 D) mindD

 47.Some hard plastics can be ________ metals in manufacturing machine parts.

 A) substituted for

 B) taken the place of

 C) replaced in

 D) given way toA

 48.His understanding made a deep impression ________ the young girl.

 A) in

 B) on

 C) for

 D) toB

 49.They have been trying to arrive at a practical solution ________ the problem.

 A) in

 B) to

 C) on

 D) withB

 50.In many American families, parents feel that children should make important decisions ________.

 A) to themselves

 B) on themselves

 C) of themselves

 D) by themselvesD

 51.There is hardly an environment on earth ________ some species of animal or other has not adapted successfully.

 A) to which

 B) wherever

 C) so that

 D) as toA

 52.Some metals are better conductors of electricity than others ________ means that the former have atom that contain more free electron than the latter.

 A) that

 B) this

 C) which

 D) itC

 53.A good friend is one who will ________ you when you are in trouble.

 A) stand for

 B) stand by

 C) stand up to

 D) stand up withB

 54.The speaker ________ his notes before the lecture.

 A) ran down

 B) ran into

 C) ran out

 D) ran overD

 55.I find this treatment very ________ to my health.

 A) advisable

 B) invaluable

 C) beneficial

 D) worthyC

 56.Don’t have him for a friend. He’s ________ a criminal.

 A) anything but

 B) but for

 C) rather than

 D) nothing butD

 57.Most doctors recognize that medicine is ________.

 A) an art as much it is a science

 B) as much an art as it is a science

 C) as an art as much it is science

 D) much an art as it is a scienceB

 58.As a ________ president, his views are treated with respect when he is interviewed.

 A) prior

 B) previous

 C) late

 D) formerD

 59.It is highly desirable that a new president ________ for this college.

 A) appointed

 B) be appointed

 C) is appointed

 D) has been appointedB

 60.The supply of electric power to Madrid and neighboring districts has had to be ________.

 A) weakened

 B) omitted

 C) restricted

 D) loweredC

 61.If the earth suddenly ________ spinning, we would all fly off it.

 A) had stopped

 B) stopped

 C) has stopped

 D) would stopB

 62.Is it advisable to ________ our body to the sunlight.

 A) reveal

 B) display

 C) expose

 D) showC

 63.He demanded that we explain what was happening, ________?

 A) hadn’t we

 B) didn’t we

 C) hadn’t he

 D) didn’t heD

 64.It was impossible to avoid ________ by the stormy weather.

 A) being much affected

 B) to be much affected

 C) having much affected

 D) to have been much affectedA

 65.________ in England. Anne Bradstreet both admired and imitated several English poets.

 A) Having born and educated

 B) To be born and educated

 C) Since born and educated

 D) Born and educatedD

 66.After searching for half an hour, she realized that her glasses ________ on the table all the time.

 A) had been lying

 B) had been lain

 C) have been lying

 D) were lainA

 67.They hurried there only to find the meeting cancelled. In fact, they ________ at all.

 A) might not have gone

 B) mustn’t have gone

 C) needn’t have gone

 D) wouldn’t have goneC

 68.The time has come ________ we can make extensive use of nuclear energy.

 A) when

 B) while

 C) as

 D) sinceA

 69.Hardly ________ the helicopter ________ when the waiting crowd ran toward it.

 A) had ..., landed

 B) has ..., landed

 C) did..., land

 D) was..., landingA

 70.________ the punishment was unjust. Helen accepted it without complaint.

 A) However

 B) So long as

 C) Even though

 D) SinceC

Part IV Close (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 An elderly woman died yesterday after being knocked down by a motorist. The driver had __71__ no attempt to brake (刹车). When a policeman asked him, a man of __69__, to read the number plate of a car parked on the __72__ side of the road, the man said this was __73__, because it was foggy. In fact, it was a sunny day, __74__ several attempts, get from __75__ distance of two metres, the man __76__ failed to read the number plate __77__. He said he had never needed glasses, though he had been __78__ in a similar accident the day before. The question __79__ fitness to drive comes up every time some, medical condition __80__ to an accident like this. Last week traffic accidents __81__ the death of two motorists, one of __82__ died as a result of blackouts (眩晕) while driving. The __83__, a man whose car hit a tree, had __84__ from blackouts for years. The second died __85__ his sports car crashed at 60 m.p.h. He had a brain disease which causes him to __86__ consciousness when he had a headache. With such cased __87__ mind, it is not surprising that __88__ prevention organizations are trying to __89__ the government to introduce stricter __90__ over drivers.

 71.A) done

 B) made

 C) given

 D) hadB

 72.A) contrary

 B) further

 C) across

 D) oppositeD

 73.A) uncertain

 B) unreal

 C) unfair

 D) untrueC

 74.A) After

 B) For

 C) With

 D) AtA

 75.A) any

 B) some

 C) a

 D) suchC

 76.A) too

 B) even

 C) yet

 D) stillD

 77.A) correctly

 B) definitely

 C) perfectly

 D) exactlyA

 78.A) linked

 B) associated

 C) involved

 D) combinedC

 79.A) to

 B) of

 C) in

 D) withB

 80.A) directs

 B) guides

 C) conducts

 D) readsD

 81.A) created

 B) resulted

 C) caused

 D) formedC

 82.A) whom

 B) these

 C) which

 D) thoseA

 83.A) former

 B) one

 C) other

 D) firstD

 84.A) troubled

 B) suffered

 C) undergone

 D) toleratedB

 85.A) when

 B) till

 C) where

 D) althoughA

 86.A) loose

 B) lost

 C) lose

 D) lockC

 87.A) on

 B) in

 C) at

 D) withinB

 88.A) accident

 B) accident’s

 C) accidents

 D) accidentalA

 89.A) enable

 B) affect

 C) drive

 D) persuadeD

 90.A) arrangements

 B) controls

 C) measures

 D) warningsB

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition on the title: Make Our City Greener, your composition should be based on the following outline:

 1.城市绿色的状况

 2.绿化的好处(如:清洁空气,美化城市,改善气候…)

 3.怎样才能实现绿化

 Your composition should be no less than 100 words. Write your composition on the Answer Sheet. Remember to write it clearly.

19906月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.B

2.D

3.D

4.C

5.A

6.B

7.C

8.A

9.B

10.C

11.D

12.C

13.D

14.A

15.B

16.B

17.C

18.A

19.D

20.A


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.C

22.D

23.B

24.C

25.D

26.D

27.B

28.D

29.C

30.A

31.B

32.C

33.A

34.D

35.B

36.A

37.C

38.D

39.B

40.B


Part III Vocabulary and Structure


41.C

42.A

43.B

44.C

45.D

46.D

47.A

48.B

49.B

50.D

51.A

52.C

53.B

54.D

55.C

56.D

57.B

58.D

59.B

60.C

61.B

62.C

63.D

64.A

65.D

66.A

67.C

68.A

69.A

70.C


Part IV Close


71.B

72.D

73.C

74.A

75.C

76.D

77.A

78.C

79.B

80.D

81.C

82.A

83.D

84.B

85.A

86.C

87.B

88.A

89.D

90.B



19911月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a line through the centre.

Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. There fore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Bill always comes on time.

 B) Bill will be on time.

 C) Bill will be late again.

 D) Bill won’t come.B

 2.A) They don’t know how to spend the money they have.

 B) They don’t know how to spend the next two weeks.

 C) They need money badly.

 D) They only have part-time jobs.C

 3.A) One.

 B) Two.

 C) Three.

 D) Four.B

 4.A) These figures are not correct.

 B) These figures are correct.

 C) These figures are probably correct.

 D) These figures are probably not correct.D

 5.A) In October.

 B) In April.

 C) She isn’t certain.

 D) Between April and October.C

 6.A) Jane speaks three languages.

 B) Jane speaks four languages.

 C) Jane speaks English only.

 D) Jane does not speak English.B

 7.A) The damage to the store.

 B) The possible harm to the people nearby.

 C) The punishment given to the crazy man.

 D) The reason for the crazy action.B

 8.A) She is going to give up biology.

 B) She spends half of her time on biology.

 C) To her, biology is difficult, but math is not.

 D) To her, math is even more difficult than biology.D

 9.A) There was a shower.

 B) There was a car accident.

 C) There was a fire.

 D) There was a heavy snow.A

 10.A) They are very rewarding.

 B) They are too easy.

 C) They are inexpensive.

 D) They are not worth the trouble.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 14 based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) The speaker’s friend.

 B) The speaker.

 C) The friend’s mother.

 D) The mother’s friend.A

 12.A) They are strangers.

 B) They are neighbours.

 C) They are friends.

 D) They are old schoolmates.A

 13.A) To return the shoes to the store.

 B) To pay the manager a visit.

 C) To buy more of the 12-dollar shoes.

 D) To complain about the price of the shoes.C

 14.A) 12 dollars

 B) 20 dollars

 C) Less than 12 dollars

 D) More than 12 dollarsD

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) Short and cool.

 B) Long and cool.

 C) Long and hot.

 D) Short and hot.D

 16.A) Because the price was too high.

 B) Because Alaska has an extremely cold winter.

 C) Because they thought Alaska was a useless land.

 D) Because the climatic difference there is too great.C

 17.A) No, only a few became rich.

 B) No, none became rich.

 C) No, very few people had actually found gold.

 D) Yes, hundreds of thousands of people became rich.A

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) She was driving along a country road.

 B) She was lying near a lonely road, trembling.

 C) She was lying in a hospital bed.

 D) She was telling an astonishing story to a doctor.B

 19.A) She fainted due to the effects of some drug.

 B) She was stopped by a policeman and treated rudely.

 C) She was attacked by robbers.

 D) She was stopped and forced to enter a flying saucer.D

 20.A) The women made up an astonishing story.

 B) The women had intended to leave her husband without a word.

 C) The women had been taken over a thousand miles away from her home.

 D) The women had been dishonest to her husband.C

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 The aim of the teacher is to get his pupils as quickly as possible over the period in which each printed symbol is looked at for its shape, and arrive at the stage when the pupil looks at words and phrases, for their meaning, almost without noticing the shapes of the separate letters.

 When a good reader is at work he does not look at letters, nor even at words, one by one however quickly; he takes in the meaning of two, three, or four words at a time, in a single moment. Watch carefully the eyes of a person who is reading, and it will be seen that they do not travel smoothly along the lines of print, but they move by jumps separated by very short stops. The eyes of a very good reader move quickly, taking long jumps and making very short halts (停顿); the eyes of a poor reader move more slowly, taking only short jumps and stopping longer at each halt. Sometimes, when he meets a difficulty, he even goes backwards to see again what has already been looked at once.

 The teacher’s task is therefore clear: it is to train his pupils to take in several words at a glance (one eye-jump’) and to remove the necessity for going backwards to read something a second time.

 This shows at once that letter-by-letter, or syllable-by-syllable, or word-by-word reading, with the finger pointing to the word, carefully fixing each one in turn, is wrong. It is wrong because such a method ties the pupil’s eyes down to a very short jump, and the aim is to train for the long jump. Moreover, a very short jump is too short to provide any meaning or sense; and it will be found that having struggled with three or four words separately, the pupil has to look at them again, all together and in one group, in order to get the meaning of the whole phrase.

 21.Which of the following is closest in meaning to the first paragraph?

 A) Pupils should be trained to reach quickly the stage of reading without having to concentrate on the separate symbols.

 B) Pupils should look at each printed symbol for its meaning as well as for its shape.

 C) Teachers should help their pupils avoid looking at the shape of the printed symbols.

 D) Teachers should tell their pupils the different stages of their study.A

 22.In a single moment, a good reader picks up ________.

 A) several words

 B) several phrases

 C) several sentences

 D) several linesA

 23.According to the passage, which of the following is FALSE?

 A) The eyes of a good reader make short halts and long jumps.

 B) The eyes of a bad reader take in the meaning of one word at a time.

 C) The eyes of a bad reader take only short jumps.

 D) The eyes of a good reader move steadily.D

 24.One may have to read something a second time if ________.

 A) there is enough time

 B) one reads too fast

 C) the passage is very long

 D) one reads word by wordD

 25.The main idea of the last paragraph is that ________.

 A) word-by-word reading is highly inefficient

 B) the pupil’s eyes should focus on groups of syllables instead of single syllables

 C) pupils have to move their eyes back and forth when reading

 D) finger pointing in reading helps the pupil concentrate on meaningA

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Television has changed the lifestyle of people in every Industrialized country in the world. In the United States, where sociologists have studied the effects, some interesting observations have been made.

 Television, although not essential, has become an important part of most people’s lives. It alters peoples’ ways of seeing the world; in many ways, it supports and sustains (维持) modern life. Television has become a baby-sitter, an introducer of conversations, the major transmitter of culture, a keeper of tradition. Yet when what can be seen on TV in one day is critically analyzed, it becomes evident that television is not a teacher but a sustainer; the poor quality of programming does not elevate (提高) people into greater understanding, but rather maintains and encourages the life as it exists.

 The primary reason for the lack of quality in American television is related to both the history of TV programming development and the economics of TV. Television in America began with the radio. Radio companies and their sponsors first experimented with television. Therefore, the close relationship which the advertisers had with radio programs became the system for American TV. Sponsors not only paid money for time within programs, but many actually produced the programs.

 Thus, in American society, television is primarily concerned with reflecting and attracting society rather than experimenting with new ideas. Advertisers want to attract the largest viewing audience possible, to do so requires that the programs be entertaining rather than educational, attractive rather than challenging.

 Television in America today remains, to a large extent, with the same organization and standards as it had thirty years ago. The hope for further development and true achievement toward improving society will require a change in the entire system.

 26.According to the author American television is poor in quality because ________.

 A) advertisers are interested in experimenting with new ideas

 B) it is still at an early stage of development, compared with the radio

 C) the programs have to be developed in the interests of the sponsors for economic reasons

 D) it is controlled by radio companiesC

 27.The second paragraph is mainly about ________.

 A) TV as the sustainer of American life

 B) TV as the major transmitter of culture

 C) the educational effect of TV on society

 D) the strong influence and the poor quality of American TVD

 28.In the author’s view American TV should ________.

 A) be critical but entertaining

 B) be creative and educational

 C) change with the development of society

 D) attract as many viewers as possibleC

 29.The author believes that television in the United States has become important to most people because ________.

 A) it promotes family unity

 B) it helps them develop their speaking ability

 C) it affects their life in many ways

 D) it challenges societyC

 30.The author’s attitude towards American television is ________.

 A) critical

 B) praising

 C) doubtful

 D) sympatheticA

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 “... We are not about to enter the Information Age but instead are rather well into it.” Present predictions are that by 1990, about thirty million jobs in the United States, or about thirty percent of the job market, will be computer-related. In 1980, only twenty-one percent of all United States high schools owned one or more computers for student use. In the fall of 1985, a new survey revealed that half of United States secondary schools have fifteen or more computers for student use. And now educational experts, administrators, and even the general public are demanding that all students become “computer literate (慢点…的).” “By the year 2000 knowledge of computers will be necessary in over eighty percent of all occupations. Soon those people not educated in computer use will be compared to those who are print illiterate today.”

 What is “computer literacy”? The term itself seems to imply soon extent of “knowing” about computers, but knowing what. The current opinion seems to be that this should include a general knowledge of what computers are, plus a little of their history and something of how they operate.

 Therefore, it is vital that educators everywhere take a careful look not only at what is being done, but also at what should be done in the field of computer education. Today most adults are capable of utilising a motor vehicle without the slightest knowledge of how the internal-combustion engine works. We effectively use all types of electrical equipment without being able to tell their histories or to explain how they work. Business people for years have made good use of typewriters and adding machines, yet few have ever known how to repair them. Why, then, attempt to teach computers by teaching how or why they work?

 Rather, we first must concentrate on teaching the effective use of the computer as the tool is.

 “Knowing how to use a computer is what’s going to be important, we don’t talk about ‘automobile literacy. ‘ We just get in our cars and drive them.”

 31.In 1990, the number of jobs having nothing to do with computers in the United States will be reduced to ________.

 A) 79 million

 B) 30 million

 C) 70 million

 D) 100 millionC

 32.The expression “Print illiterate” (Para. 1, Line 16) refers to ________.

 A) one who has never learnt printing

 B) one who is not computer literate

 C) one who has never learnt to read

 D) one who is not able to use a typewriterC

 33.The first paragraph is mainly about ________.

 A) recent predictions of computer-related jobs

 B) the wide use of computers in schools

 C) the urgency of computer education

 D) public interest in computersC

 34.According to the author, the effective way to spread the use of computers is to teach ________.

 A) what computers are

 B) how to use computers

 C) where computers can be used

 D) how computers workB

 35.Which of the following statements is FALSE?

 A) What to teach about computers should be reconsidered.

 B) Those who are not educated in computer use will find it difficult to get a job.

 C) Human society has already entered the Information Age.

 D) Those who want to use computers should know how computers operate.D

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 Editor:

 While a new school term is about to begin, perhaps we should reconsider the matter of examinations. In July, two writers (Letters to the Editor) praised the cancellation of exams because they believe “tests don’t tell the whole story.”

 As a teacher who has worked in four countries, I have had the experience that a student who earns good marks is generally a good student, and that a student’s final mark in a subject is usually a grade average of the year’s work. Of course there are exceptions, but they do not have the frequency that would give an unfair picture of a student’s ability.

 The simple fact is that proper class work, diligent exam studies and good marks are almost certain indicators of a student’s future performance. The opposite, almost certainly, incompetence.

 There is no acceptable substitute for competition and examination of quality. How can teachers and future officials determine what a student has learned and remembered? Should we simply take the student word for it? Any institution that “liberates” students from fair and formal exams is misguided, if not ignorant. And surely the “graduates” of such institutions will lack trustworthiness, not to mention being rejected by foreign universities for graduate or other studies.

 When all is said and done, I sense that a fear of failure and a fear of unpleasant comparison with others is at the bottom of most ban-exams (废除考试) talk. Excellence and quality fear nothing. On the contrary, they seek competition and desire the satisfaction of being the best.

 36.Which of the following will the author of this passage probably agree with?

 A) Tests are not effective in measuring the students’ abilities.

 B) Tests are an effective measure of the students’ abilities.

 C) Tests can only measure some of the students’ abilities.

 D) Tests may not be useful for measuring students’ abilities.B

 37.The two writers mentioned in the first paragraph ________.

 A) opposed judging students by the results of exams

 B) must have proposed other ways of testing students

 C) regarded exams as a way of punishing students

 D) seem to be worried about the poor marks of their studentsA

 38.According to the letter, a student’s final mark ________.

 A) is often encouraging

 B) often gives a fair picture of the year’s work

 C) often proves unreliable

 D) often tells whether he likes the subject of notB

 39.If a student graduated from a university which does not require exams he would ________.

 A) have to continue his studies

 B) have a feeling of failure

 C) be incompetent

 D) not be admitted by foreign institutionsD

 40.According to the letter, those who dislike the idea of examinations are probably afraid of ________.

 A) competing with other students

 B) being graded unfairly

 C) working too hard

 D) being dismissed from schoolA

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 41.It is not difficult to ________ the idea that machines may communicate information to us.

 A) admit

 B) receive

 C) accept

 D) convinceC

 42.I have not the least ________ of hurting your feelings.

 A) concept

 B) intention

 C) mind

 D) purposeB

 43.As the shortage of certain metals approaches, others must be found to take their ________.

 A) share

 B) place

 C) role

 D) shapeB

 44.The new power station is reported ________ within three years.

 A) to have completed

 B) to have been completed

 C) having Been completed

 D) to completeB

 45.Mary is in bed with a fever and she can’t hope to ________ the cold in a few day.

 A) get over

 B) get away

 C) get off

 D) get outA

 46.Although the weather was very had, the buses still ran on ________.

 A) list

 B) plan

 C) schedule

 D) arrangementC

 47.The situation today is obviously quite different from ________ it was only 50 years ago.

 A) what

 B) which

 C) when

 D) suchA

 48.Soon, Americans hope, the rains will return and ease the hardship ________ U.S. farmers.

 A) faced

 B) faces

 C) facing

 D) to faceC

 49.Ever since the family moved to the suburbs last year, they ________ better health.

 A) could have enjoyed

 B) have been enjoying

 C) had enjoyed

 D) are enjoyingB

 50.It is much easier to talk about social change than to ________.

 A) bring it on

 B) bring it about

 C) burning it up

 D) bring it outB

 51.Jane was hit on the head by the robber and was knocked ________.

 A) mindless

 B) unaware

 C) brainless

 D) unconsciousD

 52.He likes doing some reading at home to the cinema.

 A) than to go

 B) than going

 C) more than going

 D) rather than to goC

 53.________ neglecting our education, my father sent my brother and me to a summer school.

 A) Accused of

 B) Accusing of

 C) That he was accused of

 D) To be accused ofA

 54.I bought a new house last year, but I ________ my old house yet, so at the moment I have two houses.

 A) did not sell

 B) do not sell

 C) had not sold

 D) have not soldD

 55.She didn’t regret paying 200 dollars for the bookcase. As a matter or a fact, she would gladly have paid ________ for it.

 A) as much twice

 B) much as twice

 C) as twice much

 D) twice as muchD

 56.By the time you get to Beijing tomorrow, I ________ for Shanghai.

 A) am leaving

 B) should have left

 C) will leave

 D) have already leftB

 57.It was essential that all the necessary documents ________ to the president’s office being the end of this month.

 A) be handed in

 B) must be handed in

 C) should

 D) had been handed inA

 58.The car is quite ________ of petrol.

 A) economic

 B) economical

 C) saving

 D) sparingB

 59.The traffic was very heavy; otherwise I ________ here 50 minutes sooner.

 A) would be

 B) should be

 C) had been

 D) would have beenD

 60.________ his great wealth, he always remained a man of simple tastes.

 A) Except for

 B) With regard to

 C) Despite

 D) AlthoughC

 61.The socks were too small and it was only by ________ them that he managed to get them on.

 A) spreading

 B) extending

 C) lengthening

 D) stretchingD

 62.Language can be defined as a tool by which human beings ________ with one another.

 A) associate

 B) connect

 C) communicate

 D) correspondC

 63.As a small boy, he was slow ________ learning to read and write.

 A) on

 B) with

 C) in

 D) aboutC

 64.Tony was ________ a mile of the hotel when he ran out of petrol.

 A) within

 B) inside

 C) about

 D) offD

 65.It has been rather costly to install the machinery, but it will prove to be worth the money ________.

 A) in the long run

 B) in conclusion

 C) at long last

 D) at the endA

 66.I don’t know why he ________ in the middle of a sentence.

 A) broke off

 B) broke out

 C) broke through

 D) broke awayA

 67.I’m sorry Andy didn’t want to go to the conference. ________ willing to go we would have paid all his expenses.

 A) Being

 B) Was he

 C) He had been

 D) Had he beenD

 68.The minister was the person ________.

 A) whom the state dinner was given in honour

 B) for whom the state dinner was given honour

 C) whose honour the state dinner was given

 D) in whose honour the state dinner was givenD

 69.The young driver looked over the engine carefully lest it ________ on the way.

 A) goes wrong

 B) would go wrong

 C) went wrong

 D) should go wrongD

 70.John had been working hard and ________.

 A) so his brother had

 B) so had his brother

 C) so was his brother

 D) so his brother didB

Part IV Close (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Albert Einstein is said to have been asked by a student, “what finding helped you most when you were __71__ the theory of relativity?” Einstein replied without __72__ moment’s hesitation. “Finding how to __73__ about the problem.”

 The same __74__ is told about Sir Isaac Newton and __75__ other scientists. We have no proof __76__ any of these well-known conversations __77__ took place, but we are prepared to __78__ that they did, and, if so, that the __79__ was the same one Einstein gave, __80__ this is the “way scientists work __81__ science progresses.”

 Scientists usually work toward models of the process of structure they are studying. __82__ we have models of the structure __83__ the universe and of the atom, models of the process __84__ which the genetic (遗传的) pattern is passed from one building block of life to __85__ models of the economic system and __86__ on. Some models are mathematical, but a __87__ does not have to have equations (方程) or even diagrams; the __88__ requirement is no doubt that it __89__ an insight (洞察) into the relationships that determine __90__ something works as it does or how it is put together.

 71.A) designing

 B) inventing

 C) revealing

 D) developingD

 72.A) a

 B) the

 C) an

 D) someA

 73.A) know

 B) learn

 C) think

 D) argueC

 74.A) event

 B) news

 C) story

 D) informationC

 75.A) any

 B) more

 C) few

 D) severalD

 76.A) that

 B) since

 C) which

 D) asA

 77.A) naturally

 B) actually

 C) eventually

 D) regularlyB

 78.A) forget

 B) consider

 C) believe

 D) realizeC

 79.A) question

 B) answer

 C) conversation

 D) topicB

 80.A) although

 B) because

 C) unless

 D) onceB

 81.A) while

 B) or

 C) and

 D) butC

 82.A) Otherwise

 B) Nevertheless

 C) Still

 D) ThusD

 83.A) of

 B) in

 C) with

 D) overA

 84.A) for

 B) by

 C) on

 D) toB

 85.A) either

 B) other

 C) both

 D) anotherD

 86.A) so

 B) later

 C) further

 D) straightA

 87.A) structure

 B) pattern

 C) process

 D) modelD

 88.A) urgent

 B) important

 C) original

 D) unnecessaryB

 89.A) provide

 B) will provide

 C) provided

 D) is providedA

 90.A) when

 B) what

 C) why

 D) whetherC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition about “BicycleAnImportant Means of Transport in China”. You should base your composition on the following outline:

 1.为什么自行车在中国这样普及。

 2.和汽车比较。

 3.自行车在中国的前途。

 Your composition should be no less than 100 words. Remember to write your composition on the Composition Sheet.

Bicycle – An Important Means of Transport In China.

19911月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.B

2.C

3.B

4.D

5.C

6.B

7.B

8.D

9.A

10.A

11.A

12.A

13.C

14.D

15.D

16.C

17.A

18.B

19.D

20.C


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.A

22.A

23.D

24.D

25.A

26.C

27.D

28.C

29.C

30.A

31.C

32.C

33.C

34.B

35.D

36.B

37.A

38.B

39.D

40.A


Part III Vocabulary and Structure


41.C

42.B

43.B

44.B

45.A

46.C

47.A

48.C

49.B

50.B

51.D

52.C

53.A

54.D

55.D

56.B

57.A

58.B

59.D

60.C

61.D

62.C

63.C

64.D

65.A

66.A

67.D

68.D

69.D

70.B


Part IV Close


71.D

72.A

73.C

74.C

75.D

76.A

77.B

78.C

79.B

80.B

81.C

82.D

83.A

84.B

85.D

86.A

87.D

88.B

89.A

90.C


19916月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a line through the centre.

Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. There fore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) She paid 40.00 for the coat.

 B) Her husband presented it to her as a gift.

 C) She bought the coat on her fortieth birthday.

 D) Her friend sent it to her as a birthday gift.B

 2.A) To keep his old car and get a new one.

 B) To leave it in the garage to be repaired.

 C) To sell his car for a new one.

 D) To get his car repaired later.C

 3.A) Husband and wife.

 B) Father and daughter.

 C) Doctor and patient.

 D) Teacher and student.C

 4.A) The man went to the concert, but the woman didn’t.

 B) The woman went to the concert, but the man didn’t.

 C) The speakers did not go to the concert.

 D) Both speakers went to the concert.C

 5.A) An English textbook.

 B) A Chinese textbook.

 C) A chemistry hook.

 D) A history book.D

 6.A) The woman goes to school during the day and works at night.

 B) The woman has to work to support herself.

 C) The woman’s classes are not difficult.

 D) The woman studies at night.D

 7.A) She feels that he won’t accept anything.

 B) She’s sure he already has a pocket calculator.

 C) She thinks he has almost everything he wants.

 D) She’s afraid he wants more than she can afford.C

 8.A) Tom survived the accident.

 B) Tom was killed in the accident.

 C) Someone saved Tom’s life.

 D) It did little damage to Tom’s car.A

 9.A) The train is crowded.

 B) The train is late.

 C) The train is empty.

 D) The train is on time.B

 10.A) No, all the rooms are taken.

 B) Yes, there is a double room.

 C) Yes, there are some spare rooms.

 D) Yes, there is a single room.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) Her husband had got a higher position.

 B) Her husband had lost his job.

 C) She wanted to have a cleaner house.

 D) She wanted to move to New York.A

 12.A) His telephone went out of order.

 B) The buyers had to leave soon.

 C) He began to work at 8 a.m.

 D) He had made an appointment with her for 8 a.m.B

 13.A) To return the shoes to the store.

 B) To pay the manager a visit.

 C) To buy more of the 12-dollar shoes.

 D) To complain about the price of the shoes.D

 14.A) 12 dollars

 B) 20 dollars

 C) Less than 12 dollars

 D) More than 12 dollarsB

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) Short and cool.

 B) Long and cool.

 C) Long and hot.

 D) Short and hot.B

 16.A) Because the price was too high.

 B) Because Alaska has an extremely cold winter.

 C) Because they thought Alaska was a useless land.

 D) Because the climatic difference there is too great.C

 17.A) No, only a few became rich.

 B) No, none became rich.

 C) No, very few people had actually found gold.

 D) Yes, hundreds of thousands of people became rich.A

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) She was driving along a country road.

 B) She was lying near a lonely road, trembling.

 C) She was lying in a hospital bed.

 D) She was telling an astonishing story to a doctor.D

 19.A) She fainted due to the effects of some drug.

 B) She was stopped by a policeman and treated rudely.

 C) She was attacked by robbers.

 D) She was stopped and forced to enter a flying saucer.A

 20.A) The women made up an astonishing story.

 B) The women had intended to leave her husband without a word.

 C) The women had been taken over a thousand miles away from her home.

 D) The women had been dishonest to her husband.D

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 reading passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 The aim of the teacher is to get his pupils as quickly as possible over the period in which each printed symbol is looked at for its shape, and arrive at the stage when the pupil looks at words and phrases, for their meaning, almost without noticing the shapes of the separate letters.

 When a good reader is at work he does not look at letters, nor even at words, one by one, however, he quickly takes in the meaning of two, three, or four words at a time, in a single moment. Watch carefully the eyes of a person who is reading, and it will be seen that they do not travel smoothly along the lines of print, but they move by jumps separated by very short stops. The eyes of a very good reader move quickly, taking long jumps and making very short halts (停顿); the eyes of a poor reader move more slowly, taking only short jumps and stopping longer at each halt. Sometimes, when he meets a difficulty, he even goes backwards to see again what has already been looked at once.

 The teacher’s task is therefore clear: it is to train his pupils to take in several words at a glance (one eye-jump’) and to remove the necessity for going backwards to read something a second time.

 This shows at once that letter-by-letter, or syllable-by-syllable, or word-by-word reading, with the finger pointing to the word, carefully fixing each one in turn, is wrong. It is wrong because such a method ties the pupil’s eyes down to a very short jump, and the aim is to train for the long jump. Moreover, a very short jump is too short to provide any meaning or sense; and it will be found that having struggled with three or four words separately, the pupil has to look at them again, all together and in one group, in order to get the meaning of the whole phrase.

 21.Which of the following is closest in meaning to the first paragraph?

 A) Pupils should be trained to reach quickly the stage of reading without having to concentrate on the separate symbols.

 B) Pupils should look at each printed symbol for its meaning as well as for its shape.

 C) Teachers should help their pupils avoid looking at the shape of the printed symbols.

 D) Teachers should tell their pupils the different stages of their study.B

 22.In a single moment, a good reader picks up ________.

 A) several words

 B) several phrases

 C) several sentences

 D) several linesD

 23.Teachers encourage the use of dictionaries so that ________.

 A) students will be able to express their ideas more freely

 B) teachers will have less trouble in correcting mistakes

 C) students will have more confidence in writing

 D) students will learn to be independent of teachersA

 24.The writer seems to think that the teacher’s judgement on that sensitive piece of writing is ________.

 A) reasonable

 B) unfair

 C) foolish

 D) carelessB

 25.The major point discussed in the passage is ________.

 A) the importance of developing writing skills

 B) the complexities of spelling

 C) the correct way of marking compositions

 D) the relationship between spelling and the content of a compositionD

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 A breakthrough (突破) in the provision of energy from the sun for the European Economic Community (EEC) could be brought forward by up to two decades, if a modest increase could be provided in the EEC’s research effort in this field, according to the senior EEC scientists engaged in experiments in solar energy at EEC’s scientific laboratories at Ispra, near Milan.

 The senior West German scientist in charge of the Community’s solar energy programme, Mr. Joachim Gretz, told journalists that at present levels of research spending it was most unlikely that solar energy would provide as much as three per cent of the Community’s energy requirements even after the year 2000. But he said that with a modest increase in the present< sums, devoted by the EEC to this work it was possible that the breakthrough could be achieved by the end of the next decade.

 Mr. Gretz calculates that if solar energy only provided three per cent of the EEC’s needs, this could still produce a saving of about a billion pounds in the present bill for imported energy each year. And he believes that with the possibility of utilizing more advanced technology in this field it might be possible to satisfy a much bigger share of the Community’s future energy needs.

 At present the EEC spends about $2.6 millions a year on solar research at Ispra, one of the EEC’s official joint research centres, and another $3 millions a year in indirect research with universities and other independent bodies.

 26.The phrase “be brought forward” (Line 2, Para. 1) most probably means ________.

 A) be expected

 B) be completed

 C) be advanced

 D) be introducedC

 27.Some scientists believe that a breakthrough in the use of solar energy depends on ________.

 A) sufficient funding

 B) further experiments

 C) advanced technology

 D) well-equipped laboratoriesA

 28.According to Mr. Gretz, the present sum of money will enable the scientists to provide ________.

 A) more than 3 ~, 6 of the EEC’s needs after the year 2000

 B) only 3% of the EEC’s needs before the year 2000

 C) less than 3% of the EEC’s needs before the year 2000

 D) 3% of the EEC’s needs after the year 2000C

 29.Which of the following is NOT true according to the passage?

 A) The EEC spends one billion pounds on imported energy each year.

 B) At the present level of research spending, it is difficult to make any significant progress in the provision of energy from the sun.

 C) The desired breakthrough could be obtained by the end of the next decade if investment were increased.

 D) The total yearly spending of the EEC on solar energy research amounted to almost 6 million.A

 30.The application of advanced technology to research in solar energy ________.

 A) would lead to a big increase in research funding

 B) would make it unnecessary to import oil

 C) would make it possible to meet the future energy needs of the EEC

 D) would provide a much greater proportion of the Community’s future energy needsD

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Just seven years ago, the Jarvik-7 artificial heart was being cheered as the model of human creativeness. The sight of Barney Clark-alive and conscious after trading his diseased heart for a metal-and-plastic pump-convinced the press, the public and many doctors that the future had arrived. It hadn’t. After monitoring production of the Jarvik-7, and reviewing its effects on the 150 or so patients (most of whom got the device as a temporary measure) the U.S. Food and Drug Administration concluded that the machine was doing more to endanger lives than to save them. Last week the agency cancelled its earlier approval, effectively banning (禁止) the device.

 The recall may hurt Symbion Inc., maker of the Jarvik-7, but it won’t end the request for an artificial heart. One problem with the banned model is that the tubes connecting it to an external power source created a passage for infection. Inventors are now working on new devices that would be fully placed, along with a tiny power pack, in the patient’s chest. The first sample products aren’t expected for another 10 or 20 years: But some people are already worrying that they’ll work-and that America’s overextended health-care programs will lose a precious $2.5 billion to $5 billion a year providing them for a relatively few dying patients. If such expenditures (开支) cut into funding for more basic care, the net effect could actually be a decline in the nation’s health.

 31.According to the passage the Jarvik-7 artificial heart proved to be ________.

 A) a technical failure

 B) a technical wonder

 C) a good life-saver

 D) an effective means to treat heart diseaseA

 32.From the passage we know that Symbion Inc ________.

 A) has been banned by the government from producing artificial hearts

 B) will review the effects of artificial hearts before designing new models

 C) may continue to work on new models of reliable artificial hearts

 D) can make new models of artificial hearts available on the market in 10 to 20 yearsC

 33.The new models of artificial hearts are expected ________.

 A) to have a working life of 10 or 20 years

 B) to be set fully in the patient’s chest

 C) to be equipped with an external power source

 D) to create a new passage for infectionB

 34.The word “them” in Line 7, Para. 2 refers to ________.

 A) doctors who treat heart diseases

 B) makers of artificial hearts

 C) America’s health-care programs

 D) new models of artificial heartsD

 35.Some people feel that ________.

 A) artificial hearts are seldom effective

 B) the country should not spend so much money on artificial hearts

 C) the country is not spending enough money on artificial hearts

 D) America’s health-care programs are not doing enough for the nation’s healthB

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 A raped means of long-distance transportation became a necessity for the United States as settlement (新拓居地) spread ever farther westward. The early trains were impractical curiosities, and for a long time the railroad companies met with troublesome mechanical problems. The most serious ones were the construction of rails able to bear the load, and the development of a safe, effective stopping system. Once these were solved, the railroad was established as the best means of land transportation. By 1860 there were thousands of miles of railroads crossing the eastern mountain ranges and reaching westward to the Mississippi. There were also regional southern and western lines.

 The high point in railroad building came with the construction of the first transcontinental system. In 1862 Congress authorized two western railroad companies to build lines from Nebraska westward and from California eastward to a meeting point, so as to complete a transcontinental crossing linking the Atlantic seaboard with the Pacific. The Government helped the railroads generously with money and land. Actual work on this project began four years later. The Central Pacific Company, starting from California, used Chinese labor, while the Union Pacific employed crews of Irish laborers. The two groups worked at remarkable speed, each trying to cover a greater distance than the other. In 1869 they met at a place called Promontory in what is now the state of Utah. Many visitors came there for the great occasion. There were joyous celebrations all over the country, with parades and the ringing of church bells to honor the great achievement.

 The railroad was very important in encouraging westward movement. It also helped build up industry and farming by moving raw materials and by distributing products rapidly to distant markets. In linking towns and people to one another it helped unify the United States.

 36.The major problems with America’s railroad system in the mid 19th century lay in ________.

 A) poor quality rails and unreliable stopping systems

 B) lack of financial support for development

 C) limited railroad lines

 D) lack of a transcontinental railroadA

 37.The building of the first transcontinental system ________.

 A) brought about a rapid growth of industry and farming in the west

 B) attracted many visitors to the construction sites

 C) attracted laborers from Europe

 D) encouraged people to travel all over the countyA

 38.The best title for this passage would be ________.

 A) Settlements Spread Westward

 B) The Coast-to-Coast Railroad: A Vital Link

 C) American Railroad History

 D) The Importance of Trains in the American EconomyB

 39.The construction of the transcontinental railroad took ________.

 A) 9 years

 B) 7 years

 C) 4 years

 D) 3 yearsD

 40.What most likely made people think’ about a transcontinental railroad?

 A) The possibility of government support for such a task.

 B) The need to explore Utah.

 C) The need to connect the east coast with the west.

 D) The need to del, clop the railroad industry in the west.C

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four Choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single time through the centre.

 41.We had a party last month, and it was a lot of fun, so let’s have ________ one this month.

 A) another

 B) more

 C) the other

 D) otherA

 42.It was difficult to guess what her ________ to the news would be.

 A) impression

 B) reaction

 C) comment

 D) opinionB

 43.I decided to go to the library as soon as I ________.

 A) finish what I did

 B) finished what I did

 C) would finish what I was doing

 D) finished what I was doingD

 44.There were some ________ flowers on the table.

 A) artificial

 B) unnatural

 C) false

 D) unrealA

 45.We are interested in the weather because it ________ us so directly-what we wear, what we do, and even how we feel.

 A) benefits

 B) affects

 C) guides

 D) effectsB

 46.Will all those ________ the proposal raise their hands?

 A) in relation to

 B) in contrast to

 C) in excess of

 D) in favor ofD

 47.Children are very curious ________.

 A) at heart

 B) in person

 C) on purpose

 D) by natureD

 48.The match was cancelled because most of the members ________ a match without a standard court.

 A) objected to having

 B) were objected to have

 C) objected to have

 D) were objected to havingA

 49.The teacher doesn’t permit ________ in class.

 A) smoke

 B) to smoke

 C) smoking

 D) to have a smokeC

 50.I like watching TV ________ to the cinema.

 A) more than to go

 B) than going

 C) more than going

 D) rather than to goC

 51.I appreciate ________ to your home.

 A) to be invited

 B) to have invited

 C) having invited

 D) being invitedD

 52.I hope my teacher will take my recent illness into ________ when judging my examination.

 A) regard

 B) counting

 C) account

 D) observationC

 53.You ________ all those calculations! We have a computer to do that sort of thing.

 A) needn’t have done

 B) must not have done

 C) shouldn’t have done

 D) can not have cloneA

 54.Important people don’t often have much free time as their work ________ all their time.

 A) takes away

 B) takes over

 C) takes up

 D) takes inC

 55.When I was very young, I was terribly frightened of school, but I soon ________ it.

 A) got off

 B) got across

 C) got away

 D) got overD

 56.Many people complain of the rapid ________ of modern life.

 A) rate

 B) speed

 C) pace

 D) growthC

 57.San Francisco is usually cool in the summer, but Los Angeles ________.

 A) is rarely

 B) rarely is

 C) hardly is

 D) is scarcelyB

 58.The speaker, ________ for her splendid speeches, was warmly received by the audience.

 A) having known

 B) being known

 C) knowing

 D) knownD

 59.American women were ________ the right to vote until 1920 after many years of hard struggle.

 A) ignored

 B) neglected

 C) refused

 D) deniedD

 60.I couldn’t find ________, and so I took this one.

 A) a large enough coat

 B) an enough large coat

 C) a large coat enough

 D) a coat enough largeA

 61.I always ________ what I have said.

 A) get to

 B) hold to

 C) lead to

 D) see toB

 62.No sooner had we reached the top of the hill ________ we all sat down to rest.

 A) when

 B) then

 C) than

 D) untilC

 63.Evidence came up ________ specific speech sounds are recognized by babies as young as 6 months old.

 A) what

 B) which

 C) that

 D) whoseC

 64.He moved away from his parents, and missed them ________ enjoy the exciting life in New York.

 A) too much to

 B) enough to

 C) very much to

 D) much so as toA

 65.He was ________ of having asked such a silly question.

 A) sorry

 B) guilty

 C) ashamed

 D) miserableC

 66.The last time we had a family reunion was ________ my brother’s wedding ceremony four years ago.

 A) in

 B) at

 C) during

 D) overB

 67.What ________ would happen if the director knew you felt that way?

 A) do you suppose

 B) you suppose

 C) will you suppose

 D) you would supposeA

 68.________ the advances of science, the discomforts of old age will no doubt always be with us.

 A) As for

 B) Besides

 C) Except

 D) DespiteD

 69.How close parents are to their children ________ a strong influence on the character of the children.

 A) have

 B) has

 C) having

 D) to haveB

 70.He ________ when the bus came to a sudden stop.

 A) was almost hurt

 B) was hurt himself

 C) was to hurt himself

 D) was hurting himselfA

Part IV Close (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Geography is the study of the relationship between people and the land. Geographers (地理学家) compare and contrast __71__ places on the earth. But they also __72__ beyond the individual places and consider the earth as a __73__ The word geography __74__ from two Greek words, ge, the Greek word for “earth” and graphein, __75__ means “to write.” The English word geography means “to describe the earth.” __76__ geography books focus on a small area __77__ a town or city. Others deal with a state, a region, a nation, or an __78__ continent. Many geography books deal with the whole earth. Another __79__ to divide the study of __80__ is to distinguish between physical geography and cultural geography. The former focuses on the natural world; the __81__ starts with human beings and __82__ how human beings and their environment act __83__ each other. But when geography is considered as a single subject, __84__ branch can neglect the other. A geographer might be described __85__ one who observes, records, and explains the __86__ between places. If all places __87__ alike, there would be little need for geographers. We know, however, __88__ no two places are exactly the same. Geography, __89__, is a point of view, a special way of __90__ at places.

 71.A) similar

 B) various

 C) distant

 D) famousB

 72.A) pass

 B) reach

 C) go

 D) setC

 73.A) whole

 B) unit

 C) part

 D) totalA

 74.A) falls

 B) removes

 C) results

 D) comesD

 75.A) what

 B) that

 C) which

 D) itC

 76.A) Some

 B) Many

 C) Most

 D) FewA

 77.A) outside

 B) except

 C) as

 D) likeD

 78.A) extensive

 B) entire

 C) overall

 D) enormousB

 79.A) way

 B) means

 C) habit

 D) techniqueA

 80.A) world

 B) earth

 C) geography

 D) globeC

 81.A) second

 B) later

 C) next

 D) latterD

 82.A) learns

 B) studies

 C) realises

 D) understandsB

 83.A) upon

 B) for

 C) as

 D) toA

 84.A) neither

 B) either

 C) one

 D) eachA

 85.A) for

 B) to

 C) as

 D) byC

 86.A) exceptions

 B) sameness

 C) differences

 D) divisionsC

 87.A) being

 B) are

 C) be

 D) wereD

 88.A) although

 B) whether

 C) since

 D) thatD

 89.A) still

 B) then

 C) nevertheless

 D) moreoverB

 90.A) working

 B) looking

 C) arriving

 D) gettingB

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition of no less than 100 words on Changes in People’s Diet. Study the following table carefully and your composition must be based on the information given in the table. Write three paragraphs to:

 1.state the changes in people’s diet (饮食) in the past five years;

 2.give possible reasons for the changes;

 3.draw your own conclusions;

 4.you should quote as few figures as possible.


FoodYear

1986

1987

1988

1989

1990

Grain

49%

47%

46.5%

45%

45%

Milk

10%

11%

11%

12%

13%

Meet

17%

20%

22.5%

23%

21%

Fruitandvegetables

24%

22%

20%

20%

21%

Total

100%

100%

100%

100%

100%


19916月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.B

2.C

3.C

4.C

5.D

6.D

7.C

8.A

9.B

10.A

11.A

12.B

13.D

14.B

15.B

16.C

17.A

18.D

19.A

20.D


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.B

22.D

23.A

24.B

25.D

26.C

27.A

28.C

29.A

30.D

31.A

32.C

33.B

34.D

35.B

36.A

37.A

38.B

39.D

40.C


Part III Vocabulary and Structure


41.A

42.B

43.D

44.A

45.B

46.D

47.D

48.A

49.C

50.C

51.D

52.C

53.A

54.C

55.D

56.C

57.B

58.D

59.D

60.A

61.B

62.C

63.C

64.A

65.C

66.B

67.A

68.D

69.B

70.A


Part IV Close


71.B

72.C

73.A

74.D

75.C

76.A

77.D

78.B

79.A

80.C

81.D

82.B

83.A

84.A

85.C

86.C

87.D

88.D

89.B

90.B


Part V Writing ()

19921月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversation s. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A)B)C), and D)and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Give the woman what she wants.

 B) Help the woman in a moment.

 C) Tell the woman what he is doing.

 D) Stop his work immediately.B

 2.A) He wants the woman to call him again.

 B) He will call the woman in two weeks.

 C) He wants her to fix the watch within one week.

 D) He will fix the woman’s watch.D

 3.A) To see the doctor.

 B) To go to a party.

 C) To make an appointment.

 D) To look after her children.A

 4.A) She is eager to know what the present is.

 B) She is not anxious to know what it is.

 C) She doesn’t know what she is asked to wait for.

 D) She really doesn’t care about the present.A

 5.A) The program was on too late.

 B) His TV set was out of order.

 C) He doesn’t think much of the President.

 D) He had a late class.D

 6.A) The teacher postponed the conference.

 B) There won’t be a test this afternoon.

 C) The students will be attending the conference.

 D) The students took a science test this afternoon.B

 7.A) She thinks his lectures are boring.

 B) She thinks his tests are too long.

 C) She doesn’t like his choice of test questions.

 D) She doesn’t think he prepares his lectures well enough.C

 8.A) She thinks he talks too much.

 B) She thinks he is simple-minded.

 C) She thinks he is always very frank.

 D) She thinks he doesn’t like speaking.C

 9.A) On foot.

 B) By bus.

 C) By car.

 D) By bike.B

 10.A) 7.

 B) 9.

 C) 11.

 D) 15.B

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A)B)C), and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) They are in a good temper.

 B) They like music.

 C) They want to say something.

 D) They sing for enjoyment.C

 12.A) They make some signs.

 B) They keep from other birds.

 C) They keep silent.

 D) They hide themselves.A

 13.A) It spreads out its tail.

 B) It dances.

 C) It uses shells and flowers to make a garden.

 D) It flies high in the sky.C

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) They hung meat in the sun.

 B) They cooked meat with salt.

 C) They preserved meat with ice.

 D) They kept meat underground.A

 15.A) He began to use chemicals.

 B) He preserved food with sugar.

 C) He kept food in cans.

 D) He sealed food in jars.D

 16.A) Development of the canning industry.

 B) Food processing and chemicals.

 C) Food industry in different countries.

 D) Preserving food-past and present.D

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) In the United states.

 B) At Sutter’s Fort.

 C) In Sweden.

 D) In Switzerland.D

 18.A) He left the farm.

 B) He kept it a secret to himself.

 C) He told Sutter about it.

 D) He tried to find more gold.C

 19.A) Because too many people came there for gold.

 B) Because Sutter was not good at farming.

 C) Because the army occupied it.

 D) Because Sutter gave up farming.A

 20.A) It made him a very rich man.

 B) It brought him great misfortune.

 C) It had little effect on his life.

 D) It cause the death of his wife.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A)B)C), and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Time was—and not so many years ago, either—when the average citizen took a pretty dim view of banks and Banking. That this was so, it should be said, was to no small extent the fault of banks and bankers themselves. Banks used to be—and a few still are—forbidding structures. Behind the little barred windows were, more often than not, elderly gentlemen whose expression of friendliness reflected the size of the customer’s account, and nothing less than a few hundred thousand in the bank could have inspired the suggestion of a smile.

 And yet the average bank for many year was, to the average citizen, a fearful, if necessary, instrument for dealing with business—usually big business. But somewhere in the past quarter century, banks Began to grow human, even pleasant, and started to attract the little man. It is possible that this movement began in medium-sized towns, or in small towns where people know each other by their first names, and spread to big towns. At any rate, the results have been remarkable.

 The movement to “humanize” hanks, of course, received a big push during the war, when more and more women were employed to do work previously performed by men. Also more and more “little” people found themselves in need of personal loans, as taxes became heavier and as the practice of installment (分期付款) buying broke down the previously long—held concept that there was something almost morally wrong about being in debt. All sorts of people began to discover that the intelligent use of credit (信贷) could be extremely helpful.

 21.The author believes that the unfriendly atmosphere in banks many years ago was chiefly due to ________.

 A) the outer appearance of bank buildings

 B) unfriendliness of customers toward banks

 C) economic pressure of the time

 D) the attitude of hankersD

 22.The banks of many years ago showed interest only in ________.

 A) regular visitors

 B) rich customers

 C) friendly businessmen

 D) elderly gentlemenB

 23.When did banks begin to grow human?

 A) Sometime before the war.

 B) A few years ago.

 C) During the war.

 D) In the last century.A

 24.What helped to push the “humanization” of banks?

 A) More and more “little” people became customers of banks.

 B) The elderly gentlemen in banks were replaced by women.

 C) More banks were set up in small and medium-sized towns.

 D) The size of the customer’s account was greatly increased.B

 25.Average People seldom borrowed money from bank in the bank because ________.

 A) the bank buildings looked forbidding

 B) they were comparatively rich before the war

 C) they thought it was not proper to be in debt

 D) they rarely spent more than they could earnC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Last summer, Transportation Secretary Elizabeth Dole announced a new rule: Unless states representing two-thirds of the country’s population pass compulsory (强制性的) seat-belt-use laws by April 1989, all new vehicles will have to be fitted with air bags or automatic seat belts.

 The rule wouldn’t have been necessary but for one simple fact. Even though seat belts could prevent nearly half of the deaths in fatal car accidents, 85 percent of the population simply won’t wear them.

 Why not? Behavioral engineers have found that there are all sorts of reasons—usually unstated. These are some of the most popular. It’s safer to be thrown from a car man trapped. According to E. Scott Geller, that’s a faulty argument. “In fact”, he says, “being thrown from a car is twenty-five times more dangerous than being trapped”.

 It won’t happen to me; I’m a good driver. But what about the other person who may be a terrible driver? The data show that the average incidence (发生率) for all accidents in one per driver every 10 years.

 My car will end up underwater or on fire, and I won’t be able to get out. According to the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), only 0.5 percent of all injury-producing accidents occur under these conditions. “If you’re wearing a belt, you’ve got a better chance of being conscious and not having your legs broken—distinct advantages in getting out of a dangerous situation”.

 I’m only going a few blocks. Yet 80 percent of accidents happen at speeds or less that 25 miles per hour, 75 percent happen within 25 miles of home.

 26.Before 1989, in the United States ________.

 A) the use of seat belts was not compulsory for the majority of the population

 B) a new law requiring the use of seat belts had just been passed

 C) people had to choose between the use of seat belts or the use of air bags

 D) almost fifty percent of the people involved in car accidents were saved by seat BeltsA

 27.The word “trapped” (Para. 3, Line 3) means to be ________.

 A) held up in a traffic jam

 B) confined in the car

 C) caught in an accident

 D) pulled into a carB

 28.One of the reasons why many drivers refuse to wear seat belts is because ________.

 A) they don’t think that it is comfortable to wear seat belts

 B) they don’t believe that an accident involving a terrible driver is highly probable

 C) they believe that no danger is involved in just driving a few blocks

 D) they think that few drivers are willing to wear seat beltsC

 29.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) seat belts should be replaced by air bags

 B) eighty-five percent of all drivers are likely to Break traffic rules

 C) all drivers, whether good or bad, are liable to have an accident at one time or another

 D) wearing seat belts will get drivers out of dangerous situationsC

 30.The purpose of the writer in writing this passage is ________.

 A) to urge the government to pass the law sooner

 B) to tell how dangerous car-driving can be

 C) to criticise those who refuse to use seat belts

 D) to prove the necessity of the new ruleB

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 For well over 2000 years the world’s great religions have taught the virtues of a trusting heart. Now there is another reason to merit the wisdom of the ages: scientific evidence indicates that those with trusting hearts will live longer, healthier lives.

 As a result of the work published in the 1970s by two pioneering heart specialists, Meyer Friedman and Ray H. Rosenman, nearly every American is aware that blood Type. A people are impatient, and easily moved to hostility and anger. Many have come to believe that Type As are at a much higher risk of suffering heart attack or dying of heart disease than others.

 The driving force behind hostility is a cynical (愤世嫉俗) mistrust of others. If we expect others to mistreat us, we are seldom disappointed. This generates anger and leads us to respond with hostility.

 The most characteristic attitude of a cynic is being suspicious of the motives of people he doesn’t know. Imagine you are waiting for an elevator and it stops two floors above for longer than usual. How inconsiderate (不替别人着想的) You think. In a few seconds, you have drawn hostile conclusions about unseen people and their motives.

 Meanwhile, your cynical mistrust is leading to noticeable physical consequences. Your voice rises. The rate and depth of your breathing increases. Your heart is beating faster and harder, and the muscles of your arms and legs become tight. You feel “charged up”, ready for action.

 If you frequently experience these feelings, you may be at increased risk of developing serious health problems. Anger can add to the risk of heart and other diseases.

 31.According to the author, people with trusting hearts are ________.

 A) usually intelligent and wise

 B) usually very religious

 C) less likely to get heart diseases

 D) not likely to be mistreated by othersC

 32.The book by Meyer Friedman and Ray H. Rosenman most probably discusses ________.

 A) friendliness and hostility

 B) trust and mistrust of people

 C) heart diseases and death rate

 D) people’s characters and their blood typesD

 33.According to the passage, if you have a fixed idea in mind that people will mistreat you, you will always find it ________.

 A) to be disappointing

 B) to be pleasing

 C) to be wrong

 D) to be soD

 34.A cynic, in the passage, is a person ________.

 A) who is always ready to fight

 B) who usually has doubts about the people around him

 C) whose behaviour usually leads to serious health problems

 D) whose behaviour usually seems strange to the people he knowsC

 35.The author’s intention in writing the passage is to ________.

 A) advise people to be patient

 B) analyze the danger of heart diseases

 C) persuade people to be trustful

 D) praise the wisdom of the old peopleC

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 “Time is a problem for kids,” states a news report for a new Swiss watch. Children in some countries “learn time slowly” because “they don’t wear watches” and “parents don’t really know how to teach them time”. The kids grow up with this handicap and become adults—and then can’t get to work on time. Is there an answer to this problem? of course—it’s the Flik Flak, made by a famous Swiss watch company.

 The Flik Flak is being marketed as something teaching watch for children aged 4 to 10. The watch itself does not teach kids how to tell time, of course it merely “captures their imagination” by presenting the “hour” hand as a beautiful red girl named Flak and the “minute” hand as a tall blue boy named Flik. Flik points to corresponding “blue“ minutes on the dial, while Flak points to red hour numbers. The characters and the colors combined with parental help, are supposed to teach young children how to tell time.

 The watch comes equipped with a standard battery and a nylon band. Peter Lipkin, the United States sales manager for the Flik Flak, calls it Kidproof: if it gets dirty you can throw the whole watch in the washing machine.” The product is being sold in select department stores in Europe, Asia and the United States for a suggested price of $25. Parents who buy the watch may discover that it is one thing for kids to tell time; it’s quite another for them to be on time.

 36.From the news report we know that ________.

 A) parents are patient when teaching children time

 B) parents have little idea of how to teach children time

 C) children tend to learn time quickly

 D) children enjoy wearing the Flik Flak watchB

 37.The author doesn’t seem to believe ________.

 A) children will be on time if they have learnt how to tell time

 B) a Flik Flak can help parents teach their children how to tell time

 C) the Flik Flak can capture children’s imagination

 D) children usually have trouble telling time if they don’t wear watchesA

 38.The word “handicap” (Para. 1, Line 4) means ________.

 A) displeasure

 B) discouragement

 C) disappointment

 D) disadvantageD

 39.Flik and Flak in the passage stand for ________.

 A) a tall boy and a beautiful girl

 B) the minute hand and the hour hand

 C) the Swiss watch company

 D) the designers of the watchB

 40.The United States sales manager calls the new watch kidproof because ________.

 A) it is designed to teach children to be on time

 B) it proves to be effective in teaching children time

 C) it is made so as not to be easily damaged by children

 D) it is the children’s favourite watchC

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A)B)C), and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 41.I can’t understand how you ________ these unpleasant surroundings.

 A) put out

 B) put down

 C) put up with

 D) put forwardC

 42.________ you decide to take up you should try to make it a success.

 A) Whatever

 B) Unless

 C) Whenever

 D) If onlyA

 43.If Harry did not attend the conference last night, he ________ too much work to do.

 A) must have had

 B) must have

 C) had had

 D) had to have hadA

 44.John often attends public lectures at the University of Oxford, chiefly ________ his English.

 A) to improve

 B) improving

 C) to have improved

 D) improvedA

 45.It was suggested at the meeting that effective measures ________ to solve the problem.

 A) were taken

 B) be taken

 C) must be taken

 D) takeB

 46.I am ________ of your stupid conversation.

 A) annoyed

 B) worried

 C) angry

 D) tiredD

 47.They are building the dam in ________ with another firm.

 A) comparison

 B) association

 C) touch

 D) tuneB

 48.Most parents encourage their children to take an active part in social events, ________ those events do not interfere with their studies.

 A) lest

 B) though

 C) unless

 D) providedD

 49.Orlando, a city in Florida, ________ for its main attraction, Magic Kingdom.

 A) which is well known

 B) is well known

 C) well known

 D) being well knownB

 50.He is ________ a writer as a reporter.

 A) more

 B) rather

 C) not so much

 D) not muchC

 51.Jim is sorry ________ so impolite to your guest last Saturday.

 A) to be

 B) having been

 C) being

 D) to have beenD

 52.I suppose that when I come back in ten years’ time all these old houses ________ down.

 A) will have been pulled

 B) will have pulled

 C) will be pulling

 D) will be pulledA

 53.To be sure, some insects can build complex societies ________ different types of individuals performing different tasks.

 A) taken from

 B) made of

 C) composed of

 D) developed fromC

 54.The students will put off the outing until next week, ________ they won’t be so busy.

 A) when

 B) as

 C) since

 D) whileA

 55.I have not found my book yet; in fact, I am not sure ________ I could have done with it.

 A) whether

 B) why

 C) what

 D) whenC

 56.If you do not fasten your safety belt, your chances of being ________ will be greater.

 A) beaten

 B) hurt

 C) damaged

 D) strickenB

 57.“ ________” for many years, the writer suddenly became famous.

 A) Having ignored him

 B) To be ignored

 C) To have been ignored

 D) Having been ignoredD

 58.This bird’s large wings ________ it to fly very fast.

 A) able

 B) enable

 C) unsure

 D) causeB

 59.The picture exhibition bored me to death. I wish I ________ to it.

 A) have not gone

 B) did not go

 C) had not gone

 D) should not have goneC

 60.I don’t swim not, but I ________ when I was a kid.

 A) used to it

 B) used to doing it

 C) used to

 D) used to doC

 61.I found my daughter sitting in the kitchen, crying ________.

 A) strongly

 B) bitterly

 C) heavily

 D) deeplyB

 62.You are getting too old for football. You’d better ________ tennis instead.

 A) take in

 B) take up

 C) take for

 D) take overB

 63.When the two young people were married, the ceremony was anything ________ up to data.

 A) but

 B) beside

 C) except

 D) apart fromA

 64.He didn’t mention anything about the party, ________ the date.

 A) either even

 B) even nor

 C) even neither

 D) not evenD

 65.After being rescued from the air crash, the people agreed that they had much to ________.

 A) thank

 B) be thanked

 C) be thankful

 D) be thankful forD

 66.This new method not only saves time but also saves energy ________ operating on two batteries instead to four.

 A) in

 B) on

 C) by

 D) forC

 67.What ________ to him is whether the job allows him to pursue his studies.

 A) matters

 B) refers

 C) happens

 D) appliesA

 68.He said that very clearly so that nobody was in any ________ about what was meant.

 A) doubt

 B) wonder

 C) question

 D) considerationA

 69.It is predicted that heavy rains are ________ to flood the area in a few days.

 A) frightening

 B) threatening

 C) scattering

 D) warningB

 70.In most of the United States, the morning newspaper is ________ by school age children.

 A) directed

 B) discharged

 C) derived

 D) deliveredD

Part IV Close (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A)B)C), and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on, the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 When television first began to expand, very few of the people who had become famous as __71__ announcers were able to be equally effective __72__ television. Some of the difficulties they experienced when they were trying to __73__ themselves to the new medium were technical. When __74__ on radio, for example, they had become __75__ to seeing on behalf of the listener. This art of seeing for others __76__ that the announcer has to be very good __77__ talking. Above all, he has to be able to __78__ a continuous sequence (序列) of visual (视觉的) images which add meaning __79__ the round the listener hears. In the __80__ of television, however, the announcer sees __81__ with the viewer. His duty, __82__, is completely different. He is there to make __83__ that the viewer does not __84__ any point of interest, to help him focus __85__ particular things, and to help him __86__ the images on the television screen. __87__ his radio colleague, he must know the __88__ of silence and how to use it at those __89__ when the pictures speak for __90__.

 71.A) television

 B) advertisement

 C) radio

 D) newspaperC

 72.A) of

 B) in

 C) at

 D) onD

 73.A) adopt

 B) adjust

 C) alter

 D) adaptB

 74.A) working

 B) listening

 C) appearing

 D) showingA

 75.A) practised

 B) experienced

 C) determined

 D) usedD

 76.A) guarantees

 B) means

 C) convinces

 D) warnsB

 77.A) at

 B) with

 C) in

 D) ofA

 78.A) reflect

 B) create

 C) cause

 D) affectB

 79.A) to

 B) in

 C) on

 D) aboutA

 80.A) occasion

 B) matter

 C) example

 D) caseD

 81.A) something

 B) everything

 C) nothing

 D) anythingB

 82.A) moreover

 B) therefore

 C) furthermore

 D) neverthelessB

 83.A) clear

 B) definite

 C) sure

 D) easyC

 84.A) miss

 B) ignore

 C) drop

 D) catchA

 85.A) to

 B) at

 C) in

 D) onD

 86.A) reveal

 B) expose

 C) understand

 D) translateC

 87.A) Unlike

 B) Besides

 C) Like

 D) AsA

 88.A) price

 B) cost

 C) value

 D) worthC

 89.A) minutes

 B) periods

 C) times

 D) momentsD

 90.A) them

 B) him

 C) themselves

 D) himselfC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition in no less than 100 words, on the topic: Is Failure a Bad Thing? Your composition should be based on the following outline (give in Chinese)

 1.失败是常有的事?

 2.人们对失败有各种不同的态度。

 3.我对失败的态度。

 You should write your composition in three paragraphs. Remember to write your composition in readable handwriting on the right side of this sheet.

Is Failure a Bad Thing?

19921月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.B

2.D

3.A

4.A

5.D

6.B

7.C

8.C

9.B

10.B

11.C

12.A

13.C

14.A

15.D

16.D

17.D

18.C

19.A

20.B


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.D

22.B

23.A

24.B

25.C

26.A

27.B

28.C

29.C

30.D

31.C

32.D

33.D

34.C

35.C

36.B

37.A

38.D

39.B

40.C


Part III Vocabulary and Structure


41.C

42.A

43.A

44.A

45.B

46.D

47.B

48.D

49.B

50.C

51.D

52.A

53.C

54.A

55.C

56.B

57.D

58.B

59.C

60.C

61.B

62.B

63.A

64.D

65.D

66.C

67.A

68.A

69.B

70.D


Part IV Close


71.C

72.D

73.B

74.A

75.D

76.B

77.A

78.B

79.A

80.D

81.B

82.B

83.C

84.A

85.D

86.C

87.A

88.C

89.D

90.C


Part V Writing ()

19926月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) The man should stay a little longer.

 B) The man should leave at once.

 C) The man will miss the train.

 D) The man must try to catch the last train.B

 2.A) Walking.

 B) Boating.

 C) Shopping.

 D) Driving.C

 3.A) Twenty minutes.

 B) Twenty-five minutes.

 C) Fifty minutes.

 D) Fifty-five minutes.C

 4.A) Go and buy a new dress.

 B) Try to get some tickets.

 C) Go and see a performance.

 D) Do some sewing at home.A

 5.A) Do the work for the woman.

 B) Take care of the woman.

 C) Work together with the woman.

 D) Drive the woman home.B

 6.A) The man is showing the woman round the city.

 B) The woman is asking the way.

 C) The man is a stranger to the city.

 D) The two persons are talking about sending letters.D

 7.A) Buying a car costs too much.

 B) Driving lessons are too expensive.

 C) Taking the bus is more convenient.

 D) Driving is too dangerous.C

 8.A) By twelve o’clock.

 B) By three o’clock.

 C) By nine o’ clock.

 D) By two o’clock.D

 9.A) She is going to see her uncle there.

 B) She has a relative who once lived there.

 C) She will visit the city soon.

 D) She used to have an apartment there.A

 10.A) 7:30

 B) 8:00

 C) 8:30

 D) 7:00D

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) In green forests.

 B) In the North Pole region.

 C) In the Pacific Ocean.

 D) In dry deserts.D

 12.A) Snakes like warmth.

 B) Snakes like to stay in the sun.

 C) Snakes are used to extra-hot weather.

 D) Snakes are good swimmers.B

 13.A) They are unintelligent.

 B) They are not very intelligent.

 C) They are fairly intelligent.

 D) They are very intelligent.D

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) He was talking to a policeman.

 B) He was making a phone call.

 C) He was watching a film.

 D) He was shopping.A

 15.A) Her beautiful figure.

 B) Her unusual height.

 C) Her attractive manners.

 D) Her fashionable handbag.A

 16.A) He was arrested by the police.

 B) He was only making a joke.

 C) He had taken the woman’s bag by mistake.

 D) He was acting in a film.B

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) 6 million dollars.

 B) 25 million dollars.

 C) 70 million dollars.

 D) 400 million dollars.B

 18.A) An engine room.

 B) A big kitchen.

 C) A high building.

 D) A great theatre.C

 19.A) More than 200.

 B) More than 300.

 C) More than 400.

 D) More than 600.C

 20.A) The giant jet will be forced to land.

 B) The giant jet will crash.

 C) The mechanical pilots will do the job.

 D) The engines of the giant jet will stop working.A

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Looking back on my childhood, I am convinced that naturalists are born and not made.

 Although we were all brought up in the same way, my brothers and sisters soon abandoned their pressed flowers and insects. Unlike them, I had no ear for music and languages. I was not an early reader and I could not do mental arithmetic.

 Before world I we spent our summer holidays in Hungary. I have only the dim memory of the house we lived in, of my room and my toys. Nor do I recall clearly the large family of grandparents, aunts, uncles and cousins who gathered next door. But I do have a crystal-clear memory of the dogs, the farm animals, the local birds and, above all the insects.

 I am a naturalist, not a scientist. I have a strong love of the natural world, and my enthusiasm has led me into varied investigations. I love discussing my favorite topics and enjoy burning the midnight oil while reading about other people’s observations and discoveries. Then something happens that brings these observations together in my conscious mind. Suddenly you fancy you see the answer to the riddle (), because it all seems to fit together. This has resulted in my publishing 300 papers and books, which some might honour with the title of scientific research.

 But curiosity, a keen eye, a good memory and enjoyment of the animal and plant world do not make a scientist: one of the outstanding and essential qualities require is self-discipline, quality I lack. A scientist requires not only self-discipline but all training, determination and a goal. A scientist, up to a point, can be made. A naturalist is born. If you can combine the two, you get the best of both worlds.

 21.The first paragraph tells us that the author ________.

 A) was born to a naturalist’s family

 B) lost his hearing when he was a child

 C) didn’t like his brothers and sisters

 D) was interested in flowers and insects in his childhoodA

 22.The author can’t remember his relatives clearly because ________.

 A) he didn’t live very long with them

 B) he was fully occupied with observing nature

 C) he was too young when he lived with them

 D) the family was extremely largeD

 23.It can be inferred from the passage that the author was ________.

 A) no more than a born naturalist

 B) a naturalist but not a scientist

 C) a scientist as well as a naturalist

 D) first of all a scientistC

 24.The author says that he is a naturalist rather than a scientist probably because he thinks he ________.

 A) lacks some of the qualities required of a scientist

 B) has a great deal of trouble doing mental arithmetic

 C) just reads about other people’s observations and discoveries

 D) comes up with solutions in a most natural wayB

 25.According to the author, a born naturalist should first of all be ________.

 A) full of ambition

 B) full of enthusiasm

 C) knowledgeable

 D) self-disciplinedD

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Sporting activities are essentially modified forms of hunting behaviour. Viewed biologically, the modern footballer is in reality a member of a hunting group. His killing weapon has turned into a harmless football and his prey (猎物) into a goalmouth. If his aim is accurate and he scores a goal, he enjoys the hunter’s triumph of killing his prey.

 To understand how this transformation has taken place we must briefly look back at our forefathers. They spent over a million years evolving (进化) as cooperative hunters. Their very survival depended on success in the hunting-field. Under this pressure their whole way of life, even their bodies, became greatly changed. They became chasers, runners, jumpers, aimers, throwers and prey-killers. They cooperated as skillful male-group attackers.

 Then about ten thousand years ago, after this immensely long period of hunting their food, they became farmers. Their improved intelligence, so vital to their old hunting life, was put to a new use—that of controlling and domesticating their prey. The hunt became suddenly out of date. The food was there on the farms, awaiting their needs. The risks and uncertainties of the hunt were no longer essential for survival.

 The skills and thirst for hunting remained, however, and demanded new outlets. Hunting for sport replaced hunting for necessity. This new activity involved all the original hunting sequencer but the aim of the operation was no longer to avoid starvation. Instead the sportsmen set off to test their skill against prey that were no longer essential to their survival, to be sure, the kill may have been eaten, but there were other, much simpler ways of obtaining a meaty meal.

 26.The author believes that sporting activities ________.

 A) are forms of biological development

 B) are essentially forms of taming the prey

 C) have actually developed from hunting

 D) have changed the ways of huntingB

 27.For over a million years, our forefathers were basically ________.

 A) any member of the opposing team

 B) the goal-mouth

 C) the goal keeper

 D) the footballC

 28.For over a million years, our foregathers were basically ________.

 A) co-operating hunters,

 B) successful farmers

 C) runners and jumpers

 D) skillful sportsmenB

 29.The word “operation” (Para. 4, Line 4) refers to ________.

 A) domesticating animals

 B) hunting

 C) prey killing

 D) sports activitiesB

 30.Which of the following best summarizes the main idea of the passage?

 A) It is farming that gives human beings enough leisure time for sporting activities.

 B) Farming is very important in human civilization because it saves human beings from risks and uncertainties of hunting for survival.

 C) It is hunting that provides human beings with much simpler ways of obtaining meaty meals.

 D) Sporting activities satisfy the desire of modern man to exercise hunting skills which his forefathers developed for survival.D

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passages.

 The world is known to us through many senses, not just hearing, smell, vision, and at close range, touch and taste.

 Our skins let us know whether the air is moist or dry, whether surfaces are wet without being sticky or slippery. From the uniformity of slight pressure, we can be aware how deeply a finger is thrust into water at body temperature, even if the finger is enclosed in a rubber glove that keeps the skin completely dry. Many other animals, with highly sensitive skins, appear to be able to learn still more about their environment. Often they do so without employing any of the five senses.

 By observing the capabilities of other members of the animal kingdom, we come to realise that a human being has far more possibilities than are utilised. We neglect ever so many of our senses in concentrating on the five major ones. At the same time, a comparison between animals and man draws attention to the limitations of each sense. The part of the spectrum (光谱) seen by colour-conscious man as red is non-existent for honey-bees. But a bee can see far more in flowers than we, because the ultra-violet (紫外线) to which our eyes are blind is a stimulating (刺激的) part of the insect’s spectrum, and, for honey-bees at least, constitutes a separate colour.

 31.From the passage, we realise that ________.

 A) man possesses as many senses as animals

 B) man possesses a few more senses than animals

 C) man possesses far more senses than the five major ones

 D) man has fully utilised his sensesA

 32.Which of the following is TRUE?

 A) The honey-bee is blind to red.

 B) Man is more colour-conscious than the honey-bee.

 C) The honey-bee can see far more colours than man.

 D) Man is sensitive to the ultra-violet.B

 33.We can realise how deeply a finger is put into water at body temperature ________.

 A) from the sense of direct touch

 B) through skin contact

 C) from the even distribution of pressure

 D) through the difference in temperatureD

 34.The phrase “sensitive skins” (Para. 2 Line 6) most probably means ________.

 A) skins that are sticky or slippery

 B) skins that are delicate

 C) skins that are completely dry

 D) skins that are quick to feel and respondA

 35.What is the main idea of the passage?

 A) All senses have their limitations.

 B) Man has not fully utilized all his senses.

 C) Insects are more sensitive to colours than man.

 D) Man is not as good as animals in learning about the environment.C

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 America is a country on the move. In unheard-of numbers, people of all ages are exercising their way to better health. According to the latest figures, 59 percent of American adults exercise regularly-up 12 percent from just two years ago and more than double the figure of 25 years ago. Even non-exercisers believe they would be more attractive and confident if they were more active.

 It is hard not to get the message. The virtues of physical fitness are shown on magazine covers, postage stamps, and television ads for everything from beauty soaps to travel books.

 Exercise as a part of daily life did not catch on until the late 1960s when research by military doctors began to show the health benefits of doing regular physical exercises. Growing publicity (宣传) for races held in American cities helped fuel a strong interest in the ancient sport of running. Although running has leveled off in recent years as Americans have discovered equally rewarding-and sometimes safer-forms of exercise, such as walking and swimming, running, remaining the most popular form of exercise.

 As the popularity of exercise continues to mount, so does scientific evidence of its health benefits. The key to fitness is exercising the major muscle groups vigorously (强有力的) enough to approximately double the heart rate and keep it doubled for 20 to 30 minutes at a time. Doing such physical exercises three times or more a week will produce considerable improvements in physical health in about three months.

 36.According to the passage, what was the percentage of American adults doing regular physical exercises two years ago?

 A) About 70%

 B) Almost 50%

 C) Nearly 60%

 D) More than 12%C

 37.A growing interest in sports developed after ________.

 A) research showed their health benefits

 B) people got the message from magazine covers and postage stamps

 C) scientific evidence of health benefits was shown on TV ads

 D) an increasing number of races were held in American citiesA

 38.Which of the following is closest in meaning to the phrase “leveled off” (Para. 2, Line 8)?

 A) “become very popular”

 B) “stopped being popular”

 C) “stopped increasing in popularity”

 D) “reached its lowest level in popularity”D

 39.It can be learnt from the passage that the health benefits of exercise ________.

 A) are yet to be proved

 B) are to be further studied

 C) are self-evident

 D) are supported by scientific evidenceC

 40.Which of the following would be the best TITLE for the passage?

 A) Exercise-The Road to Health.

 B) Different Forms of Exercise.

 C) Scientific Evidence of Health Benefits.

 D) Running A Popular Form of Sport.B

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

 41.Language has always been—as the phrase goes—the mirror to society. English is no ________.

 A) explanation

 B) excuse

 C) exception

 D) expectationD

 42.An investigation was made into the accident, ________ fifty people were killed.

 A) for that

 B) where

 C) when

 D) in whichA

 43.Some confusion has ________ about who can join the association.

 A) arisen

 B) lifted

 C) raised

 D) retainedD

 44.It was unwise of him to ________ the unreliable data in his speech.

 A) add to

 B) refer to

 C) keep to

 D) point toA

 45.The money will be used to keep a space vehicle on the moon busy ________ back to the earth photographs and other information about the surface of the moon.

 A) to send

 B) being sent

 C) to be sent

 D) sendingB

 46.The ceremony was not for the ________ of the dead, but for the comfort of the living.

 A) purpose

 B) sake

 C) respect

 D) impressionC

 47.Even if I had known her address, I ________ time to write to her.

 A) can not have had

 B) will not have had

 C) must not have had

 D) might not have hadC

 48.It suddenly occurred to Anne that money couldn’t ________ all that Bob had suffered in the past five years.

 A) make up for

 B) make out

 C) live up to

 D) live throughC

 49.I think the Red Team will win the final game; it’s ________ that they will.

 A) almost surely

 B) rather possibly

 C) very likely

 D) quite certainlyB

 50.Television was not invented by any one person. ________ into being overnight.

 A) Nor has it sprung

 B) Nor does it spring

 C) Nor did it spring

 D) Nor can it springA

 51.She accused the man ________ breaking into her house.

 A) of

 B) for

 C) at

 D) withC

 52.He often stopped at the sound of his own steps and was afraid to look ________ shoulder.

 A) over

 B) back

 C) round

 D) beyondC

 53.Go straight into the cave and find out what’s in there, ________?

 A) don’t you

 B) do you

 C) will you

 D) can youB

 54.The persons that have the greatest influence ________ children are their teachers.

 A) in

 B) on

 C) for

 D) toD

 55.Cambridge has announced plans to establish a business school ________ the master’s degree in business administration.

 A) representing

 B) presenting

 C) offering

 D) supplyingB

 56.Many Europeans ________ the continent of Africa in the 19th century.

 A) exploded

 B) explored

 C) exposed

 D) expandedD

 57.The police are ________ the records of all those involved in the crime.

 A) looking into

 B) looking after

 C) looking out

 D) looking onC

 58.Building that railway was very difficult and involved ________ ten tunnels.

 A) dig

 B) having dug

 C) to have dug

 D) diggingB

 59.________ with the picture. Mary tore it to pieces.

 A) Dissatisfying thoroughly

 B) Being thoroughly dissatisfied

 C) To dissatisfy thoroughly

 D) To be thoroughly dissatisfiedC

 60.________ you are familiar with the author’s ideas, try reading all the sections as quickly as you possibly can.

 A) As long as

 B) Ever since

 C) So that

 D) Now thatA

 61.________ its hot sun and beautiful beaches. Hawaii is a fine place to live in or to visit.

 A) As

 B) With

 C) From

 D) ForD

 62.Bob’s leg got hurt ________ the Purple Mountains.

 A) while he is climbing up

 B) while we were climbing up

 C) while we climbed up

 D) while he climbed upD

 63.There are certain ________ when you must interrupt people who are in the middle of doing something.

 A) conditions

 B) situations

 C) occasions

 D) environmentsA

 64.The time is not far away ________ modern communications will become widespread in China’s vast countryside.

 A) when

 B) as

 C) until

 D) beforeB

 65.It was proposed that the matter ________ discussed at the next meeting.

 A) will be

 B) has

 C) be

 D) would beD

 66.He didn’t go to the party, but he does wish he ________ there.

 A) would be

 B) has been

 C) would have been

 D) had beenA

 67.Pick me up at 8 o’clock. I ________ my bath by then.

 A) may have

 B) will be having

 C) can have had

 D) will have hadA

 68.She was so angry that she felt like ________ something at him.

 A) to throw

 B) to have thrown

 C) throwing

 D) having thrownB

 69.You should hire a more ________ manager than the one you currently have.

 A) sufficient

 B) effective

 C) respective

 D) efficientC

 70.Pupils who pass the test will be ________ to the next grade.

 A) promoted

 B) proceeded

 C) progressed

 D) proposedC

Part IV Close (15 minutes)

 What do we mean by a perfect English pronunciation? In one __71__ there are as many different kinds of English as there are speakers of it. __72__ two speakers speak in exactly the same __73__, we can always hear differences __74__ them, and the pronunciation of English __75__ a great deal in different geographical __76__ How do we decide what sort of English to use as a __77__ This is not a question that can be __78__ in the same. Way for all foreign learners of English __79__ you live in a part of the world, __80__ India or West Africa, where there is a long __81__ of speaking English for general communication purposes, you should __82__ to acquire a good variety of the pronunciation of this area. It would be a __83__ in these circumstances to use as a model BBC English or __84__ of the sort. On the other hand, if you live in a country __85__ there is no traditional use of English, you must take __86__ your model some form of __87__ English pronunciation. It does not __88__ very much which form you choose. The most __89__ way is to take as your model the tort of English you can __90__ most often.

 71.A) meaning

 B) case

 C) sense

 D) situationB

 72.A) Not

 B) None

 C) No

 D) NorB

 73.A) way

 B) form

 C) sort

 D) typeD

 74.A) from

 B) among

 C) of

 D) betweenA

 75.A) varies

 B) changes

 C) shifts

 D) altersB

 76.A) parts

 B) areas

 C) countries

 D) spacesA

 77.A) direction

 B) model

 C) symbol

 D) guideD

 78.A) given

 B) responded

 C) answered

 D) satisfiedD

 79.A) Because

 B) When

 C) Whether

 D) IfC

 80.A) like

 B) in

 C) as

 D) nearC

 81.A) tradition

 B) use

 C) custom

 D) habitC

 82.A) propose

 B) aim

 C) select

 D) tendD

 83.A) fashion

 B) nonsense

 C) mistake

 D) possibilityA

 84.A) everything

 B) nothing

 C) things

 D) anythingC

 85.A) that

 B) where

 C) which

 D) whereverA

 86.A) as

 B) with

 C) on

 D) toD

 87.A) practical

 B) domestic

 C) new

 D) nativeC

 88.A) care

 B) affect

 C) matter

 D) troubleD

 89.A) sensitive

 B) effective

 C) ordinary

 D) carefulA

 90.A) listen

 B) find

 C) notice

 D) hearB

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition based on, the following two questions:

 1.你在英语学习中有哪些困难?

 2.你是如何克服这些困难的?

 Your composition should be no less than 100 words. Write this composition on the Answer Sheet. Remember to write it clearly.

How I Overcame my Difficulties in Learning English

19926月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.B

2.C

3.C

4.A

5.B

6.D

7.C

8.D

9.A

10.D

11.D

12.B

13.D

14.A

15.A

16.B

17.B

18.C

19.C

20.A


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.A

22.D

23.C

24.B

25.D

26.B

27.C

28.B

29.B

30.D

31.A

32.B

33.D

34.A

35.C

36.C

37.A

38.D

39.C

40.B


Part III Vocabulary and Structure


41.D

42.A

43.D

44.A

45.B

46.C

47.C

48.C

49.B

50.A

51.C

52.C

53.B

54.D

55.B

56.D

57.C

58.B

59.C

60.A

61.D

62.D

63.A

64.B

65.D

66.A

67.A

68.B

69.C

70.C


Part IV Close


71.B

72.B

73.D

74.A

75.B

76.A

77.D

78.D

79.C

80.C

81.C

82.D

83.A

84.C

85.A

86.D

87.C

88.D

89.A

90.B



19931月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) Go over the list.

 B) Do some shopping.

 C) List everything her friend needs.

 D) Go for an outing.C

 2.A) The man did most of the talking.

 B) The man and the woman robbed the bank.

 C) The woman was wearing a black sweater.

 D) The man and the woman had dark hair.A

 3.A) The traffic.

 B) The weather.

 C) Their health.

 D) Their time-table.D

 4.A) John missed a test.

 B) John has kept his job.

 C) John has stolen a car.

 D) John was called a thief.C

 5.A) To buy Frank a new car.

 B) To drive Frank’s car.

 C) To help Frank sell his car.

 D) To help Frank repair his car.C

 6.A) English.

 B) English and Education.

 C) Education.

 D) Neither English nor Education.A

 7.A) As big as she expected.

 B) Much bigger than she expected.

 C) Not as big as she expected.

 D) So small that she is not satisfied.A

 8.A) The rent is too high.

 B) He can’t afford the high taxes.

 C) He doesn’t want to live in the suburbs.

 D) It’s too far away from his office.D

 9.A) No. He has to finish his homework.

 B) No. He doesn’t like going to the club.

 C) Yes. He’ll go after he finished his homework.

 D) Yes. He’ll write his paper after he returns.A

 10.A) Because Maria doesn’t like football.

 B) Because Maria fell ill.

 C) Because he didn’t have the time.

 D) Because he can’t stand football.D

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) His friend bought them for him.

 B) He bought them himself.

 C) He booked them quite a while ago.

 D) He got them free of charge.D

 12.A) Her husband was taking her out to the theater.

 B) Her husband had got her a job in his office.

 C) Her husband was going to buy her some nice gifts.

 D) Her husband had found his lost money.C

 13.A) He had lost the tickets for the theater.

 B) He had lost his briefcase.

 C) He had left his briefcase at home.

 D) He had left the ticket in the office.A

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) Lack of electricity.

 B) Shortage of books.

 C) Lack of clean water.

 D) Shortage of experts.A

 15.A) A system which trains doctors.

 B) A group of experts who can provide professional advice.

 C) A computer program which can provide professional advice.

 D) A system which trains computer experts.B

 16.A) It is not easy to see the shortage of experts in the villages.

 B) Many doctors and engineers are sent to the villages to make up for the shortage of experts.

 C) Expert medical systems are widely used in developing countries.

 D) Expert systems are owned by wealthy farmers and businessmen.C

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) To learn Spanish.

 B) To tour the city.

 C) To see the ancient art.

 D) To visit friends.C

 18.A) By taxi.

 B) By bus.

 C) By subway.

 D) By foot.B

 19.A) He got lost.

 B) A taxi was faster.

 C) He lost his map.

 D) The policeman advised him to.B

 20.A) He was greatly disappointed.

 B) He was pleased to get there finally.

 C) He was pleased with his knowledge of Spanish.

 D) He was at a loss about what to do.D

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 With fifteen years Britain and other nations should be well on with the building of huge industrial complexes for the recycling of waste. The word rubbish could lose its meaning because everything which goes into the dumps (垃圾堆) would be made into something useful. Even the most dangerous and unpleasant wastes would provide energy if nothing else.

 The latest project is to take a city of around half a million inhabitants and discover exactly what raw materials go into it and what go out. The aim is to find out how much of these raw materials could be provided if a plant for recycling waste were built just outside the city. This plant would recycle not only metal such as steel, lead and copper, but also paper and rubber as well.

 Another new project is being set up to discover the best ways of sorting and separating the rubbish. When this project is complete, the rubbish will be processed like this: First, it will pass through sharp metal bas which will tear open the plastic bags in which rubbish is usually packed; then it will pass through a powerful fan to separate the lightest elements from the heavy solids; after that grounders and rollers will break up everything that can be broken. Finally, the rubbish will pass under magnets (磁铁), which will remove the bits of iron and steel; the rubber and plastic will then be sorted out in the final stage.

 The first full-scale giant recycling plants are perhaps fifteen years away. Indeed, with the growing cost of transporting rubbish to more distant dumps, some big cities will be forced to build their own recycling plants before long.

 21.The phrase “be well on with...” (Para. 1, Line 1) most probably means ________.

 A) have completed what was started

 B) get ready to start

 C) have achieved a great deal in

 D) put an end toA

 22.What is NOT mentioned as a part of the recycling process described in Paragraph 3?

 A) Breaking up whatever is breakable.

 B) Sharpening metal bars.

 C) Separating light elements from the heavy ones.

 D) Sorting out small pieces of metal.B

 23.What’s the main reason for big cities to build their own recycling plants?

 A) To deal with wastes in better way.

 B) To protect the environment from pollution.

 C) To get raw materials locally.

 D) To get big profits from those plants.A

 24.The first full-scale huge recycling plants ________.

 A) began to operate fifteen years ago

 B) will probably take less than fifteen years to build

 C) will be built fifteen years later

 D) will probably be in operation in fifteen yearsC

 25.The passage is mainly about ________.

 A) a cheap way to get energy

 B) the location of recycling plants

 C) new ways of recycling wastes

 D) the probably of city environmentC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 By 1970, according to a World Wildlife Fund report, only about 4,500 tigers survived throughout the world-half of them in India. Mr. Foresters, who followed and counted tiger footprints, estimated that in May 1972 only about 1,800 tigers existed in India. Project Tiger Supported by W. W. F. was immediately launched. Nine tiger reserves were created, with armed guards protecting them.

 The project provided opportunities for researchers from India and abroad to study tigers in the reserves and gather previously unavailable information about their habits. Studies show that a male tiger may control a hunting territory of between 10 and 20 sq.kms, depending on its age, size and strength. The territory of male includes the smaller territories of three or four tigresses. A tiger marks the boundaries of its territories by spraying urine (尿) and other bodily liquids on bushes. But it tries to avoid territorial fights, being guided by the distinctive body smell of other tigers. Tigers fight to death only when a tigress is defending her young, or when a tiger is guarding a tigress from the attentions of other males.

 The popular image of the tiger is that of a merciless and unconquerable hunter. But studies show that it catches only one of 20 victims (牺牲品) it tries to attack.

 Fears have recently developed that Project Tiger has been too successful. It has enabled the tiger population to double (by mid-80s), but India’s human population has also grown out of control. Currently it is 750 million and likely to be 900 million by the end of the century. Land problem is becoming serious and many rural people feel bitter about the fact that some rich forests are reserved for tigers. A growing number of attacks by tigers on man has added to the hostility (敌意).

 26.The ultimate aim of Project Tiger is to ________.

 A) study the growth rate of tigers

 B) protect tigers from being killed

 C) promote the breeding of young tigers

 D) analyze the behavioral patterns of tigersB

 27.Studies have shown that ________.

 A) a tigress never attacks until attacked

 B) the tigress is not as fierce as the tigers

 C) a tiger usually fights another tiger to defend its own territory

 D) the tiger is not an efficient hunter as is commonly describedD

 28.According to the passage, a tiger’s territory ________.

 A) remains unchanged

 B) is often defended by tigresses

 C) expands as the tiger grows up

 D) is the cause of most fightsC

 29.Some people are afraid that Project Tiger ________.

 A) has been carried too far

 B) has not received enough attention

 C) has failed to achieve its goal

 D) is not worth the money spent on itA

 30.The author seems ________.

 A) to be enthusiastic about Project Tiger

 B) to have a matter-of-fact attitude towards Project Tiger

 C) to have a hostile attitude towards Project Tiger

 D) to be satisfied with Project TigerB

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 In only two decades Asian Americans have become the fastest-growing U.S. minority (少数民族). As their children began moving up through the nation’s schools, it became clear that a new class of academic achievers was emerging. Their achievements are reflected in the nation’s best universities, where mathematics, science and engineering departments have taken on a decidedly Asian character. This special liking for mathematics and science is partly explained by the fact that Asian-American students who began their educations abroad arrived in the U.S. with a solid grounding in mathematics but little or no knowledge of English. They are also influenced by the promise of a good job after college. Asians feel there will be less unfair treatment in areas like mathematics and science because they will be judged more objectively. And the return on the investment in education is more immediate in something like engineering than with an arts degree.

 Most Asian-American students owe their success to the influence of parents who are determined that their children take full advantage of what the American educational system has to offer. An effective measure of parental attention is homework. Asian parents spend more time with their children than American parents do, and it helps. Many researchers also believe there is something in Asian Culture that breeds success, such ideals that stress family values and emphasize education.

 Both explanations for academic success worry Asian Americans because of fears that they feed a typical racial (种族的) image. Many can remember when Chinese, Japanese and Filipino immigrants (移民) were the victims of social isolation. Indeed, it was not until 1952 that laws were laid down giving all Asian immigrants the right to citizenship.

 31.While making tremendous achievements at college, Asian-American students ________.

 A) feel they are mistreated because of limited knowledge of English

 B) are afraid that their academic successes bear a strong Asian character

 C) still worry about unfair treatment in society

 D) generally feel it a shame to have to depend on their parentsC

 32.What are the major factors that determine the success of Asian Americans?

 A) A solid foundation in basic mathematics and Asian Americans?

 B) Hard work and intelligence.

 C) Parental help and a limited knowledge of English.

 D) Asian culture and the American educational system.D

 33.Few Asian-American students major in human sciences mainly because ________.

 A) their English is not good enough

 B) they are afraid they might meet with unfair judgement in these areas

 C) there is a wide difference between Asian and Western cultures

 D) they know little about American cultures and Western culturesB

 34.Why do the two “explanations” (Para. 3, Line 1) worry Asian Americans?

 A) They are afraid that they would again be isolated from American society in general.

 B) People would think that Asian students rely on their parents for success.

 C) Asian American would be a threat to other minorities.

 D) American academic achievements have taken on too strong an Asian character.A

 35.The author’s tone in this passage is ________.

 A) sympathetic

 B) doubtful

 C) critical

 D) objectiveD

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 Like fine food, good writing is something we approach with pleasure and enjoy from the first taste to the last. And good writers, good cooks, do not suddenly appear full-blown. Quite the contrary, just as the cook has to undergo an intensive training, mastering the skills of his trade, the writer must sit at his desk and devote long hours to achieving a style in his writing, whatever its purpose-schoolwork, matters of business, or purely social communication. You may be sure that the more painstaking the effort, the more effective the writing, and the more rewarding.

 There are still some remote places in the world where you might find a public scribe to do your business or social writing for you, for a fee. There are a few managers who are lucky enough to have the service of that rate kind of secretary who can take care of all sorts of letter writing with no more than a quick note to work from. But for most of us, if there is any writing to be done, we have to do it ourselves.

 We have to write school papers, business papers or home papers. We are constantly called on to put words to paper. It would be difficult to count the number of such words, messages, letters, and reports put into the mails or delivered by hand, but the daily figure must be enormous. What is more, everyone who writes expects, or at least hopes. We want whatever we write to be read, from first word to last, not just thrown into some “letters-to-be-read” file (档案) or into a wastepaper basket. This is the reason we bend our efforts toward learning and practicing the skill of interesting, effective writing.

 36.In this passage, good writing is compared to fine food because ________.

 A) both writers and cooks have to work long hours every day

 B) both are essential to life

 C) both writers and cooks can earn a good living

 D) both are enjoyableD

 37.A public “scribe” (Para. 2, Line 1) is ________.

 A) a secretary who does your business or social writing

 B) a machine that does writing for you

 C) a public school where writing is taught

 D) a person who ears a living by writing for othersD

 38.According to the passage, some managers don’t have to do any letter writing because ________.

 A) they rely on quick notes

 B) they have excellent secretaries

 C) they have a computer to do it

 D) they prefer making phone callsB

 39.According to the author, if your letter is thrown into some “letter-to-be-read” file, ________.

 A) it will receive immediate attention

 B) it will be dealt with by the secretary

 C) it is likely to be neglected

 D) it is meant to be delivered soonC

 40.The purpose of the author in writing this passage is ________.

 A) to explain and persuade

 B) to comment and criticize

 C) to interest and entertain

 D) to argue and demonstrateA

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

 41.If you smoke in a non-smoking section people ________.

 A) have objected

 B) objected

 C) must object

 D) will objectD

 42.There was a ________ drop in support for the Union in the 1974 election.

 A) delicate

 B) distinct

 C) distant

 D) downwardB

 43.The computer works very fast, ________ data at the speed of light.

 A) having handled

 B) handing

 C) handled

 D) handsB

 44.Through out his life, Henry Moore ________ an interest in encouraging art in the city of Leeds.

 A) contained

 B) secured

 C) reserved

 D) maintainedD

 45.They claim that ________ 1,000 factories closed down during the economic crisis.

 A) sufficiently

 B) approximately

 C) considerably

 D) properlyB

 46.If you happen to ________ my lost papers while you’re looking for your book, please let me know at once by telephone.

 A) come across

 B) come up

 C) come to

 D) properlyA

 47.Her fluency in English gives her an advantage ________ other girls for the job.

 A) above

 B) over

 C) than

 D) withB

 48.It is ________ impossible to find a good educational computer program in this part of the country.

 A) barely

 B) hardly

 C) merely

 D) nearlyD

 49.What he told us about the affair simply doesn’t make any ________.

 A) sense

 B) idea

 C) meaning

 D) significanceA

 50.As a mother, she is too ________ towards her daughter, she should let her see more of the world.

 A) hopeful

 B) protective

 C) modest

 D) confidentB

 51.“Doesn’t he know that it is not ________?” “Yes, he does.”

 A) truth

 B) some truth

 C) the truth

 D) any truthC

 52.That tree looked as if it ________ for a long time.

 A) hasn’t watered

 B) didn’t water

 C) hadn’t been watered

 D) wasn’t wateredC

 53.Hitler set out to conquer all of Europe in the belief that the Germans were the master ________.

 A) race

 B) human

 C) blood

 D) brainsA

 54.Ever since Picasso’s painting went on exhibit, there ________ large crowds at the museum every day.

 A) is

 B) has been

 C) have been

 D) are beingC

 55.Don’t forget to walk the dog while I am away, ________.

 A) can you

 B) shall you

 C) do you

 D) will youD

 56.It is a pity that we should stay at home when we have ________ weather.

 A) so fine

 B) such a fine

 C) such fine

 D) so fine aC

 57.There were beautiful clothes ________ in the shop windows.

 A) spread

 B) displayed

 C) exposed

 D) locatedB

 58.Mr. Smith advised us to withdraw ________.

 A) so that to get not involved

 B) so as to get not involved

 C) so as not to get involved

 D) so that not to get involvedC

 59.________ in a seemingly endless war, the general was forced to evaluate the situation again.

 A) Since the loss of 50,000 soldiers

 B) Because of 50,000 soldiers having lost

 C) Having lost over 50,000 soldiers

 D) 50,000 soldiers were lostC

 60.Knowing something as a whole is far from knowing all its ________.

 A) instance

 B) character

 C) items

 D) detailsD

 61.________ for your laziness, you could have finished the assignment by now.

 A) Had it not been

 B) It were not

 C) Weren’t it

 D) Had not it beenA

 62.The minister had his secretaries ________ a press conference.

 A) arrange

 B) to arrange

 C) arranging

 D) arrangedA

 63.She left the reception early because she ________ get up early the next morning.

 A) needed

 B) might

 C) used to

 D) had toD

 64.Let’s not wait any longer, he might not ________ at all.

 A) turn over

 B) turn up

 C) used to

 D) turn downB

 65.Anne couldn’t concentrate ________ what she was doing while her family were watching TV.

 A) to

 B) on

 C) for

 D) inB

 66.My wife said in her letter that she would appreciate ________ from you sometime.

 A) to have heard

 B) to hear

 C) having heard

 D) hearingD

 67.________ men have learned much from the behavior of animals in badly new.

 A) That

 B) Those

 C) What

 D) WhetherA

 68.It’s necessary ________ the dictionary immediately.

 A) that he will return

 B) that he returned

 C) that he return

 D) that he has to returnC

 69.Franklin’s ability to learn from observations and experience ________ greatly to his success in public life.

 A) contributed

 B) owed

 C) attached

 D) relatedA

 70.The manager assured the customer that his complaint would be seen ________ immediately.

 A) to

 B) at

 C) on

 D) withA

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

 Customs officers at a London airport yesterday found 500,000 pounds worth of drugs which were being smuggled (走私) into Britain in boxes marked “Urgent Medical Supplies.” The __71__ might have suspected for some time __72__ drugs were being brought into the country in this way. The __73__ is believed to be the work of a __74__ international group. Four men were arrested at __75__ airport and help for questioning, __76__ it is unlikely that they are the organizers. In __77__ they declared that they were __78__ of what the boxes contained and __79__ acted in good faith in bringing __80__ into Britain. This is the third time __81__ six months that attempts have been made to smuggle __82__ goods through Customs by declaring them to __83__ medical supplies. They are frequently __84__ in special containers and a __85__ is given that they may be __86__ if they are not handled with care. “__87__ are determined to put a __88__ to this practice,” said one of the Customs officers today. “__89__ is no way these people are going to get away __90__ this any longer. We have the full co-operation of the international police who are as anxious as we are to track down the main source of supply.”

 71.A) authorities

 B) commanders

 C) leaders

 D) directorsA

 72.A) what

 B) that

 C) although

 D) whenB

 73.A) operation

 B) behavior

 C) movement

 D) developmentA

 74.A) well-constructed

 B) well-designed

 C) well-composed

 D) well-organizedD

 75.A) an

 B) some

 C) the

 D) oneC

 76.A) but

 B) so

 C) because

 D) asA

 77.A) turn

 B) return

 C) case

 D) factD

 78.A) unconscious

 B) unaware

 C) unfamiliar

 D) unknownB

 79.A) were

 B) had

 C) have

 D) beingB

 80.A) all

 B) it

 C) them

 D) suchC

 81.A) of

 B) for

 C) by

 D) inD

 82.A) immoral

 B) criminal

 C) illegal

 D) irregularC

 83.A) get

 B) be

 C) become

 D) sellB

 84.A) parked

 B) picked

 C) passed

 D) packedD

 85.A) warning

 B) note

 C) symbol

 D) signatureA

 86.A) harmed

 B) injured

 C) damaged

 D) hurtC

 87.A) Some

 B) We

 C) They

 D) ThoseB

 88.A) stop

 B) hold

 C) stay

 D) stepA

 89.A) It

 B) This

 C) There

 D) ThatC

 90.A) off

 B) in

 C) for

 D) withD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition on the topic Positive and Negative Aspects of Sport. You should write no less than 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.运动的积极因素;

 2.运动的消极因素;

 3.你的体会。

19931月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.C

2.A

3.D

4.C

5.C

6.A

7.A

8.D

9.A

10.D

11.D

12.C

13.A

14.A

15.B

16.C

17.C

18.B

19.B

20.D


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.B

22.B

23.A

24.C

25.C

26.B

27.D

28.C

29.A

30.B

31.C

32.D

33.B

34.A

35.D

36.D

37.D

38.B

39.C

40.A


Part III Vocabulary and Structure


41.D

42.B

43.B

44.D

45.B

46.A

47.B

48.D

49.A

50.B

51.C

52.C

53.A

54.C

55.D

56.C

57.B

58.C

59.C

60.D

61.A

62.A

63.D

64.B

65.B

66.D

67.A

68.C

69.A

70.A


Part IV Close


71.A

72.B

73.A

74.D

75.C

76.A

77.D

78.B

79.B

80.C

81.D

82.C

83.B

84.D

85.A

86.C

87.B

88.A

89.C

90.D



19936月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) The pear.

 B) The weather.

 C) The sea food.

 D) The cold.C

 2.A) Mary has never studied mathematics.

 B) Mary must be good at mathematics.

 C) Mary enjoys learning mathematics.

 D) Mary probably is poor at mathematics.D

 3.A) George’s brother.

 B) George’s wife.

 C) George’s father.

 D) George’s father-in-law.C

 4.A) She can use his car.

 B) She can borrow someone else’s car.

 C) She must get her car fixed.

 D) She can’t borrow his car.D

 5.A) At 2:35.

 B) At 2:45.

 C) At 3:00.

 D) At 3:15.B

 6.A) To the bank.

 B) To bookstore.

 C) To a shoe store.

 D) To the grocer’s.D

 7.A) Near the station.

 B) In the country.

 C) In the city.

 D) Near her work place.B

 8.A) At a cigarette store.

 B) At a bus station.

 C) At a gas station.

 D) At Aunt Mary’s.C

 9.A) From upstairs.

 B) From next door.

 C) From the Nelsons’ house.

 D) From the back door.A

 10.A) The choice of course.

 B) A day course.

 C) An evening course.

 D) Their work.A

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 14 are based on the following passage you have just heard.

 11.A) They haven’t reached a decision yet.

 B) They have decided to go hunting bears.

 C) They want to go hunting camping.

 D) They want to go exploring the country.A

 12.A) Susie.

 B) Tom.

 C) The speaker.

 D) The speaker’s husband.A

 13.A) They chased the bear away.

 B) They stayed outside the tent and did nothing.

 C) They climbed up a tree.

 D) They put some honey outside for the bear to eat.B

 14.A) He ate the honey.

 B) He drank the beer.

 C) He chased the people away.

 D) He turned things upside down.D

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) He missed the appointment.

 B) He arrived late.

 C) He was sick.

 D) He was very busy.C

 16.A) He was busy sightseeing.

 B) He couldn’t reach Mr. Jordan’s office.

 C) He didn’t want to see Mr. Jordan any more.

 D) He didn’t want to take the trouble making it.D

 17.A) The trip didn’t do any good to his health.

 B) The trip was a complete disappointment.

 C) The trip was enjoyable but not fruitful in terms of business.

 D) The trip made it possible for him to meet many interesting people.C

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) He lost consciousness.

 B) He was slightly wounded.

 C) He was seriously injured.

 D) He was buried under an icebox.B

 19.A) About four days.

 B) Around eight days.

 C) A day and a half.

 D) More than six days.A

 20.A) His father pulled him out in time.

 B) He left the area before the earthquake.

 C) He stayed in an icebox.

 D) Their house escaped the earthquake.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Nursing at Beth Israel Hospital produces the best patient care possible. If we are to solve the nursing shortage (不足), hospital administration and doctors everywhere would do well to follow Beth Israel’s example.

 At Beth Israel each patient is assigned to a primary nurse who visits at length with the patient and constructs a full-scale health account that covers everything from his medical history to his emotional state. Then she writes a care plan centered on the patient’s illness but which also includes everything else that is necessary.

 The primary nurse stays with the patient through his hospitalization, keeping track with his progress and seeking further advice from his doctor. If a patient at Beth Israel is not responding to treatment, it is not uncommon for his nurse to propose another approach to his doctor. What the doctor at Beth Israel has in the primary nurse is a true colleague.

 Nursing at Beth Israel also involves a decentralized (分散的) nursing administration; every floor, every unit is a self-contained organization. There are nurse-managers instead of head nurses; in addition to their medical duties they do all their own hiring and dismissing, employee advising, and they make salary recommendations. Each unit’s nurses decide among themselves who will work what shifts and when.

 Beth Israel’s nurse-in-chief ranks as an equal with other vice presidents of the hospital. She also is a member of the Medical Executive Committee, which is most hospitals includes only doctors.

 21.Which of the following best characterizes the main feature of the nursing system at Beth Israel Hospital?

 A) The doctor gets more active professional support from the primary nurse.

 B) Each patient is taken care of by a primary nurse day and night.

 C) The primary nurse writes care plans for every patient.

 D) The primary nurse keeps records of the patient’s health conditions every day.A

 22.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) compared with other hospitals nurse at Beth Israel Hospital are more patient

 B) in most hospitals patient care is inadequate from the professional point of view

 C) in most hospital nurse get low salaries

 D) compared with other hospital nurses have to work longer hours at Beth Israel HospitalB

 23.A primary nurse can propose a different approach of treatment when ________.

 A) the present one is refused by the patient

 B) the patient complains about the present one

 C) the present one proves to be ineffective

 D) the patient is found unwilling to cooperateC

 24.The main difference between a nurse-manager and a head nurse is that the former ________.

 A) is a member of the Medical Executive Committee of the hospital

 B) has to arrange the work shifts of the unit’s nurses

 C) can make decisions concerning the medical treatment of a patient

 D) has full responsibility in the administration of the unit’s nursesD

 25.The author’s attitude towards the nurse system at Beth Israel Hospital is ________.

 A) negative

 B) critical

 C) neutral

 D) positiveD

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 For some time past it has been widely accepted that babies-and other creatures-learn to do things because certain acts lead to “rewards”; and there is no reason to doubt that this is true. But it used also to be widely believed that effective reward, at least in the early stages, had to be directly related to such basic physiological (生理的) “drives” as thirst or hunger. In other words, a baby would learn if he got food or drink of some sort of physical comfort, not otherwise.

 It is now clear that this is not so. Babies will learn to behave in ways that produce results in the world with no reward except the successful outcome.

 Papousek began his studies by using milk in the normal way to “reward” the babies and so teach them to carry out some simple movements, such as turning the head to one side or the other. Then he noticed that a baby who had had enough to drink would refuse the milk but would still go on making the learned response with clear signs of pleasure. So he began to study the children’s responses in situations where on milk was provided. He quickly found that children as young as four months would learn to turn their heads to right or left if the movement “switched on”. A display of lights-and indeed that they were capable of learning quite complex turns to bring about this result, for instance, two left or two right, or even to make as many three turns to one side.

 Papousek’s light display was placed directly in front of the babies and he made the interesting observation that sometimes they would not turn back to watch the lights closely although they would “smile and bubble” when the display came on. Papousek concluded that it was not primarily the sight of the lights which pleased them, it was the success they were achieving in solving the problem, in mastering the skill, and that there exists a fundamental human urge to make sense of the world and bring it under intentional control.

 26.According to the author, babies learn to do things which ________.

 A) are directly related to pleasure

 B) will meet their physical needs

 C) will bring them a feeling of success

 D) will satisfy their curiosityC

 27.Papousek noticed in his studies that a baby ________.

 A) would make learned responses when it saw the milk

 B) would carry out learned movements when it had enough to drink

 C) would continue the simple movements without being given milk

 D) would turn its head to right or left when it had enough to drinkC

 28.In Papousek’s experiment babies make learned movements of the head in order to ________.

 A) have the lights turned on

 B) be rewarded with milk

 C) please their parents

 D) be praisedA

 29.The babies would “smile and bubble” at the lights because ________.

 A) the lights were directly related to some basic “drives”

 B) the sight of the lights was interesting

 C) they need not turn back to watch the lights

 D) they succeeded in “switching on” the lightsD

 30.According to Papousek, the pleasure babies get in achieving something is a reflection of ________.

 A) a basic human desire to understand and control the world

 B) the satisfaction of certain physiological needs

 C) their strong desire to solve complex

 D) a fundamental human urge to display their learned skillsA

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 When a consumer finds that an item she or he bought is faulty or in some way does not live up to the manufacturer’s claim for it, the first step is to present the warranty (保单), or any other records which might help, at the store of purchase. In most cases, this action will produce results. However, if it does not, there are various means the consumer may use to gain satisfaction.

 A simple and common method used by many consumers is to complain directly to the store manager. In general, the “higher up” the consumer takes his or her complaint, the faster he or she can expect it to be settled. In such a case, it is usually settled in the consumer’s favor, assuming he or she has a just claim.

 Consumers should complain in person whenever possible, but if they cannot get to the place of purchase, it is acceptable to phone or write the complaint in a letter.

 Complaining is usually most effective when it is done politely but firmly, and especially when the consumer can demonstrate what is wrong with the item in questions. If this cannot be done, the consumer will succeed best by presenting specific information as to what is wrong, rather than by making general statements. For example, “The left speaker does not work at all and the sound coming out of the right one is unclear” is better than “This stereo (立体声音响) does not work.”

 The store manager may advise the consumer to write to the manufacturer. If so, the consumer should do this, stating the complaint as politely and as firmly as possible. But if a polite complaint does not achieve the desired result, the consumer can go a step further. She or he can threaten to take the seller to court or report the seller to a private or public organization responsible for protecting consumers’ rights.

 31.When a consumer finds that his purchase has a fault in it, the first thing he should do is to ________.

 A) complain personally to the manager

 B) threaten to take the matter to court

 C) write a firm letter of complaint to the store or purchase

 D) show some written proof of the purchase to the storeD

 32.If a consumer wants a quick settlement of his problem, it’s better to complain to ________.

 A) a shop assistant

 B) the store manager

 C) the manufacturer

 D) a public organizationB

 33.The most effective complaint can be made by ________.

 A) showing the faulty item to the manufacturer

 B) explaining exactly what is wrong with the item

 C) saying firmly that the item of poor quality

 D) asking politely to change the itemB

 34.The phrase “live up” (Para. 1, Line 2) in the context means ________.

 A) meet the standard of

 B) realize the purpose of

 C) fulfill the demands of

 D) keep the promise ofA

 35.The passage tells us ________.

 A) how to settle a consumer’s complaint about a faulty item

 B) how to make an effective complaint about a faulty item

 C) how to avoid buying a faulty item

 D) how to deal with complaints from customersB

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 If women are mercilessly exploited (剥削) year after year, they have only themselves to blame. Because they tremble at the thought of being seem in public in clothes that are out of fashion, they are always taken advantage of by the designers and the big stores. Clothes which have been worn only a few times have to be put aside because of the change of fashion. When you come to think of it, only a woman is capable of standing in front of a wardrobe (衣柜) packed full of clothes and announcing sadly that she has nothing to wear.

 Changing fashions are nothing more than the intentional creation of waste. Many women spend vast sums of money each year to replace clothes that have hardly been worn. Women who cannot afford to throw away clothing in this way, waste hours of their time altering the dresses they have. Skirts are lengthened or shortened; neck-lines are lowered or raised, and so on.

 No one can claim that the fashion industry contributes anything really important to society. Fashion designers are rarely concerned with vital things like warmth, comfort and durability (耐用). They are only interested in outward appearance and they take advantage of the fact that women will put up with any amount of discomfort, as long as they look right. There can hardly be a man who hasn’t at some time in his life smiled at the sight of a woman shaking in a thin dress on a winter day, or delicately picking her way through deep snow in high-heeled shoes.

 When comparing men and men and women in the matter of fashion, the conclusions to be drawn are obvious. Do the constantly changing fashions of women’s clothes, one wonders, reflect basic qualities of inconstancy and instability? Men are too clever to let themselves be cheated by fashion designers. Do their unchanging styles of dress reflect basic qualities of stability and reliability? That is for you to decide.

 36.Designers and big stores always make money ________.

 A) by mercilessly exploiting women workers in the clothing industry

 B) because they are capable of predicting new fashions

 C) by constantly changing the fashions in women’s clothing

 D) because they attach great importance to quality in women’s clothingC

 37.To the writer, the fact that women alter their old-fashioned dresses is seen as ________.

 A) a waste of money

 B) a waste of time

 C) an expression of taste

 D) an expression of creativityB

 38.The writer would be less critical if fashion designers placed more stress on the ________ of clothing.

 A) cost

 B) appearance

 C) comfort

 D) suitabilityC

 39.According to the passage, which of the following statements is TRUE? ________.

 A) New fashions in clothing are created for the commercial exploitation of women.

 B) The constant changes in women’s clothing reflect their strength of character.

 C) The fashion industry makes an important contribution to society.

 D) Fashion designs should not be encouraged since they are only welcomed by women.A

 40.By saying “the conclusion to be drawn are obvious” (Para. 4, Line 1-2), the writer means that ________.

 A) women’s inconstancy in their choice of clothing is often laughed at

 B) women are better able to put up with discomfort

 C) men are also exploited greatly by fashion designers

 D) men are more reasonable in the matter of fashionD

Part III vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

 41.Jean did not have time to go to the concert last night because she was busy ________ for her examination.

 A) to prepare

 B) to be prepared

 C) preparing

 D) being preparedC

 42.Five minutes earlier, ________ we could have caught the last train.

 A) and

 B) but

 C) or

 D) an orderA

 43.I cannot give you ________ for the type of car you sell because there is no demand for it in the market.

 A) an expense

 B) a charge

 C) a purchase

 D) an orderD

 44.After ________ for the job, you will be required to take a language test.

 A) being interviewed

 B) interviewed

 C) interviewing

 D) having interviewedA

 45.By the end of this month, we surely ________ a satisfactory solution to the problem.

 A) have found

 B) will be finding

 C) will have found

 D) are findingC

 46.Mr. Wilson said that he did not want to ________ any further responsibilities.

 A) take on

 B) get on

 C) put up

 D) look upA

 47.Having no money but ________ to know, he simply said he would go without dinner.

 A) not to want anyone

 B) not wanting anyone

 C) wanted no one

 D) to want no oneB

 48.We desire that the tour leader ________ us immediately of any change in plans.

 A) inform

 B) informs

 C) informed

 D) has informedA

 49.Not ________, the process of choosing names varies widely from culture to culture.

 A) obviously

 B) surprisingly

 C) particularly

 D) normallyB

 50.A man escaped from the prison last night. It was a long time ________ the guards discovered what had happened.

 A) before

 B) until

 C) since

 D) whenA

 51.In the experiment we kept a watchful eye ________ the developments and recorded every detail.

 A) in

 B) at

 C) for

 D) onD

 52.There’s little chance that mankind would ________ a nuclear war.

 A) retain

 B) endure

 C) maintain

 D) surviveD

 53.Nuclear science be developed to benefit the people ________ harm them.

 A) more than

 B) other than

 C) rather than

 D) better thanC

 54.They usually have less money at the end of the month than ________ at the beginning.

 A) which is

 B) which was

 C) they have

 D) it isC

 55.In the course of a day students do far more than just ________ classes.

 A) attend

 B) attended

 C) to attend

 D) attendingA

 56.The French pianist who had been praised very highly ________ to be a great disappointment.

 A) turned up

 B) turned in

 C) turned out

 D) turned downC

 57.Many difficulties have ________ as a result of the change over to a new type of fuel.

 A) risen

 B) arisen

 C) raised

 D) arrivedB

 58.He made such a ________ contribution to the university that they are naming one of the new buildings after him.

 A) genuine

 B) minimum

 C) modest

 D) generousD

 59.Helen was much kinder to her youngest child than she was to the others, of course, made the others jealous.

 A) who

 B) that

 C) what

 D) whichD

 60.In the advanced course students must take performance tests at monthly ________.

 A) gaps

 B) intervals

 C) length

 D) distanceB

 61.Mr. Johnson preferred ________ heavier work to do.

 A) to be given

 B) to be giving

 C) to have given

 D) having givenA

 62.I remember ________ to help us if we ever got into trouble.

 A) once offering

 B) him once offering

 C) him to offer

 D) to offer himB

 63.We regret to inform you that the materials you ordered are ________.

 A) out of work

 B) out of stock

 C) out of reach

 D) out of practiceB

 64.Our company decided to ________ the contract because a number of the conditions in it had not been met.

 A) destroy

 B) resist

 C) assume

 D) cancelD

 65.She is ________ a musician than her brother.

 A) much of

 B) much as

 C) more of

 D) more asA

 66.Having been found guilty, the man was given a severe ________ by the judge.

 A) service

 B) sentence

 C) crime

 D) crisisB

 67.________ is known to the world, Mark Twain is great American writer.

 A) That

 B) Which

 C) As

 D) ItC

 68.The residents, ________ had been damaged by the flood, were given help by the Red Cross.

 A) all their homes

 B) all whose homes

 C) all of whose homes

 D) all of their homesC

 69.You can’t afford to let the situation get worse. You must take ________ to put it right.

 A) decisions

 B) directions

 C) sides

 D) stepsD

 70.Look at the terrible situation I am in! If only I ________ your advice.

 A) follow

 B) had followed

 C) would follow

 D) have followedB

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

 Many teachers believe that the responsibilities for learning lie with the student. __71__ a long reading assignment is given, instructors expect students to be familiar with the __72__ in the reading even if they do not discuss it in class or take an examination. The __73__ student is considered to be __74__ who is motivated (激励) to learn for the sake of __75__, not the one interested only in getting high grades. Sometimes homework is returned __76__ brief written comments but without a grade. Even if a grade is not given, the student is __77__ for learning the material assigned. When research is

__78__, the professor expects the student to take it actively and to complete it with __79__ guidance. It is the __80__ responsibility to find books, magazines, and articles in the library. Professors do not have the time to explain __81__ a university library works; they expect students, __82__ graduate students, to be able to exhaust the reference __83__ in the library. Professors will help students who need it, but __84__ that their students should not be __85__ dependent on them. In the United States professors have many other duties __86__ teaching, such as administrative or research work. __87__, the time that a professor can spend with student outside of class is __88__. If a student has problems with classroom work, the student should either __89__ a professor during office hour __90__ make an appointment.

 71.A) If

 B) Although

 C) Because

 D) SinceA

 72.A) suggestion

 B) context

 C) abstract

 D) informationD

 73.A) poor

 B) ideal

 C) average

 D) disappointedB

 74.A) such

 B) one

 C) any

 D) someB

 75.A) fun

 B) work

 C) learning

 D) prizeC

 76.A) by

 B) in

 C) for

 D) withD

 77.A) criticized

 B) innocent

 C) responsible

 D) dismissedC

 78.A) collected

 B) distributed

 C) assigned

 D) finishedC

 79.A) maximum

 B) minimum

 C) possible

 D) practicalB

 80.A) student’s

 B) professor’s

 C) assistant’s

 D) librarian’sA

 81.A) when

 B) hat

 C) why

 D) howD

 82.A) particularly

 B) essentially

 C) obviously

 D) rarelyA

 83.A) selections

 B) collections

 C) sources

 D) originsC

 84.A) hate

 B) dislike

 C) like

 D) preferD

 85.A) too

 B) such

 C) much

 D) moreA

 86.A) but

 B) except

 C) with

 D) besidesD

 87.A) However

 B) Therefore

 C) Furthermore

 D) NeverthelessB

 88.A) plentiful

 B) limited

 C) irregular

 D) flexibleB

 89.A) greet

 B) annoy

 C) approach

 D) attachC

 90.A) or

 B) and

 C) to

 D) butA

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition on the topic My Most Favorite Programme. You should write no less than 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.我最喜爱的电视(或无线电)节目是…...

 2.这类节目的内容和特点

 3.我喜欢它的原因

 You can write the composition in one or more paragraphs. Remember to write it neatly.

19936月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.D

3.C

4.D

5.B

6.D

7.B

8.C

9.A

10.A

11.A

12.A

13.B

14.D

15.C

16.D

17.C

18.B

19.A

20.B


Part II


21.A

22.B

23.C

24.D

25.D

26.C

27.C

28.A

29.D

30.A

31.D

32.B

33.B

34.A

35.B

36.C

37.B

38.C

39.A

40.D


Part III


41.C

42.A

43.D

44.A

45.C

46.A

47.B

48.A

49.B

50.A

51.D

52.D

53.C

54.C

55.A

56.C

57.B

58.D

59.D

60.B

61.A

62.B

63.B

64.D

65.A

66.B

67.C

68.C

69.D

70.B


Part IV


71.A

72.D

73.B

74.B

75.C

76.D

77.C

78.C

79.B

80.A

81.D

82.A

83.C

84.D

85.A

86.D

87.B

88.B

89.C

90.A



19941月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) Once a week.

 B) Twice a week.

 C) Three times a week.

 D) Four times a week.C

 2.A) He left his notes at home.

 B) He doesn’t know where his notes are.

 C) He doesn’t want to lend his notes to the woman.

 D) He agrees to lend her his notes.D

 3.A) He will go in spite of the cold weather.

 B) He won’t go since he is not feeling well.

 C) He will go when he feels better.

 D) He won’t go as he hasn’t finished his work.B

 4.A) Check the timetable.

 B) Go to the railway station earlier.

 C) Travel on a later train.

 D) Cancel the trip earlier.C

 5.A) In New York.

 B) In Boston.

 C) In Newport.

 D) In Washington.D

 6.A) A clerk at the airport information desk.

 B) A clerk at the railway station information desk.

 C) A policeman.

 D) A taxi-driver.A

 7.A) A guest and a receptionist.

 B) A passenger and an air hostess.

 C) A customer and a shop assistant.

 D) A guest and a waitress.B

 8.A) He’s better.

 B) He’s feeling worse.

 C) He’s sick in bed.

 D) He has recovered.A

 9.A) The man didn’t want the woman to have her hair cut.

 B) The woman followed the man’s advice.

 C) The woman is wearing long hair now.

 D) The man didn’t care if the woman had her hair cut or not.A

 10.A) He will return from Paris in two weeks.

 B) He is studying French in Paris.

 C) He is having a vacation in Paris.

 D) He is planning to go back to Paris in a year.B

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 14 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) Washing plates.

 B) Clearing tables.

 C) Shining shoes.

 D) Sweeping the floor.C

 12.A) He must work six days a week.

 B) He should never be late for work.

 C) He must study hard in his spare time.

 D) He should not bring his friends to the restaurant.B

 13.A) To pay him for his work.

 B) To let him have 3 meals a day in the restaurant.

 C) To give his friends free drinks.

 D) To allow him to have more free time.A

 14.A) Because the boy was not a full-time worker.

 B) Because the boy had made some mistakes.

 C) Because he thought the boy had failed to meet his requirements.

 D) Because he thought it was his son who should pay him.D

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) Watching traditional plays.

 B) Visiting the magnificent libraries.

 C) Boating on the river.

 D) Cycling in narrow streets.C

 16.A) There are many visitors there.

 B) There are many students there.

 C) There are many old streets there.

 D) There are many bicycles there.D

 17.A) He thinks the city is too crowded.

 B) He likes the place very much.

 C) He thinks the streets are too narrow.

 D) He admires the comfortable life of the students there.B

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) He was good at writing about interesting people.

 B) It was much easier to write stories about people.

 C) He believed that people are always easier to learn about other people.

 D) He thought people played an important role in world events.C

 19.A) Action.

 B) World News.

 C) Enterprise.

 D) Faces and places.A

 20.A) He is a sportsman.

 B) He is an actor.

 C) He is a photographer.

 D) He is a publisher.D

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Suppose we built a robot (机器人) to explore the planet Mars. We provide the robot with seeing detectors to keep it away from danger. It is powered entirely by the sun. Should we program the robot to be equally active at all times? No. The robot would be using up energy at a time when it was not receiving any. So we would probably program it to cease its activity at night and to wake up at dawn the next morning.

 According to the evolutionary (进化的) theory of sleep, evolution equipped us with a regular pattern of sleeping and waking for the same reason. The theory does not deny (否认) that sleep provides some important restorative functions. It merely says that evolution has programmed us to perform those functions at a time when activity would be inefficient and possibly dangerous. However, sleep protects us only from the sort of trouble we might walk into; it does not protect us from trouble that comes looking for us. So we sleep well when we are in familiar, safe place, but we sleep lightly, if at all, when we fear that bears will nose into the tent.

 The evolutionary theory accounts well for differences in sleep among creatures. Why do cats, for instance, sleep so much, while horses sleep so little? Surely cats do not need five times as much repair and restoration as horses do. But cats can afford to have long periods of inactivity because they spend little time eating and are unlikely to be attacked while they sleep. Horses must spend almost all their waking hours eating, because what they eat is very low in energy value. Moreover, they cannot afford to sleep too long or too deeply, because their survival depends on their ability to run away from attackers.

 21.The author uses the example of the robot in space exploration to tell us ________.

 A) the differences between robots and men

 B) the reason why men need to sleep

 C) about the need for robots to save power

 D) about the danger of men working at nightB

 22.Evolution has programmed man to sleep at night chiefly to help him ________.

 A) maintain a regular pattern of life

 B) prevent trouble that comes looking for him

 C) avoid danger and inefficient labor

 D) restore his bodily functionsC

 23.According to the author, we cannot sleep well when we ________.

 A) are worrying about our safety

 B) are overworked

 C) are in a tent

 D) are away from homeA

 24.Cats sleep much more than horses do partly because cats ________.

 A) need more time for restoration

 B) are unlikely to be attackers

 C) are more active than horses when they are awake

 D) spend less time eating to get enough energyD

 25.Which of the following is the main idea of the passage? ________.

 A) Evolution has equipped all creatures with a regular pattern of sleeping and waking.

 B) The study of sleep is an important part of the evolutionary theory.

 C) Sleeping patterns must be taken into consideration in the designing of robots.

 D) The sleeping pattern of a living creature is determined by the food it eats.A

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 “Congratulations, Mr. Jones, it’s a girl.”

 Fatherhood is going to have a different meaning and bring forth a different response from every man who hears these words. Some feel pride when they receive the news, while others worry, wondering whether they will be good father. Although there are some men who like children and may have had considerable experience with them, others do not particularly care for children and spend little time with them. Many fathers and mothers have been planning and looking forward to children for some time. For other couples, pregnancy (怀孕) was an accident that both husband and wife have accepted willingly or unwillingly.

 Whatever the reaction to the birth of a child, it is obvious that the shift from the role of husband to that of father is a difficult task. Yet, unfortunately, few attempts have been made to educate fathers in this resocialization process. Although numerous books have been written about American mothers, only recently has literature focused on the role of a father.

 It is argued by some writers that the transition to the father’s role, although difficult, is not nearly as great as the transition the wife must make to the mother’s role. The mother’s role seems to require a complete transformation in daily routine (生活规律) and highly innovative (创新的) adaptation, on the other hand, the father’s role is less demanding and immediate. However, even though we mentioned the fact that growing numbers of women are working outside the home, the father is still thought by many as the breadwinner in the household.

 26.According to the author, being a father ________.

 A) brings a feeling of excitement to some men

 B) has a different meaning for those who have daughters

 C) makes some men feel proud and others uneasy

 D) means nothing but more responsibilitiesC

 27.It is stated in the passage that ________.

 A) some parents are not prepared to have a child

 B) young couples do not like children at all

 C) working couples do not have much time to take care of their children

 D) many parents look forward to having a boy as their first childA

 28.In the second paragraph, the author ________.

 A) criticizes fathers for not taking enough responsibilities in bringing up their children

 B) excuses the American writers for ignoring the difficulties of being a father

 C) supports the idea that the chief role of a father is to earn money for the family

 D) complains about the lack of social programs to help husbands adjust themselves to being a fatherA

 29.The transition to the mother’s role requires that the wife ________.

 A) change her life style in a highly innovative way

 B) make a complete change in her everyday life to deal with the new situation

 C) stay at home to take care of the baby

 D) help her husband in his resocialization processB

 30.Some writers argue that with respect to the change of roles, fathers, compared with mothers, ________.

 A) have to shoulder more burdens

 B) have to make more difficult adaptations

 C) have an easier job to do

 D) can usually do a better jobC

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Reading is thought to be a kind of conversation between the reader and the text. The reader puts questions, as it were, to the text and gets answers. In the light of these he puts further questions, and so on.

 For most of the time this “conversation” goes on below the level of consciousness. At times, however, we become aware of it. This is usually when we are running into difficulties, when mismatch is occurring between expectations and meaning. When successful matching is being experienced, our questioning of the text continues at the unconscious level.

 Different people converse with the text differently. Some stay very close to the words on the page; others take off imaginatively from the words, interpreting, criticizing, analyzing and examining. The former represents a kind of comprehension which is written in the text. The latter represents higher levels of comprehension. The balance between these is important, especially for advanced readers.

 There is another conversation which from our point of view is equally important, and that is to do not with what is read but with how it is read. We call this a “process” conversation as opposed to a “content” conversation. It is concerned not with meaning but with the strategies (策略) we employ in reading. If we are an advanced reader our ability to hold a process conversation with a text is usually pretty well developed. Not so our ability to hold a content conversation. It is precisely this kind of conversation that is of importance when we are seeking to develop our reading to meet the new demands being placed upon us by studying at a higher level.

 31.Reading as a kind of conversation between the reader and the text becomes conscious only when ________.

 A) the reader’s expectations agree with what is said in the text

 B) the reader has trouble understanding what the author says

 C) the reader asks questions and gets answers

 D) the reader understands a text very wellB

 32.At a lower level of comprehension, readers tend to ________.

 A) read a text slowly

 B) read without thinking hard

 C) interpret a text in their own way

 D) concentrate on the meaning of words onlyD

 33.A “process” conversation has to do with ________.

 A) the application of reading strategies

 B) matching our expectations with the meaning of a text

 C) the development of our ability to check the details

 D) determining the main idea of a textA

 34.According to the passage, it is of great importance for readers at a higher level to maintain a balance between ________.

 A) conscious and unconscious levels of comprehension

 B) the reader’s expectations and the meaning of a text

 C) lower and higher levels of comprehension

 D) interpreting and criticizing a textC

 35.If we want to develop our reading ability at an advanced level, we should ________.

 A) learn to use different approaches in reading different texts

 B) make our reading process more conscious

 C) pay more attention to the content of a text

 D) take a critical attitude towards the author’s ideaA

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 Although April did not bring us the rains we all hoped for, and although the Central Valley doesn’t generally experience the atmospheric sound and lightning that can accompany those rains, it’s still important for parents to be able to answer the youthful questions about thunder and lightning.

 The reason these two wonders of nature are so difficult for many adults to explain to children is that they are not very well understood by adults themselves. For example, did you know that the lightning we see flashing down to the earth from a cloud is actually flashing up to a cloud from the earth? Our eyes trick us into thinking we see a downward motion when it’s actually the other way around. But then, if we believed only what we think we see, we’d still insist that the sun rises in the morning and sets at night.

 Most lightning flashes take place inside a cloud, and only a relative few can be seen jumping between two cloud or between earth and a cloud. But, with about 2,000 thunderstorms taking place above the earth every minute of the day and night, there’s enough activity to produce about 100 lightning strikes on earth every second.

 Parents can use thunder and lightning to help their children learn more about the world around them. When children understand that the light of the lightning flashing reaches their eyes almost at the same moment, but the sound of the thunder takes about 5 seconds to travel just one mile, they can begin to time the interval between the flash and the crash to learn how close they were to the actual spark.

 36.According to the author, in the area of the Central Valley, ________.

 A) rains usually come without thunder and lightning

 B) it is usually dry in April

 C) children pay no attention to natural phenomena

 D) parents are not interested in thunder and lightningA

 37.We believe that lightning is a downward notion because ________.

 A) we were taught so by our parents from our childhood

 B) we are deceived by our sense of vision

 C) it is a common natural phenomenon

 D) it is a truth proved by scienceB

 38.What is TRUE about lightning according to the passage?

 A) Only a small number of lightning flashes occur on earth.

 B) Lightning travels 5 minutes faster than thunder.

 C) Lightning flashes usually jump from one cloud to another.

 D) There are far more lightning strikes occurring on earth than we imagine.D

 39.The word “activity” (Para. 3, Line 3) is most closely related to the word(s) ________.

 A) “cloud”

 B) “lightning strikes”

 C) “lightning flashes”

 D) “thunderstorms”D

 40.It can be concluded from the passage that ________.

 A) we should not believe what we see or hear

 B) things moving downward are more noticeable

 C) people often have wrong concepts about ordinary phenomena

 D) adults are not as good as children in observing certain natural phenomenaC

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

 41.Before he left for his vacation he went to the bank to ________ some money.

 A) pull

 B) pick

 C) gain

 D) drawD

 42.By the end of the year all but two people ________.

 A) have left

 B) will leave

 C) will be leaving

 D) will have leftD

 43.Frankfurt, Germany, is in one of the most ________ populated regions of Western Europe.

 A) densely

 B) vastly

 C) enormously

 D) largelyA

 44.Everyone had an application from in his hand, but no one knew which office room ________.

 A) to send it to

 B) to send it

 C) to be sent to

 D) to have it sentA

 45.The police set a ________ to catch the thieves.

 A) plan

 B) device

 C) trap

 D) trickC

 46.We ________ to start our own business, but we never had enough money.

 A) have hoped

 B) hope

 C) had hoped

 D) should hopeC

 47.We have to try every means to ________ the costs of the construction project.

 A) bring off

 B) bring forth

 C) bring down

 D) bring backC

 48.The students were participating ________ an international energy-saving competition between towns in New England and Canada.

 A) for

 B) in

 C) to

 D) atB

 49.When she was criticized, she claimed that it was outside her ________ of responsibility.

 A) field

 B) limit

 C) extent

 D) rangeD

 50.While ________ the sun, the satellite has sent more than four billion bits of information back to earth.

 A) having orbited

 B) being orbited

 C) having been orbited

 D) orbitingD

 51.Language is a city, to the building of ________ every human being brought a stone.

 A) which

 B) that

 C) it

 D) thisA

 52.________ of the two books holds the opinion that the danger of nuclear war is increasing.

 A) None

 B) Either

 C) Both

 D) NeitherD

 53.Government cannot operate effectively ________ it is free from such interference.

 A) so long as

 B) so that

 C) unless

 D) becauseC

 54.We welcome rain, but a(an) ________ large amount of rainfall will cause floods.

 A) extensively

 B) extremely

 C) specially

 D) constantlyB

 55.Beethoven is my favorite musician. I regard him as ________ other musicians.

 A) superior to

 B) more superior than

 C) more superior to

 D) superior thanA

 56.I hope that you’ll be more careful in typing the letter. Don’t ________ anything.

 A) withdraw

 B) omit

 C) reduce

 D) leadB

 57.We don’t need air conditioning, ________.

 A) nor can we afford it

 B) and nor we can afford it

 C) neither can afford it

 D) and we can neither afford itA

 58.She is a very ________ secretary: she never forgets anything or makes a mistake.

 A) anxious

 B) effective

 C) adequate

 D) efficientD

 59.The Browns ________ here, but not any more.

 A) were used to living

 B) had lived

 C) used to live

 D) had been livingC

 60.I’ll accept any job ________ I don’t have to get up early.

 A) lest

 B) as long as

 C) in case

 D) thoughB

 61.Once out of the earth’s gravity, the astronauts is ________ by the problem of weightlessness.

 A) affected

 B) effected

 C) inclined

 D) relatedA

 62.Medical research has shown that the widespread of use of cigarettes contributes ________ the increase of cancers.

 A) towards

 B) for

 C) with

 D) toD

 63.Could you find someone ________.

 A) for me to play tennis with

 B) for me to play tennis

 C) play tennis with

 D) playing tennis withA

 64.The computer has brought about surprising technological changes ________ we organize and produce information.

 A) in a way

 B) in the way

 C) in that way

 D) in no wayB

 65.The manager of the hotel requests that their guests ________ after 11:00 p.m.

 A) not to play loud music

 B) shouldn’t play loud music

 C) don’t play loud music

 D) couldn’t play loud musicB

 66.He is late again today. I’ll ________ that he will not be late tomorrow.

 A) be sure

 B) hope for

 C) felt

 D) to be feltB

 67.In Australia the Asians make their influence ________ in businesses large and small.

 A) feeling

 B) feel

 C) felt

 D) to be feltC

 68.This popular sports car is now being ________ at the rate of a thousand a week.

 A) turned down

 B) turned out

 C) turned up

 D) turned onB

 69.In Britain people drive ________ the left.

 A) at

 B) on

 C) to

 D) inB

 70.This programme will examine the writer’s books in detail, ________ an introduction to her life.

 A) following

 B) having followed

 C) being followed

 D) to be followedA

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

 As the place circled over the airport, everyone sensed that something was wrong. The plane was moving unsteadily through the air, and __71__ the passengers had fastened their seat belts, they were suddenly __72__ forward. At that moment, the air-hostess __73__. She looked very pale, but was quite __74__. Speaking quickly but almost in a whisper, she __75__ everyone that the pilot had __76__ and asked if any of the passengers knew anything about machines—or at __77__ how to drive a car. After a moment’s __78__, a man got up and followed the hostess into the pilot’s cabin.

 Moving the pilot __79__, the man took his seat and listened carefully to the __80__ instructions that were being sent by radio from the airport __81__. The plane was now dangerously close __82__ the ground, but to everyone’s __83__, it soon began to climb. The man had to __84__ the airport several times in order to become __85__ with the controls of the plane. __86__ the danger had not yet passed. The terrible __87__ came when he had to land. Following __88__, the man guided the plane to ward the airfield. It shook violently __89__ it touched the ground and then moved rapidly __90__ the runway and after a long run it stopped safely.

 71.A) although

 B) while

 C) therefore

 D) thenA

 72.A) shifted

 B) thrown

 C) put

 D) movedB

 73.A) showed

 B) presented

 C) exposed

 D) appearedB

 74.A) well

 B) still

 C) calm

 D) quietC

 75.A) inquired

 B) insured

 C) informed

 D) instructedC

 76.A) fallen

 B) failed

 C) faded

 D) faintedD

 77.A) best

 B) least

 C) length

 D) firstB

 78.A) hesitation

 B) surprise

 C) doubt

 D) delayA

 79.A) back

 B) aside

 C) about

 D) offB

 80.A) patient

 B) anxious

 C) urgent

 D) nervousC

 81.A) beneath

 B) under

 C) down

 D) belowD

 82.A) to

 B) by

 C) near

 D) onA

 83.A) horror

 B) trust

 C) pleasure

 D) reliefD

 84.A) surround

 B) circle

 C) observe

 D) viewB

 85.A) intimate

 B) familiar

 C) understood

 D) closeB

 86.A) Then

 B) Therefore

 C) But

 D) MoreoverC

 87.A) moment

 B) movement

 C) idea

 D) affairA

 88.A) impression

 B) information

 C) inspections

 D) instructionsD

 89.A) as

 B) unless

 C) while

 D) soA

 90.A) around

 B) over

 C) along

 D) aboveC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition on the topic The World Is Getting Smaller and Smaller. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.现代的交通工具越来越发达

 2.人与人之间的交往越来越频繁

 3.结论

19941月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.D

3.B

4.C

5.D

6.A

7.B

8.A

9.A

10.B

11.C

12.B

13.A

14.D

15.C

16.D

17.B

18.C

19.A

20.D


Part II


21.B

22.C

23.A

24.D

25.A

26.C

27.A

28.A

29.B

30.C

31.B

32.D

33.A

34.C

35.A

36.A

37.B

38.D

39.D

40.C


Part III


41.D

42.D

43.A

44.A

45.C

46.C

47.C

48.B

49.D

50.D

51.A

52.D

53.C

54.B

55.A

56.B

57.A

58.D

59.C

60.B

61.A

62.D

63.A

64.B

65.B

66.B

67.C

68.B

69.B

70.A


Part IV


71.A

72.B

73.B

74.C

75.C

76.D

77.B

78.A

79.B

80.C

81.D

82.A

83.D

84.B

85.B

86.C

87.A

88.D

89.A

90.C



19946月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) His wife doesn’t want him to.

 B) He will be out of town.

 C) He has some work to do.

 D) He doesn’t want to.A

 2.A) Do shopping.

 B) Make a phone call.

 C) Take a bus.

 D) Give them to the woman.B

 3.A) Maria’s friends don’t call her very often.

 B) Maria likes to talk on the phone with her friends.

 C) Maria doesn’t like to talk on the phone with her friends.

 D) Maria doesn’t have any friends.D

 4.A) In October.

 B) Between April and October.

 C) In April.

 D) She isn’t certain.B

 5.A) Once it starts raining, it’ll rain a lot.

 B) It has been raining for some time.

 C) They’re ready to catch the train.

 D) The train has just started off.C

 6.A) He offered her a pencil.

 B) He was afraid of losing his pen.

 C) He lent her his extra pen.

 D) He said he didn’t have any ink.C

 7.A) Bob will be on time.

 B) She hopes Bob won’t come.

 C) Bob can’t come.

 D) Bob will be late.A

 8.A) To the beach.

 B) To a restaurant.

 C) To a theatre.

 D) To the zoo.C

 9.A) Ask the woman to find Mr. White for him.

 B) Hold the phone.

 C) Pay the manager a visit.

 D) Make another call.D

 10.A) She is going to give up biology.

 B) She spends half of her time on biology and half on math.

 C) To her match is even more difficult than biology.

 D) To her biology is difficult, but math is not.B

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) He had to get a job.

 B) He was afraid of failure.

 C) He wanted to join the Army.

 D) He wasn’t interested in studying.A

 12.A) She was shocked.

 B) She was disappointed.

 C) She expressed doubts.

 D) She encouraged him.B

 13.A) He was lucky.

 B) He had a good wife.

 C) He was determined.

 D) He had a good teacher.A

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) She was driving along a country road.

 B) She was lying in a hospital bed.

 C) She was lying near a lonely road trembling.

 D) She was telling an astonishing story to a doctor.D

 15.A) She was attacked by robbers.

 B) She was stopped by a policeman.

 C) She fainted due to the effects of some drug.

 D) She was forced to enter a flying saucer.B

 16.A) The woman had been taken a long distance away from her home.

 B) The woman had intended to leave her husband without telling him.

 C) The woman had been dishonest to her husband.

 D) The woman made up an astonishing story.D

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) In the 15th century.

 B) In the 16th century.

 C) In the 5th century.

 D) In the 6th century.C

 18.A) Because it was at the seaside.

 B) Because it was the only modern building there.

 C) Because of the beautiful garden in front of it.

 D) Because of its old style of architecture.C

 19.A) To keep the tourists away.

 B) To welcome the tourists.

 C) To make money.

 D) To warn the tourists not to ruin his garden.A

 20.A) In order to earn more money.

 B) In order to have more peace.

 C) In order to welcome more visitors.

 D) In order to have a bigger garden.D

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 The failed Skylab will come screaming home to earth in disappointment sometime next month. But it will fall we know not where.

 That precise information is beyond even the calculations of scientists and their computers.

 The best they can tell us is that the space station, weighing 77 tons and as high as a 12 story building, will break into hundreds of pieces that will be scattered across a track 100 miles wide and 4,000 miles long.

 We are again exposed to one of those unexpected adventures, or misadventures, of science that attracts our attention from the boring routines of daily existence and encourages us to think a lot about man’s future.

 What worries Richard Smith, the Skylab’s director, is the “big pieces” that will come through the atmosphere, Two lumps, weighing 2 tons each, and ten, weighing at least 1,000 pounds each, will come in at speeds of hundreds of miles an hour and if they crash on land they will dig holes up to 100 feet deep.

 What worries us, with our lack of scientific knowledge and our quick imagination, is both the big and little pieces, although project officials say there is a very small chance that anyone will be injured by them.

 That’s good to know, but it doesn’t remove the doubts of the millions who still remember the nuclear accident at Three Mile Island. That accident took place in 1979 in spite of what the officials had assured us as to the safely of the nuclear reactor.

 21.Where the Skylab will fall?

 A) is kept secret

 B) has been made public

 C) has been predicted by scientists

 D) can’t be predicted even by computersD

 22.According to the passage, what does an incident such as the failed Skylab lead us to do?

 A) Not to believe in officials.

 B) To think about our future.

 C) Has been predicted by scientists.

 D) To fear for our lives.D

 23.The author suggests that ________.

 A) the danger of the Skylab’s fall has been overestimated

 B) it’s useless to worry over things you can’t do anything about

 C) the danger of the Skylab’s fall has been underestimated

 D) computers can solve the problem caused by the broken SkylabA

 24.The author refers to Three Mils Island ________.

 A) because he is doubtful about what the officials said

 B) because he fears that a piece of the Skylab may strike a nuclear power plant

 C) because he is afraid of the use of nuclear power

 D) because the nuclear reactor there and the Skylab were both built by the same companyB

 25.This passage is mainly about the author’s ________.

 A) interest in the failure of the Skylab

 B) willingness to give his advice

 C) eagerness to see more new scientific discoveries

 D) concern that science cannot answer all questionsC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 As supplier of most of the food we eat and of raw materials for many industrial processes, agriculture is clearly an important area of the economy. But the industrial performance of agriculture (the relative efficiency of agricultural production compared to other areas in the economy) is even more important than this. For in nations where the productivity of farmers is low, most of the working population is needed to raise food and few people are available for the production of investment goods or for other activities required for economic growth. Indeed, one of the factors related most closely to the per capita income (人均收入) of a nation is the fraction of its population engaged in farming. In the poorest nations of the world more than half of the population lives on farms. This compares sharply with less than 10 percent in western Europe and less than 4 percent in the United States.

 In short, the course of economic development in general depends in a fundamental way on the performance of farmers. This performance, in turn, depends on how agriculture is organized and on the economic environment, or market structure, within which it functions. In the following pages the performance of American agriculture is examined. It is appropriate to begin with a consideration of its market structure.

 26.This passage is most probably ________.

 A) a news item

 B) part of an introduction to a book

 C) part of a lecture

 D) an advertisementC

 27.What is the most important to agriculture is ________.

 A) the amount of food it produces

 B) the per capita income of farmers

 C) its industrial performance

 D) the production of investment goodsC

 28.The underlined word “this” in the first paragraph refers to ________.

 A) the provision of food and raw materials

 B) the productivity of farmers

 C) the production of investment goods

 D) the economy as a wholeA

 29.The performance of farmers essentially determines ________.

 A) the size of the working population

 B) the organization of agriculture

 C) the market structure

 D) the general development of economyD

 30.This passage will most probably be followed by a discussion of ________.

 A) the structure of American farming population

 B) the market structure of American agriculture

 C) the various functions of American agriculture

 D) the organization of American agricultureB

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage:

 Editor:

 While a new school term is about to begin, perhaps we should reconsider the matter of examinations. In July, two writers (Letters to the Editor) praised the cancellation of exams because they believe “tests don’t tell the whole story.”

 As a teacher who has worked in four countries, I have had the experience that a student who earns good marks is generally a good student, and that a student’s final mark in a subject is usually a grade average of the year’s work. Of course there are exceptions, but they do not have the frequency that would give an unfair picture of a student’s ability.

 The simple fact is that proper class work, diligent exam studies and good marks are almost certain indicators of a student’s future performance. The opposite is, almost certainly, incompetence.

 There is no acceptable substitute for competition and examination of quality. How can teachers and future officials determine what a student has learned and remembered? Should we simply take the student’s word for it? Any institution that “liberates” students from fair and formal exams is misguided, if not ignorant. And surely the “graduates” of such institutions will lack trustworthiness, not to mention being rejected by foreign universities for graduate or other studies.

 When all is said and done, I sense that a fear of failure and a fear of unpleasant comparison with others is at the bottom of most ban-exams (废除考试) talk. Excellence and quality fear nothing. On the contrary, they seek competition and desire the satisfaction of being the best.

 31.Which of the following will the author of this passage probably agree with?

 A) Tests are not effective in measuring the students’ abilities.

 B) Tests are an effective measure of the students’ abilities.

 C) Tests can only measure some of the students’ abilities.

 D) Tests may not be useful for measuring students’ abilities.()

 32.The two writers mentioned in the first paragraph ________.

 A) opposed judging students by the results of exams

 B) must have proposed other ways of testing students

 C) regarded exams as a way of punishing students

 D) seemed to be worried about the poor marks of their students()

 33.According to the letter, a student’s final mark ________.

 A) is often encouraging

 B) often gives a fair picture of the year’s work

 C) often proves unreliable

 D) often tells whether he likes the subject or not()

 34.If a student graduated from a university which does not require exams he would ________.

 A) have to continue his studies

 C) be incompetent

 B) have a feeling of failure

 D) not be admitted by foreign institutions()

 35.According to the letter, those who dislike the idea of examinations are probably afraid of ________.

 A) competing with other students

 C) working too hard

 B) being graded unfairly

 D) being dismissed from school()

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage:

 Time was—and not so many years ago, either—when the average citizen to ok a pretty dim view of banks and banking. That this was so, it should be said, was to no small extent the fault of banks and bankers themselves. Banks used to be—and a few still are—forbidding (令人生畏的) structures. Behind the little barred windows were, more often than not, elderly gentlemen w hose expression of friendliness reflected the size of the customer’s account, and nothing less than a few hundred thousand in the bank could have inspired the suggestion of a smile.

 And yet the average bank for many years was, to the average citizen, a fearful, if necessary, instrument for dealing with business—usually big business. But somewhere in the 1930’s banks started to grow human, even pleasant, and started to attract the little man. It is possible that this movement beg an in medium-sized towns, or in small towns where people know each other by their first names, and spread to big towns. At any rate, the results have be en remarkable.

 The movement to “humanize” banks, of course, received a new push during the war, when more and more women were employed to do work previously performed by men. Also more and more “little” people found themselves in need of personal loans, as taxes became heavier and as the practice of installment (分期付款) buying broke down the previously long-held concept that there was something almost morally wrong about being in debt. All sorts of people began to discover that the intelligent use of credit (信贷) could be extremely helpful

 .

 36.The author believes that the unfriendly atmosphere in banks many years a go was chiefly due to ________.

 A) the attitude of bankers

 B) unfriendliness of customers toward banks

 C) economic pressure of the time

 D) the outer appearance of bank buildings()

 37.The banks of many years ago showed interest only in ________.

 A) rich customers

 C) friendly businessmen

 B) regular visitors

 D) elderly gentlemen()

 38.When did banks begin to grow human?

 A) In the last century.

 C) Sometime before the war.

 B) A few years ago.

 D) During the war.()

 39.What helped the “humanization” of banks?

 A) The elderly gentlemen in banks were replaced by younger men.

 B) More and more “little” people became customers of banks.

 C) More banks were set up in small and medium-sized towns.

 D) The size of the customer’s account was greatly increased.()

 40.Ordinary people seldom borrowed money from banks in the past because ________.

 A) the bank buildings looked forbidding

 B) they were comparatively rich before the war

 C) they thought it was not proper to be in debt

 D) they rarely spent more than they could earn()

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

 41.I don’t know whether what she said is true, but I’ll try to ________ it.

 A) conform

 B) confirm

 C) confess

 D) confineA

 42.Last year Mike earned ________ his brother, though his brother has a better position.

 A) twice as much as

 B) twice as many as

 C) twice than

 D) twice as more asC

 43.If you suspect that the illness might be serious, you should not ________ going to the doctor.

 A) pick out

 B) make out

 C) put off

 D) give offD

 44.My only purpose was to get shelter ________ the snow, to get myself covered and warm.

 A) for

 B) form

 C) off

 D) overD

 45.Maggie ran back to the kitchen, eggs ________ carefully in her hands.

 A) were held

 B) to be held

 C) held

 D) holdingB

 46.I have two boys but ________ of them likes sweets.

 A) both

 B) none

 C) either

 D) neitherA

 47.The man to whom we handed the forms pointed out that they had not been ________ filled in.

 A) properly

 B) regularly

 C) thoroughly

 D) consequentlyC

 48.None of the servants were ________ when Mr. Smith wanted to send a message.

 A) allowable

 B) approachable

 C) available

 D) applicableA

 49.My sister’s professor had her ________ her paper many times before allowing her to present it to the committee.

 A) rewrite

 B) to rewrite

 C) rewritten

 D) rewritingD

 50.After a long and exhausting journey they arrived ________.

 A) till the last

 B) by the end

 C) at the end

 D) at lastB

 51.His understanding made a deep impression ________ the young girl.

 A) in

 B) on

 C) for

 D) toD

 52.Silver is the best conductor of electricity, copper ________ it closely.

 A) followed

 B) to follow

 C) following

 D) being followingA

 53.There is hardly an environment on earth ________ some species of animal or other has not adapted successfully.

 A) as to

 B) wherever

 C) so that

 D) to whichC

 54.It is highly desirable that a new president ________ to this college.

 A) appointed

 B) be appointed

 C) was appointed

 D) has been appointedB

 55.After searching for half an hour she realized that her glasses ________ on the table all the time.

 A) were lain

 B) had been lain

 C) had been lying

 D) would have been lyingC

 56.The time has come ________ we can make extensive use of nuclear energy.

 A) when

 B) while

 C) as

 D) sinceD

 57.Hardly ________ the helicopter ________ when the waiting crowd ran toward it.

 A) has ... landed

 B) had ... landed

 C) would ... land

 D) was ... landingA

 58.Although the weather was very bad the buses still ran on ________.

 A) list

 B) schedule

 C) plan

 D) arrangementA

 59.The situation today is obviously quite different from ________ it was only 50 years ago.

 A) such

 B) which

 C) when

 D) whatD

 60.Jane was hit on the head by the robber and was knocked ________.

 A) mindless

 B) unconscious

 C) brainless

 D) unawareB

 61.The traffic was very heavy, otherwise I ________ here 50 minutes sooner.

 A) would be

 B) should be

 C) had been

 D) would have BeenB

 62.________ you decide to take up, you should try to make it a success.

 A) If only

 B) Unless

 C) Whatever

 D) WheneverC

 63.This bird’s large wings ________ it to fly very fast.

 A) make

 B) cause

 C) enable

 D) ensureB

 64.In most of the United States, the morning newspaper is ________ by school-age children.

 A) directed

 B) discharged

 C) derived

 D) deliveredA

 65.It was not until be arrived at the station ________ he realised he had forgotten his ticket.

 A) that

 B) before

 C) when

 D) afterC

 66.Though the long-term ________ cannot be predicted, the project has been approved by the committee.

 A) effect

 B) effort

 C) affect

 D) affordA

 67.He asked ________ since he had been chairman for seven years.

 A) not to be re-elected

 B) to be not re-elected

 C) not to have been re-elected

 D) to have not been re-electedB

 68.Only by shouting at the top of his voice ________.

 A) he was able to make himself hear

 B) was he able to make himself hear

 C) he was able to make himself heard

 D) was he able to make himself heardD

 69.Jane was fairly good at English, but in mathematics she could not ________ the rest of the students in her class.

 A) put up with

 B) do away with

 C) keep up with

 D) run away withC

 70.He went ahead ________ all warnings about the danger of his mission.

 A) in case of

 B) because of

 C) prior to

 D) regardless ofD

Part IV Close (15 minutes)

 One of the most interesting of all studies is the study of words and word origins. Each language is __71__ of several earlier languages and the words of a language can sometimes be traced __72__ through two or three different languages to their __73__ Again a word from one language may pass into other languages and __74__ a new meaning. The word “etiquette,” which is __75__ French origin and originally Meant a label (标志), __76__ a sign, passed into Spanish and kept its original meaning. So in Spanish the word “etiquette” today is used to __77__ the small tags (标签) which a store __78__ to a suit, a dress or a bottle. The word “etiquette” in French, __79__, gradually developed a different meaning. It __80__ became the custom to write directions on small cards, or “etiquette”, as to how visitors should dress themselves and __81__ during an important ceremony at the royal court. __82__ the word “etiquette” began to indicate a system of correct manners for people to follow. __83__ this meaning, the word passed into English.

 Consider the word “breakfast”. “To fast” is to go for some period of time without __84__. Thus in the morning after many hours __85__ the night without food, one __86__ one’s fast.

 Consider the everyday English __87__ “Good-bye”. Many many years ago, people would say to each __88__ on parting “God be with you.” As this was __89__ over and over millions of times, it gradually became __90__ to “Good-bye”.

 71.A) collected

 B) made

 C) composed

 D) containedA

 72.A) to

 B) on

 C) in

 D) backA

 73.A) ends

 B) backgrounds

 C) bases

 D) originsC

 74.A) pick

 B) develop

 C) change

 D) chooseC

 75.A) of

 B) with

 C) on

 D) byA

 76.A) with

 B) and

 C) or

 D) forB

 77.A) show

 B) design

 C) hold

 D) indicateC

 78.A) lays

 B) attaches

 C) binds

 D) givesD

 79.A) however

 B) moreover

 C) therefore

 D) furthermoreD

 80.A) late

 B) lately

 C) later

 D) latestA

 81.A) respond

 B) prepare

 C) act

 D) followB

 82.A) Thus

 B) Also

 C) Yet

 D) NeverthelessA

 83.A) After

 B) With

 C) Of

 D) ForC

 84.A) sleeping

 B) working

 C) eating

 D) talkingB

 85.A) for

 B) during

 C) at

 D) onD

 86.A) breaks

 B) continues

 C) remembers

 D) forgetsB

 87.A) statement

 B) expression

 C) proverb

 D) conversationB

 88.A) other

 B) person

 C) one

 D) memberD

 89.A) reproduced

 B) revised

 C) reviewed

 D) repeatedA

 90.A) combined

 B) accepted

 C) reformed

 D) shortenedC

Part V Writing (15 minutes)

 1.人们对职业各有不同的理想

 2.我理想的职业是什么

 3.我怎样为我理想的职业做准备

19946月四级参考答案

Part I


1.A

2.B

3.D

4.B

5.C

6.C

7.A

8.C

9.D

10.B

11.A

12.B

13.A

14.D

15.B

16.D

17.C

18.C

19.A

20.D


Part II


21.D

22.D

23.A

24.B

25.C

26.D

27.A

28.C

29.C

30.A

31.B

32.D

33.C

34.B

35.A

36.D

37.B

38.C

39.B

40.A


Part III


41.A

42.C

43.D

44.D

45.B

46.A

47.C

48.A

49.D

50.B

51.D

52.A

53.C

54.B

55.C

56.D

57.A

58.A

59.D

60.B

61.B

62.C

63.B

64.A

65.C

66.A

67.B

68.D

69.C

70.D


Part IV


71.D

72.A

73.C

74.C

75.A

76.B

77.C

78.D

79.D

80.A

81.B

82.A

83.C

84.B

85.D

86.B

87.B

88.D

89.A

90.C


19951月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) Go out to work.

 B) Listen carefully to John.

 C) Be calm and patient.

 D) Do the easiest thing.C

 2.A) He doesn’t like to talk.

 B) He is a very kind man.

 C) He is friendly.

 D) He is not a pleasant person.D

 3.A) The doctor won’t see her tomorrow.

 B) The doctor is busy tomorrow.

 C) The doctor is busy all day today.

 D) The doctor will see her today.C

 4.A) Young people are too quick in making decisions.

 B) Young people seldom stay long on the same job.

 C) Young people lose their jobs easily.

 D) Young people are too eager to succeed.B

 5.A) She felt it was tiring.

 B) She felt it was very nice.

 C) She thought it took less time.

 D) She thought it was expensive.B

 6.A) They are having breakfast.

 B) They are eating some fruit.

 C) They are preparing a hot soup.

 D) They are drinking cold milk.A

 7.A) The woman doesn’t want to spend Christmas with the man.

 B) The woman is going home for Christmas party.

 C) The woman has not been invited to the Christmas party.

 D) The woman is going to spend Christmas abroad.D

 8.A) By car.

 B) By bus.

 C) By place.

 D) By train.A

 9.A) It closes at four on weekdays.

 B) He doesn’t know its business hours.

 C) It isn’t open on Sundays.

 D) It is open till four on Sundays.D

 10.A) Tennis shoes.

 B) Some clothes.

 C) Nothing yet.

 D) Music records.C

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) In about 20 years.

 B) Within a week.

 C) In a couple of weeks.

 D) As early as possible.D

 12.A) Yes, of course.

 B) Possibly not.

 C) Not mentioned.

 D) Definitely not.D

 13.A) Her complaint was ignored.

 B) The store sent her the correct order.

 C) The store apologized for their mistake.

 D) The store picked up the wrong items.A

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) The prison gates always open.

 B) Its prisoner can work outside.

 C) The prison has no armed guards.

 D) The prison is open to the public.B

 15.A) The prisoners are provided with jobs on release.

 B) Its prisoners are seldom made to work overtime.

 C) It is run on the principle of trusting prisoners.

 D) It has no security measures.C

 16.A) One year.

 B) Two years.

 C) Thirteen years.

 D) Fourteen years.D

 17.A) Doubtful.

 B) Positive.

 C) Critical.

 D) Indifferent.B

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) It’s good for training one’s character but not good for one’s health.

 B) It cannot prepare pupils to be good citizens.

 C) It has less effect on a child’s character than sports and games.

 D) It’s as important as after-class activities.C

 19.A) Because pupils there have to spend most of the time studying.

 B) Because the school authorities insist on traditional ways of teaching.

 C) Because the school authorities have neglected discipline.

 D) Because pupils there are too fond of playing.A

 20.A) Practical work.

 B) Collective activities.

 C) Teacher’s encouragement.

 D) Book knowledge.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 People tend to be more impressed by evidence that seems to confirm some relationship. Thus many are convinced their dreams are prophetic (预言的) because a few have come true; they fail to notice the many that have not. Consider also the belief that “the phone always rings when I’m in the shower.” If it does ring while you are in the shower, the event will stand out and be remembered. If it doesn’t ring, that nonevent probably won’t even register (留下印象).

 People want to see order, pattern and meaning in the world. Consider, for example, the common belief that things like personal misfortunes, plane crashes, and deaths “happen in threes.” Such beliefs stem from the tendency of people to allow the third event to define the time period. If three plane crashes occur in a month, then the period of time that counts as their “happening together” is one month; if three crashes occur in a year, the period of time is stretched. Flexible end points reinforce such beliefs.

 We also tend to believe what we want to believe. A majority of people think they are more intelligent, more fair-minded and more skilled behind the wheel of an automobile than the average person. Part of the reason we view ourselves so favorably is that we use criteria that work to our advantage. As economist Thomas Schelling explains, “Everybody ranks himself high in qualities he values: careful drivers give weight to care, skilled drivers give weight to skill, and those who are polite give weight to courtesy,” This way everyone ranks high on his own scale.

 Perhaps the most important mental habit we can learn is to be cautious (谨慎的) in drawing conclusions. The “evidence” of everyday life is sometimes misleading.

 21.In the first paragraph the author states that ________.

 A) dreams cannot be said to be prophetic even though a few have come true

 B) dreams are prophetic because some of them did come true

 C) dreams may come true if clearly remembered

 D) dreams and reality are closely relatedA

 22.By “things like...” “happen in threes” (Para. 3, Line 2), the author indicates that people believe ________.

 A) personal misfortunes tend to happen every now and then

 B) personal misfortunes, plane crashes, and deaths usually happen together

 C) misfortunes tend to occur according to certain patterns

 D) misfortunes will never occur more than three times to a person in his lifetimeC

 23.Ten word “courtesy” (Para. 4, line 6) probably means ________.

 A) good manners

 B) appropriate speech

 C) friendly relations

 D) satisfactory serviceA

 24.What can be inferred from the passage? ________.

 A) Happenings that go unnoticed deserve more attention.

 B) In a series of misfortunes the third one is usually the most serious.

 C) People tend to make use of evidence that supports their own beliefs.

 D) Believers of misfortunes happening in threes are cautious in interpreting events.A

 25.It can be concluded from the passage that ________.

 A) there is some truth even in the wildest dreams

 B) one should take notice of other people’s merits

 C) there is no order or pattern in world events

 D) we should not base our conclusions on accidental evidenceD

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 It has been thought and said that Africans are born with musical talent. Because music is so important in the lives of many Africans and because so much music is performed in Africa, we are inclined to think that Africans are musicians. The impression is strengthened when we look at ourselves and find that we have become largely a society of musical spectators (旁观). Music is important to us, but most of us can be considered consumers rather than producers of music. We have records, television, concerts, and radio to fulfill many of our musical needs. In most situations where music is performed in our culture it is not difficult to distinguish the audience from the performers, but such is often not the case in Africa. Alban Ayipaga, a Kasena semiprofessional musician from northern Ghana, says that when his flute (长笛) and drum ensemble (歌舞团) is performing. “Anybody can take part”. This is true, but Kasena musicians recognize that not all people are equally capable of taking part in the music. Some can sing along with the drummers, but relatively few can drum and even fewer can play the flute along with the ensemble. It is fairly common in Africa for there to be an ensemble of expert musicians surrounded by others who join in by clapping, singing, or somehow adding to the totality of musical sound. Performances often take place in an open area (that is, not on a stage) and so the lines between the performing nucleus and the additional performers, active spectators, and passive spectators may be difficult to draw from our point of view.

 26.The difference between us and Africans, as far as music is concerned, is that ________.

 A) most of us are consumers while most of them are producers of music

 B) we are musical performers and they are semiprofessional musicians

 C) most of us are passive spectators while they are active spectators

 D) we are the audience and they are the additional performersC

 27.The word “such” (Line 6) refers to the fact that ________.

 A) music is performed with the participation of the audience

 B) music is performed without the participation of the audience

 C) people tend to distinguish the audience from the performers

 D) people have records, television sets and radio to fulfill their musical needsB

 28.The author of the passage implies that ________.

 A) all Africans are musical and therefore much music is performed in Africa

 B) not all Africans are born with musical talent although music is important in their lives

 C) most Africans are capable of joining in the music by playing musical instruments

 D) most Africans perform as well as professional musiciansB

 29.The word “nucleus” (Line 13) probably refers to ________.

 A) musicians famous in Africa

 B) musicians at the center of attention

 C) musicians acting as the core in a performance

 D) active participants in a musical performanceD

 30.The best title for this passage would be ________.

 A) The Importance of Music to African People

 B) Differences Between African Music and Music of Other Countries

 C) The Relationship Between Musicians and Their Audience

 D) A Characteristic Feature of African Musical PerformancesD

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Most people would agree that, although our age exceeds all previous ages in knowledge, there has been no corresponding increase in wisdom. But Agreement ceases as soon as we attempt to define “wisdom” and consider means of promoting it.

 There are several factors that contribute to wisdom. Of these I should put first a sense of proportion: the capacity to take account of all the important factors in a problem and to attach to each its due weight. This has become more difficult than it used to be owing to the extent and complexity of the special knowledge required of various kinds of technicians. Suppose, for example, that you are engaged in research in scientific medicine. The work is difficult and is likely to absorb the whole of your mind. You have no time to consider the effect which your discoveries or inventions may have outside the field of medicine. You succeed (let us say) as modern medicine has succeeded, in enormously lowering the infant death-rate, not only in Europe and America, but also in Asia and Africa. This has the entirely unintended result of making the food supply inadequate and lowing the standard of life in the parts of the world that have the greatest populations. To take an even more dramatic example, which is in everybody’s mind at the present time; you study the makeup of the atom from a disinterested (无利害关系的) desire for knowledge, and by chance place in the hands of a powerful mad man the means of destroying the human race.

 Therefore, with every increase of knowledge and skill, wisdom becomes more necessary, for every such increase augments (增强) our capacity for realizing our purposes, and therefore augments our capacity for evil, if our purpose are unwise.

 31.Disagreement arises when people try to decide ________.

 A) how much more wisdom we have now than before

 B) what wisdom is and how to develop it

 C) if there is a great increase of wisdom in our age

 D) whether wisdom can be developed or notB

 32.According to the author, “wisdom” is the ability to ________.

 A) carefully consider the bad effects of any kind of research work

 B) give each important problem some careful consideration

 C) acquire a great deal of complex and special knowledge

 D) give suitable consideration to all the possible elements in a problemD

 33.Lowering the infant death-rate may ________.

 A) prove to be helpful everywhere in the world

 B) give rise to an increase in population in Europe

 C) cause food shortages in Asia and Africa

 D) raise the living standard of the people in AfricaC

 34.The author uses the examples in the passage to illustrate his point that ________.

 A) it’s extremely difficult to consider all the important elements in problem

 B) success in medical research has its negative effects

 C) scientists may unknowingly cause destruction to the human race

 D) it’s unwise to be totally absorbed in research in scientific medicineA

 35.What is the main idea of the passage?

 A) It is unwise to place the results of scientific research in the hands of a powerful mad man.

 B) The more knowledge one has, the wiser one becomes.

 C) Any increase of knowledge could lead to disastrous results without the guidance of wisdom.

 D) Wisdom increases in proportion to one’s age.C

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 For any given task in Britain there are more men than are needed. Strong unions keep them there in Fleet Street, home of some London’s biggest dailies, it is understood that when two unions quarrel over three jobs, the argument is settled by giving each union two. That means 33 per cent overmanning, 33 per cent less productivity than could be obtained.

 A reporter who has visited plants throughout Europe has an impression that the pace of work is much slower here. Nobody tries too hard. Tea breaks do matter and are frequent. It is hard to measure intensity of work, but Britons give a distinct impression of going at their tasks in a more leisurely way.

 But is all this so terrible? It certainly does not improve the gross national product or output per worker. Those observant visitors, however, have noticed something else about Britain. It is a pleasant place.

 Street crowds in Stockholm. Paris and New York move quickly and silently heads down, all in a hurry. London crowds tend to walk at an easy pace (except in the profitable, efficient City, the financial district).

 Every stranger is struck by the patient and orderly way in which Britons queue for a bus: if the saleswoman is slow and out of stock she will likely say, ‘oh dear, what a pity’; the rubbish collectors stop to chat (聊天) and call the housewives “Luv.” Crime rises here as in every city but there still remains a gentle tone and temper that is unmatched in Berlin, Milan or Detroit.

 In short, what is wrong with Britain may also be what is right. Having reached a tolerable standard, Britons appear to be choosing leisure over goods.

 36.What happens when disputes over job opportunities arise among British unions?

 A) Thirty three per cent of the workers will be out of work.

 B) More people will be employed than necessary.

 C) More jobs will be created by the government.

 D) The unions will try to increase productivity.B

 37.What does the reporter who has visited plants throughout Europe think about Britain? ________.

 A) Tea breaks do not affect the intensity of work in Britain.

 B) Britons do their work in an unhurried sort of way.

 C) The pace of work in Continental Europe is much slower than in Britain.

 D) Britons give the impression of working intensively.B

 38.“The breaks matter” (Para. 2, Line 2) indicates that ________.

 A) they are an important aspect of the British way of life

 B) they are greatly enjoyed by British workers

 C) they can be used by the workers as an excuse to take time off from work

 D) they help the workers to be on good terms with each otherA

 39.The word “this” (Para. 3, Line 1) the author means to say that ________.

 A) there are more men on any given job than are needed

 B) 33 per cent overmanning leads to 33 per cent less productivity

 C) it is difficult to measure the intensity of work

 D) Britons generally do not want to work too hardA

 40.By “what is wrong with Britain may also be what is right” (Para. 6, Line 1) the author means to say that ________.

 A) quarrels between unions will help create jobs

 B) a leisurely way of life helps Britons increase productivity

 C) the gentle tone and temper of the people in Britain makes it a pleasant place

 D) Britons will not sacrifice their leisure to further increase productivityD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

 41.The grey building is where the workers live, and the white one is where the spare parts ________.

 A) are producing

 B) are produced

 C) produced

 D) being producedB

 42.I could not persuade him to accept it, ________ make him see the important of it.

 A) if only I could not

 B) no more than I could

 C) or I could not

 D) nor could ID

 43.Because of the ________ emphasis placed on classroom work, the instructor will report your absences to the adviser.

 A) large

 B) strong

 C) hard

 D) highB

 44.Homework ________ on time will lead to better grades.

 A) done

 B) be done

 C) having done

 D) to have been doneA

 45.The speech ________ a lively discussion started.

 A) being delivered

 B) was delivered

 C) be delivered

 D) having been deliveredD

 46.I have had great deal of trouble ________ the rest of the class.

 A) coming up against

 B) making up for

 C) keeping up with

 D) living up toC

 47.________ for my illness I would have lent him a helping hand.

 A) Not being

 B) Had it not been

 C) Without being

 D) Not having beenB

 48.________ a teacher in a university, it is necessary to have at least a master’s degree.

 A) To become

 B) Become

 C) One become

 D) On becomingA

 49.The little man was ________ more than one metre fifty tall.

 A) nearly

 B) quite

 C) hardly

 D) almostA

 50.Certain programs work better for some ________ for others.

 A) and

 B) than

 C) as

 D) butB

 51.Some plants are so sensitive ________ pollution that they can only survive in a perfectly clean environment.

 A) from

 B) against

 C) to

 D) withC

 52.It does not alter the fact that he was the man ________ for the death of the little girl.

 A) accounting

 B) guilty

 C) responsible

 D) obligedC

 53.Medical care reform has become this country’s most important public health ________.

 A) question

 B) stuff

 C) matter

 D) issueC

 54.Not that John doesn’t want to help you, ________ it’s beyond his power.

 A) but that

 B) for that

 C) and that

 D) in thatA

 55.It is not unusual for workers in that region ________.

 A) to be paid more than a month late

 B) to be paid later than more a month

 C) to pay later than a month more

 D) to pay late more than a monthA

 56.I used to smoke ________ but I gave it up three years ago.

 A) seriously

 B) heavily

 C) badly

 D) severelyB

 57.The doctor told Penny that too much ________ to the sun is bad for the skin.

 A) exposure

 B) extension

 C) exhibition

 D) expansionA

 58.Michael used to look hurt and surprised when ________.

 A) scolding

 B) to scold

 C) having scolded

 D) scoldedD

 59.He decided to make further improvements on the computer’s design ________ the light of the requirements of customers.

 A) on

 B) for

 C) in

 D) withC

 60.If you don’t like to swim, you ________ stay at home.

 A) should as well

 B) may as well

 C) can as well

 D) would as wellB

 61.To be frank, I’d rather you ________ in the case.

 A) will not be involved

 B) not involved

 C) not to be involved

 D) were not involvedD

 62.If you suspect that the illness might be serious you should not ________ going to the doctor.

 A) put off

 B) hold back

 C) put aside

 D) hold upA

 63.If you want to know the train schedule, please ________ at the booking office.

 A) acquire

 B) inquire

 C) request

 D) requireB

 64.He thought that ________.

 A) the effort doing the job was not worth

 B) the effort was not worth in doing the job

 C) it was not worth the effort doing the job

 D) it was not worth the effort by doing the jobC

 65.The coming of the railways in the 1830s ________ our society and economic life.

 A) transformed

 B) transported

 C) transferred

 D) transmittedA

 66.I have no objection ________ the evening with them.

 A) to spend

 B) to spending

 C) of spending

 D) spendingB

 67.Realizing that he hadn’t enough money and ________ to borrow from his father, he decided to sell his watch.

 A) not wanted

 B) not to want

 C) not wanting

 D) wanting notC

 68.In preparing scientific reports of laboratory experiments, a student should ________ his findings in logical order and clear language.

 A) furnish

 B) propose

 C) raise

 D) presentD

 69.________ they reached the centre of the city, they stopped the car at a bar.

 A) Before a mile or so when

 B) For a mile or so after

 C) Further than a mile or so

 D) A mile or so beforeD

 70.They are teachers and don’t realize ________ to start and run a company.

 A) what it takes

 B) what takes it

 C) what they take

 D) what takes themA

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

 Did you ever have someone’s name on the tip of your tongue and yet you were unable to recall it? __71__ this happens again, do not __72__ to recall it. Do something __73__ for a couple of minutes. __74__ the name may come into your head. The name is there, since you have met __75__ person and learned his name. It __76__ has to be dug out. The initial effort to recall __77__ the mind for operation, but it is the subconscious (下意识的) __78__ that go to work to dig up a __79__ memory. Forcing yourself to recall __80__ never helps because it doesn’t __81__ your memory; it only tightens it. Students find the preparatory method helpful __82__ examinations. They read over the questions __83__ trying to answer any of them. __84__ they answer first the ones __85__ which they are most confident. Meanwhile, deeper mental activities in the subconscious mind are taking __86__; work is being done on the __87__ difficult question. By the time the easier questions are answered, answers __88__ the more difficult ones will usually begin to __89__ into consciousness. It is often __90__ a question of waiting for recall to come to the memory.

 71.A) As

 B) When

 C) While

 D) WhetherB

 72.A) try

 B) want

 C) hesitate

 D) waitA

 73.A) simple

 B) apart

 C) else

 D) similarC

 74.A) unless

 B) and

 C) or

 D) untilB

 75.A) some

 B) certain

 C) a

 D) thisD

 76.A) then

 B) really

 C) only

 D) indeedC

 77.A) leads

 B) begins

 C) helps

 D) preparesD

 78.A) deeds

 B) activities

 C) movements

 D) proceduresB

 79.A) light

 B) fresh

 C) dim

 D) darkC

 80.A) merely

 B) almost

 C) barely

 D) hardlyB

 81.A) loosen

 B) weaken

 C) decrease

 D) reduceA

 82.A) into

 B) in

 C) about

 D) byB

 83.A) after

 B) besides

 C) before

 D) againstC

 84.A) Thus

 B) But

 C) Therefore

 D) ThenD

 85.A) of

 B) with

 C) for

 D) inA

 86.A) place

 B) shape

 C) charge

 D) actionA

 87.A) too

 B) less

 C) not

 D) moreD

 88.A) to

 B) of

 C) about

 D) forA

 89.A) appear

 B) grow

 C) extend

 D) comeD

 90.A) nearly

 B) likely

 C) just

 D) evenC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition on the topic Can Money Buy Happiness? You should write no less than 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.有人认为金钱是幸福之本(source of happiness)

 2.也有人认为金钱是万恶之源(root of all evil)

 3.我的看法

 Remember to write your composition neatly.

19951月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.D

3.C

4.B

5.B

6.A

7.D

8.A

9.D

10.C

11.D

12.D

13.A

14.B

15.C

16.D

17.B

18.C

19.A

20.B


Part II


21.A

22.C

23.A

24.A

25.D

26.C

27.B

28.B

29.D

30.D

31.B

32.D

33.C

34.A

35.C

36.B

37.B

38.A

39.A

40.D


Part III


41.B

42.D

43.B

44.A

45.D

46.C

47.B

48.A

49.A

50.B

51.C

52.C

53.C

54.A

55.A

56.B

57.A

58.D

59.C

60.B

61.D

62.A

63.B

64.C

65.A

66.B

67.C

68.D

69.D

70.A


Part IV


71.B

72.A

73.C

74.B

75.D

76.C

77.D

78.B

79.C

80.B

81.A

82.B

83.C

84.D

85.A

86.A

87.D

88.A

89.D

90.C


19956月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) Librarian and student.

 B) Operator and caller.

 C) Boss and secretary.

 D) Customer and repairman.D

 2.A) Look for the key.

 B) Repair the car.

 C) Fix a shelf.

 D) Paint a shelf.C

 3.A) To make the woman angry.

 B) To please the man’s mother.

 C) David is the man’s good friend.

 D) David is good at carrying on conversations.B

 4.A) He must meet his teacher.

 B) He must attend a class.

 C) He must go out with his girlfriend.

 D) He must stay at school to finish his homework.A

 5.A) He wants to pay.

 B) he doesn’t want to eat out

 C) He wants to eat somewhere else.

 D) He doesn’t like Japanese food.A

 6.A) He didn’t work as hard as he was supposed to.

 B) He didn’t pass the physics exam.

 C) He did better in an earlier exam.

 D) He found something wrong with the exam.B

 7.A) He is attending his sick mother at home.

 B) He is on a European tour with his mother.

 C) He is at home on sick leave.

 D) He is in Europe to see his mother.D

 6.A) They don’t know how to get to Mike’s home.

 B) They are discussing when to meet again.

 C) They went to the same party some time ago.

 D) They will go to Mike’s birthday party.C

 9.A) Five lessons.

 B) Three lessons.

 C) Twelve lessons.

 D) Fifteen lessons.B

 10.A) Find a larger room.

 B) Sell the old table.

 C) Buy two bookshelves.

 D) Rearrange some furniture.D

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) Courses in British history.

 B) Language courses.

 C) Courses in sports.

 D) Teacher training courses.B

 12.A) To attract more students.

 B) To make the courses suitable for students of all levels.

 C) To let the students have a good rest.

 D) To make the summer school more like a holiday.D

 13.A) Because they all work very hard.

 B) Because their teachers are all native speakers of English.

 C) Because they learn not only in but also out of class.

 D) Because they are all advanced students.C

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) Because it takes too long to process all the applications.

 B) Because its resources are limited.

 C) Because it is a library for special purposes.

 D) Because there is a shortage of staff.B

 15.A) Discard his application from.

 B) Forbid him to borrow any items.

 C) Cancel his video card.

 D) Ask him to apply again.C

 16.A) One month.

 B) One week.

 C) Two weeks.

 D) Two months.A

Passage Three

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) Chemicals.

 B) Vapor.

 C) Water.

 D) Gas.D

 18.A) By passing steam over dry ice.

 B) By turning ordinary ice into steam.

 C) By heating dry ice.

 D) By mixing dry ice with ordinary ice.A

 19.A) It takes a longer time to melt.

 B) It is lighter to carry.

 C) It is cleaner to use than ordinary ice.

 D) It is not so cold as ordinary ice.C

 20.A) In the 1920’s.

 B) In the 1930’s.

 C) In the 1940’s.

 D) In the 1950’s.A

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Researchers have established that when people are mentally engaged, biochemical changes occur in the brain that allow it to act more effectively in cognitive (认知的) areas such as attention and memory. This is true regardless of age.

 People will be alert (警觉的) and receptive (接受能力强的) if they are faced with information that gets them to think about things they are interested in. And someone with a history of doing more rather than less will go into old age more cognitively sound than someone who has not had an active mind.

 Many experts are so convinced of the benefits of challenging the brain that they are putting, the theory to work in their own lives. “The idea is not necessarily to learn to memorize enormous amounts of information.” says James Fozard, associate director of the national Institute on Aging. “Most of us don’t need that kind of skill. Such specific training is of less interest than being able to maintain mental alertness. Fozard and others say they challenge their brains with different mental skill, both because they enjoy them and because they are sure that their range of activities will help the way their brains work.

 Gene Cohen, acting director of the same institute, suggests that people in their old age should engage in mental and physical activities individually as well as in groups. Cohen says that we are frequently advised to keep physically active as we age, but older people need to keep mentally active as well. Those who do are more likely to maintain their intellectual abilities and to be generally happier and better adjusted. “The point is, you need to do both,” Cohen says. “Intellectual activity influences brain-cell health and size.”

 21.People who are cognitively healthy are those ________.

 A) who can remember large amounts of information

 B) who are highly intelligent

 C) whose minds are alert and receptive

 D) who are good at recognizing different soundsC

 22.According to Fozard’s argument people can make their brains work more efficiently by ________.

 A) constantly doing memory work

 B) taking part in various mental activities

 C) going through specific training

 D) making frequent adjustmentsB

 23.The findings of James and other scientists in their work ________.

 A) remain a theory to be further proved

 B) have been generally accepted

 C) have been challenged by many other experts

 D) are practiced by the researchers themselvesD

 24.Older people are generally advised to ________.

 A) keep fit by going in for physical activities

 B) keep mentally active by challenging their brains

 C) maintain mental alertness through specific training

 D) maintain a balance between individual and group activitiesA

 25.What is the passage mainly about?

 A) How biochemical changes occur in the human brain.

 B) Why people should keep active not only physically but also mentally.

 C) How intellectual activities influence brain-cell health.

 D) Why people should receive special mental training as they age.B

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Attention to detail is something everyone can and should do—especially in a tight job market. Bob Crossley, a human-resources expert notices this in the job applications that come across his desk every day. “It’s amazing how many candidates eliminate themselves.” he says.

Resume (简历) arrive with stains. Some candidates don’t bother to spell the company’s name correctly. Once I see a mistake, I eliminate the candidate, Crossley concludes. “If they cannot take of these details, why should we trust them with a job?”

 Can we pay too much attention to detail? Absolutely. Perfectionists struggle over little things at the cost of something larger they work toward, “To keep from losing the forest for the trees”, says Charles Garfield, associate professor at the University of California, San Francisco, “We must constantly ask ourselves how the details we’re working on fit into the larger picture. If they don’t, we should drop them and move to something else”.

 Garfield compares this process to his work as a computer scientist at NASA. “The Apollo II moon launch was slightly off-course 90 percent of the time.” Says Garfield, “But a successful landing was still likely because we knew the exact coordinates of our goal. This allowed us to make adjustments as necessary.” Knowing where we want to go helps us judge the importance of every task we undertake.

 Too often we believe what accounts for others’ success is some special secret or a lucky break (机遇). But rarely is success so mysterious. Again and again, we see that by doing little things within our grasp well, large rewards follow.

 26.According to the passage, some job applicants were rejected ________.

 A) because of their carelessness as shown in their failure to present a clean copy of a resume

 B) because of their inadequate education as shown in their poor spelling in writing a resume

 C) because they failed to give detailed description of their background in their applications

 D) because they eliminated their names from the applicants’ list themselvesA

 27.The word “perfectionists” (Para. 3, Line) refers to those who ________.

 A) demand others to get everything absolutely right

 B) know how to adjust their goals according to the circumstances

 C) pay too much attention to details only to lose their major objectives

 D) are capable of achieving perfect results in whatever they doC

 28.Which of the following is the author’s device to the reader?

 A) Although too much attention to details may be costly, they should not be overlooked.

 B) Don’t forget details when drawing pictures.

 C) Be aware of the importance of a task before undertaking it.

 D) Careless applicants are not to be trusted.A

 29.The example of the Apollo II moon launch is given to illustrate that ________.

 A) minor mistakes can be ignored in achieving major objectives

 B) failure is the mother of success

 C) adjustments are the key to the successful completion of any work

 D) keeping one’s goal in mind helps in deciding which details can be overlookedD

 30.The best title for this passage would be ________.

 A) Don’t Be a Perfectionist

 B) Importance of Adjustments

 C) Details and Major Objectives

 D) Hard Work Plus Good LuckC

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Britain almost more than any other country in the world must seriously face the problem of building upwards, that is to say, of accommodating a considerable proportion of its population in high blocks of flats. It is said that the English man objects to this type of existence, but if the case is such, he does in fact differ from the inhabitants of most countries of the world today. In the past our own blocks of flats have been associated with the lower-income groups and they have lacked the obvious provisions, such as central heating, constant hot water supply, electrically operated lifts from top to bottom, and so on, as well as such details, important notwithstanding (然而), as easy facilities for disposal of dust and rubbish and storage places for baby carriages in the ground floor, playgrounds for children on the top of the buildings, and drying grounds for washing. It is likely that the dispute regarding flats versus (对,对抗) individual houses will continue to rage on for a long time as far as Britain is concerned. And it is unfortunate that there should be hot feelings on both sides whenever this subject is raised. Those who oppose the building of flats base their case primarily on the assumption (设想) that everyone prefers an individual home and on the high cost per unit of accommodation. The latter ignores the higher cost of providing full services to a scattered community and the cost in both money and time of the journeys to work for the suburban resident.

 31.We can infer from the passage that ________.

 A) English people, like most people in other countries, dislike living in flats

 B) people in most countries of the world today are not opposed to living in flats

 C) people in Britain are forced to move into high blocks of flats

 D) modern flats still fail to provide the necessary facilities for livingB

 32.What is said about blocks of flats built in the past in Britain?

 A) They were mostly inhabited by people who did not earn much.

 B) They were usually not large enough to accommodate big families.

 C) They were sold to people before necessary facilities were installed.

 D) They provided playgrounds for children on the top of the buildings.A

 33.The word “rage” (Line 9) means ________.

 A) be ignored

 B) develop with great force

 C) encourage people greatly

 D) be in fashionB

 34.Some people oppose the building of flats because ________.

 A) the living expenses for each individual family are higher

 B) it involves higher cost compared with the building of houses

 C) they believe people like to live in houses with gardens

 D) the disposal of rubbish remains a problem for those living in flatsC

 35.The author mentions that people who live in suburban houses ________.

 A) do not have access to easy facilities because they live away from the city

 B) have to pay a lot of money to employ people to do service work

 C) take longer time to know each other because they are a scattered community

 D) have to spend more money and time travelling to work every dayD

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 Where do pesticides (杀虫剂) fit into the picture of environmental disease? We have seen that they now pollute soil, water and food, that they have the power to make our streams fishless and our gardens and woodlands silent and birdless. Man, however much he may like to pretend the contrary, is part of nature. Can he escape a pollution that is now so thoroughly distributed throughout our world:

 We know that even single exposures to these chemicals, if the amount is large enough, can cause extremely severe poisoning. But this is not the major problem. The sudden illness or death of farmers, farm workers, and others exposed to sufficient quantities of pesticides is very sad and should not occur. For the population as a whole, we must be more concerned with the delayed effects of absorbing small amounts of the pesticides that invisibly pollute our world.

 Responsible public health officials have pointed out that the biological effects of chemicals are cumulative (累积) over long periods of time, and that the danger to individual may depend on the sum of the exposures received throughout his lifetime. For these very reasons the danger is easily ignored. It is human nature to shake off what may seem to us a threat of future disaster. “Men are naturally most impressed by diseases which have obvious signs,” says a wise physician, Dr. Rene Dubos, “yet some of their worst enemies slowly approach them unnoticed.”

 36.Which of the following is closest in meaning to the sentence “Man... is part of nature” (Para. 1, Lines 3-4)?

 A) Man appears indifferent to what happens in nature.

 B) Man acts as if he does not belong to nature.

 C) Man can avoid the effects of environmental pollution.

 D) Man can escape his responsibilities for environmental effects of pesticides?B

 37.What is the author’s attitude toward the environmental effects of pesticides?

 A) Pessimistic

 B) Indifferent

 C) Defensive

 D) ConcernedD

 38.In the author’s view, the sudden death caused by exposure to large amounts of pesticides ________.

 A) is not the worst of the negative consequences resulting from the use of pesticides

 B) now occurs most frequently among all accidental deaths

 C) has sharply increased so as to become the center of public attention

 D) is unavoidable because people can’t do without pesticides in farmingA

 39.People tend to ignore the delayed effects of exposure to chemical because ________.

 A) limited exposure to them does little harm to people’s health

 B) the present is more important for them than the future

 C) the danger does not become apparent immediately

 D) humans are capable of withstanding small amounts of poisoningC

 40.It can be concluded from Dr. Dubos remarks that ________.

 A) people find invisible diseases difficult to deal with

 B) attacks by hidden enemies tend to be fatal

 C) diseases with obvious signs are easy to cure

 D) people tend to overlook hidden dangers caused by pesticidesD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

 41.I would appreciate ________ it a secret.

 A) your keeping

 B) you to keep

 C) that you keep

 D) that you will keepA

 42.Mark often attempts to escape ________ whenever he breaks traffic regulations.

 A) having been fined

 B) to be fined

 C) to have been fined

 D) being finedD

 43.No matter how frequently ________, the works of Beethoven always attract large audiences.

 A) performing

 B) performed

 C) to be performed

 D) being performedB

 44.It is recommended that the project ________ until all the preparations have been made.

 A) is not started

 B) will not be started

 C) not be started

 D) is not to be startedC

 45.I wish I ________ longer this morning, but I had to get up and come to class.

 A) could have slept

 B) slept

 C) might have slept

 D) have sleptA

 46.We didn’t know his telephone number, otherwise we ________ him.

 A) would have telephoned

 B) must have telephoned

 C) would telephone

 D) had telephonedA

 47.Turn on the television or open a magazine and you ________ advertisements showing happy, balanced families.

 A) are often seeing

 B) often see

 C) will often see

 D) have often seenC

 48.While people may refer to television for up-to-minute news, it is unlikely that television ________ the newspaper completely.

 A) replaced

 B) have replaced

 C) replace

 D) will replaceD

 49.An Olympic Marathon is 26 miles and 385 yards, ________ approximately from Marathon to Athens.

 A) distance

 B) is the distance

 C) the distance

 D) the distance isC

 50.You will want two trees about ten feet apart, from ________ to suspend your tent.

 A) there

 B) them

 C) which

 D) whereC

 51.As I was just getting familiar with this job, I had ________ to ask my boss.

 A) many

 B) most

 C) more

 D) muchD

 52.________ quite recently, most mothers in Britain did not take paid work outside the home.

 A) Before

 B) Until

 C) From

 D) SinceB

 53.The survival of civilization as we know it is ________ threat.

 A) within

 B) under

 C) towards

 D) uponB

 54.Scientists say it may be five or ten years ________ it is possible to test this medicine on human patients.

 A) since

 B) before

 C) after

 D) whenB

 55.In some countries, ________ is called “equality” does not really mean equal rights for all people.

 A) which

 B) what

 C) that

 D) oneB

 56.I walked too much yesterday and ________ are still aching now.

 A) my leg’s muscles

 B) my muscles of leg

 C) my leg muscles

 D) my muscles of the legC

 57.Radio, television and press ________ of conveying news and information.

 A) are the most three common means

 B) are the most common three means

 C) are the three most common means

 D) are three the most common meansC

 58.Liquids are like solids ________ they have a definite volume.

 A) in that

 B) for that

 C) with that

 D) at thatA

 59.When a fire ________ at the National Exhibition in London, at least ten priceless paintings were completely destroyed.

 A) broke off

 B) broke out

 C) broke down

 D) broke upB

 60.The destruction of these treasures was a loss for mankind that no amount of money could ________.

 A) stand up to

 B) make up for

 C) come up with

 D) put up withB

 61.Then the speaker ________ the various factors leading to the present economic crisis.

 A) went after

 B) went for

 C) went into

 D) went onC

 62.The students was just about to ________ the questions, when suddenly he found the answer.

 A) arrive at

 B) submit to

 C) work out

 D) give upD

 63.When there are small children around, it is necessary to put bottles of pills out of ________.

 A) reach

 B) hand

 C) hold

 D) placeA

 64.The ________ of blood always makes him feel sick.

 A) sight

 B) view

 C) look

 D) formA

 65.In Britain, the best season of the year is probably ________ spring.

 A) later

 B) last

 C) latter

 D) lateD

 66.Free medical treatment in this country covers sickness of mind as well as ________ sickness.

 A) normal

 B) regular

 C) average

 D) ordinaryD

 67.This hotel ________ $ 60 for a single room with bath.

 A) claims

 B) demands

 C) prices

 D) chargesD

 68.Although he had looked through all the reference material on the subject, he still found it hard to understand this point and her explanation only ________ to his confusion.

 A) extended

 B) amounted

 C) added

 D) turnedC

 69.A completely new situation will ________ when the examination system comes into existence.

 A) arise

 B) rise

 C) raise

 D) arouseA

 70.It took him several months to ________ the wild horse.

 A) tend

 B) cultivate

 C) breed

 D) tameC

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

 A land free from destruction, plus wealth, natural resources, and labor supply—all these were important __71__in helping England to become the center for the Industrial Revolution. __72__ they were not enough. Something __73__ was needed to start the industrial process. That “something special” was men-__74__ individuals who could invent machines, find new __75__ of power, and establish business organizations to reshape society.

 The men who __76__ the machines of the Industrial Revolution __77__ from many backgrounds and many occupations. Many of them were __78__ inventors than scientists. A man who is a __79__ scientist is primarily interested in doing his research __80__. He is not necessarily working __81__ that his findings can be used.

 An inventor or one interested in applied science is __82__ trying to make something that has a concrete __83__. He may try to solve a problem by using the theories __84__ science or by experimenting through trial and error. Regardless of his method, he is working to obtain a __85__ result: the construction of a harvesting machine, the burning of a light bulb, or one of __86__ other objectives.

 Most of the people who __87__ the machines of the Industrial Revolution were inventors, not trained scientists. A few were both scientists and inventors. Even those who had __88__ or no training in science might not have made their inventions __89__ a groundwork had not been laid by scientists years __90__.

 71.A) cases

 B) reasons

 C) factors

 D) situationsC

 72.A) But

 B) And

 C) Besides

 D) EvenA

 73.A) else

 B) near

 C) extra

 D) similarA

 74.A) generating

 B) effective

 C) motivation

 D) creativeD

 75.A) origins

 B) sources

 C) bases

 D) discoveriesB

 76.A) employed

 B) created

 C) operated

 D) controlledB

 77.A) came

 B) arrived

 C) stemmed

 D) appearedA

 78.A) less

 B) better

 C) more

 D) worseC

 79.A) genuine

 B) practical

 C) pure

 D) cleverC

 80.A) happily

 B) occasionally

 C) reluctantly

 D) accuratelyD

 81.A) now

 B) and

 C) all

 D) soD

 82.A) seldom

 B) sometimes

 C) usually

 D) neverC

 83.A) plan

 B) use

 C) idea

 D) meansB

 84.A) of

 B) with

 C) to

 D) asA

 85.A) single

 B) sole

 C) specialized

 D) specificD

 86.A) few

 B) those

 C) many

 D) allC

 87.A) proposed

 B) developed

 C) supplied

 D) offeredB

 88.A) little

 B) much

 C) some

 D) anyA

 89.A) as

 B) if

 C) because

 D) whileB

 90.A) ago

 B) past

 C) ahead

 D) beforeD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Advantage of a Job Interview. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.现在找工作一般都要面试,通过面试,面试者(interviewer)和应试者(interviewee) 可以互相了解情况。

 2.面试者可以向应试者介绍情况如工作性质、条件、待遇等。

 3.应试者也有机会给对方留下一个好印象,如可以表现出自信心,可以介绍教育背景,工作能力等。

19956月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.C

3.B

4.A.

5.A

6.B

7.D

8.C

9.B

10.D

11.B

12.D

13.C

14.B

15.C

16.A

17.D

18.A

19.C

20.A


Part II


21.C

22.B

23.D

24.A

25.B

26.A

27.C

28.A

29.D

30.C

31.B

32.A

33.B

34.C

35.D

36.B

37.D

38.A

39.C

40.D


Part III


41.A

42.D

43.B

44.C

45.A

46.A

47.C

48.D

49.C

50.C

51.D

52.B

53.B

54.B

55.B

56.C

57.C

58.A

59.B

60.B

61.C

62.D

63.A

64.A

65.D

66.D

67.D

68.C

69.A

70.C


Part IV


71.C

72.A

73.A

74.D

75.B

76.B

77.A

78.C

79.C

80.D

81.D

82.C

83.B

84.A

85.D

86.C

87.B

88.A

89.B

90.D


19961月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) At home.

 B) At the riverside.

 C) At the health center.

 D) At his office.D

 2.A) Having an interview.

 B) Filling out a form.

 C) Talking with his friend.

 D) Asking for information.B

 3.A) She made a mistake by taking too few courses in the first term.

 B) The courses she took were too difficult for her.

 C) She took too many courses during her first term.

 D) She found it difficult to deal with college courses.C

 4.A) Worried and frightened.

 B) Very relaxed.

 C) Quite unhappy.

 D) Angry with the professor.A

 5.A) He enjoys reading letters.

 B) He has been job-hunting.

 C) He is offering the woman a job.

 D) He is working for a company.B

 6.A) She lost her way.

 B) She lost her keys.

 C) She lost her car.

 D) She lost her handbag.B

 7.A) More than an hour and a half.

 B) Not more than half an hour.

 C) More than two hours.

 D) Less than an hour and a half.D

 8.A) She is sure who is going to win.

 B) Now it is a good time to start the game.

 C) The game has been going on for a long time.

 D) The same team always wins.C

 9.A) The ideas of the paper are not convincing.

 B) Some parts of the paper are not well written.

 C) The handwriting of the paper is not good.

 D) The paper is not complete.B

 10.A) Looking for a young lady.

 B) Looking for her wrist watch.

 C) Looking for a young gentleman.

 D) Looking for a man wearing a wrist watch.C

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 14 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) It had many problems.

 B) It was the most democratic country in the world.

 C) It was fair to women.

 D) It had some minor problems to solve.A

 12.A) The women of some states.

 B) The women in the state of Wyoming only.

 C) The members of the National Women’s Association.

 D) The women in the state of Massachusetts only.A

 13.A) At the very beginning of the 20th century.

 B) At the end of the 19th century.

 C) After Susan Anthony’s death.

 D) Just before Susan Anthony’s death.C

 14.A) She worked on the draft of the American Constitution.

 B) She was the chairman of the National Women’s Association.

 C) She was born in New York and died in Massachusetts.

 D) She was an activist in the women’s movement for equal rights.D

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) People with problems.

 B) Travels around the world.

 C) Beautiful America.

 D) People in great cities.A

 16.A) He spent three months writing “Travels with Charley”.

 B) He enjoyed his travels around the United States.

 C) He was fond of writing about his travels.

 D) He didn’t enjoy the trip as much as Charley.B

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) The long distance between his home town and New York.

 B) His unpopular character.

 C) The high unemployment rate in New York.

 D) His criminal record.D

 18.A) He wanted to be put in prison again.

 B) He needed the money to support his family.

 C) He hated the barber there.

 D) He wanted to make himself well known.A

 19.A) He went directly to the police station.

 B) He drove out of the town and tried to escape.

 C) He waited for the police to arrest him.

 D) He argued with the police angrily.C

 20.A) Mr. Spears enjoyed living in prison.

 B) Mr. Spears was known as a greedy man in his community.

 C) The police in New York were not very efficient.

 D) The only way for Mr. Spears to support his family was by going to prison again.D

Part II Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 21.The fifth generation computers, with artificial intelligence, ________ and perfected now.

 A) developed

 B) have developed

 C) are being developed

 D) will have been developedC

 22.This ticket ________ you to a free meal in our new restaurant.

 A) gives

 B) grants

 C) entitles

 D) creditsC

 23.You ________ her in her office last Friday; she’s been out of town for two weeks.

 A) needn’t have seen

 B) must have seen

 C) might have seen

 D) can’t have seenD

 24.That was so serious a matter that I had no choice but ________ the police.

 A) called in

 B) calling in

 C) call in

 D) to call inD

 25.She was so ________ in her job that she didn’t hear anybody knocking at the door.

 A) attracted

 B) absorbed

 C) drawn

 D) concentratedB

 26.________ as it was at such a time, his work attracted much attention.

 A) Being published

 B) Published

 C) Publishing

 D) To be publishedB

 27.At first, the speaker was referring to the problem of pollution in the country, but halfway in her speech, she suddenly ________ to another subject.

 A) committed

 B) switched

 C) favoured

 D) transmittedB

 28.It is politely requested by the hotel management that radios ________ after 11 o’clock at night.

 A) were not played

 B) not to play

 C) not be played

 D) did not playC

 29.Although I like the appearance of the house, what really made me decide to buy it was the beautiful ________ through the window.

 A) vision

 B) look

 C) picture

 D) viewD

 30.Cancer is second only ________ heart disease as a cause of death.

 A) of

 B) to

 C) with

 D) fromB

 31.Despite the wonderful acting and well-developed plot the ________ movie could not hold our attention.

 A) three-hours

 B) three-hour

 C) three-hours’

 D) three-hour’sB

 32.The manager needs an assistant that he can ________ to take care of problems in his absence.

 A) count on

 B) count in

 C) count up

 D) count outA

 33.The organization had broken no rules, but ________ had it acted responsibly.

 A) neither

 B) so

 C) either

 D) bothA

 34.We gave out a cheer when the red roof of the cottage came ________ view.

 A) from

 B) in

 C) before

 D) intoD

 35.They took ________ measures to prevent poisonous gases from escaping.

 A) fruitful

 B) beneficial

 C) valid

 D) effectiveD

 36.Doing your homework is a sure way to improve your test scores, and this is especially true ________ it comes to classroom tests.

 A) when

 B) since

 C) before

 D) afterA

 37.Careful surveys have indicated that as many as 50 percent of patients do not take drugs ________ directed.

 A) like

 B) so

 C) which

 D) asD

 38.In developing countries people are ________ into overcrowded cities in great numbers.

 A) breaking

 B) filling

 C) pouring

 D) hurryingC

 39.It’s reported that by the end of this month the output of cement in the factory ________ by about 10%.

 A) will have risen

 B) has risen

 C) will be rising

 D) has been risingA

 40.If I had remembered ________ the window, the thief would not have got in.

 A) to close

 B) closing

 C) to have closed

 D) having closedA

 41.There are other problems which I don’t propose to ________ at the moment.

 A) go into

 B) go around

 C) go for

 D) go upA

 42.Don’t get your schedule ________; stay with us in this class.

 A) to change

 B) changing

 C) changed

 D) changeC

 43.It is quite necessary for a qualified teacher to have good manners and ________ knowledge.

 A) extensive

 B) expansive

 C) intensive

 D) expensiveA

 44.Jean doesn’t want to work right away because she thinks that if she ________ a job she probably wouldn’t be able to see her friends very often.

 A) has to get

 B) were to get

 C) had got

 D) could have gotB

 45.I felt somewhat disappointed and was about to leave, ________ something occurred which attracted my attention.

 A) unless

 B) until

 C) when

 D) whileC

 46.A love marriage, however, does not necessarily ________ much sharing of interests and responsibilities.

 A) take over

 B) result in

 C) hold on

 D) keep toB

 47.The ability to store knowledge makes computers different form every other machine ________ invented.

 A) ever

 B) thus

 C) yet

 D) asA

 48.I’m not sure whether I can gain any profit from the investment, so I can’t make a(n) ________ promise to help you.

 A) exact

 B) defined

 C) definite

 D) sureC

 49.I have kept that portrait ________ I can see it every day, as it always reminds me of my university days in London.

 A) which

 B) where

 C) whether

 D) whenB

 50.The sports meet, originally due to be held last Friday, was finally ________ because of the bad weather.

 A) set off

 B) broken off

 C) worn off

 D) called offD

Part III Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 51 to 55 are based on the following passage.

 Space is a dangerous place, not only because of meteors (流星) but also because of rays from the sun and other stars. The atmosphere again acts as our protective blanket on earth. Light gets through, and this is essential for plants to make the food, which we eat. Heat, too, makes our environment endurable. Various kinds of rays come through the air from outer space, but enormous quantities of radiation from the sun are screened off. As soon as men leave the atmosphere they are exposed to this radiation but their spacesuits or the walls of their spacecraft, if they are inside, do prevent a lot of radiation damage.

 Radiation is the greatest known danger to explorers in space. The unit of radiation is called rem. Scientists have reason to think that a man can put up with far more radiation than 0.1 rem without being damaged; the figure of 60 rems has been agreed on. The trouble is that it is extremely difficult to be sure about radiation damage-a person may feel perfectly well, but the cells of his or her sex organs may be damaged, and this will not be discovered until the birth of deformed (畸形的) children or even grandchildren. Missions of the Apollo flights have had to cross belts of high radiation and, during the outward and return journeys, the Apollo crew accumulated a large amount of rems. So far, no dangerous amounts of radiation have been reported, but the Apollo missions have been quite short. We simply do not know yet how men are going to get on when they spend weeks and months outside the protection of the atmosphere, working in a space laboratory. Drugs might help to decrease the damage done by radiation, but no really effective ones have been found so far.

 51.According to the first paragraph, the atmosphere is essential to man in that ________.

 A) it protects him against the harmful rays from space

 B) it provides sufficient light for plant growth

 C) it supplies the heat necessary for human survival

 D) it screens off the falling meteorsA

 52.We know from the passage that ________.

 A) exposure to even tiny amounts of radiation is fatal

 B) the effect of exposure to radiation is slow in coming

 C) radiation is avoidable in space exploration

 D) astronauts in spacesuits needn’t worry about radiation damageB

 53.The harm radiation has done to the Apollo crew members ________.

 A) is insignificant

 B) seems overestimated

 C) is enormous

 D) remains unknownD

 54.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) the Apollo mission was very successful

 B) protection from space radiation is no easy job

 C) astronauts will have deformed children or grandchildren

 D) radiation is not a threat to well-protected space explorersB

 55.The best title for this passage would be ________.

 A) The Atmosphere and Our Environment

 B) Research on Radiation

 C) Effects of Space Radiation

 D) Importance Protection Against RadiationC

Passage Two

Questions 56 to 60 are based on the following passage.

 Taste is such a subjective matter that we don’t usually conduct preference tests for food. The most you can say about anyone’s preference, is that it’s one person’s opinion. But because the two big cola (可口可乐) companies—Coca-Cola and Pepsi Cola are marketed so aggressively, we’ve wondered how big a role taste preference actually plays in brand loyalty. We set up a taste test that challenged people who identified themselves as either Coca-Cola or Pepsi fans: Find your brand in a blind tasting.

 We invited staff volunteers who had a strong liking for either Coca-Cola Classic (传统型) or Pepsi, Diet (低糖的) Coke, or Diet Pepsi. These were people who thought they’d have no trouble telling their brand from the other brand.

 We eventually located 19 regular cola drinkers and 27 diet cola drinkers. Then we fed them four unidentified samples of cola one at a time, regular colas for the one group, diet versions for the other. We asked them to tell us whether each sample was Coke or Pepsi; then we analyzed the records statistically to compare the participants’ choices with what mere guess-work could have accomplished.

 Getting all four samples right was a tough test, but not too tough, we thought, for people who believed they could recognize their brand. In the end, only 7 out of 19 regular cola drinkers correctly identified their brand of choice in all four trials. The diet-cola drinkers did a little worse-only 7 of 27 identified all four samples correctly.

 While both groups did better than chance would predict, nearly half the participants in each group made the wrong choice two or more times. Two people go all four samples wrong. Overall, half the participants did about as well on the last round of tasting as on the first, so fatigue, or taste burnout, was not a factor. Our preference test results suggest that only a few Pepsi participants and Coke fans may really be able to tell their favorite brand by taste and price.

 56.According to the passage the preference test was conducted in order to ________.

 A) find out the role taste preference plays in a person’s drinking

 B) reveal which cola is more to the liking of the drinkers

 C) show that a person’s opinion about taste is mere guess-work

 D) compare the ability of the participants in choosing their drinksA

 57.The statistics recorded in the preference tests show ________.

 A) Coca-Cola and Pepsi are people’s two most favorite drinks

 B) there is not much difference in taste between Coca-Cola and Pepsi

 C) few people had trouble telling Coca-Cola from Pepsi

 D) people’s tastes differ from one anotherB

 58.It is implied in the first paragraph that ________.

 A) the purpose of taste tests is to promote the sale of colas

 B) the improvement of quality is the chief concern of the two cola companies

 C) the competition between the two colas is very strong

 D) blind tasting is necessary for identifying fansC

 59.The word “burnout” (Line 4, Para. 5) here refers to the state of ________.

 A) being seriously burnt in the skin

 B) being unable to burn for lack of fuel

 C) being badly damaged by fire

 D) being unable to function because of excessive useD

 60.The author’s purpose in writing this passage is to ________.

 A) show that taste preference is highly subjective

 B) argue that taste testing is an important marketing strategy

 C) emphasize that taste and price are closely related to each other

 D) recommend that blind tasting be introduced in the quality control of colasA

Passage Three

Questions 61 to 65 are based on the following passage.

 The concept of “environment” is certainly difficult and may even be misunderstood; but we have no handy substitute. It seems simple enough to distinguish between the organism and the surrounding environment and to separate forces acting on an organism into those that are internal and biological and those that are external and environmental. But in actual practice this system breaks down in many ways, because the organism and the environment are constantly interacting so that the environment is modified by the organism and vice versa (反之亦然).

 In the case of man, the difficulties with the environmental concept are even more complicated because we have to deal with man as an animal and with man as a bearer (持有者) of culture. If we look at man as an animal and try to analyze the environmental forces that are acting on the organism, we find that we have to deal with things like climate, soil, plants and such-like factors common to all biological situations; but we also find, always, very important environmental influences that we can only class as “cultural”, which modify the physical and biological factors. But man, as we know him, is always a bearer of culture; and if we study human culture, we find that it, in turn, is modified by the environmental factors of climate and geography. We thus easily get into great difficulties from the necessity of viewing culture, at one moment, as a part of the man and, at another moment, as a part of the environment.

 61.Which of the following words can best describe the popular understanding of “environment” as the author sees it?

 A) Elaborate.

 B) Prejudiced.

 C) Faultless.

 D) Oversimplified.D

 62.According to the author the concept of “environment” is difficult to explain because ________.

 A) it doesn’t distinguish between the organism and the environment

 B) it involves both internal and external forces

 C) the organism and the environment influence each other

 D) the relationship between the organism and the environment is unclearC

 63.In analyzing the environmental forces acting on man the author suggests that ________.

 A) biological factors are less important to the organism than cultural factors to man

 B) man and other animals are modified equally by the environmental forces

 C) man is modified by the cultural environment as well as by the natural environment

 D) physical and biological factors exert more influence on other organisms than on manC

 64.As for culture, the author points out that ________.

 A) it develops side by side with environmental factors

 B) it is also affected by environmental factors

 C) it is generally accepted to be part of the environment

 D) it is a product of man’s biological instinctsB

 65.In this passage, the author is primarily concerned with ________.

 A) the interpretation of the term “environment”

 B) the discussion on organisms and biological environment

 C) the comparison between internal and external factors influencing man

 D) the evaluation of man’s influence on cultureA

Passage Four

Questions 66 to 70 are based on the following passage.

 The speaker, a teacher from a community college, addressed a sympathetic audience. Heads nodded in agreement when he said, “High school English teachers are not doing their jobs.” He described the inadequacies of his students, all high school graduates who can use language only at a grade 9 level. I was unable to determine from his answers to my questions how this grade 9 level had been established.

 My topic is not standards nor its decline (降低). What the speaker was really saying is that eh is no longer young; he has been teaching for sixteen years, and is able to think and speak like a mature adult.

 My point is that the frequent complaint of one generation about the one immediately following it is inevitable. It is also human nature to look for the reasons for our dissatisfaction. Before English became a school subject in the late nineteenth century, it was difficult to find the target of the blame for language deficiencies (缺陷). But since then, English teachers have been under constant attack.

 The complainers think they have hit upon an original idea. As their own command of the language improves, they notice that young people do not have this same ability. Unaware that their own ability has developed through the years, they assume the new generation of young people must be hopeless in this respect. To the eyes and ears of sensitive adults the language of the young always seems inadequate.

 Since this concern about the decline and fall of the English language is not perceived as a generational phenomenon but rather as something new and peculiar to today’s young people, it naturally follows that today’s English teachers cannot be doing their jobs. Otherwise, young people would not commit offenses against the language.

 66.The speaker the author mentioned in the passage believed that ________.

 A) the language of the younger generation is usually inferior to that of the older generation

 B) the students had a poor command of English because they didn’t work hard enough

 C) he was an excellent language teacher because he had been teaching English for sixteen years

 D) English teachers should be held responsible for the students’ poor command of EnglishD

 67.In the author’s opinion, the speaker ________.

 A) gave a correct judgment of the English level of the students

 B) had exaggerated the language problems of the students

 C) was right in saying that English teachers were not doing their jobs

 D) could think and speak intelligentlyB

 68.The author’s attitude towards the speaker’s remarks is ________.

 A) neutral

 B) positive

 C) critical

 D) compromisingC

 69.It can be concluded from the passage that ________.

 A) it is justifiable to include English as a school subject

 B) the author disagrees with the speaker over the standard of English at Grade 9 level

 C) English language teaching is by no means an easy job

 D) language improvement needs time and effortD

 70.In the passage the author argues that ________.

 A) it is unfair to blame the English teachers for the language deficiencies of the students

 B) young people would not commit offences against the language is the teachers did their jobs properly

 C) to eliminate language deficiencies one must have sensitive eyes and ears

 D) to improve the standard of English requires the effort of several generationsA

Part IV Translation (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part, there are five items which you should translate into Chinese, each item consisting of one or two sentences. These sentences are all taken from the Reading Passages you have just read in Part Three of Test Paper One. You are allowed 15 minutes to do the translation. You should refer back to the passages so as to identify their meanings in the context.

 71.(Passage 2, Lines 1-2, Para. 5)

 Scientists have reason to think that a man can put up with far more radiation than 0.1 rem without being damaged;

 72.(Passage 2, Lines 1-3, Para. 3)

 Them we fed them four unidentified samples of cola on at a time, regular colas for the one group, diet versions for the other.

 73.(Passage 2, Lines 1-2, Para. 5)

 While both groups did better than chance would predict, nearly half the participants in each group made the wrong choice two or more times.

 74.(Passage 3, Lines 4-5, Para. 2)

 ... we find that we have to deal with things like climate, soil, plants, and such-like factors common to all biological situations;

 75.(Passage 4, Lines 1-2, Para. 3)

 My point is that the frequent complaint of one generation about the one immediately following it is inevitable.

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic The Two-day Weekend. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.双休日给大学生带来的好处。

 2.双休日可能给大学生带来的问题。

 3.我应当怎样过好双休日。

The Two-day Weekend

19961月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.B

3.C

4.A

5.B

6.B

7.D

8.C

9.B

10.C

11.A

12.A

13.C

14.D

15.A

16.B

17.D

18.A

19.C

20.D


Part II


21.C

22.C

23.D

24.D

25.B

26.B

27.B

28.C

29.D

30.B

31.B

32.A

33.A

34.D

35.D

36.A

37.D

38.C

39.A

40.A

41.A

42.C

43.A

44.B

45.C

46.B

47.A

48.C

49.B

50.D


Part III


51.A

52.B

53.D

54.B

55.C

56.A

57.B

58.C

59.D

60.A

61.D

62.C

63.C

64.B

65.A

66.D

67.B

68.C

69.D

70.A


 71.科学家有理由相信,一个人能够承受远远高于0.1雷目(rem)的辐射而不受到伤害。

 72.然后我们给他们喝4种没有任何标记的可乐,一次一种,一组人喝普通的可乐,另一组喝低糖型的可乐。

 73.虽然两组做的都比随机猜测的正确度高,仍有约一半的受试者做出了两个或更多的错误选择。

 74.我们发现我们必须和气候、土壤、植物以及诸如此类的对所有生物环境都很普遍的因素打交道。

 75.我的观点是一代人经常抱怨下一代人是不可避免的。

19966月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Place another order.

 B) Call to check on it.

 C) Wait patiently.

 D) Go and find the furniture.C

 2.A) She doesn’t need the job.

 B) She hasn’t got a job yet.

 C) She has got a good job.

 D) She is going to start work soon.B

 3.A) She got home before 9 o’clock.

 B) She had a bad cold.

 C) She had a car accident.

 D) She was delayed.D

 4.A) She hasn’t gone camping for several weeks.

 B) She like to take long camping trips.

 C) She prefers not to go camping on weekends.

 D) She often spends a lot of time planning her camping trips.B

 5.A) A writer.

 B) A teacher.

 C) A reporter.

 D) A student.C

 6.A) She has not heard of Prof. Johnson.

 B) She has not heard of Prof. Johnson’s brother.

 C) She is a good friend of Prof. Johnson’s.

 D) She does not know Prof. Johnson’s.D

 7.A) Coming back for a later show.

 B) Waiting in a queue.

 C) Coming back in five minutes.

 D) Not going to the movie today.A

 8.A) He has got a heart attack.

 B) He was unharmed.

 C) He was badly hurt.

 D) He has fully recovered from the shock.B

 9.A) The man went to Australia during Christmas.

 B) The man visited Australia during the summer vacation.

 C) The man didn’t have a good time because of the different weather.

 D) The man remained home while his parents went to see his uncle.A

 10.A) To attend a party at a classmate’s home.

 B) To do homework with her classmate.

 C) To attend an evening class.

 D) To have supper out with her classmate.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) He fell into the river but couldn’t swim.

 B) He fell into the river together with his bike.

 C) He had his foot caught between two posts in the river.

 D) He dived into the river but couldn’t reach the surface.C

 12.A) He jumped into the river immediately.

 B) He took off his coat and jumped into the water.

 C) He dashed down the bridge to save the boy.

 D) He shouted out for help.A

 13.A) He asked what the young man’s name was.

 B) He asked the young man to take him home.

 C) He gave his name and then ran away.

 D) He thanked the young man and then ran away.D

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) Alcohol helps develop people’s intelligence.

 B) Heavy drinking is not necessarily harmful to one’s health.

 C) Controlled drinking helps people keep their wits as they age.

 D) Drinking, even moderately, may harm one’s health.C

 15.A) Worried.

 B) Pleased.

 C) Surprised.

 D) Unconcerned.B

 16.A) At a conference.

 B) In a newspaper.

 C) On television.

 D) In a journal.A

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) To seek adventure there.

 B) To be with her mother on Christmas.

 C) To see the animals and plants there.

 D) To join her father on Christmas.D

 18.A) She was seriously injured.

 B) She survived the accident.

 C) She lost consciousness.

 D) She fell into a stream.B

 19.A) To avoid hostile Indians.

 B) To avoid the rain.

 C) To avoid the strong sunlight.

 D) To avoid wild animals.C

 20.A) They gave Julia food to eat.

 B) They drove Julia to a hospital.

 C) They invited Julia to their hut.

 D) They took Julia to a village by boat.D

Part II Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 21.After the robbery, the shop installed a sophisticate alarm system as an insurance ________ further losses.

 A) for

 B) from

 C) against

 D) towardsC

 22.________ the earth to be flat, many feared that Columbus would fall off the edge of the earth.

 A) Having believed

 B) Believing

 C) Believed

 D) Being believedB

 23.A healthy life is frequently thought to be ________ with the open countryside and homegrown food.

 A) tied

 B) bound

 C) involved

 D) associatedD

 24.Sir Denis, who is 78, has made it known that much of his collection ________ to the nation.

 A) has left

 B) is to leave

 C) leaves

 D) is to be leftD

 25.Before the first non-stop flight made in 1949, it ________ necessary for all planes to land for refueling.

 A) would be

 B) has been

 C) had been

 D) would have beenC

 26.In Britain today women ________ 44% of the workforce, and nearly half the mothers with children are in paid work.

 A) build up

 B) stand for

 C) make up

 D) conform toC

 27.________ might be expected, the response to the question was very mixed.

 A) As

 B) That

 C) It

 D) WhatA

 28.If I correct someone, I will do it with as much good humor and self-restraint as if I were the one ________.

 A) to correct

 B) correcting

 C) having corrected

 D) being correctedD

 29.Features such as height, weight, and skin color ________ from individual to individual and from face to face.

 A) change

 B) vary

 C) alter

 D) convertB

 30.I make notes in the back of my diary ________ thing to be mended or replaced.

 A) by

 B) in

 C) with

 D) ofD

 31.The room is in a terrible mess; it ________ cleaned.

 A) can’t have been

 B) mustn’t have been

 C) shouldn’t have been

 D) wouldn’t have beenA

 32.A well-written composition ________ good choice of words and clear organization among other things.

 A) calls on

 B) calls for

 C) calls up

 D) calls offB

 33.The traditional approach ________ with complex problems is to break them down into smaller, more easily managed problems.

 A) to dealing

 B) in dealing

 C) dealing

 D) to dealA

 34.It has been revealed that some government leaders ________ their authority and position to get illegal profits for themselves.

 A) employ

 B) take

 C) abuse

 D) overlookC

 35.We were struck by the extent ________ which teachers’ decisions served the interests of the school rather than those of the students.

 A) to

 B) for

 C) in

 D) withA

 36.Shelly had prepared carefully for her biology examination so that she could be sure of passing it on her first ________.

 A) intention

 B) attempt

 C) purpose

 D) desireB

 37.The ancient Egyptians are supposed ________ rockets to the moon.

 A) to send

 B) to be sending

 C) to have sent

 D) to have been sendingC

 38.The store had to ________ a number of clerks because sales were down.

 A) lay out

 B) lay off

 C) lay aside

 D) lay downB

 39.All the students in this class passed the English exam ________ the exception of Li Ming.

 A) on

 B) in

 C) for

 D) withD

 40.Young adults ________ older people are more likely to prefer pop songs.

 A) other than

 B) more than

 C) less than

 D) rather thanD

 41.Writing is a slow process, requiring ________ thought, time, and effort.

 A) significant

 B) considerable

 C) enormous

 D) numerousB

 42.________ right now, she would get there on Sunday.

 A) Would she leave

 B) If she leaves

 C) Were she to leave

 D) If she had leftC

 43.It’s already 5 o’clock now. Don’t you think it’s about time ________?

 A) we are going home

 B) we go home

 C) we went home

 D) we can go homeC

 44.Lightning is a ________ of electrical current from a cloud to the ground or from one cloud to another.

 A) rush

 B) rainbow

 C) rack

 D) ribbonA

 45.Today, ________ major new products without conducting elaborate market research.

 A) corporations hardly introduce ever

 B) corporations hardly ever introduce

 C) hardly corporations introduce ever

 D) hardly corporations ever introduceB

 46.I’ve already told you that I’m going to buy it, ________.

 A) however much it costs

 B) however does it costs much

 C) how much does it cost

 D) no matter how it costsA

 47.New York ________ second in the production of apples, producing 850,000,000 pounds this year.

 A) ranked

 B) occupied

 C) arranged

 D) classifiedA

 48.Melted iron is poured into the mixer much ________ tea is poured into a cup from a teapot.

 A) in the same way like

 B) in the same way which

 C) in the same way

 D) in the same way asD

 49.By success I don’t mean ________ usually thought of when that word is used.

 A) what is

 B) that we

 C) as you

 D) all isA

 50.I caught a ________ of the taxi before it disappeared around the corner of the street.

 A) vision

 B) glimpse

 C) look

 D) sceneB

Part III Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Exchange a glance with someone, then look away. Do you realize that you have made a statement? Hold the glance for a second longer, and you have made a different statement. Hold it for 3 seconds, and the meaning has changed again. For every social situation, there is a permissible time that you can hold a person’s gaze without being intimate, rude, or aggressive. If you are on an elevator, what gaze-time are you permitted? To answer this question, consider what you typically do. You very likely give other passengers a quick glance to size them up (打量) and to assure them that you mean no threat. Since being close to another person signals the possibility of interaction. You need to emit a signal telling others you want to be left alone. So you cut off eye contact, what sociologist Erving Goffman (1963) calls “a dimming of the lights.” You look down at the floor, at the indicator lights, anywhere but into another passenger’s eyes. Should you break the rule against staring at a stranger on an elevator, you will make the other person exceedingly uncomfortable, and you are likely to feel a bit strange yourself.

 If you hold eye contact for more than 3 seconds, what are you telling another person? Much depends on the person and the situation. For instance, a man and a woman communicate interest in this manner. They typically gaze at each other for about 3 seconds at a time, then drop their eyes down for 3 seconds, before letting their eyes meet again. But if one man gives another man a 3-second-plus stare, he signals, “I know you”, “I am interested in you,” or “You look peculiar and I am curious about you.” This type of stare often produces hostile feelings.

 51.It can be inferred form the first paragraph that ________.

 A) every glance has its significance

 B) staring at a person is an expression of interest

 C) a gaze longer than 3 seconds is unacceptable

 D) a glance conveys more meaning than wordsA

 52.If you want to be left alone on an elevator, the best thing to do is ________.

 A) to look into another passenger’s eyes

 B) to avoid eye contact with other passengers

 C) to signal you are not a threat to anyone

 D) to keep a distance from other passengersB

 53.By “a dimming of the lights” (Para. 1, Line 9) Erving Goffman means “________”.

 A) closing one’s eyes

 B) turning off the lights

 C) creasing to glance at others

 D) reducing gaze-time to the minimumC

 54.If one is looked at by a stranger for too long, he tends to feel ________.

 A) depressed

 B) uneasy

 C) curious

 D) amusedB

 55.The passage mainly discusses ________.

 A) the limitations of eye contact

 B) the exchange of ideas through eye contact

 C) proper behavior in situations

 D) the role of eye contact in interpersonal communicationD

Passage Two

Questions 56 to 60 are based on the following passage.

 The picnics, speeches, and parades of today’s Labor Day were all part of the first celebration, held in New York City in 1882. Its promoter was an Irish-American labor leader named peter J. McGuire. A carpenter by trade, McGuire had worked since the age of eleven, and in 1882 was president of the United Brotherhood of Carpenters and Joiners (UBCJ). Approaching the City’s Central Labor Union that summer, he proposed a holiday that would applaud (赞许)“the industrial spirit-the great vital force of every nation,” On September 5 his suggestion bore fruit, as an estimated 10,000 workers, many of them ignoring their bosses’ warnings, left work to march from Union square up Fifth Avenue to 42nd Street. The event gained national attention, and by 1893 thirty states had made Labor Day an annual holiday.

 The quick adoption of the scheme may have indicated less about the state lawmakers’ respect for working people than about a fear of risking their anger. In the 1880s the United States was a land sharply divided between the immensely wealthy and the very poor. Henry George was accurate in describing the era as one of “progress and poverty.” In a society in which factory, owners rode in private Pullmans while ten-year-olds slaved in the mines, strong anti-capitalist feeling ran high. Demands for fundamental change were common throughout the labor press. With socialists demanding an end to “wage slavery” and anarchists (无政府主义) singing the praises of the virtues of dynamite (炸药), middle-of-the-roaders like Samuel Gompers and McGuire seemed attractively mild by comparison. One can imagine practical capitalists seeing Labor Day as a bargain: A one-day party certainly cost them less than paying their workers decent wages.

 56.Judging from the passage, McGuire was ________.

 A) a moderate labor leader

 B) an extreme-anarchist in the labor movement

 C) a devoted socialist fighting against exploitation of man by man

 D) a firm anti-capitalist demanding the elimination of wage slaveryA

 57.We can see from the first paragraph that the first Labor Day march ________.

 A) immediately won nationwide support

 B) involved workers from 30 states

 C) was opposed by many factory owners

 D) was organized by the UBCJC

 58.Which of the following is the key factor in the immediate approval of Labor Day as a national holiday?

 A) The lawmakers’ respect for the workers.

 B) The worker’s determination to have a holiday of their own.

 C) The socialists’ demands for thorough reform.

 D) The politicians’ fear of the workers’ anger.D

 59.We lean from the passage that the establishment of Labor Day ________.

 A) was accepted by most bosses as a compromise

 B) marked a turning point in the workers’ struggle for more rights

 C) indicated the improvement of the workers’ welfare

 D) signaled the end of “wage slavery”A

 60.McGuire proposed Labor Day in order to ________.

 A) draw people’s attention to the striking contrast between the rich and the poor

 B) make prominent the important role of the working class in society

 C) win for the workers the right to shorter working hours

 D) expose the exploitation of the workers by their bossesB

Passage Three

Questions 61 to 65 are based on the following passage.

 In the old day, children were familiar with birth and death as part of life. This is perhaps the first generation of American youngsters (年轻人) who have never been close by during the birth of a baby and have never experienced the death of a family member.

 Nowadays when people grow old, we often send them to nursing homes. When they get sick, we transfer them to a hospital, where children are forbidden to visit terminally ill patients-even when those patients are their parents. This deprives (剥夺) the dying patient of significant family members during the last few days of his life and it deprives the children of an experience of death, which is an important learning experience.

 Some of my colleagues and I once interviewed and followed approximately 500 terminally ill patients in order to find out what they could teach us and how we could be of more benefit, not just to them but to the members of their families as well. We are most impressed by the fact that even those patients who were not told of their serious illness were quite aware of its potential outcome.

 It is important for family members, and doctors and nurses to understand these patients’ communications in order to truly understand their needs, fears, andfantasies (幻想). Most of our patients welcomed another human being with whom they could talk openly, honestly, and frankly about their trouble. Many of them shared with us their tremendous need to be informed, to be kept up-to-date on their medical condition and to be told when the end was near. We found out that patients who had been dealt with openly and frankly were better able to cope with the approach of death and finally to reach a true stage of acceptance prior to death.

 61.The elders of contemporary Americans ________.

 A) were often absent when a family member was born or dying

 B) were quite unfamiliar with birth and death

 C) usually witnessed the birth or death of a family member

 D) had often experienced the fear of death as part of lifeC

 62.Children in America today are denied the chance ________.

 A) to learn how to face death

 B) to visit dying patients

 C) to attend to patients

 D) to have access to a hospitalB

 63.Five hundred critically ill patients were investigated with the main purpose of ________.

 A) observing how they reacted to the crisis of death

 B) helping them and their families overcome the fear of death

 C) finding out their attitude towards the approach of death

 D) learning how to best help them and their familiesD

 64.The need of a dying patient for company shows ________.

 A) his desire for communication with other people

 B) his fear of approaching death

 C) his pessimistic attitude towards his condition

 D) his reluctance to part with his familyA

 65.It may be concluded from the passage that ________.

 A) dying patients are afraid of being told of the approach of death

 B) most doctors and nurses understand what dying patients need

 C) dying patients should be truthfully informed of their condition

 D) most patients are unable to accept death until it is obviously inevitableC

Passage Four

Questions 66 to 70 are based on the following passage.

 Faces, like fingerprints, are unique. Did you ever wonder how it is possible for us to recognize people. Even a skilled writer probably could not describe all the features that make one face different from another. Yet a very young child-or even an animal, such as a pigeon-can learn to recognize faces, we all take this ability for granted.

 We also tell people apart by how they behave. When we talk about someone’s personality, we mean the ways in which he or she acts, speaks thinks and feels that make that individual different from others.

 Like the human face, human personality is very complex. But describing someone’s personality in words is somewhat easier than describing his face. If you were asked to describe what a “nice face” looked like, you probably would have a difficult time doing so. But if you were asked to describe a “nice person”, you might begin to think about someone who was kind considerate, friendly, warm, and so forth.

 There are many words to describe how a person thinks, feels and acts. Gordon Allport, an American psychologist, found nearly 18,000 English words characterizing differences in people’s behavior. And many of us use this information as a basis for describing, or typing, his personality. Bookworms, conservatives, military types-people are described with such terms.

 People have always tried to “type” each other. Actors in early Greek drama wore masks to show the audience whether they played the villain’s (坏人) or the hero’s role. In fact, the words “person” and “personality” come from the Latin persona, meaning “mask”. Today, most television and movie actors do not wear masks. But we can easily tell the “good guys” from the “bad guys” because the two types differ in appearance as well as inactions.

 66.By using the example of finger prints, the author tells us that ________.

 A) people can learn to recognize faces

 B) people have different personalities

 C) people have difficulty in describing the features of finger prints

 D) people differ from each other in facial featuresD

 67.According to this passage, some animals have the gift of ________.

 A) telling people apart by how they behave

 B) typing each other

 C) telling good people from had people

 D) recognizing human facesD

 68.Who most probably knows best how to describe people’s personality?

 A) The ancient Greek audience

 B) The movie actors

 C) Psychologists

 D) The modern TV audienceC

 69.According to the passage, it is possible for us tell one type of person from another because ________.

 A) people differ in their behavioral and physical characteristics

 B) human fingerprints provide unique information

 C) people’s behavior can be easily described in words

 D) human faces have complex featuresA

 70.Which of the following is the major point of the passage?

 A) Why it is necessary to identify people’s personality

 B) Why it is possible to describe people

 C) How to get to know people

 D) How best to recognize peopleB

Part IV Translation (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part, there are four items which you should translate into Chinese, each item consisting of one or two sentences. These sentences are all taken from the Reading Passages you have just read in Part Three of Test Paper One. You are allowed 15 minutes to do the translation. You should refer back to the passages so as to identify their meanings in the context.

 71.(Passage 1, Lines 6-7, Para. 1)

 You very likely give other passengers a quick glance to size them up and to assure them that you mean no threat.

 72.(Passage 2, Lines 2-3, Para. 2)

 In the 1880s the United States was a land sharply divided between the immensely wealthy and the very poor.

 73.(Passage 3, Lines 3-5, Para. 3)

 We were most impressed by the fact that even those patients who were not told of their serious illness were quite aware of its potential outcome

 74.(Passage 4, Lines 2-3, Para. 1)

 Even a skilled writer probably could not describe all the features that make one face different from another.

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Global Shortage of Fresh Water. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.人们以为淡水是取之不尽的

 (提示:雨水、河水、井水…)

 2.实际上淡水是非常紧缺的

 (提示:人口增加,工业用水增加,污染…)

 3.我们应该怎么办

Global Shortage of Fresh Water

19966月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.B

3.D

4.B

5.C

6.D

7.A

8.B

9.A

10.A

11.C

12.A

13.D

14.C

15.B

16.A

17.D

18.B

19.C

20.D


Part II


21.C

22.B

23.D

24.D

25.C

26.C

27.A

28.D

29.B

30.D

31.A

32.B

33.A

34.C

35.A

36.B

37.C

38.B

39.D

40.D

41.B

42.C

43.C

44.A

45.B

46.A

47.A

48.D

49.A

50.B


Part III


51.A

52.B

53.C

54.B

55.D

56.A

57.C

58.D

59.A

60.B

61.C

62.B

63.D

64.A

65.C

66.D

67.D

68.C

69.A

70.B


 71.你很可能给其他乘客很快的一瞥,打量他们一下,以此让他们确信你对他们没有威胁。

 72.十九世纪八十年代的美国是一个贫富分化极为分明的国家。

 73.给我们留下极深印象的事实是:即使那些没有被告知严重病情的病人,对其疾病的潜在后果也是非常清楚的。

 74.即使是很老到的作家也很可能不能描述出区分人脸的全部特征。

19971月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Look for a more expensive hotel.

 B) Go to another hotel by bus.

 C) Try to find a quiet place.

 D) Take a walk around the city.C

 2.A) They’re talking about nice children.

 B) The man has a house for sale.

 C) The woman lives in a nice house.

 D) The man has three children.B

 3.A) In a hotel.

 B) At a dinner table.

 C) In the street.

 D) At the man’s house.A

 4.A) Relatives.

 B) Roommates.

 C) Colleagues.

 D) Neighbors.D

 5.A) 5:00.

 B) 5:15.

 C) 5:30.

 D) 5:45.B

 6.A) He wants to have more sleep.

 B) His wife doesn’t sleep well.

 C) Women need more sleep than men.

 D) He doesn’t need as much sleep as his wife.D

 7.A) A student.

 B) A reporter.

 C) A visitor.

 D) A lecturer.A

 8.A) To the school.

 B) To a friend’s house.

 C) To the post office.

 D) Home.C

 9.A) He is afraid he won’t be chosen for the trip.

 B) The boss has not decided where to go.

 C) Such a trip is necessary for the company.

 D) It’s not certain whether the trip will take place.D

 10.A) It was boring.

 B) It was entertaining.

 C) It was touching.

 D) It was encouraging.C

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) He wanted to find a place to read his papers.

 B) He wanted to kill time before boarding the plane.

 C) He felt thirsty and wanted some coffee.

 D) He went there to meet his friends.B

 12.A) Toys for children.

 B) Important documents.

 C) Food and coffee.

 D) Clothes and scientific papers.D

 13.A) The woman took his case on purpose.

 B) All his papers had been stolen.

 C) He had taken the woman’s case.

 D) The woman played a joke on him.C

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) The liberation movement of British women.

 B) Rapid economic development in Britain.

 C) Changing attitudes to family life.

 D) Reasons for changes in family life in Britain.D

 15.A) Because millions of men died in the war.

 B) Because women had proved their worth.

 C) Because women were more skillful than men.

 D) Because factories preferred to employ women.A

 16.A) The concept of “the family” as a social unit.

 B) The attitudes to birth control.

 C) The attitudes to religion.

 D) The ideas of authority and tradition.A

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) Those who are themselves spoiled and self-centered.

 B) Those who expected to have several children but could only have one.

 C) Those who like to give expensive jewels to their children.

 D) Those who give birth to their only children when they are below 30.B

 18.A) Because their parents want them to share the family burden.

 B) Because their parents are too strict with them in their education.

 C) Because they have nobody to play with.

 D) Because their parents want them to grow up as fast as possible.B

 19.A) Two types of only children.

 B) Parents’ responsibilities.

 C) The necessity of family planning.

 D) The relationship between parents and children.A

 20.A) They have no sisters or brothers.

 B) They are overprotected by their parents.

 C) Their parents expect too much of them.

 D) Their parents often punish them for minor faults.C

Part II Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 21.Until then, his family ________ from him for six months.

 A) didn’t hear

 B) hasn’t been hearing

 C) hasn’t heard

 D) hadn’t heardD

 22.The conference ________ a full week by the time it ends.

 A) must have lasted

 B) will have lasted

 C) would last

 D) has lastedB

 23.Students or teachers can participate in excursions to lovely beaches around the island at regular ________.

 A) gaps

 B) rate

 C) length

 D) intervalsD

 24.Physics is ________ to the science which was called natural philosophy in history.

 A) alike

 B) equivalent

 C) likely

 D) uniformB

 25.There’s a man at the reception desk who seems very angry and I think he means ________ trouble.

 A) making

 B) to make

 C) to have made

 D) having makeB

 26.After the Arab states won independence, great emphasis was laid on expanding education, with girls as well as boys ________ to go to school.

 A) to be encouraged

 B) been encouraged

 C) being encouraged

 D) be encouragedC

 27.The new appointment of our president ________ from the very beginning of next semester.

 A) takes effect

 B) takes part

 C) takes place

 D) takes turnsA

 28.The president made a ________ speech at the opening ceremony of the sports meeting, which encouraged the sportsmen greatly.

 A) vigorous

 B) tedious

 C) flat

 D) harshA

 29.It is useful to be able to predict the extent ________ which a price change will affect supply and demand.

 A) from

 B) with

 C) to

 D) forC

 30.Finding a job in such a big company has always been ________ his wildest dreams.

 A) under

 B) over

 C) above

 D) beyondD

 31.It is not easy to learn English well, but if you ________, you will succeed in the end.

 A) hang up

 B) hang about

 C) hang on

 D) hang ontoC

 32.It is reported that ________ adopted children want to know who their natural parents are.

 A) the most

 B) most of

 C) most

 D) the most ofC

 33.Last year the advertising rate ________ by 20 percent.

 A) raised

 B) aroused

 C) arose

 D) roseD

 34.________ before we depart the day after tomorrow, we should have a wonderful dinner party.

 A) Had they arrived

 B) Would they arrive

 C) Were they arriving

 D) Were they to arriveD

 35.The strong storm did a lot of damage to the coastal villages: several fishing boats were ________ and many houses collapsed.

 A) wrecked

 B) spoiled

 C) torn

 D) injuredA

 36.The little man was ________ one metre fifty high.

 A) almost more than

 B) hardly more than

 C) nearly more than

 D) as much asB

 37.As ________ announced in today’s papers, the Shanghai Export Commodities Fair is also open on Sundays.

 A) being

 B) is

 C) to be

 D) beenB

 38.You see the lightning ________ it happens, but you hear the thunder later.

 A) the instant

 B) for an instant

 C) on the instant

 D) in an instantA

 39.The manager lost his ________ just because his secretary was ten minutes late.

 A) mood

 B) temper

 C) mind

 D) passionB

 40.Great as Newton was, many of his ideas ________ today and are being modified by the work of scientists of our time.

 A) are to challenge

 B) may be challenged

 C) have been challenged

 D) are challengingC

 41.Please be careful when you are drinking coffee in case you ________ the new carpet.

 A) crash

 B) pollute

 C) spot

 D) stainD

 42.I’d rather read than watch television; the programs seem ________ all the time.

 A) to get worse

 B) to be getting worse

 C) to have got worse

 D) getting worseB

 43.Convenience foods which are already prepared for cooking are ________ in grocery stores.

 A) ready

 B) approachable

 C) probable

 D) availableD

 44.When I caught him ________ I stopped buying things there and started dealing with another shop.

 A) cheating

 B) cheat

 C) to cheat

 D) to be cheatingA

 45.It is important that enough money ________ to fund the project.

 A) be collected

 B) must be collected

 C) was collected

 D) can be collectedA

 46.Some old people don’t like pop songs because they can’t ________ so much noise.

 A) resist

 B) sustain

 C) tolerate

 D) undergoC

 47.If only the committee ________ the regulations and put them into effect as soon as possible.

 A) approve

 B) will approve

 C) can approve

 D) would approveD

 48.________ one time, Manchester was the home of the most productive cotton mills in the world.

 A) On

 B) By

 C) At

 D) OfC

 49.________ it or not, his discovery has created a stir in scientific circles.

 A) Believe

 B) To believe

 C) Believing

 D) BelievedA

 50.Mr. Morgan can be very sad ________, though in public he is extremely cheerful.

 A) by himself

 B) in person

 C) in private

 D) as individualC

Part III Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 51 to 55 are based on the following passage.

 Statuses are marvelous human inventions that enable us to get along with one another and to determine where we “fit” in society. As we go about our everyday lives, we mentally attempt to place people in terms of their statuses. For example, we must judge whether the person in the library is a reader or a librarian, whether the telephone caller is a friend or a salesman, whether the unfamiliar person on our property is thief or a meter reader, and so on.

 The statuses we assume often vary with the people we encounter, and change throughout life. Most of us can, at very high speed, assume the statuses that various situations require. Much of social interaction consists of identifying and selecting among appropriate statuses and allowing other people to assume their statuses in relation to us. This means that we fit our actions to those of other people based on a constant mental process of appraisal and interpretation. Although some of us find the task more difficult than others, most of us perform it rather effortlessly.

 A status has been compared to ready-made clothes. Within certain limits, the buyer can choose style and fabric. But an American is not free to choose the costume (服装) of a Chinese peasant or that of a Hindu prince. We must choose from among the clothing presented by our society. Furthermore, our choice is limited to a size that will fit, as well as by our pocketbook (钱包). Having made a choice within these limits we can have certain alterations made, but apart from minor adjustments, we tend to be limited to what the stores have on their racks. Statuses too come ready made, and the range of choice among them is limited.

 51.In the first paragraph, the writer tells us that statuses can help us ________.

 A) determine whether a person is fit for a certain job

 B) behave appropriately in relation to other people

 C) protect ourselves in unfamiliar situations

 D) make friends with other peopleB

 52.According to the writer, people often assume different statuses ________.

 A) in order to identify themselves with others

 B) in order to better identify others

 C) as their mental processes change

 D) as the situation changesD

 53.The word “appraisal” (Line 5, Para. 2) most probably means “________”.

 A) involvement

 B) appreciation

 C) assessment

 D) presentationC

 54.In the last sentence of the second paragraph, the pronoun “it” refers to “________”.

 A) fitting our actions to those of other people appropriately

 B) identification of other people’s statuses

 C) selecting one’s own statuses

 D) constant mental processA

 55.By saying that “an American is not free to choose the costume of a Chinese peasant or that of a Hindu prince” (Line 2-3, Para. 3), the writer means ________.

 A) different people have different styles of clothes

 B) ready-made clothes may need alterations

 C) statuses come ready made just like clothes

 D) our choice of statuses is limitedD

Passage Two

Questions 56 to 60 are based on the following passage.

 Many a young person tells me he wants to be a writer. I always encourage such people, but I also explain that there’s big difference between “being a writer” and writing. In most cases these individuals are dreaming of wealth and fame, not the long hours alone at a typewriter. “You’ve got to want to write,” I say to them, “not want to be a writer.”

 The reality is that writing is a lonely, private and poor-paying affair. For every writer kissed by fortune there are thousands more whose longing is never rewarded. When I left a 20-year career in the U.S. Coast Guard to become a freelance writer (自由撰稿者), I had no prospects at all. What I did have was a friend who found me my room in a New York apartment building. It didn’t even matter that it was cold and had no bathroom. I immediately bought a used manual type writer and felt like a genuine writer.

 After a year or so, however, I still hadn’t gotten a break and began to doubt myself. It was so hard to sell a story that barely made enough to eat. But I knew I wanted to write. I had dreamed about it for years. I wasn’t going to be one of those people who die wondering, What if? I would keep putting my dream to the test-even though it meant living with uncertainty and fear of failure. This is the Shadowland of hope, and anyone with a dream must learn to live there.

 56.The passage is meant to ________.

 A) warn young people of the hardships that a successful writer has to experience

 B) advise young people to give up their idea of becoming a professional writer

 C) show young people it’s unrealistic for a writer to pursue wealth and fame

 D) encourage young people to pursue a writing careerA

 57.What can be concluded from the passage?

 A) Genuine writers often find their work interesting and rewarding.

 B) A writer’s success depends on luck rather than on effort.

 C) Famous writers usually live in poverty and isolation.

 D) The chances for a writer to become successful are small.D

 58.Why did the author begin to doubt himself after the first year of his writing career?

 A) He wasn’t able to produce a single book.

 B) He hadn’t seen a change for the better.

 C) He wasn’t able to have a rest for a whole years.

 D) He found his dream would never come true.B

 59.“... People who die wondering, What if?” (Line 3, Para. 3) refers to “those ________”.

 A) who think too much of the dark side of life

 B) who regret giving up their career halfway

 C) who think a lot without making a decision

 D) who are full of imagination even upon deathB

 60.“Shadowland” in the last sentence refers to ________.

 A) the wonderland one often dreams about

 B) the bright future that one is looking forward to

 C) the state of uncertainty before one’s final goal is reached

 D) a world that exists only in one’s imaginationC

Passage Three

Questions 61 to 65 are based on the following passage.

 It is everyone agrees, a huge task that the child performs when he learns to speak, and the fact that he does so in so short a period of time challenges explanation.

 Language learning begins with listening. Individual children vary greatly in the amount of listening they do before they start speaking, and late starters are often long listeners. Most children will “obey” spoken instructions some time before they can speak, though the word obey is hardly accurate as a description of the eager and delighted cooperation usually shown by the child. Before they can speak, many children will also ask questions by gesture and by making questioning noises.

 Any attempt to trace the development from the noises babies make to their first spoken words leads to considerable difficulties. It is agreed that they enjoy making noises, and that during the first few months one or two noises sort themselves out as particularly indicative of delight, distress, sociability, and so on. But since these cannot be said to show the baby’s intention to communicate, they can hardly be regarded as early forms of language. It is agreed, too, that from about three months they play with sounds for enjoyments, and that by six months they are able to add new sounds to their repertoire (能发出的全部声音). This self-imitation leads on to deliberate (有意识的) imitation of sounds made or words spoken to them by other people. The problem then arises as to the point at which one can say that these imitations can be considered as speech.

 61.By “... challenges explanation” (Line 2, Para. 1) the author means that ________.

 A) no explanation is necessary for such an obvious phenomenon

 B) no explanation has been made up to now

 C) it’s no easy job to provide an adequate explanation

 D) it’s high time that an explanation was providedC

 62.The third paragraph is mainly about ________.

 A) the development of babies’ early forms of language

 B) the difficulties of babies in learning to speak

 C) babies’ strong desire to communicate

 D) babies’ intention to communicateA

 63.The author’s purpose in writing the second paragraph is to show that children ________.

 A) usually obey without asking questions

 B) are passive in the process of learning to speak

 C) are born cooperative

 D) learn to speak by listeningD

 64.From the passage we learn that ________.

 A) early starters can learn to speak within only six months

 B) children show a strong desire to communicate by making noises

 C) imitation plays an important role in learning to speak

 D) children have various difficulties in learning to speakC

 65.The best title for this passage would be ________.

 A) How Babies Learn to Speak

 B) Early Forms of Language

 C) A Huge Task for Children

 D) Noise Making and Language LearningA

Passage Four

Questions 66 to 70 are based on the following passage.

 Psychologists take opposing views of how external rewards, from warm praise to cold cash, affect motivation and creativity. Behaviorists, who study the relation between actions and their consequences, argue that rewards can improve performance at work and school. Cognitive (认知学派的) researchers, who study various aspects of mental life, maintain that rewards often destroy creativity by encouraging dependence on approval and gifts from others.

 The latter view has gained many supporters, especially among educators. But the careful use of small monetary (金钱的) rewards sparks creativity in grade-school children, suggesting that properly presented inducements (刺激) indeed aid inventiveness, according to a study in the June Journal of Personality and Social Psychology.

 “If kids know they’re working for a reward and can focus on a relatively challenging task, they show the most creativity,” says Robert Eisenberger of the University of Delaware in Newark. “But it’s easy to kill creativity by giving rewards for poor performance or creating too much anticipation for rewards.”

 A teacher who continually draws attention to rewards or who hands out high grades for ordinary achievement ends up with uninspired students, Eisenberger holds. As an example of the latter point, he notes growing efforts at major universities to tighten grading standards and restore failing grades.

 In earlier grades, the use of so-called token economies, in which students handle challenging problems and receive performance-based points toward valued rewards, shows promise in raising effort and creativity, the Delaware psychologist claims.

 66.Psychologists are divided with regard to their attitudes toward ________.

 A) the choice between spiritual encouragement and monetary rewards

 B) the amount of monetary rewards for student’ creativity

 C) the study of relationship between actions and their consequences

 D) the effects of external rewards on students’ performanceD

 67.What is the response of many educators to external rewards for their students?

 A) They have no doubts about them.

 B) They have doubts about them.

 C) They approve of them.

 D) They avoid talking about them.B

 68.Which of the following can best raise students’ creativity according to Robert Eisenberger?

 A) Assigning them tasks they have not dealt with before.

 B) Assigning them tasks which require inventiveness.

 C) Giving them rewards they really deserve.

 D) Giving them rewards they anticipate.C

 69.It can be inferred from the passage that major universities are trying to tighten their grading standards because they believe ________.

 A) rewarding poor performance may kill the creativity of students

 B) punishment is more effective than rewarding

 C) failing uninspired students helps improve their overall academic standards

 D) discouraging the students’ anticipation for easy rewards is a matter of urgencyA

 70.The phrase “token economies” (Line 1, Para. 5) probably refers to ________.

 A) ways to develop economy

 B) systems of rewarding students

 C) approaches to solving problems

 D) methods of improving performanceD

Part IV Short Answer Questions (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part there is a short passage with five questions or incomplete statements. Read the passage carefully. Then answer the questions or complete the statements in the fewest possible words (not exceeding 10 words.)

 In Britain, the old Road Traffic Act restricted speeds to 2 m.p.h. (miles per hour) in towns and 4 m.p.h. in the country. Later Parliament increased the speed limit to 14 m.p.h. But by 1903 the development of the car industry had made it necessary to raise the limit to 20 m.p.h. By 1930, however, the law was so widely ignored that speeding restrictions were done away with altogether. For five years motorists were free to drive at whatever speeds they likes. Then in 1935 the Road Traffic Act imposed a 30 m.p.h. speed limit in built-up areas, along with the introduction of driving tests and pedestrian crossing.

 Speeding is now the most common motoring offence in Britain. Offences for speeding fall into three classes: exceeding the limit on a restricted road, exceeding on any road the limit for the vehicle you are driving, and exceeding the 70 m.p.h. limit on any road. A restricted road is one where the street lamps are 200 yards apart, or more.

 The main controversy (争论) surrounding speeding laws is the extent of their safety value. The Ministry of Transport maintains that speed limits reduce accidents. It claims that when the 30 m.p.h. limit was introduced in 1935 there was a fall of 15 percent in fatal accidents. Likewise, when the 40 m.p.h. speed limit was imposed on a number of roads in London in the late fifties, there was a 28 percent reduction in serious accidents. There were also fewer casualties (伤亡) in the year after the 70 m.p.h. motorway limit was imposed in 1966.

 In America, however, it is thought that the reduced accident figures are due rather to the increase in traffic density. This is why it has even been suggested that the present speed limits should be done away with completely, or that a guide should be given to inexperienced drivers and the speed limits made advisory, as is done in parts of the USA.

 Questions: (注意:答题尽量简短,超过10个词要扣分。每条横线限写一个英语单词,标点符号不占格。)

 71.During which period could British motorists drive without speed limits?

 72.What measures were adopted in 1935 in addition to the speeding restrictions?

 73.Speeding is a motoring offence a driver commits when he ________.

 74.What is the opinion of British authorities concerning speeding laws?

 75.What reason do Americans give for the reduction in traffic accidents?

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes tow rite a composition on the topic Practice Makes Perfect. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.怎样理解“熟能生巧”?

 2.例如:在英语学习中…

 3.又如…

Practice Makes Perfect

19971月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.B

3.A

4.D

5.B

6.D

7.A

8.C

9.D

10.C

11.B

12.D

13.C

14.D

15.A

16.A

17.B

18.B

19.A

20.C


Part II


21.D

22.B

23.D

24.B

25.B

26.C

27.A

28.A

29.C

30.D

31.C

32.C

33.D

34.D

35.A

36.B

37.B

38.A

39.B

40.C

41.D

42.B

43.D

44.A

45.A

46.C

47.D

48.C

49.A

50.C


Part III


51.B

52.D

53.C

54.A

55.D

56.A

57.D

58.B

59.B

60.C

61.C

62.A

63.D

64.C

65.A

66.D

67.B

68.C

69.A

70.B


Part IV

 71.1930-1934 (or-1935)/from 1930 to 1934

 72.(The introduction of) Driving tests and pedestrian crossings

 73.exceeds the speed limits/breaks speeding laws

 74.Speed limits reduce accidents.

 75.The increase in traffic density.

19976月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Skating.

 B) Swimming.

 C) Boating and swimming.

 D) Boating and skating.B

 2.A) Put her report on his desk.

 B) Read some papers he recommended.

 C) Improve some parts of her paper.

 D) Mail her report to the publisher.C

 3.A) She takes it as a kind of exercise.

 B) She wants to save money.

 C) She loves doing anything that is new.

 D) Her office isn’t very far.A

 4.A) A shop assistant.

 B) A telephone operator.

 C) A waitress.

 D) A clerk.C

 5.A) A railway porter.

 B) A taxi driver.

 C) A bus conductor.

 D) A postal clerk.D

 6.A) Most people killed in traffic accidents are heavy drinkers.

 B) She does not agree with the man.

 C) Drunk drivers are not guilty.

 D) People should pay more attention to the danger of drunk driving.D

 7.A) $1.40.

 B) $6.40.

 C) $4.30.

 D) $8.60.B

 8.A) Collect papers for the man.

 B) Do the typing once again.

 C) Check the paper for typing errors.

 D) Read the whole newspaper.C

 9.A) The woman does not want to go to the movies.

 B) The man is too tired to go to the movies.

 C) The woman wants to go to the movies.

 D) The man wants to go out for dinner.A

 10.A) By bus.

 B) By bike.

 C) By taxi.

 D) On foot.A

Section B Compound Dictation

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. Then listen to the passage again. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from S1 to S7 with the exact works you have just heard. For blanks numbered from S8 to S10 you are required to fill in the missing information. You can either use the exact works you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

 In police work, you can never predict the next crime or problem. No working day is identical to any other, so there is no “(S1) ________” day for a police officer. Some days are (S2) ________ slow, and the job is (S3) ________; other days are so busy that there is no time to eat. I think I can (S4) ________ police work in one word: (S5) ________. Sometimes it’s dangerous. One day, for example, I was working undercover; that is, I was on the job, but I was wearing (S6) ________ clothes, not my police (S7) ________. I was trying to catch some robbers who were stealing money from people as they walked down the street. Suddenly, (S8) ________. Another policeman arrived, and together, we arrested three of the men; but the other four ran away. Another day, I helped a woman who was going to have a baby. (S9) ________. I put her in my police car to get her there faster. I thought she was going to have the baby right there in my car. But fortunately, (S10) ________.

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 15 are based on the following passage.

 The fridge is considered a necessity. It has been so since the 1960s when packaged food first appeared with the label: “store in the refrigerator.”

 In my fridgeless Fifties childhood, I was fed well and healthy. The milkman came daily, the grocer, the butcher (肉商), the baker, and the ice-cream man delivered two or three times a week. The Sunday meat would last until Wednesday and surplus (剩余的) bread and milk became all kinds of cakes. Nothing was wasted, and we were never troubled by rotten food. Thirty years on, food deliveries have ceased, fresh vegetables are almost unobtainable in the country.

 The invention of the fridge contributed comparatively little to the art of food preservation. A vast way of well-tried techniques already existed-natural cooling, drying, smoking, salting, sugaring, bottling...

 What refrigeration did promote was marketing—marketing hardware and electricity, marketing soft drinks, marketing dead bodies of animals around the globe in search of a good price.

 Consequently, most of the world’s fridges are to be found, not in the tropics where they might prove useful, but in the wealthy countries with mild temperatures where they are climatically almost unnecessary. Every winter, millions of fridges hum away continuously, and at vast expense, busily maintaining an artificially-cooled space inside an artificially-heated house-while outside, nature provides the desired temperature free of charge.

 The fridge’s effect upon the environment has been evident, while its contribution to human happiness has been insignificant. If you don’t believe me, try it yourself, invest in a food cabinet and turn off your fridge next winter. You may miss the hamburgers (汉堡包), but at least you’ll get rid of that terrible hum.

 11.The statement “In my fridgeless Fifties childhood, I was fed well and healthily.” (Line 1, Para. 2) suggests that ________.

 A) the author was well-fed and healthy even without a fridge in his fifties

 B) the author was not accustomed to using fridges even in his fifties

 C) there was no fridge in the author’s home in the 1950s

 D) the fridge was in its early stage of development in the 1950sC

 12.Why does the author say that nothing was wasted before the invention of fridges?

 A) People would not buy more food than was necessary.

 B) Food was delivered to people two or three times a week.

 C) Food was sold fresh and did not get rotten easily.

 D) People had effective ways to preserve their food.D

 13.Who benefited the least from fridges according to the author?

 A) Inventors.

 B) Consumers.

 C) Manufacturers.

 D) Traveling salesmen.B

 14.Which of the following phrases in the fifth paragraph indicates the fridge’s negative effect on the environment?

 A) “Hum away continuously”.

 B) “Climatically almost unnecessary”.

 C) “Artificially-cooled space”.

 D) “With mild temperatures”.A

 15.What is the author’s overall attitude toward fridges?

 A) Neutral.

 B) Critical.

 C) Objective.

 D) Compromising.B

Passage Two

Questions 16 to 20 are based on the following passage.

 The human brain contains 10 thousand million cells and each of these may have a thousand connections. Such enormous numbers used to discourage us and cause us to dismiss the possibility of making a machine with human-like ability, but now that we have grown used to moving forward at such a pace we can be less sure. Quite soon, in only 10 or 20 years perhaps, we will be able to assemble a machine as complex as the human brain, and if we can we will. It may then take us a long time to render it intelligent by loading in the right software (软件) or by altering the architecture but that too will happen.

 I think it certain that in decades, not centuries, machines of silicon () will arise first to rival and then exceed their human ancestors. Once they exceed us they will be capable of their own design. In a real sense they will be able to reproduce themselves. Silicon will have ended carbon’s long control. And we will no longer be able to claim ourselves to be the finest intelligence in the known universe.

 As the intelligence of robots increases to match that of humans and as their cost declines through economies of scale we may use them to expand our frontiers, first on earth through their ability to withstand environments, harmful to ourselves. Thus, deserts may bloom and the ocean beds be mined. Further ahead, by a combination of the great wealth this new age will bring and the technology it will provide, the construction of a vast, man-created world in space, home to thousands or millions of people, will be within our power.

 16.In what way can we make a machine intelligent?

 A) By making it work in such environments as deserts, oceans or space.

 B) By working hard for 10 or 20 years.

 C) By either properly programming it or changing its structure.

 D) By reproducing it.C

 17.What does the writer think about machines with human-like ability?

 A) He believes they will be useful to human beings.

 B) He believes that they will control us in the future.

 C) He is not quite sure in what way they may influence us.

 D) He doesn’t consider the construction of such machines possible.A

 18.The word “carbon” (Line 4, Para. 2) stands for ________.

 A) intelligent robots

 B) a chemical element

 C) an organic substance

 D) human beingsD

 19.A robot can be used to expand our frontiers when ________.

 A) its intelligence and cost are beyond question

 B) it is able to bear the rough environment

 C) it is made as complex as the human brain

 D) its architecture is different from that of the present onesA

 20.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) after the installation of a great number of cells and connections, robots will be capable of self-reproduction

 B) with the rapid development of technology, people have come to realize the possibility of making a machine with human-like ability

 C) once we make a machine as complex as the human brain, it will posses intelligence

 D) robots will have control of the vast, man-made world in spaceB

Passage Three

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 After the violent earthquake that shook Los Angeles in 1994, earthquake scientists had good news to report: The damage and death toll (死亡人数) could have been much worse.

 More than 60 people died in this earthquake. By comparison, as earthquake of similar intensity that shook America in 1988 claimed 25,000 victims.

 Injuries and deaths were relatively less in Los Angeles because the quake occurred at 4:31 a.m. on a holiday, when traffic was light on the city’s highways. In addition, changes made to the construction codes in Los Angeles during the last 20 years have strengthened the city’s buildings and highways, making them more resistant to quakes.

 Despite the good new, civil engineers aren’t resting on their successes. Pinned to their drawing boards are blueprints (蓝图) for improved quake-resistant buildings. The new designs should offer even greater security to cities where earthquakes often take place.

 In the past, making structures quake-resistant meant firm yet flexible materials, such as steel and wood, that bend without breaking. Later, people tried to lift a building off its foundation, and insert rubber and steel between the building and its foundation to reduce the impact of ground vibrations. The most recent designs give buildings brains as well as concrete and steel supports. Called smart buildings, the structures respond like living organisms to an earthquake’s vibrations. When the ground shakes and the building tips forward, the computer would force the building to shift in the opposite direction.

 The new smart structures could be very expensive to build. However, they would save many lives and would be less likely to be damaged during earthquakes.

 21.One reason why the loss of lives in the Los Angeles earthquake was comparatively low is that ________.

 A) new computers had been installed in the buildings

 B) it occurred in the residential areas rather than on the highways

 C) large numbers of Los Angeles residents had gone for a holiday

 D) improvements had been made in the construction of buildings and highwaysD

 22.The function of the computer mentioned in the passage is to ________.

 A) counterbalance an earthquake’s action on the building

 B) predict the coming of an earthquake with accuracy

 C) help strengthen the foundation of the building

 D) measure the impact of an earthquake’s vibrationsA

 23.The smart buildings discussed in the passage ________.

 A) would cause serious financial problems

 B) would be worthwhile though costly

 C) would increase the complexity of architectural design

 D) can reduce the ground vibrations caused by earthquakesB

 24.It can be inferred from the passage that in minimizing the damage caused by earthquakes attention should be focused on ________.

 A) the increasing use of rubber and steel in capital construction

 B) the development of flexible building materials

 C) the reduction of the impact of ground vibrations

 D) early forecasts of earthquakesC

 25.The author’s main purpose in writing the passage is to ________.

 A) compare the consequences of the earthquakes that occurred in the U.S.

 B) encourage civil engineers to make more extensive use of computers

 C) outline the history of the development of quake-resistant building materials

 D) report new developments in constructing quake-resistant buildingsD

Passage Four

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Even plants can run a fever, especially when they’re under attack by insects or disease. But unlike humans, plants can have their temperature taken from 3,000 feet away-straight up. A decade ago, adapting the infrared (红外线) scanning technology developed for military purposes and other satellites, physicist Stephen Paley came up with a quick way to take the temperature of crops to determine which ones are under stress. The goal was to let farmers precisely target pesticide (杀虫剂) spraying rather than rain poison on a whole field, which invariably includes plants that don’t have pest (害虫) problems.

 Even better, Paley’s Remote Scanning Services Company could detect crop problems before they became visible to the eye. Mounted on a plane flown at 3,000 feet at night, an infrared scanner measured the heat emitted by crops. The data were transformed into a color-coded map showing where plants were running “fevers”. Farmers could then spot-spray, using 50 to 70 percent less pesticide than they otherwise would.

 The bad news is that Paley’s company closed down in 1984, after only three years. Farmers resisted the new technology and long-term backers were hard to find. But with the renewed concern about pesticides on produce, and refinements in infrared scanning, Paley hopes to get back into operation. Agriculture experts have no doubt the technology works. “This technique can be used on 75 percent of agricultural land in the United States,” says George Oerther of Texas A&M. Ray Jackson, who recently retired from the Department of Agriculture, thinks remote infrared crop scanning could be adopted by the end of the decade. But only if Paley finds the financial backing which he failed to obtain 10 years ago.

 26.Plants will emit an increased amount of heat when they are ________.

 A) sprayed with pesticides

 B) facing an infrared scanner

 C) in poor physical condition

 D) exposed to excessive sun raysC

 27.In order to apply pesticide spraying precisely, we can use infrared scanning to ________.

 A) estimate the damage to the crops

 B) draw a color-coded map

 C) measure the size of the affected area

 D) locate the problem areaD

 28.Farmers can save a considerable amount of pesticide by ________.

 A) resorting to spot-spraying

 B) consulting infrared scanning experts

 C) transforming poisoned rain

 D) detecting crop problems at an early dateA

 29.The application of infrared scanning technology to agriculture met with some difficulties due to ________.

 A) the lack of official support

 B) its high cost

 C) the lack of financial support

 D) its failure to help increase productionC

 30.Infrared scanning technology may be brought back into operation because of ________.

 A) the desire of farmers to improve the quality of their produce

 B) growing concern about the excessive use of pesticides on crops

 C) the forceful promotion by the Department of Agriculture

 D) full support from agricultural expertsB

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 31.The medicine is on sale everywhere. You can get it at ________ chemist’s.

 A) each

 B) some

 C) certain

 D) anyD

 32.You cannot be ________ careful when you drive a car.

 A) very

 B) so

 C) too

 D) enoughC

 33.In general, the amount that a student spends for housing should be held to one-fifth the total ________ for living expenses.

 A) acceptable

 B) available

 C) advisable

 D) applicableB

 34.Every man in this country has the right to live where he wants to ________ the color of his skin.

 A) with the exception of

 B) in the light of

 C) by virtue of

 D) regardless ofD

 35.Housewives who do not go out to work feel they are not working to their full ________.

 A) capacity

 B) strength

 C) length

 D) possibilityA

 36.I hate people who ________ the end of a film that you haven’t seen before.

 A) reveal

 B) rewrite

 C) revise

 D) reverseA

 37.He’s watching TV? He’s ________ to be cleaning his room.

 A) known

 B) supposed

 C) regarded

 D) consideredB

 38.The old couple decided to ________ a boy and a girl though they had three of their own.

 A) adapt

 B) bring

 C) receive

 D) adoptD

 39.The government is trying to do something to ________ better understanding between the two countries.

 A) raise

 B) promote

 C) heighten

 D) increaseB

 40.The newspaper did not mention the ________ of the damage caused by the fire.

 A) range

 B) level

 C) extent

 D) quantityC

 41.The soldier was ________ of running away when the enemy attacked.

 A) scolded

 B) charged

 C) accused

 D) punishedC

 42.Had he worked harder, he ________ the exams.

 A) must have got through

 B) would have got through

 C) permitted are freshmen

 D) are permitted freshmenB

 43.Only under special circumstances ________ to take make-up tests.

 A) are freshmen permitted

 B) freshmen are permitted

 C) permitted are freshmen

 D) are permitted freshmenA

 44.I had just started back for the house to change my clothes ________ I heard voices.

 A) as

 B) when

 C) after

 D) whileB

 45.It seems oil ________ from this pipe for some time. We’ll have to take the machine apart to put it right.

 A) had leaked

 B) is leaking

 C) leaked

 D) has been leakingD

 46.When he arrived, he found ________ the aged and the sick at home.

 A) none but

 B) none other than

 C) nothing but

 D) no other thanA

 47.The pressure ________ causes Americans to be energetic, but it also puts them under a constant emotional strain.

 A) to compete

 B) competing

 C) to be competed

 D) having competedA

 48.Your hair wants ________. You’d better have it done tomorrow.

 A) cut

 B) to cut

 C) cutting

 D) being cutC

 49.As teachers we should concern ourselves with what is said, not what we think ________.

 A) ought to be said

 B) must say

 C) have to be said

 D) need to sayA

 50.Once environmental damage ________, it takes many years for the system to recover.

 A) has done

 B) is to do

 C) does

 D) is doneD

 51.Studies show that the things that contribute most to a sense of happiness cannot be bought, ________ a good family life, friendship and work satisfaction.

 A) as for

 B) in view of

 C) in case of

 D) such asD

 52.He will agree to do what you require ________ him.

 A) of

 B) from

 C) to

 D) forA

 53.The mere fact ________ most people believe nuclear war would be madness does not mean that it will not occur.

 A) what

 B) which

 C) that

 D) whyC

 54.John seems nice person. ________, I don’t trust him.

 A) Even though

 B) Even so

 C) Therefore

 D) ThoughB

 55.I don’t think it advisable that Tom ________ to the job since he has no experience.

 A) is assigned

 B) will be assigned

 C) be assigned

 D) has been assignedC

 56.________, a man who expresses himself effectively is sure to succeed more rapidly than a man whose command of language is poor.

 A) Other things being equal

 B) Were other things equal

 C) To be equal to other things

 D) Other things to be equalA

 57.________ that my head had cleared, my brain was also beginning to work much better.

 A) For

 B) Now

 C) Since

 D) DespiteB

 58.The man in the corner confessed to ________ a lie to the manager of the company.

 A) have told

 B) be told

 C) being told

 D) having toldD

 59.By 1929, Mickey Mouse was as popular ________ children as Coca-Cola.

 A) for

 B) in

 C) to

 D) withD

 60.Because Edgar was convinced of the accuracy of this fact, he ________ his opinion.

 A) struck at

 B) stove for

 C) stuck to

 D) stood forC

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Most children with healthy appetites are ready to eat almost anything that is offered them and a child rarely dislikes food __61__ it is badly cooked. The __62__ a meal is cooked and served is most important and an __63__ served meal will often improve a child’s appetite. Never ask a child __64__ he likes or dislikes a food and never __65__ likes and dislikes in front of him or allow __66__ else to do so. If the father says he hates fat meat or the mother __67__ vegetables in the child’s hearing he is __68__ to copy this procedure. Take it __69__ granted that he likes everything and he probably __70__. Nothing healthful should be omitted from the meal because of a __71__ dislike. At meal times it is a good __72__ to give a child a small portion and let him __73__ back for a second helping rather than give him as __74__ as he is likely to eat all at once. Do not talk too much to the child __75__ meal times, but let him get on with his food; and do not __76__ him to leave the table immediately after a meal or he will __77__ learn to swallow his food __78__ he can hurry back to his toys. Under __79__ circumstances must a child be coaxed (哄骗) __80__ forced to eat.

 61.A) if

 B) until

 C) that

 D) unlessD

 62.A) procedure

 B) process

 C) way

 D) methodC

 63.A) adequately

 B) attractively

 C) urgently

 D) eagerlyB

 64.A) whether

 B) what

 C) that

 D) whichA

 65.A) remark

 B) tell

 C) discuss

 D) argueC

 66.A) everybody

 B) anybody

 C) somebody

 D) nobodyB

 67.A) opposes

 B) denies

 C) refuses

 D) offendsC

 68.A) willing

 B) possible

 C) obliged

 D) likelyD

 69.A) with

 B) with

 C) over

 D) forD

 70.A) should

 B) may

 C) will

 D) mustC

 71.A) supposed

 B) proved

 C) considered

 D) relatedA

 72.A) point

 B) custom

 C) idea

 D) planC

 73.A) ask

 B) come

 C) return

 D) takeB

 74.A) much

 B) little

 C) few

 D) manyA

 75.A) on

 B) over

 C) by

 D) duringD

 76.A) agree

 B) allow

 C) force

 D) persuadeB

 77.A) hurriedly

 B) soon

 C) fast

 D) slowlyB

 78.A) so

 B) until

 C) lest

 D) althoughA

 79.A) some

 B) any

 C) such

 D) noD

 80.A) or

 B) nor

 C) but

 D) neitherA

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Getting to Know the World Outside the Campus. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.大学生了解社会的必要性。

 2.了解社会的途径(大众媒介、社会服务等)

 3.我打算怎么做。

Getting to Know the World Outside the Campus

19976月四级参考答案

Part I


1.B

2.C

3.A

4.C

5.D

6.D

7.B

8.C

9.A

10.A


Part II


11.C

12.D

13.B

14.A

15.B

16.C

17.A

18.D

19.A

20.B

21.D

22.A

23.B

24.C

25.D

26.C

27.D

28.A

29.C

30.B


Part III


31.D

32.C

33.B

34.D

35.A

36.A

37.B

38.D

39.B

40.C

41.C

42.B

43.A

44.B

45.D

46.A

47.A

48.C

49.A

50.D

51.D

52.A

53.C

54.B

55.C

56.A

57.B

58.D

59.D

60.C


Part IV


61.D

62.C

63.B

64.A

65.C

66.B

67.C

68.D

69.D

70.C

71.A

72.C

73.B

74.A

75.D

76.B

77.B

78.A

79.D

80.A



 S1.typical

 S2.relatively

 S3.boring

 S4.describe

 S5.variety

 S6.normal

 S7.uniform

 S8.seven bad men jumped out, one man had a knife and we got into a fight.

 S9.She was trying to get to the hospital, but there was a bad traffic jam.

 S10.the baby waited to “arrive” until we got to the hospital.

19981月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) The man wants to attend tomorrow’s show.

 B) There aren’t any tickets left for tonight’s show.

 C) There aren’t any tickets left for tomorrow’s show.

 D) The man doesn’t want to attend tomorrow’s show.B

 2.A) Detective stories.

 B) Stories about jail escapes.

 C) Love stories.

 D) Stories about royal families.C

 3.A) It was a long lecture, but easy to understand.

 B) It was not as easy as she had thought.

 C) It was as difficult as she had expected.

 D) It was interesting and easy to follow.B

 4.A) To put him through to the director.

 B) To have a talk with the director about his work.

 C) To arrange an appointment for him with the director.

 D) To go and see if the director can meet him right now.C

 5.A) Margaret wanted to return some magazines to the woman.

 B) Margaret wanted to lend some magazines to the woman.

 C) Margaret wanted to borrow some magazines from the woman.

 D) Margaret wanted to get some magazines back from the woman.D

 6.A) He doesn’t care much about it.

 B) He enjoys it very much.

 C) He doesn’t mind even though it’s tedious.

 D) He hates working overtime.B

 7.A) The woman doesn’t think it exciting to travel by air.

 B) They’ll stay at home during the holidays.

 C) They are offered some plane tickets for their holidays.

 D) They’ll be flying somewhere for their vacation.D

 8.A) Something went wrong with the bus.

 B) She took somebody to hospital.

 C) Something prevented her from catching the bus.

 D) She came on foot instead of taking a bus.A

 9.A) Do her homework.

 B) Clean the backyard.

 C) Wash clothes.

 D) Enjoy the beautiful day.C

 10.A) The man is looking for a place to live in.

 B) The man has a house for rent.

 C) The woman is a secretary.

 D) The two speakers are old friends.A

Section B Compound Dictation

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. Then listen to the passage again. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from S1 to S7 with the exact works you have just heard. For blanks numbered from S8 to S10 you are required to fill in the missing information. You can either use the exact works you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

 Very few people can get college degree before 11, but Michael was an exception. He started high school when he was 5, finish in just nine months. He became the (S1) ________ youngest college graduate when he was 10 years and 4 months old, earning an (S2) ________ degree. Now at 11 Michael’s working on a master’s degree in (S3) ________ intelligence.

 But Michael’s (S4) ________ hasn’t always come easy. (S5) ________ his intelligence. He still lacks important life (S6) ________.

 In one class, he had to struggle to understand (S7) ________ novels, because, he says, “I’m 11. I’ve never been in love before.”

 Another challenge was his size. (S8) ________.

 He likes computers so much (S9) ________

 He wants to make robots do all the heavy tasks. (S10) ________

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 15 are based on the following passage.

 In bringing up children, every parent watches eagerly the child’s acquisition (学会) of each new skill-the first spoken words, the first independent steps, or the beginning of reading and writing. It is often tempting to hurry the child beyond his natural learning rate, but this can set up dangerous feelings of failure and states of worry in the child: This might happen at any stage. A baby might be forced to use a toilet too early, a young child might be encouraged to learn to read before he knows the meaning of the words he reads. On the other hand, though, if a child is left alone too much, or without any learning opportunities, he loses his natural enthusiasm for life and his desire to find out new things for himself.

 Patents vary greatly in their degree of strictness towards their children. Some may be especially strict in money matters. Others are sever over times of coming home at night or punctuality for meals. In general, the controls imposed represent the needs of the parents and the values of the community as much as the child’s own happiness.

 As regards the development of moral standards in the growing child, consistency is very important in parental teaching. To forbid a thing one day and excuse it the next is no foundation for morality (道德). Also, parents should realize that “example is better than precept”. If they are not sincere and do not practise what they preach (说教), their children may grow confused, and emotionally insecure when they grow old enough to think for themselves, and realize they have been to some extent fooled.

 A sudden awareness of a marked difference between their parents’ principles and their morals can be a dangerous disappointment.

 11.Eagerly watching the child’s acquisition of new skills ________.

 A) should be avoided

 B) is universal among parents

 C) sets up dangerous states of worry in the child

 D) will make him lose interest in learning new thingsB

 12.In the process of children’s learning new skills parents ________.

 A) should encourage them to read before they know the meaning of the words they read

 B) should not expect too much of them

 C) should achieve a balance between pushing them too hard and leaving them on their own

 D) should create as many learning opportunities as possibleC

 13.The second paragraph mainly tells us that ________.

 A) parents should be strict with their children

 B) parental controls reflect only the needs of the parents and the values of the community

 C) parental restrictions vary, and are not always enforced for the benefit of the children alone

 D) parents vary in their strictness towards their children according to the situationC

 14.The word “precept” (Line 3, Para. 3) probably means “________”.

 A) idea

 B) punishment

 C) behavior

 D) instructionD

 15.In moral matters, parents should ________.

 A) observe the rules themselves

 B) be aware of the marked difference between adults and children

 C) forbid things which have no foundation in morality

 D) consistently ensure the security of their childrenA

Passage Two

Questions 16 to 20 are based on the following passage.

 A good modern newspaper is an extraordinary piece of reading. It is remarkable first for what it contains: the range of news from local crime to international politics, from sport to business to fashion to science, and the range of comment and special features (特写) as well, from editorial page to feature articles and interviews to criticism of books, art, theatre and music. A newspaper is even more remarkable for the way one reads it: never completely, never straight through, but always by jumping from here to there, in and not glancing at one piece, reading another article all the way through, reading just a few paragraphs of the next. A good modern newspaper offers variety to attract many different readers, but far more than nay one reader is interested in. What brings this variety together in one place is its topicality (时事性), its immediate relation to what is happening in your world and your locality now, but immediacy and the speed of production that goes with it mean also that much of what papers in a newspaper has no more than transient (短暂的) value. For all these reasons, no two people really read the same paper: what each person does is to put together out of the pages of that day’s paper, his own selection and sequence, his own newspaper. For all these reasons, reading newspapers efficiently, which means getting what you want from them without missing things you need but without wasting time, demands skill and self-awareness as you modify and apply the techniques of reading.

 16.A modern newspaper is remarkable for all the following except its ________.

 A) wide coverage

 B) uniform style

 C) speed in reporting news

 D) popularityB

 17.According to the passage, the reason why no two people really read the “same” newspaper is that ________.

 A) people scan for the news they are interested in

 B) different people prefer different newspapers

 C) people are rarely interested in the same kind of news

 D) people have different views about what a good newspaper isC

 18.It can be conclude from the passage that newspaper readers ________.

 A) apply reading techniques skillfully

 B) jump from one newspaper to another

 C) appreciate the variety of a newspaper

 D) usually read a newspaper selectivelyD

 19.A good newspaper offers “a variety” to readers because ________.

 A) it tries to serve different readers

 B) it has to cover things that happen in a certain locality

 C) readers are difficult to please

 D) readers like to read different newspapersA

 20.The best title for this passage would be “________”.

 A) The Importance of Newspaper Topicality

 B) The Characteristics of a Good Newspaper

 C) The Variety of a Good Newspaper

 D) Some Suggestions on How to Read a NewspaperB

Passage Three

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 American society is not nap (午睡) friendly. In fact, says David Dinges, a sleep specialist at the University of Pennsylvania School of Medicine. “There’s even a prohibition against admitting we need sleep.” Nobody wants to be caught napping or found asleep at work. To quote proverb: “Some sleep five hours, nature requires seven, laziness nine and wickedness eleven.”

 Wrong. The way not to fall asleep at work is to take naps when you need them. “We have to totally change our attitude toward napping”, says Dr. William Dement of Stanford University, the godfather of sleep research.

 Last year a national commission led by Dement identified an “American sleep debt” which one member said was as important as the national debt, the commission was concerned about the dangers of sleepiness: people causing industrial accidents or falling asleep while driving. This may be why we have a new sleep policy in the White House. According to recent reports, president Clinton is trying to take a half-hour snooze (打瞌睡) every afternoon.

 About 60 percent of American adults nap when given the opportunity. We seem to have “a midafternoon quiet phase” also called “a secondary sleep gate.” Sleeping 15 minutes to two hours in the early afternoon can reduce stress and make us refreshed. Clearly, we were born to nap.

 We Superstars of Snooze don’t nap to replace lost shut-eye or to prepare for a night shift. Rather, we “snack” on sleep, whenever, wherever and at whatever time we feel like it. I myself have napped in buses, cars, planes and on boats; on floors and beds; and in libraries, offices and museums.

 21.It is commonly accepted in American society that too much sleep is ________.

 A) unreasonable

 B) criminal

 C) harmful

 D) costlyA

 22.The research done by the Dement commission shows that Americans ________.

 A) don’t like to take naps

 B) are terribly worried about their national debt

 C) sleep less than is good for them

 D) have caused many industrial and traffic accidentsC

 23.The purpose of this article is to ________.

 A) warn us of the wickedness of napping

 B) explain the danger of sleepiness

 C) discuss the side effects of napping

 D) convince the reader of the necessity of nappingD

 24.The “American sleep debt” (Line 1, Para. 3) is the result of ________.

 A) the traditional misconception the Americans have about sleep

 B) the new sleep policy of the Clinton Administration

 C) the rapid development of American industry

 D) the Americans’ worry about the danger of sleepinessA

 25.The second sentence of the last paragraph tells us that it is ________.

 A) preferable to have a sound sleep before a night shift

 B) good practice to eat something light before we go to bed

 C) essential to make up for cost sleep

 D) natural to take a nap whenever we feel the need for itD

Passage Four

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Violin prodigies (神童), I learned, have come in distinct waves from distinct regions. Most of the great performers if the late 19th and early 20th centuries were born and brought up in Russia and Eastern Europe. I asked Isaac Stern, one of the world’s greatest violinists the reason for this phenomenon. “It is very clear,” he told me. “They were all Jews (犹太人) and Jews at the time were severely oppressed and ill-treated in that part of the world. They were not allowed into the professional fields, but they were allowed to achieve excellence on a concert stage.” As a result, every Jewish parent’s dream was to have a child in the music school because it was a passport to the West.

 Another element in the emergence of prodigies, I found, is a society that values excellence in a certain field to nurture (培育) talent. Nowadays, the most nurturing societies seem to be in the Far East. “In Japan, a most competitive society, with stronger discipline than ours,” says Isaac Stem, children are ready to test their limits every day in many fields, including music. When Western music came to Japan after World War II, that music not only became part of their daily lives, but it became a discipline as well. The Koreans and Chinese as we know, are just as highly motivated as the Japanese.

 That’s a good thing, because even prodigies must work hard. Next to hard work, biological inheritance plays an important role in the making of a prodigy. J. S. Bach, for example, was the top of several generations of musicians, and four of his sons had significant careers in music.

 26.Jewish parents in Eastern Europe longed for their children to attend music school because ________.

 A) it would allow them access to a better life in the West

 B) Jewish children are born with excellent musical talent

 C) they wanted their children to enter into the professional field

 D) it would enable the family to get better treatment in their own countryA

 27.Nurturing societies as mentioned in the passage refer to societies that, ________.

 A) enforce strong discipline on students who want to achieve excellence

 B) treasure talent and provide opportunities for its full development

 C) encourage people to compete with each other

 D) promise talented children high positionsB

 28.Japan is described in the passage as a country that attaches importance to ________.

 A) all-round development

 B) the learning of Western music

 C) strict training of children

 D) variety in academic studiesC

 29.Which of the following contributes to the emergence of musical prodigies according to the passage?

 A) A natural gift.

 B) Extensive knowledge of music.

 C) Very early training.

 D) A prejudice-free society.A

 30.Which of the following titles best summarises the main idea of the passage?

 A) Jewish Contribution to Music

 B) Training of Musicians in the World

 C) Music and Society

 D) The Making of ProdigiesD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 31.Although punctual himself, the professor was quite ________ used late for his lecture.

 A) to have students

 B) for students’ being

 C) for students to be

 D) to students’ beingD

 32.You should have been more patient ________ that customer; I’m sure that selling him the watch was a possibility.

 A) of

 B) with

 C) for

 D) atB

 33.Neither of the young men who had applied for a position in the university ________.

 A) has been accepted

 B) have been accepted

 C) was accepted

 D) were acceptedC

 34.This box is too heavy, ________ give me a hand?

 A) would you mind

 B) would you please

 C) will you like to

 D) will you please toB

 35.________ he works hard, I don’t mind when he finishes the experiment.

 A) As soon as

 B) As well as

 C) So far as

 D) So long asD

 36.As early as 1647 Ohio made a decision that free, tax-supported schools must be established in every town ________ 50 households or more.

 A) having

 B) to have

 C) to have had

 D) having hadA

 37.People appreciate ________ with him because he has a good sense of humor.

 A) to work

 B) to have worked

 C) working

 D) having workedD

 38.The man was put in the soft-padded cell lest he ________ himself.

 A) injure

 B) had injured

 C) injured

 D) would injureC

 39.We love peace, yet we are not the kind of people to yield ________ any military threat.

 A) up

 B) to

 C) in

 D) atB

 40.Although he knew little about the large amount of work done in the field, he succeeded ________ other more well-informed experimenters failed.

 A) which

 B) that

 C) what

 D) whereA

 41.If tap water were as dangerous as some people think, ________ would be getting sick.

 A) a lot of more us

 B) more a lot of us

 C) a lot of us more

 D) a lot more of usA

 42.Living in the central Australian desert has its problems. ________ obtaining water is not the least.

 A) for which

 B) to which

 C) of which

 D) in whichB

 43.Which sport has the most expenses ________ training equipment, players’ personal equipment and uniforms?

 A) in place of

 B) in terms of

 C) by means of

 D) by way ofB

 44.They are going to have the serviceman ________ an electric fan in the office tomorrow.

 A) install

 B) to install

 C) to be installed

 D) installedD

 45.I’m sure he is up to the job ________ he would give his mind to it.

 A) if only

 B) in case

 C) until

 D) unlessA

 46.The car ________ halfway for no reason.

 A) broke off

 B) broke down

 C) broke up

 D) broke outB

 47.The newcomers found it impossible to ________ themselves to the climate sufficiently to make permanent homes in the new country.

 A) suit

 B) adapt

 C) regulate

 D) coordinateC

 48.A ________ to this problem is expected to be found before long.

 A) result

 B) response

 C) settlement

 D) solutionA

 49.You have nothing to ________ by refusing to listen to our advice.

 A) gain

 B) grasp

 C) seize

 D) earnD

 50.As a result of careless washing the jacket ________ to a child’s size.

 A) compressed

 B) shrank

 C) dropped

 D) decreasedB

 51.He hoped the firm would ________ him to the Paris branch.

 A) exchange

 B) transmit

 C) transfer

 D) removeA

 52.Having decided to rent a flat, we ________ contacting all the accommodation agencies in the city.

 A) set about

 B) set down

 C) set out

 D) set upD

 53.The relationship between employers and employees has been studied ________.

 A) originally

 B) extremely

 C) violently

 D) intensivelyA

 54.________ their differences. The couple were developing an obvious and genuine affection for each other.

 A) But for

 B) For all

 C) Above all

 D) Except forC

 55.One day I ________ a newspaper article about the retirement of an English professor at a nearby state college.

 A) came across

 B) came about

 C) came after

 D) came atC

 56.She was complaining that the doctor was ________ too much for the treatment he was giving her.

 A) expending

 B) offering

 C) costing

 D) chargingC

 57.The manager spoke highly of such ________ as loyalty, courage and truthfulness shown by his employees.

 A) virtues

 B) features

 C) properties

 D) characteristicsD

 58.Since the matter was extremely ________, we dealt with it immediately.

 A) tough

 B) tense

 C) urgent

 D) instantB

 59.You don’t have to be in such a hurry, I would rather you ________ on business first.

 A) would go

 B) will go

 C) went

 D) have goneB

 60.When I try to understand ________ that prevents so many Americans from being as happy as one might expect, it seems to me that there are two causes.

 A) why it does

 B) what it does

 C) what it is

 D) why it isC

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 During recent years we have heard much about “race”: how this race does certain things and that race believes certain things and so on. Yet, the __61__ phenomenon of race consists of a few surface indications.

 We judge race usually __62__ the colouring of the skin: a white race, a brown race, a yellow race and a black race. But __63__ you were to remove the skin you could not __64__ anything about the race to which the individual belonged. There is __65__ in physical structure, the brain or the internal organs to __66__ a difference.

 There are four types of blood. __67__ types are found in every race, and no type is distinct to any race. Human brains are the __68__. No scientists could examine a brain and tell you the race to which the individual belonged. Brains will __69__ in size, but this occurs within every race. __70__ does size have anything to do with intelligence. The largest brain __71__ examined belonged to a person of weak __72__. On the other hand, some of our most distinguished, people have had __73__ brains.

 Mental tests which are reasonably __74__ show no differences in intelligence between races. High and low test results both can be recorded by different members of any race. __75__ equal educational advantages, there will be no difference in average standings, either on account of race or geographical location.

 Individuals of every race __76__ civilization to go backward or forward. Training and education can change the response of a group of people __77__ enable them to behave in a __78__ way.

 The behavior and ideals of people change according to circumstances, but they can always go back or go on to something new __79__ is better and higher than anything __80__ the past.

 61.A) complete

 B) full

 C) total

 D) wholeC

 62.A) in

 B) from

 C) at

 D) onB

 63.A) since

 B) if

 C) as

 D) whileA

 64.A) speak

 B) talk

 C) tell

 D) mentionA

 65.A) something

 B) everything

 C) nothing

 D) anythingD

 66.A) display

 B) indicate

 C) demonstrate

 D) appearC

 67.A) All

 B) Most

 C) No

 D) SomeA

 68.A) same

 B) identical

 C) similar

 D) alikeA

 69.A) remain

 B) increase

 C) decrease

 D) varyD

 70.A) Only

 B) Or

 C) Nor

 D) SoC

 71.A) ever

 B) then

 C) never

 D) onceA

 72.A) health

 B) body

 C) mind

 D) thoughtC

 73.A) big

 B) small

 C) minor

 D) majorB

 74.A) true

 B) exact

 C) certain

 D) accurateD

 75.A) Provided

 B) Concerning

 C) Given

 D) FollowingC

 76.A) make

 B) cause

 C) move

 D) turnB

 77.A) and

 B) but

 C) though

 D) soA

 78.A) ordinary

 B) peculiar

 C) usual

 D) commonD

 79.A) that

 B) what

 C) whichever

 D) whateverA

 80.A) for

 B) to

 C) within

 D) inD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Harmfulness of Fake Commodities. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.目前社会上有不少假冒伪劣商品(fake commodities)。为什么会有这种现象?

 2.举例说明假冒伪劣商品对消费者个人、社会等的危害。

Harmfulness of Fake Commodities

19981月四级参考答案

Part I


1.B

2.C

3.B

4.C

5.D

6.B

7.D

8.A

9.C

10.A


Part II


11.B

12.C

13.C

14.D

15.A

16.B

17.C

18.D

19.A

20.B

21.A

22.C

23.D

24.A

25.D

26.A

27.B

28.C

29.A

30.D


Part III


31.D

32.B

33.C

34.B

35.D

36.A

37.D

38.C

39.B

40.A

41.A

42.B

43.B

44.D

45.A

46.B

47.C

48.A

49.D

50.B

51.A

52.D

53.A

54.C

55.C

56.C

57.D

58.B

59.B

60.C


Part IV


61.C

62.B

63.A

64.A

65.D

66.C

67.A

68.A

69.D

70.C

71.A

72.C

73.B

74.D

75.C

76.B

77.A

78.D

79.A

80.D


 S1.world’s

 S2.architectural

 S3.artificial

 S4.success

 S5.Despite

 S6.experiences

 S7.romantic

 S8.High school physical education was difficult because all of the equipment was too big for the then five-year-old student.

 S9.that in graduate school he was studying how to make them think like people.

 S10.Michael is smart, but he is like every other kid.

19986月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) They are twins.

 B) They are classmates.

 C) They are friends.

 D) They are colleagues.A

 2.A) The man is planning a trip to Austin.

 B) The man has not been to Austin before.

 C) The man doesn’t like Austin.

 D) The man has been to Austin before.B

 3.A) The size of the room.

 B) Long working hours.

 C) The hot weather.

 D) The fan in the room.C

 4.A) The man has changed his destination.

 B) The man is returning his ticket.

 C) The man is flying to New York tomorrow morning.

 D) The man can’t manage to go to New York as planned.D

 5.A) It is difficult to identify.

 B) It has been misplaced.

 C) It is missing.

 D) It has been borrowed by someone.B

 6.A) Looking for a timetable.

 B) Buying some furniture.

 C) Reserving a table.

 D) Window shopping.C

 7.A) Cold and windy.

 B) Snow will be replaced by strong winds.

 C) It will get better.

 D) Rainy and cold.A

 8.A) It is no longer available.

 B) It has been reprinted four times.

 C) The store doesn’t have it now, but will have it soon.

 D) The information in the book is out of date.B

 9.A) Henry doesn’t like the color.

 B) Someone else painted the house.

 C) There was no ladder in the house.

 D) Henry painted the house himself.B

 10.A) In a cotton field.

 B) At a railway station.

 C) On a farm.

 D) On a train.D

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) They invited him to a party.

 B) They asked him to make a speech.

 C) They gave a special dinner for him.

 D) They invited his wife to attend the dinner.C

 12.A) He was embarrassed.

 B) He felt greatly encouraged.

 C) He felt sad.

 D) He was deeply touched.D

 13.A) Sam’s wife did not think that the company was fair to Sam.

 B) Sam’s wife was satisfied with the gold watch.

 C) Sam did not like the gold watch.

 D) The company had some financial problems.A

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) The number of students they take in is limited.

 B) They receive little or no support from public taxes.

 C) They are only open to children from rich families.

 D) They have to pay more taxes.B

 15.A) Private schools admit more students.

 B) Private schools charge less than religious schools.

 C) Private schools run a variety of programs.

 D) Private schools allow students to enjoy more freedom.C

 16.A) The churches.

 B) The program designers.

 C) The local authorities.

 D) The state government.A

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) She was found stealing in a bookstore.

 B) She caught someone in the act of stealing.

 C) She admitted having stolen something.

 D) She said she was wrongly accused of stealing.D

 18.A) A book.

 B) $3,000.

 C) A handbag.

 D) A Christmas card.D

 19.A) She was questioned by the police.

 B) She was shut in a small room for 20 minutes.

 C) She was insulted by the shopper around her.

 D) She was body-searched by the store manager.B

 20.A) They refused to apologize for having followed her through the town.

 B) They regretted having wrongly accused her of stealing.

 C) They still suspected that she was a thief.

 D) The agreed to pay her $3,000 damages.C

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Psychologist George Spilich and colleagues at Washington College in Chestertown, Maryland, decided to find out whether, as many smokers say, smoking helps them to “think and concentrate. Spilich put young non-smokers, active smokers and smokers deprived (被剥夺) of cigarettes through a series of tests.

 In the first test, each subject (试验对象) sat before a computer screen and pressed a key as soon as he or she recognized a target letter among a grouping of 96. In this simple test, smokers, deprived smokers and non-smokers performed equally well.

 The next test was more complex, requiring all to scan sequences of 20 identical letters and respond the instant one of the letters transformed into a different one. Non-smokers were faster, but under the stimulation of nicotine (尼古丁), active smokers were faster than deprived smokers.

 In the third test of short-term memory, non-smokers made the fewest errors, but deprived smokers committed fewer errors than active smokers.

 The fourth test required people to read a passage, then answer questions about it. Non-smokers remembered 19 percent more of the most important information than active smokers, and deprived smokers bested those who had smoked a cigarette just before testing. Active smokers tended not only to have poorer memories but also had trouble separating important information from insignificant details.

 “As our tests became more complex,” sums up Spilich, “non-smokers performed better than smokers by wider and wider margins” He predicts, “smokers might perform adequately at many jobs-until they got complicated. A smoking airline pilot could fly adequately if no problems arose, but if something went wrong, smoking might damage his mental capacity.”

 21.The purpose of George Spilich’s experiments is ________.

 A) to test whether smoking has a positive effect on the mental capacity of smokers

 B) to show how smoking damages people’s mental capacity

 C) to prove that smoking affects people’s regular performance

 D) to find out whether smoking helps people’s short-term memoryA

 22.George Spilich’s experiment was conducted in such a way as to ________.

 A) compel the subjects to separate major information from minor details

 B) put the subjects through increasingly complex tests

 C) check the effectiveness of nicotine on smokers

 D) register the prompt responses of the subjectsB

 23.The word “bested” (Line 3, Para. 5) most probably means ________.

 A) beat

 B) envied

 C) caught up with

 D) made the best ofA

 24.Which of the following statements is true?

 A) Active smokers in general performed better than deprived smokers.

 B) Active smokers responded more quickly than the other subjects.

 C) Non-smokers were not better than other subjects in performing simple tasks.

 D) Deprived smokers gave the slowest responses to the various tasks.C

 25.We can infer from the last paragraph that ________.

 A) smokers should not expect to become airline pilots

 B) smoking in emergency cases causes mental illness

 C) no airline pilots smoke during flights

 D) smokers may prove unequal to handing emergency casesD

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 There is no denying that students should learn something about how computers work, just as we expect them at least to understand that the internal-combustion engine (内燃机) has something to do with burning fuel, expanding gases and pistons (活塞) being driven. For people should have some basic idea of how the things that they use do what they do. Further, students might be helped by a course that considers the computer’s impact on society. But that is not what is meant by computer literacy. For computer literacy is not a form of literacy (读写能力); it is a trade skill that should not be taught as a liberal art.

 Learning how to use a computer and learning how to program one are two distinct activities. A case might be made that the competent citizens of tomorrow should free themselves from their fear of computers. But this is quite different from saying that all ought to know how to program one. Leave that to people who have chosen programming as a career. While programming can be lots of fun, and while our society needs some people who are experts at it, the same is true of auto repaid and violin-making.

 Learning how to use a computer is not that difficult, and it gets easier all the time as programs become more “user-friendly”. Let us assume that in the future everyone is going to have to know how to use a computer to be a competent citizen. What does the phrase “learning to use a computer” mean? It sounds like “learning to drive a car”, that is, it sounds as if there is some set of definite skills that, once acquired, enable one to use a computer.

 In fact, “learning to use a computer” is much more like “learning to play a game”, but learning the rules of one game may not help you play a second game, whose rules may not be the same. There is no such a thing as teaching someone how to use a computer. One can only teach people to use this or that program and generally that is easily accomplished.

 26.To be the competent citizens of tomorrow, people should ________.

 A) try to lay a solid foundation in computer science

 B) be aware of how the things that they use do what they do

 C) learn to use a computer by acquiring a certain set of skills

 D) understand that programming a computer is more essential than repairing a carC

 27.In the second paragraph “violin-making” is mentioned to show that ________.

 A) programming a computer is as interesting as making a violin

 B) our society needs experts in different fields

 C) violin-making requires as much skill as computer programming

 D) people who can use a computer don’t necessarily have to know computer programmingD

 28.Learning to use a computer is getting easier all the time because ________.

 A) programs are becoming less complicated

 B) programs are designed to be convenient to users

 C) programming is becoming easier and easier

 D) programs are becoming readily available to computer usersB

 29.According to the author, the phrase “learning to use a computer” (Lines 3-4, Para. 3) means learning ________.

 A) a set of rules

 B) the fundamentals of computer science

 C) specific programs

 D) general principles of programmingC

 30.The author’s purpose in writing this passage is ________.

 A) to stress the impact of the computer on society

 B) to explain the concept of the computer literacy

 C) to illustrate the requirements for being competent citizens of tomorrow

 D) to emphasize that computer programming is an interesting and challenging jobD

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 The way people hold to the belief that a fun-filled, pain free life equals happiness actually reduces their chances of ever attaining real happiness, if fun and pleasure are equal to happiness then pain must be equal to unhappiness. But in fact, the opposite is true: more often than not things that lead to happiness involve some pain.

 As a result, many people avoid the very attempts that are the source of true happiness. They fear the pain inevitably brought by such things as marriage, raising children, professional achievement, religious commitment (承担的义务), self-improvement.

 Ask abachelor (单身汉) why he resists marriage even though he finds dating to be less and less satisfying. If he is honest he will tell you that he is afraid of making a commitment. For commitment is in fact quite painful. The single life is filled with fun, adventure, excitement. Marriage has such moments, but they are not its most distinguishing features.

 Couples with infant children are lucky to get a whole night’s sleep or a three-day vacation. I don’t know any parent who would choose the word fun to describe raising children. But couples who decide not to have children never know the joys of watching a child grow up or of playing with a grandchild.

 Understanding and accepting that true happiness has nothing to do with fun is one of the most liberating realizations. It liberates time: now we can devote more hours to activities that can genuinely increase our happiness. It liberates money: buying that new car or those fancy clothes that will do nothing to increase our happiness now seems pointless. And it liberates us from envy: we now understand that all those who are always having so much fun actually may not be happy at all.

 31.According to the author, a bachelor resists marriage chiefly because ________.

 A) he is reluctant to take on family responsibilities

 B) he believes that life will be more cheerful if he remains single

 C) he finds more fun in dating than in marriage

 D) he fears it will put an end to all his fun adventure and excitementA

 32.Raising children, in the author’s opinion, is ________.

 A) a moral duty

 B) a thankless job

 C) a rewarding task

 D) a source of inevitable painC

 33.From the last paragraph, we learn that envy sometimes stems from ________.

 A) hatred

 B) misunderstanding

 C) prejudice

 D) ignoranceB

 34.To understand what true happiness is one must ________.

 A) have as much run as possible during one’s lifetime

 B) make every effort to liberate oneself from pain

 C) put up with pain under all circumstances

 D) be able to distinguish happiness from funD

 35.What is the author trying to tell us?

 A) Happiness often goes hand in hand with pain.

 B) One must know how to attain happiness.

 C) It is important to make commitments.

 D) It is pain that leads to happiness.A

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 It’s very interesting to note where the debate about diversity (多样化) is taking place. It is taking place primarily in political circles. Here at the College Fund, we have a lot of contact with top corporate (公司的) leaders; none of them is talking about getting rid of those instruments that produce diversity. In fact, they say that if their companies are to compete in the global village and in the global market place, diversity is an imperative. They also say that the need for talented, skilled Americans means we have to expand the pool means promoting policies that help provide skills to more minorities, more women and more immigrants. Corporate leaders know that if that doesn’t occur in our society, they will not have the engineers, the scientist, the lawyers, or the business managers they will need.

 Likewise, I don’t hear people in the academy saying. “Let’s go backward. Let’s go back to the good old days, when we had a meritocracy (不拘一格选人才) “ (which was never true-we never had a meritocracy, although we’ve come close to it in the last 30 years). I recently visited a great little college in New York where the campus had doubled its minority population in the last six years. I talked with an African American who has been a professor there for a long time, and she remembers that when she first joined the community, there were fewer than a handful of minorities on campus. Now, all of us feel the university is better because of the diversity. So where we hear this debate is primarily in political circles and in the media-not in corporate board rooms or on college campuses.

 36.The word “imperative” (Line 5, Para. 1) most probably refers to something ________.

 A) superficial

 B) remarkable

 C) debatable

 D) essentialD

 37.Which of the following groups of people still differ in their views on diversity?

 A) Minorities.

 B) Politicians.

 C) Professors.

 D) Managers.B

 38.High corporate leaders seem to be in favor of promoting diversity so as to ________.

 A) lower the rate of unemployment

 B) win equal political rights for minorities

 C) be competitive in the world market

 D) satisfy the demands of a growing populationC

 39.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) meritocracy can never be realized without diversity

 B) American political circles will not accept diversity

 C) it is unlikely that diversity will occur in the U.S. media

 D) minorities can only enter the fields where no debate is heard about diversityA

 40.According to the passage diversity can be achieved in American society by ________.

 A) expanding the pool of potential employees

 B) promoting policies that provide skills to employees

 C) training more engineers, scientists lawyers and business managers

 D) providing education for all regardless of race or sexD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.The last half of the nineteenth century ________ the steady improvement in the means of travel.

 A) has witnessed

 B) was witnessed

 C) witnessed

 D) is witnessedC

 42.The shy girl felt ________ and uncomfortable when she could not answer her teacher’s questions.

 A) amazed

 B) awkward

 C) curious

 D) amusedB

 43.Ann never dreams of ________ for her to be sent abroad very soon.

 A) there being a chance

 B) there to be a chance

 C) there be a chance

 D) being a chanceA

 44.It was very kind of you to do the washing-up, but you ________ it.

 A) mustn’t have done

 B) wouldn’t have done

 C) mightn’t have done

 D) didn’t have to doD

 45.Frequently single-parent children ________ some of the functions that the absent adult in the house would have served.

 A) take off

 B) take after

 C) take in

 D) take onD

 46.He gives people the impression ________ all his life broad.

 A) of having spent

 B) to have spent

 C) of being spent

 D) to spendA

 47.A peculiarly pointed chin is his most memorable facial ________.

 A) mark

 B) feature

 C) trace

 D) appearanceB

 48.I’d rather you ________ make any comment on the issue for the time being.

 A) don’t

 B) wouldn’t

 C) didn’t

 D) shouldn’tC

 49.All things ________, the planned trip will have to be called off.

 A) considered

 B) be considered

 C) considering

 D) having consideredA

 50.John Dewey believed that education should be a preparation for life, that a person learns by doing, and that teaching must ________ the curiosity and creativity of children.

 A) seek

 B) stimulate

 C) shape

 D) secureB

 51.Criticism and self-criticism is necessary ________ it helps us to find and correct our mistakes.

 A) by that

 B) at that

 C) on that

 D) in thatD

 52.However, at times this balance in nature is ________, resulting in a number of possibly unforeseen effects.

 A) troubled

 B) disturbed

 C) confused

 D) puzzledB

 53.If she doesn’t tell him the truth now, he’ll simply keep on asking her until she ________.

 A) does

 B) has done

 C) will do

 D) would doA

 54.The patient’s health failed to such an extent that he was put into ________ care.

 A) tense

 B) rigid

 C) intensive

 D) tightC

 55.Does everyone on earth have an equal right ________ an equal share of its resources?

 A) by

 B) at

 C) to

 D) overC

 56.Americans eat ________ as they actually need every day.

 A) twice as much protein

 B) twice protein as much twice

 C) twice protein as much

 D) protein as twice muchA

 57.In 1914, an apparently insignificant event in a remote part of Eastern Europe ________ Europe into a great war.

 A) inserted

 B) imposed

 C) pitched

 D) plungedD

 58.The British are not so familiar with different cultures and other ways of doing things, ________ is often the case in other countries.

 A) as

 B) what

 C) so

 D) thatA

 59.There are few electronic applications ________ to raise fears regarding future employment opportunities than robots.

 A) likely

 B) more likely

 C) most likely

 D) much likelyB

 60.We had to ________ a lot of noise when the children were at home.

 A) go in for

 B) hold on to

 C) put up with

 D) keep pace withC

 61.What he said just now had little to do with the question ________ discussion.

 A) on

 B) in

 C) under

 D) atC

 62.We need a chairman ________.

 A) for whom everyone has confidence

 B) in whom everyone has confidence

 C) who everyone has confidence of

 D) whom everyone has confidence onB

 63.Over a third of the population was estimated to have no ________ to the health service.

 A) assessment

 B) assignment

 C) exception

 D) accessD

 64.Excuse me. If your call’s not too urgent, do you mind ________ mine first?

 A) I make

 B) if I make

 C) me to make

 D) that I makeB

 65.Professor Taylor’s talk has indicated that science has a very strong ________ on the everyday life of non-scientists as well as scientists.

 A) motivation

 B) perspective

 C) impression

 D) impactC

 66.After a few rounds of talks, both sides regarded the territory dispute ________.

 A) being settled

 B) to be settled

 C) had settled

 D) as settledD

 67.Floods cause billions of dollars worth of property damage ________.

 A) relatively

 B) actually

 C) annually

 D) comparativelyC

 68.We are all for your proposal that the discussion ________.

 A) be put off

 B) was put off

 C) should put off

 D) is to put offA

 69.These goods are ________ for export, though a few of them may be sold on the home market.

 A) essentially

 B) completely

 C) necessarily

 D) remarkablyA

 70.The course normally attracts 20 students per year, ________ up to half will be from overseas.

 A) in which

 B) for whom

 C) with which

 D) of whomD

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 The task of being accepted and enrolled (招收) in a university begins early for some students. Long __71__ they graduate from high school. These Students take special __72__ to prepare for advanced study. They may also take one of more examinations that test how __73__ prepared they are for the university. In the final year of high school, they __74__ applications and send them, with their student records, to the universities which they hope to __75__. Some high school students many be __76__ to have an interview with representatives of the university. Neatly, __77__, and usually very frightened, they are __78__ to show that they have a good attitude and the __79__ to succeed.

 When the new students are finally __80__, there may be one more step they have to __81__ before registering for classes and __82__ to work. Many colleges and universities __83__ an orientation (情况介绍) program for new students. __84__ these programs, the young people get to know the __85__ for registration and student advising, university rules, the __86__ of the library and all the other __87__ services of the college or university.

 Beginning a new life in a new place can be very __88__. The more knowledge students have __89__ the school, the easier it will be fore them to __90__ to the new environment. However, it takes time to get used to college life.

 71.A) as

 B) after

 C) since

 D) beforeD

 72.A) courses

 B) disciplines

 C) majors

 D) subjectsA

 73.A) deeply

 B) widely

 C) well

 D) muchC

 74.A) fulfill

 B) finish

 C) complete

 D) accomplishC

 75.A) attend

 B) participate

 C) study

 D) belongA

 76.A) acquired

 B) considered

 C) ordered

 D) requiredD

 77.A) decorated

 B) dressed

 C) coated

 D) wornB

 78.A) decided

 B) intended

 C) settled

 D) determinedD

 79.A) power

 B) ability

 C) possibility

 D) qualityB

 80.A) adopted

 B) accepted

 C) received

 D) permittedB

 81.A) make

 B) undergo

 C) take

 D) passC

 82.A) getting

 B) putting

 C) falling

 D) sittingA

 83.A) offer

 B) afford

 C) grant

 D) supplyA

 84.A) For

 B) Among

 C) In

 D) OnC

 85.A) processes

 B) procedures

 C) projects

 D) provisionsB

 86.A) application

 B) usage

 C) use

 D) utilityC

 87.A) major

 B) prominent

 C) key

 D) greatA

 88.A) amusing

 B) misleading

 C) alarming

 D) confusingD

 89.A) before

 B) about

 C) on

 D) atB

 90.A) fit

 B) suit

 C) yield

 D) adaptD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Do Lucky Numbers Really Bring Good Luck?. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below.

 1.有些人认为某些数字会带来好运。

 2.我认为数字和运气无关,...

Do “Lucky Numbers” Really Bring Good Luck?

19986月四级参考答案

Part I


1.A

2.B

3.C

4.D

5.B

6.C

7.A

8.B

9.B

10.D

11.C

12.D

13.A

14.B

15.C

16.A

17.D

18.D

19.B

20.C


Part II


21.A

22.B

23.A

24.C

25.D

26.C

27.D

28.B

29.C

30.B

31.A

32.C

33.B

34.D

35.A

36.D

37.B

38.C

39.A

40.D


Part III


41.C

42.B

43.A

44.D

45.D

46.A

47.B

48.C

49.A

50.B

51.D

52.B

53.A

54.C

55.C

56.A

57.D

58.A

59.B

60.C

61.C

62.B

63.D

64.B

65.D

66.D

67.C

68.A

69.A

70.D


Part IV


71.D

72.A

73.C

74.C

75.A

76.D

77.B

78.D

79.B

80.B

81.C

82.A

83.A

84.C

85.B

86.C

87.A

88.D

89.B

90.D


19991月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) He watched television with his friend.

 B) He stayed at home talking with his friend.

 C) He went to see a film with his friend.

 D) He went to see his schoolmate.B

 2.A) When the meeting is to be held.

 B) Who are going to attend the meeting.

 C) Where the meeting is to be held.

 D) What’s to be discussed at the meeting.D

 3.A) The necessity of writing to Mr. Johnson.

 B) Who is going to contact Mr. Johnson.

 C) The arrangement of the Wednesday meeting.

 D) Where they are going to meet Mr. Johnson.A

 4.A) Jack brought the tape to the party.

 B) The tape had been returned to Paul.

 C) The tape was missing.

 D) Jack lent his tape to Paul.C

 5.A) The man wants to reserve a room.

 B) The man reserved a room some time ago.

 C) The man has booked a room with no bath.

 D) The man wants to buy a flat on the second floor.B

 6.A) Both editions are the same price now.

 B) It has two editions with the same cover.

 C) The paperback edition is on sale.

 D) The hardcover edition is more expensive.A

 7.A) His TV sets are all of the same brand.

 B) He doesn’t have the newest models right now.

 C) He has the best TV sets for sale.

 D) His TV sets have a good sale.C

 8.A) He must hand in a report about the museum.

 B) He has already visited the museum.

 C) He has to read a history book.

 D) He is too busy to go with her.D

 9.A) They are rewarding.

 B) They are entertaining.

 C) They are boring.

 D) They are time-consuming.A

 10.A) A sunny day.

 B) A raincoat.

 C) An attractive hut.

 D) A lovely hat.D

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 14 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) She sat back and relaxed.

 B) She decided to retire.

 C) She entered university.

 D) She worked out a new English program.C

 12.A) 8 years.

 B) 20 years.

 C) 16 years.

 D) 30 years.D

 13.A) Bring a great deal of useful experience to the university.

 B) Improve human relationships in the university.

 C) Bring a fear of aging among young students on the campus.

 D) Improve the reputation of the university.A

 14.A) She is learning English and Drama.

 B) She is learning how to make sound judgments.

 C) She is learning how to teach minority students.

 D) She is learning to perceive, not to judge.D

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) The difference between classical music and rock music.

 B) Why classical music is popular with math students.

 C) The effects of music on the results of math tests.

 D) How to improve your reasoning ability.C

 16.A) Because it stimulates your nerve activity.

 B) Because it keeps you calm.

 C) Because it strengthens your memory.

 D) Because it improves your problem solving strategies.A

 17.A) Piano music could interfere with your reasoning ability.

 B) The effects of music do not last long.

 C) The more you listen to music, the higher your test scores will be.

 D) Music, whether classical or rock, helps improve your memory.B

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) To drive the car automatically.

 B) To measure the driver’s pulse.

 C) To prevent car accidents.

 D) To monitor the driver’s health.C

 19.A) It sends out signals for help.

 B) It sounds an alarm to warn the driver.

 C) It takes over the driving immediately.

 D) It stops the car automatically.B

 20.A) It monitors the signals transmitted from the driver’s brain.

 B) It can measure the driver’s alcohol level in the blood.

 C) It can quicken the driver’s response to emergencies.

 D) It bases its analysis on the driver’s heartbeat.D

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 The view over a valley of a tiny village with thatched (草盖的) roof cottages around a church; a drive through a narrow village street lines with thatched cottages painted pink or white; the sight in parts of England. Most people will agree that the thatched roof is an essential part of the attraction of the English countryside.

 Thatching is in fact the oldest of all the building crafts practiced in the British Isles (英论诸岛). Although thatch has always been used for cottage and farm buildings, it was once used for castles and churches, too.

 Thatching is a solitary (独自的) craft, which often runs in families. The craft of thatching as it is practiced toady has changed very little since the Middle Ages. Over 800 full-time thatchers are employed in England and Wales today, maintaining and renewing the old roofs as well as thatching newer houses. Many property owners choose thatch not only for its beauty but because they know it will keep them cool in summer and warm in winter.

 In fact, if we look at developing countries, over half the world lives under thatch, but they all do it in different ways. People in developing countries are often reluctant to go back to traditional materials and would prefer modern buildings. However, they may lack the money to allow them to import the necessary materials. Their temporary mud huts with thatched roofs of wild grasses often only last six months. Thatch which has been done the British way lasts from twenty to sixty years, and is an effective defiance against the heat.

 21.Which of the following remains a unique feature of the English countryside?

 A) Narrow streets lined with pink or white houses.

 B) Rolling hills with pretty farm buildings.

 C) Cottages with thatched roofs.

 D) Churches with cottages around them.C

 22.What do we know about thatching as a craft?

 A) It is a collective activity.

 B) It is practised on farms all over England.

 C) It is quite different from what it used to be.

 D) It is in most cases handed down among family members.D

 23.Thatched houses are still preferred because of ________.

 A) their style and comfort

 B) their durability

 C) their easy maintenance

 D) their cheap and ready-made materialsA

 24.People in developing countries also live under thatch because ________.

 A) thatched cottages are a big tourist attraction

 B) thatched roof houses are the cheapest

 C) thatch is an effective defense against the heat

 D) they like thatched houses better than other buildingsB

 25.We can learn from the passage that ________.

 A) thatched cottages in England have been passed down from ancient times

 B) thatching is a building craft first created by the English people

 C) the English people have a special liking for thatched houses

 D) most thatched cottages in England are located on hillsidesA

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 President Coolidge’s statement, “The business of America is business,” still points to an important truth today-that business institutions have more prestige (威望) in American society than any other kind of organization, including the government. Why do business institutions posses this great prestige?

 One reason is that Americans view business as being more firmly based on the ideal of competition than other institutions in society. Since competition is seen as the major source of progress and prosperity by most Americans, competitive business institutions are respected. Competition is not only good in itself, it is the means by which other basic American values such as individual freedom, equality of opportunity, and hard work are protected.

 Competition protects the freedom of the individual by ensuring that there is no monopoly (垄断) of power. In contrast to one, all-powerful government, many businesses compete against each other for profits. Theoretically, if one business tries to take unfair advantage of its customers, it will lose to competing business which treats its customers more fairly. Where many businesses compete for the customers’ dollar, they cannot afford to treat them like inferiors or slaves.

 A contrast is often made between business, which is competitive, and government, which si a monopoly. Because business is competitive, many Americans believe that it is more supportive of freedom than government, even though government leaders are elected by the people and business leaders are not. Many Americans believe, then, that competition is as important, or even more important, that democracy in preserving freedom.

 Competition in business is also believed to strengthen the ideal of equality of opportunity. Competition is seen as an open and fair race where success goes to the swiftest person regardless of his or her social class background. Competitive success is commonly seen as the American alternative to social rank based on family background. Business is therefore viewed as an expression of the idea of equality of opportunity rather than the aristocratic (贵族的) idea of inherited privilege.

 26.The statement “The business of America is business” probably means “________”.

 A) The business institutions in America are concerned with commerce

 B) Business problems are of great importance to the American government

 C) Business is of primary concern to Americans

 D) America is a great power in world businessC

 27.Americans believe that they can realize their personal values only ________.

 A) when given equality of opportunity

 B) through doing business

 C) by protecting their individual freedom

 D) by way of competitionD

 28.Who can benefit from business competition?

 A) Honest businessmen.

 B) Both businessmen and their customers.

 C) People with ideals of equality and freedom.

 D) Both business institutions and government.B

 29.Government is believed to differ strikingly from business in that government is characterized by ________.

 A) its absolute control of power

 B) its function in preserving personal freedom

 C) its role in protecting basic American values

 D) its democratic way of exercising leadershipA

 30.It can be inferred from the passage that the author believes ________.

 A) Americans are more ambitious than people in other countries

 B) in many countries success often depends on one’s social status

 C) American businesses are more democratic than those in other countries

 D) businesses in other countries are not as competitive as those in AmericaB

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 The appeal of advertising to buying motives can have both negative and positive effects consumers may be convinced to buy a product of poor quality or high price because of an advertisement. For example, some advertisers have appealed to people’s desire for better fuel economy for their cars by advertising automotive products that improve gasoline mileage. Some of the products work. Others are worthless and a waste of consumers’ money.

 Sometimes advertising is intentionally misleading. A few years ago a brand of bread was offer to dieters (节食者) with the message that there were fewer calories (热量单位,大卡) in every slice. It turned out that the bread was not dietetic (适合于节食的), but just regular bread. There were fewer calories because it was sliced very thin, but there were the same number of calories in every loaf.

 On the positive side, emotional appeals may respond to a consumer’s real concerns. Consider fire insurance. Fire insurance may be sold by appealing to fear of loss. But fear of loss is the real reason for fire insurance. The security of knowing that property is protected by insurance makes the purchase of fire insurance a worthwhile investment for most people. If consumers consider the quality of the insurance plans as well as the message in the ads, they will benefit from the advertising.

 Each consumer must evaluate her or his own situation. Are the benefits of the product important enough to justify buying it? Advertising is intended to appeal to consumers, but it does not force them to buy the product. Consumers still control the final buying decision.

 31.Advertising can persuade the consumer to buy worthless products by ________.

 A) stressing their high quality

 B) convincing him of their low price

 C) maintaining a balance between quality and price

 D) appealing to his buying motivesD

 32.The reason why the bread advertisement is misleading is that ________.

 A) thin slices of bread could contain more calories

 B) the loaf was cut into regular slices

 C) the bread was not genuine bread

 D) the total number of calories in the loaf remained the sameD

 33.The passage tells us that ________.

 A) sometimes advertisements really sell what the consumer needs

 B) advertisements occasionally force consumers into buying things they don’t need

 C) the buying motives of consumers are controlled by advertisements

 D) fire insurance is seldom a worthwhile investmentA

 34.It can be inferred from the passage that a smart consumer should ________.

 A) think carefully about the benefits described in the advertisements

 B) guard against the deceiving nature of advertisements

 C) be familiar with various advertising strategies

 D) avoid buying products that have strong emotional appealA

 35.The passage is mainly about ________.

 A) how to make a wise buying decision

 B) ways to protect the interests of the consumer

 C) the positive and negative aspects of advertising

 D) the function of advertisements in promoting salesC

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 So long as teachers fail to distinguish between teaching and learning, they will continue to undertake to do for children that which only children can do for themselves. Teaching children to read is not passing reading on to them. It is certainly not endless hours spent in activities about reading. Douglas insists that “reading cannot be taught directly and schools should stop trying to do the impossible.”

 Teaching and learning are two entirely different processes. They differ in kind and function. The function of teaching is to create the conditions and the climate that will make it possible for children to devise the most efficient system for teaching themselves to read. Teaching is also public activity: It can be seen and observed.

 Learning to read involves all that each individual does to make sense of the world of printed language. Almost all of it is private, for learning is an occupation of the mind, and that process is not open to public scrutiny.

 If teacher and learner roles are not interchangeable, what then can be done through teaching that will aid the child in the quest (探索) for knowledge? Smith has one principal rule for all teaching instructions. “Make learning to read easy, which means making reading a meaningful, enjoyable and frequent experience for children.”

 When the roles of teacher and learner are seen for what they are, and when both teacher and learner fulfill them appropriately, then much of the pressure and feeling of failure for both is eliminated. Learning to read is made easier when teachers create an environment where children are given the opportunity to solve the problem of leaning to read by reading.

 36.The problem with the reading course as mentioned in the first paragraph is that ________.

 A) it is one of the most difficult school courses

 B) students spend endless hours in reading

 C) reading tasks are assigned with little guidance

 D) too much time is spent in teaching about readingD

 37.The teaching of reading will be successful if ________.

 A) teachers can improve conditions at school for the students

 B) teachers can enable students to develop their own way of reading

 C) teachers can devise the most efficient system for reading

 D) teachers can make their teaching activities observableB

 38.The word “scrutiny” (Line 3, Para. 3) most probably means “________”.

 A) inquiry

 B) observation

 C) control

 D) suspicionB

 39.According to the passage, learning to read will no longer be a difficult task when ________.

 A) children become highly motivated

 B) teacher and learner roles are interchangeable

 C) teaching helps children in the search for knowledge

 D) reading enriches children’s experienceA

 40.The main idea of the passage is that ________.

 A) teachers should do as little as possible in helping students learn to read

 B) teachers should encourage students to read as widely as possible

 C) reading ability is something acquired rather than taught

 D) reading is more complicated than generally believedC

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.A person’s calorie requirements vary ________ his life.

 A) across

 B) throughout

 C) over

 D) withinB

 42.A survey was carried out on the death rate of new-born babies in that region, ________ were surprising.

 A) as results

 B) which results

 C) the results of it

 D) the results of whichD

 43.Generous public funding of basic science would ________ considerable benefits for the country’s health, wealth and security.

 A) lead to

 B) result from

 C) lie in

 D) settle downA

 44.In a time of social reform, people’s state of mind tends to keep ________ with the rapid changes of society.

 A) step

 B) progress

 C) pace

 D) touchC

 45.________ in an atmosphere of simple living was what her parents wished for.

 A) The girl was educated

 B) The girl educated

 C) The girl’s being educated

 D) The girl to be educatedC

 46.________ the calculation is right, scientists can never be sure that they have included all variables and modeled them accurately.

 A) Even if

 B) As far as

 C) If only

 D) So long asA

 47.My train arrives in New York at eight o’clock tonight. The plane I would like to take from there ________ by then.

 A) would leave

 B) will have left

 C) has left

 D) had leftB

 48.The speech which he made ________ the project has bothered me greatly.

 A) being concerned

 B) concerned

 C) be concerned

 D) concerningD

 49.Harry was ________ by a bee when he was collecting the honey.

 A) stung

 B) stuck

 C) bitten

 D) scratchedA

 50.The thief tried to open the locked door but ________.

 A) in no way

 B) in vain

 C) without effect

 D) at a lossB

 51.All flights ________ because of the snowstorm, many passengers could do nothing but take the train.

 A) had been canceled

 B) have been canceled

 C) were canceled

 D) having been canceledD

 52.________ seeing the damage he had done, the child felt ashamed.

 A) By

 B) On

 C) At

 D) ForB

 53.Remember that customers don’t ________ about prices in that city.

 A) debate

 B) consult

 C) dispute

 D) bargainD

 54.Research findings show we spend about two hours dreaming every night, no matter what we ________ during the day.

 A) should have done

 B) may have done

 C) would have done

 D) must have doneC

 55.I hope that you’ll be more careful in typing the letter. Don’t ________ anything.

 A) lack

 B) withdraw

 C) omit

 D) leakC

 56.This crop does not do well in soils ________ the one for which it has been specially developed.

 A) outside

 B) other than

 C) beyond

 D) rather thanB

 57.“You are very selfish. It’s high time you ________ that you are not the most important person in the world,” Edgar said to his boss angrily.

 A) realized

 B) have realized

 C) realized

 D) should realizeA

 58.These two areas are similar ________ they both have a high rainfall during this season.

 A) to that

 B) besides that

 C) in that

 D) except thatC

 59.The tomato juice left brown ________ on the front of my jacket.

 A) spot

 B) point

 C) track

 D) traceA

 60.If I hadn’t stood under the ladder to catch you when you fell, you ________ now.

 A) wouldn’t be smiling

 B) couldn’t have smiled

 C) won’t smile

 D) didn’t smileA

 61.The committee is totally opposed ________ any changes being made in the plans.

 A) of

 B) on

 C) to

 D) againstC

 62.We’ll visit Europe next year ________ we have enough money.

 A) lest

 B) until

 C) unless

 D) providedD

 63.My father seemed to be in no ________ to look at my school report.

 A) mood

 B) emotion

 C) attitude

 D) feelingA

 64.When he realized the police had spotted him, the man ________ the exit as quickly as possible.

 A) made off

 B) made for

 C) made out

 D) made upB

 65.I was advised to arrange for insurance ________ I needed medical treatment.

 A) nevertheless

 B) although

 C) in case

 D) so thatC

 66.Frankly speaking, I’d rather you ________ anything about it for the time being.

 A) didn’t do

 B) haven’t done

 C) don’t do

 D) have doneA

 67.I’m sorry I can’t see you immediately; but if you’d like to take a seat, I’ll be with you ________.

 A) for a moment

 B) in a moment

 C) for the moment

 D) at the momentB

 68.The trumpet player was certainly loud. But I wasn’t bothered by his loudness ________ by his lack of talent.

 A) than

 B) more than

 C) as

 D) so much asD

 69.Our new house is very ________ for me as I can get to the office in five minutes.

 A) adaptable

 B) comfortable

 C) convenient

 D) availableC

 70.Our journey was slow because the train stopped ________ at different villages.

 A) unceasingly

 B) gradually

 C) continuously

 D) continuallyD

Part IV Short Answer Questions (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part there is a short passage with five questions or incomplete statements. Read the passage carefully. Then answer the questions or complete the statements in the fewest possible words (not exceeding 10 words.)

 Would be language teachers everywhere have one thing in common: they all want some recognition of their professional status and skills, and a job. The former requirement is obviously important on a personal level, but it is vital if you are to have any chance of finding work.

 Ten years ago, the situation was very different. In virtually every developing country, and in many developed countries as well, being a native English speaker was enough to get you employed as an English teacher.

 Now employers will only look at teachers who have the knowledge, the skills and attitudes to teach English effectively. The result of this has been to raise non-native English teachers to the same status as their native counterparts (相对应的人)—something they have always deserved but seldom enjoyed. Non-natives are now happy—linguistic discrimination (语言上的歧视) is a thing of the past.

 An ongoing research project, funded by the University of Cambridge, asked a sample of teachers, teacher educators and employers in more than 40 countries whether they regard the native/non-native speakers distinction as being at all important. “NO” was the answer. As long as candidates could teach and had the required level of English, it didn’t matter who they were and where they came from. Thus, a new form of discrimination—this time justified because it singled out the unqualified—liberated the linguistically oppressed (受压迫的). But the Cambridge project did more than just that: it confirmed that the needs of native and non-native teachers are extremely similar.

 Questions: (注意:答题尽量简短,超过10个词要扣分。每条横线限写一个英语单词,标点符号不占格。)

 S1.The selection of English teachers used to be mainly based on ________.

 S2.What did non-native English teachers deserve but seldom enjoy?

 S3.What kind of people can now find a job as an English teacher?

 S4.What is the result of the “new form of discrimination” (Line 5, Para. 4)?

 S5.The phrase “the linguistically oppressed” (Line 6, Para. 4) refers to those who were ________.

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Dont Hesitate to Say No. You should write at least 100 words and you should base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.别人请求帮助时,在什么情况下我们会说“不”。

 2.为什么有些人在该说“不”的时候不说“不”。

 3.该说“不”时不说“不”的坏处。

Don’t Hesitate to Say “No”

19991月四级参考答案

Part I


1.B

2.D

3.A

4.C

5.B

6.A

7.C

8.D

9.A

10.D

11.C

12.D

13.A

14.D

15.C

16.A

17.B

18.C

19.B

20.D


Part II


21.C

22.D

23.A

24.B

25.A

26.C

27.D

28.B

29.A

30.B

31.D

32.D

33.A

34.A

35.C

36.D

37.B

38.B

39.A

40.C


Part III


41.B

42.D

43.A

44.C

45.C

46.A

47.B

48.D

49.A

50.B

51.D

52.B

53.D

54.C

55.C

56.B

57.A

58.C

59.A

60.A

61.C

62.D

63.A

64.B

65.C

66.A

67.B

68.D

69.C

70.D



 S1.whether or not one was a native speaker.

 S2.The same status as their counterparts.

 S3.Ones who can teach and have the required English level.

 S4.Non-native English teachers have been liberated. Or: It singled out the unqualified.

 S5.qualified English teachers because they were non-native speakers.

19996月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) The woman feels sorry for the man.

 B) The man is a member of the staff.

 C) The area is for passengers only.

 D) The woman is asking the man to leave.D

 2.A) Clean her house while she is away.

 B) Buy her some plants and take care of them.

 C) Water her plants while she is away.

 D) Water her plants when he is not at work.C

 3.A) He will only be available in the afternoon.

 B) It’s not his office hour.

 C) He doesn’t have time.

 D) He is too tired after class.C

 4.A) The woman insists on going out.

 B) The woman doesn’t like watching TV.

 C) The man promised her a gift on her birthday.

 D) The man is too tired to go out.A

 5.A) There are too many courses offered to students.

 B) There woman should take fewer courses next term.

 C) The man will take four courses next semester.

 D) It is wiser to take more than four courses.B

 6.A) Ask Tom to send an invitation.

 B) Get the Johnsons’ address.

 C) Invite Tom to the party.

 D) Tell Tom to pick up the Johnsons.B

 7.A) Jane is looking for an summer job.

 B) Jane is packing for the summer vacation.

 C) Jane is on her way home.

 D) Jane is eager to go home for the vacation.D

 8.A) Spending more time on sightseeing.

 B) Visiting the city with a group.

 C) Touring the city on a fine day.

 D) Taking the man with her on the tour.A

 9.A) The woman is driving too fast.

 B) The woman is driving at a slow speed.

 C) The woman has broken a traffic rule.

 D) The woman has parked her car in a wrong place.C

 10.A) She can tell Joan’s brother about the reception.

 B) She should tell Joan’s brother about the reception.

 C) She must call on Joan after the reception.

 D) She may see Joan’s brother at lunch.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) To protect persons and property.

 B) To collect taxes.

 C) To teach and train citizens.

 D) To save natural resources for future use.A

 12.A) By selling services that make life comfortable.

 B) By selling land containing oil.

 C) By selling public lands.

 D) By selling coal and other natural products.C

 13.A) Environmental pollution and protection.

 B) Taxes and services for the public.

 C) Police efforts to protect people.

 D) People’s attitude toward taxes.B

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) He didn’t like physics any more.

 B) His eyesight was too poor.

 C) Physics was too hard for him.

 D) He had to work to support himself.D

 15.A) He was not happy with the new director.

 B) He was not qualified to be an engineer.

 C) He wanted to travel.

 D) He found his job boring.A

 16.A) He wanted to work with his friend.

 B) He wanted to go to Spain.

 C) He enjoyed travelling around the world.

 D) He was rejected by the engineering firm.C

 17.A) He enjoyed teaching English.

 B) He wanted to earn more to support his family.

 C) The owner of the school promised him a good position.

 D) He could earn more as a teacher than as a travel agent.B

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) It can be cooked in many ways.

 B) It is delicious but inexpensive.

 C) It gives higher yields than other grain crops.

 D) It grows easily in various conditions.D

 19.A) Fried potatoes.

 B) Tomato juice.

 C) Sweet corn.

 D) Chocolate beans.D

 20.A) They led to the discovery of America.

 B) They made native American foods popular.

 C) They brought great wealth to Spain.

 D) They made native American life styles well-known.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 The biggest safety threat facing airlines today may not be a terrorist with a gun, but the man with the portable computer in business class. In the last 15 years, pilots have reported well over 100 incidents that could have been caused by electromagnetic interference. The source of this interference remains unconfirmed, but increasingly, experts are pointing the blame at portable electronic device such as portable computers, radio and cassette players and mobile telephones.

 RTCA, an organization which advises the aviation (航空) industry, has recommended that all airlines ban (禁止) such devices from being used during “critical” stages of flight, particularly take-off and landing. Some experts have gone further, calling for a total ban during all flights. Currently, rules on using these devices are left up to individual airlines. And although some airlines prohibit passengers from using such equipment during take-off and landing, most are reluctant to enforce a total ban, given that many passengers want to work during flights.

 The difficulty is predicting how electromagnetic fields might affect an aircraft’s computers. Experts know that portable device emit radiation which affects those wavelengths which aircraft use for navigation and communication. But, because they have not been able to reproduce these effects in a laboratory, they have no way of knowing whether the interference might be dangerous or not.

 The fact that aircraft may be vulnerable (易受损的) to interference raises the risk that terrorists may use radio systems in order to damage navigation equipment. As worrying, though, is the passenger who can’t hear the instructions to turn off his radio because the music’s too loud.

 21.The passage is mainly about ________.

 A) a new regulation for al airlines

 B) the defects of electronic devices

 C) a possible cause of aircraft crashes

 D) effective safety measures for air flightC

 22.What is said about the over 100 aircraft incidents in the past 15 years?

 A) They may have been caused by the damage to the radio systems.

 B) They may have taken place during take-off and landing.

 C) They were proved to have been caused by the passengers’ portable computers.

 D) They were suspected to have resulted from electromagnetic interference.D

 23.Few airlines want to impose a total ban on their passengers using electronic devices because ________.

 A) they don’t believe there is such a danger as radio interference

 B) the harmful effect of electromagnetic interference is yet to be proved

 C) most passengers refuse to take a plane which bans the use of radio and cassette players

 D) they have other effective safety measures to fall back onC

 24.Why is it difficult to predict the possible effects of electromagnetic fields on an airplane’s computers?

 A) Because it is extremely dangerous to conduct such research on an airplane.

 B) Because it remains a mystery what wavelengths are liable to be interfered with.

 C) Because research scientists have not been able to produce the same effects in labs.

 D) Because experts lack adequate equipment to do such research.C

 25.It can be inferred from the passage that the author ________.

 A) is in favor of prohibiting passengers’ use of electronic devices completely

 B) has overestimated the danger of electromagnetic interference

 C) hasn’t formed his own opinion on this problem

 D) regards it as unreasonable to exercise a total ban during flightD

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 The rise of multinational corporations (跨国公司), global marketing, new communications technologies, and shrinking cultural differences have led to an unparalleled increase in global public relations or PR.

 Surprisingly, since modern PR was largely an American invention, the U.S. leadership in public relations is being threatened by PR efforts in other countries. Ten years ago, for example, the world’s top five public relations agencies were American-owned. In 1991, only one was. The British in particular are becoming more sophisticated and creative. A recent survey found that more than half of all British companies include PR as part of their corporate (公司的) planning activities, compared to about one-third of U.S. companies. It may not be long before London replaces New York as the capital of PR.

 Why is America lagging behind in the global PR race? First, Americans as a whole tend to be fairly provincial and take more of an interest in local affairs. Knowledge of world geography, for example, has never been strong in this country. Secondly, Americans lag behind their European and Asian counterparts (相对应的人) in knowing a second language. Less than 5 percent of Burson—Marshall’s U.S. employees know two languages. Ogilvy and Mather has about the same percentage. Conversely, some European firms have half or more of their employees fluent in a second language. Finally, people involved in PR abroad tend to keep a closer eye on international affairs. In the financial PR area, for instance, most Americans read the Wall Street Journal. Overseas, their counterparts read the Journal as well as the Financial Times of London and The Economist, publications not often read in this country.

 Perhaps the PR industry might take a lesson from Ted Turner of CNN (Cable News Network). Turner recently announced that the word “foreign” would no longer be used on CNN news broadcasts. According to Turner, global communications have made the nations of the world so interdependent that there is no longer any such things as foreign.

 26.According to the passage, U.S. leadership in public relations is being threatened because of ________.

 A) an unparalleled increase in the number of public relations companies

 B) shrinking cultural differences and new communications technologies

 C) the decreasing number of multinational corporations in the U.S.

 D) increased efforts of other countries in public relationsD

 27.London could soon replace New York as the center of PR because ________.

 A) British companies are more ambitious than U.S. companies

 B) British companies place more importance on PR than U.S. companies

 C) British companies are heavily involved in planning activities

 D) four of the world’s top public relations agencies are British-ownedB

 28.The word “provincial” (Line 2, Para. 3) most probably means “________”.

 A) limited in outlook

 B) like people from the provinces

 C) rigid in thinking

 D) interested in world financial affairsA

 29.We learn from the third paragraph that employees in the American PR industry ________.

 A) speak at least one foreign language fluently

 B) are ignorant about world geography

 C) are not as sophisticated as their European counterparts

 D) enjoy reading a great variety of English business publicationsB

 30.What lesson might the PR industry take from Ted Turner of CNN?

 A) American PR companies should be more internationally-minded.

 B) The American PR industry should develop global communications technologies.

 C) People working in PR should be more fluent in foreign languages.

 D) People involved in PR should avoid using the word “foreign”.A

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Brazil has become one of the developing world’s great successes at reducing population growth-but more by accident than design. While countries such as India have made joint efforts to reduce birth rates, Brazil has had better result without really trying, says George Martine at Harvard.

 Brazil’s population growth rate has dropped from 2.99% a year between 1951 and 1960 to 1.93% a year between 1981 and 1990, and Brazilian women now have only 2.7 children on average. Martine says this figure may have fallen still further since 1990, an achievement that makes it the envy of many other Third World countries.

 Martine puts it down to, among other things, soap operas (通俗电视连续剧) and installment (分期付款) plans introduced in the 1970s. Both played an important, although indirect, role in lowering the birth rate. Brazil is one of the world’s biggest producers of soap operas. Globo, Brazil’s most popular television network, shows three hours of soaps six nights a week, while three others show at least one hour a night. Most soaps are based on wealthy characters living the high life in big cities.

 “Although they have never really tried to work in a message towards the problems of reproduction, they describe middle and upper class values-not many children, different attitudes towards sex, women working,” says Martine. “They sent this image to all parts of Brazil and made people conscious of other patterns of behavior and other values, which were put into a very attractive package.”

 Meanwhile, the installment plans tried to encourage the poor to become consumers. “This led to an enormous change in consumption patterns and consumption was incompatible (不相容的) with unlimited reproduction,” says Martine.

 31.According to the passage, Brazil has cut back its population growth ________.

 A) by educating its citizens

 B) by careful family planning

 C) by developing TV programmes

 D) by chanceD

 32.According to the passage, many Third World countries ________.

 A) haven’t attached much importance to birth control

 B) would soon join Brazil in controlling their birth rate

 C) haven’t yet found an effective measure to control their population

 D) neglected the role of TV plays in family planningC

 33.The phrase “puts it down to” (Line 1, Para. 3) is closest in meaning to “________”.

 A) attributes it to

 B) finds it a reason for

 C) sums it up as

 D) compares it toA

 34.Soap operas have helped in lowering Brazil’s birth rate because ________.

 A) they keep people sitting long hours watching TV

 B) they have gradually changed people’s way of life

 C) people are drawn to their attractive package

 D) they popularize birth control measuresB

 35.What is Martine’s conclusion about Brazil’s population growth?

 A) The increase in birth rate will promote consumption.

 B) The desire for consumption helps to reduce birth rate.

 C) Consumption patterns and reproduction patterns are contradictory.

 D) A country’s production is limited by its population growth.B

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 There seems never to have been a civilization without toys, but when and how they developed is unknown. They probably came about just to give children something to do.

 In the ancient world, as is today, most boys played with some kinds of toys and most girls with another. In societies where social roles are rigidly determined, boys pattern their play after the activities of their fathers and girls after the tasks of their mothers. This is true because boys and girls are being prepared, even in play, to step into the roles and responsibilities of the adult world.

 What is remarkable about the history of toys is not so much how they changed over the centuries but how much they have remained are same. The changes have been mostly in terms of craftsmanship, mechanics, and technology. It is the universality of toys with regard to their development in all parts of the world and their persistence to the present that is amazing. In Egypt, the Americas, China, Japan and among the Arctic (北极的) peoples, generally the same kinds of toys appeared. Variations depended on local customs and ways of life because toys imitate their surroundings. Nearly every civilization had dolls, little weapons, toy soldiers, tiny animals and vehicles.

 Because toys can be generally regarded as a kind of art form, they have not been subject to technological leaps that characterize inventions for adult use. The progress from the wheel to the oxcart to the automobile is a direct line of ascent (进步). The progress from a rattle (拨浪鼓) used by a baby in 3000 BC to one used by an infant today, however, is not characterized by inventiveness. Each rattle is the product of the artistic tastes of the times and subject to the limitations of available materials.

 36.The reason why the toys most boys play with are different from those that girls play with is that ________.

 A) their social roles are rigidly determined

 B) most boys would like to follow their fathers’ professions

 C) boys like to play with their fathers while girls with their mothers

 D) they like challenging activitiesA

 37.One aspect of “the universality of toys” lies in the fact that ________.

 A) technological advances have greatly improved the durability of toys

 B) the improvement of craftsmanship in making toys depends on the efforts of universities

 C) the exploration of the universe had led to the creation of new kinds of toys

 D) the basic characteristics of toys are the same the world overD

 38.Which of the following is the author’s view on the historical development of toys?

 A) The craftsmanship in toy-making has remained essentially unchanged.

 B) Toys have remained basically the same all through the centuries.

 C) The toy industry has witnessed great leaps in technology in recent years.

 D) Toys are playing an increasingly important role in shaping a child’s character.B

 39.Regarded as a kind of art form, toys ________.

 A) follow a direct line of ascent

 B) also appeal greatly to adults

 C) are not characterized by technological progress

 D) reflect the pace of social progressC

 40.The author uses the example of rattle to show that ________.

 A) in toy-making there is a continuity in the sue of materials

 B) even the simplest toys can reflect the progress of technology

 C) even the simplest toys can reflect the progress of technology

 D) even a simple toy can mirror the artistic tastes of the timeD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.He came back late, ________ which time all the guests had already left.

 A) after

 B) by

 C) at

 D) duringB

 42.I’m very sorry to have ________ you with so many questions on such an occasion.

 A) interfered

 B) offended

 C) impressed

 D) botheredD

 43.If the whole operation ________ beforehand a great deal of time and money would have been lost.

 A) was not planned

 B) has not been planned

 C) had not been planned

 D) was not plannedC

 44.The price of beer ________ from 50 cents to $4 per liter during the summer season.

 A) altered

 B) ranged

 C) separated

 D) differedB

 45.His remarks left me ________ about his real purpose.

 A) wondered

 B) wonder

 C) to wonder

 D) wonderingD

 46.I have heard both teachers and students ________ well of him.

 A) to speak

 B) spoken

 C) to have spoken

 D) speakD

 47.Our son doesn’t know what to ________ at the university; he can’t make up his mind about his future.

 A) take in

 B) take up

 C) take over

 D) take afterB

 48.The house was very quiet, ________ as it was on the side of a mountain.

 A) isolated

 B) isolating

 C) being isolated

 D) having been isolatedA

 49.Although they plant trees in this area every year, the tops of some hills are still ________.

 A) blank

 B) hollow

 C) vacant

 D) bareD

 50.Being a pop star can be quite a hard life, with a lot of traveling ________ heavy schedules.

 A) with regard to

 B) as to

 C) in relation to

 D) owing toD

 51.Tony is very disappointed ________ the results of the exam.

 A) with

 B) for

 C) toward

 D) onA

 52.William Penn, the founder of Pennsylvania, ________ defended the right of every citizen to freedom of choice in religion.

 A) peculiarly

 B) indifferently

 C) vigorously

 D) inevitablyC

 53.I hope all the precautions against air pollution, ________ suggested by the local government, will be seriously considered here.

 A) while

 B) since

 C) after

 D) asD

 54.When people become unemployed, it is ________ which is often worse than lack of wages.

 A) laziness

 B) poverty

 C) idleness

 D) inabilityC

 55.I’ve never been to Beijing, but it’s the place ________.

 A) where I’d like to visit

 B) I most want to visit

 C) in which I’d like to visit

 D) that I want to visit it mostB

 56.________ his sister, Jack is quiet and does not easily make friends with others.

 A) Dislike

 B) Unlike

 C) Alike

 D) LikingB

 57.This crop has similar qualities to the previous one, ________ both wind-resistant and adapted to the same type of soil.

 A) being

 B) been

 C) to be

 D) having beenA

 58.________ you are leaving tomorrow, we can eat dinner together tonight.

 A) For

 B) Since

 C) Before

 D) WhileB

 59.Some people would like to do shopping on Sundays since they expect to pick up wonderful ________ in the market.

 A) batteries

 B) bargains

 C) baskets

 D) barrelsB

 60.We have been told that under no circumstances ________ the telephone in the office for personal affairs.

 A) may we use

 B) we may use

 C) we could use

 D) did we useA

 61.In previous times, then fresh meat was in short ________, pigeons were kept by many households as a source of food.

 A) store

 B) provision

 C) reserve

 D) supplyD

 62.As Commander-in-Chief of the armed forces, I have directed that all measures ________ for our defense.

 A) had been taken

 B) would be taken

 C) be taken

 D) to be takenC

 63.A thief who broke into a church was caught because traces of wax, found on his clothes, ________ from the sort of candles used only in churches.

 A) had come

 B) coming

 C) come

 D) that cameA

 64.After the guests left, she spent half an hour ________ the sitting-room.

 A) ordering

 B) arranging

 C) tidying up

 D) clearing awayC

 65.I was ________ the point of telephoning him when his letter arrived.

 A) to

 B) on

 C) at

 D) inB

 66.In no country ________ Britain, it has been said, can one experience four seasons in the course of a single day.

 A) other than

 B) more than

 C) better than

 D) rather thanA

 67.A lorry ________ Jane’s cat and sped away.

 A) ran over

 B) ran into

 C) ran through

 D) ran downD

 68.The project ________ by the end of 2000, will expand the city’s telephone network to cover 1,000,000 users.

 A) accomplished

 B) being accomplished

 C) to be accomplished

 D) having been accomplishedC

 69.________ evidence that language-acquiring ability must be stimulated.

 A) If being

 B) It is

 C) There is

 D) There beingC

 70.Those gifts of rare books that were given to us were deeply ________.

 A) appreciated

 B) approved

 C) appealed

 D) appliedA

Part IV Short Answer Questions (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part there is a short passage with five questions or incomplete statements. Read the passage carefully. Then answer the questions or complete the statements in the fewest possible words (not exceeding 10 words.)

 For many women choosing whether to work or not to work outside their home is a luxury: they must work to survive. Others face a hard decision.

 Perhaps the easiest choice has to do with economics. One husband said, “Marge and I decided after careful consideration that for her to go back to work at this moment was an extravagance (奢侈) we couldn’t afford.” With two preschool children, it soon became clear in their figuring that with babysitters (临时照看小孩的人), transportation, and increased taxes, rather than having more money, they might actually end up with less.

 Economic factors are usually the first to be considered, but they are not the most important. The most important aspects of the decision have to do with the emotional needs of each member of the family. It is in this area that husbands and wives find themselves having to face many confusing and conflicting feelings.

 There are many women who find that homemaking is boring or who feel imprisoned (被囚禁) if they have to stay home with a young child or several children. On the other hand, there are women who think that homemaking gives them the deepest satisfaction.

 From my own experience. I would like to suggest that sometime the decision to go back to work is made in too much haste. There are few decisions that I now regret more. I wasn’t mature enough to see how much I could have gained at home. I regret my impatience to get on with my career. I wish I had allowed myself the luxury of watching the world through my little girl’s eyes.

 Questions: (注意:答题尽量简短,超过10个词要扣分。每条横线限写一个英语单词,标点符号不占格。)

 S1.Which word in the first tow paragraphs best explains why many women have to work?

 S2.Why did Marge and her husband think it an extravagance for Marge to go back to work?

 S3.What are the two major considerations in deciding whether women should go out to work?

 S4.Some women would rather do housework and take care of their children than pursue a career because they feel ________.

 S5.If given a second chance, the writer would probably choose to ________.

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Reading Selectively Or Extensively? You should write at least 100 words, and base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.有人认为读书要有选择

 2.有人认为应当博览群书

 3.我的看法

Reading Selectively Or Extensively

19996月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.C

3.C

4.A

5.B

6.B

7.D

8.A

9.C

10.A

11.A

12.C

13.B

14.D

15.A

16.C

17.B

18.D

19.D

20.B


Part II


21.C

22.D

23.C

24.C

25.C

26.D

27.B

28.A

29.B

30.A

31.D

32.C

33.A

34.B

35.B

36.A

37.D

38.B

39.C

40.D


Part III


41.B

42.D

43.C

44.B

45.D

46.D

47.B

48.A

49.D

50.D

51.A

52.C

53.D

54.C

55.B

56.B

57.A

58.B

59.B

60.A

61.D

62.C

63.A

64.C

65.B

66.A

67.D

68.C

69.C

70.A



 S1.Economics.

 S2.Because the increased cost will be more than Marge’s income.

 S3.Economic factors and emotional needs.

 S4.that homemaking gives them the deepest satisfaction.

 S5.stay home.

20001月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) The woman is a close friend of the man.

 B) The woman has been working too hard.

 C) The woman is seeing a doctor.

 D) The woman is tired of her work.C

 2.A) This apple pie tastes very good.

 B) His mother likes the pie very much.

 C) This pie can’t match his mother’s.

 D) His mother can’t make apple pies.A

 3.A) Take a walk.

 B) Give a performance.

 C) Listen to the music.

 D) Dance to the music.D

 4.A) Read an article on political science.

 B) Present a different theory to the class.

 C) Read more than one article.

 D) Choose a better article to read.C

 5.A) The woman would understand if she did Mary’s job.

 B) The woman should do the typing for Mary.

 C) The woman should work as hard as Mary.

 D) The woman isn’t a skillful typist.A

 6.A) He wants to make an appointment with Mr. Smith.

 B) He wants to make sure that Mr. Smith will see him.

 C) He wants to change the time of the appointment.

 D) He wants the woman to meet him at three o’clock.B

 7.A) He gets nervous very easily.

 B) He is an inexperienced speaker.

 C) He is an awful speaker.

 D) He hasn’t prepared his speech well.B

 8.A) She didn’t like the books the man bought.

 B) There wasn’t a large selection at the bookstore.

 C) The man bought a lot of books.

 D) She wanted to see what the man bought.C

 9.A) Buy a ticket for the tem o’clock flight.

 B) Ask the man to change the ticket for her.

 C) Go to the airport immediately.

 D) Switch to a different flight.D

 10.A) Dr. Lemon is waiting for a patient.

 B) Dr. Lemon is busy at the moment.

 C) Dr. Lemon has lost his patience.

 D) Dr. Lemon has gone out to visit a patient.B

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 14 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) A car outside the supermarket.

 B) A car at the bottom of the hill.

 C) Paul’s car.

 D) The sports car.C

 12.A) Inside the car.

 B) At the foot of the hill.

 C) In the garage.

 D) In the supermarket.D

 13.A) The driver of the sports car.

 B) The two girls inside the car.

 C) The man standing nearby.

 D) The salesman from London.A

 14.A) Nobody.

 B) The two girls.

 C) The bus driver.

 D) Paul.A

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) His friend gave him the wrong key.

 B) He didn’t know where the back door was.

 C) He couldn’t find the key to his mailbox.

 D) It was too dark to put the key in the lock.A

 16.A) It was getting dark.

 B) He was afraid of being blamed by his friend.

 C) The birds might have flown away.

 D) His friend would arrive any time.B

 17.A) He looked silly with only one leg inside the window.

 B) He knew the policeman wouldn’t believe him.

 C) The torch light made him look very foolish.

 D) He realized that he had made a mistake.B

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) The threat of poisonous desert animals and plants.

 B) The exhaustion of energy resources.

 C) The destruction of oil wells.

 D) The spread of the black powder from the fires.D

 19.A) The underground oil resources have not been affected.

 B) Most of the desert animals and plants have managed to survive.

 C) The oil lakes soon dried up and stopped evaporating.

 D) The underground water resources have not been polluted.D

 20.A) To restore the normal production of the oil wells.

 B) To estimate the losses caused by the fires.

 C) To remove the oil left in the desert.

 D) To use the oil left in the oil lakes.C

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Unless we spend money to spot and prevent asteroids (小行星) now, one might crash into Earth and destroy life as we know it, say some scientists.

 Asteroids are bigger versions of the meteoroids (流星) that race across the night sky. Most orbit the sun far from Earth and don’t threaten us. But there are also thousands of asteroids whose orbits put them on a collision course with Earth.

 Buy $50 million worth of new telescopes right now. Then spend $10 million a year for the next 25 years to locate most of the space rocks. By the time we spot a fatal one, the scientists say, we’ll have a way to change its course.

 Some scientists favor pushing asteroids off course with nuclear weapons. But the cost wouldn’t be cheap.

 Is it worth it? Two things experts consider when judging any risk re: 1) How likely the event is; and 2) How bad the consequences if the event occurs. Experts think an asteroid big enough to destroy lots of life might strike Earth once every 500,000 years. Sounds pretty rare—but if one did fall, it would be the end of the world. “If we don’t take care of these big asteroids, they’ll take care of us,” says one scientist. “It’s that simple.”

 The cure, though, might be worse than the disease. Do we really want fleets of nuclear weapons sitting around on Earth? “The world has less to fear from doomsday (毁灭性的) rocks than from a great nuclear fleet set against them,” said a New York Times article.

 21.What does the passage say about asteroids and meteoroids?

 A) They are heavenly bodies different in composition.

 B) They are heavenly bodies similar in nature.

 C) There are more asteroids than meteoroids.

 D) Asteroids are more mysterious than meteoroids.B

 22.What do scientists say about the collision of an asteroid with Earth?

 A) It is very unlikely but the danger exists.

 B) Such a collision might occur once every 25 years.

 C) Collisions of smaller asteroids with Earth occur more often than expected.

 D) It’s still too early to say whether such a collision might occur.A

 23.What do people think of the suggestion of using nuclear weapons to alter the courses of asteroids?

 A) It sounds practical but it may not solve the problem.

 B) It may create more problems than it might solve.

 C) It is a waste of money because a collision of asteroids with Earth is very unlikely.

 D) Further research should be done before it is proved applicable.B

 24.We can conclude from the passage that ________.

 A) while pushing asteroids off course nuclear weapons would destroy the world

 B) asteroids racing across the night sky are likely to hit Earth in the near future

 C) the worry about asteroids can be left to future generations since it is unlikely to happen in our lifetime

 D) workable solutions still have to be found to prevent a collision of asteroids with EarthD

 25.Which of the following best describes the author’s tone in this passage?

 A) Optimistic.

 B) Critical.

 C) Objective.

 D) Arbitrary.C

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Believe it or not, opticalillusion(错觉) can cut highway crashes.

 Japan is a case in point. It has reduced automobile crashes on some roads by nearly 75 percent using a simple optical illusion. Bent stripes, calledchevrons (人字形), painted on the roads make drivers think that they are driving faster than they really are, and thus drivers slow down.

 Now the American Automobile Association Foundation for Traffic Safety in Washington D.C. is planning to repeat Japan’s success. Starting next year, the foundation will paint chevrons and other patterns of stripes on selected roads around the country to test how well the patterns reduce highway crashes.

 Excessive speed plays a major role in as much as one fifth of all fatal traffic accidents, according to the foundation. To help reduce those accidents, the foundation will conduct its tests in areas where speed-related hazards are the greatest—curves, exit slopes, traffic circles, and bridges.

 Some studies suggest that straight, horizontal bars painted across roads can initially cut the average speed of drivers in half. However, traffic often returns to full speed within months as drivers become used to seeing the painted bars.

 Chevrons, scientists say, not only give drivers the impression that they are driving faster than they really are but also make a lane appear to be narrower. The result is a longer lasting reduction in highway sped and the number of traffic accidents.

 26.The passage mainly discusses ________.

 A) a new way of highway speed control

 B) a new pattern for painting highways

 C) a new approach to training drivers

 D) a new type of optical illusionA

 27.On roads painted with chevrons, drivers tend to feel that ________.

 A) they should avoid speed-related hazards

 B) they are driving in the wrong lane

 C) they should slow down their speed

 D) they are approaching the speed limitC

 28.The advantage of chevrons over straight, horizontal bars is that the former ________.

 A) can keep drivers awake

 B) can cut road accidents in half

 C) will have a longer effect on drivers

 D) will look more attractiveC

 29.The American Automobile Association Foundation for Traffic Safety plans to ________.

 A) try out the Japanese method in certain areas

 B) change the road signs across the country

 C) replace straight, horizontal bars with chevrons

 D) repeat the Japanese road patternsA

 30.What does the author say about straight, horizontal bars painted across roads?

 A) They are falling out of use in the United States.

 B) They tend to be ignored by drivers in a short period of time.

 C) They are applicable only on broad roads.

 D) They cannot be applied successfully to traffic circles.B

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

Amtrak (美国铁路客运公司) was experiencing a downswing in ridership (客运量) along the lines comprising its rail system. Of major concern to Amtrak and its advertising agency DDB Needham, were the long-distance western routes where ridership had been declining significantly.] At one time, trains were the only practical way to cross the vast areas of the west. Trains were fast, very luxurious, and quite convenient compared to other forms of transportation existing at the time. However, times change and the automobile became America’s standard of convenience. Also, air travel had easily established itself as the fastest method of traveling great distances. Therefore, the task for DDB Needham was to encourage consumers to consider other aspects of train travel in order to change their attitudes and increase the likelihood that trains would be considered for travel in the west.

 Two portions of the total market were targeted: 1) anxious fliers—those concerned with safety, relaxation, and cleanliness and 2) travel-lovers—those viewing themselves as relaxed, casual, and interested in the travel experience as part of their vacation. The agency then developed a campaign that focused on travel experiences such as freedom, escape, relaxation, and enjoyment of the great western outdoors. It stressed experiences gained by using the trains and portrayed western train trips as wonderful adventures.

 Advertisements showed pictures of the beautiful scenery that could be enjoyed along some of the more famous western routes and emphasized the romantic names of some of these trains (Empire Builder, etc.). These ads were strategically placed among family-oriented TV shows and programs involving nature and America in order to most effectively reach target audiences. Results were impressive. The Empire Builder, which was focused on in one ad, enjoyed a 15 percent increase in profits on its Chicago to Seattle route.

 31.What’s the author’s purpose in writing this passage?

 A) To show the inability of trains to compete with planes with respect to speed and convenience.

 B) To stress the influence of the automobile on America’s standard of convenience.

 C) To emphasize the function of travel agencies in market promotion.

 D) To illustrate the important role of persuasive communication in changing consumer attitudes.D

 32.It can be inferred from the passage that the drop in Amtrak ridership was due to the fact that ________.

 A) trains were not suitable for short distance passenger transportation

 B) trains were not the fastest and most convenient form of transportation

 C) trains were not as fast and convenient as they used to be

 D) trains could not compete with planes in terms of luxury and convenienceB

 33.To encourage consumers to travel by train, DDB Needham emphasized ________.

 A) the freedom and convenience provided on trains

 B) the practical aspects of train travel

 C) the adventurous aspects of train trips

 D) the safety and cleanliness of train tripsC

 34.The train ads were placed among family-oriented TV programs involving nature and America because ________.

 A) they could focus on meaningful travel experiences

 B) they could increase the effectiveness of the TV programs

 C) their profits could be increased by some 15 percent

 D) most travel-lovers and nervous fliers were believed to be among the audiencesD

 35.According to the passage, the Empire Builder enjoyed an increase in ridership and profits because ________.

 A) the attractiveness of its name and route was effectively advertised

 B) it provided an exciting travel experience

 C) its passengers could enjoy the great western outdoors

 D) it was widely advertised in newspapers and magazines in Chicago and SeattleA

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 Why does cram go bad faster than butter? Some researchers think they have the answer, and it comes down to the structure of the food, not its chemical composition—a finding that could help rid some processed foods of chemical preservatives.

 Cream and butter contain pretty much the same substances, so why cream should sour much faster has been a mystery. Both are emulsions—tinyglobules(小球体) of one liquid evenly distributed throughout another. The difference lies in what’s in the globules and what’s in the surrounding liquid, says Brocklehurst, who led the investigation.

 In cream, fatty globules drift about in a sea of water. In butter, globules of a watery solution are locked away in a sea of fat. The bacteria which make the food go bad prefer to live in the watery regions of the mixture. “This means that in cream, the bacteria are free to grow throughout the mixture,” he says.

 When the situation is reversed, the bacteria are locked away incompartments(隔仓室) buried deep in the sea of fat. Trapped in this way, individual colonies cannot spread and rapidly run out ofnutrients(养料). They also slowly poison themselves with their waste products. “In butter, you get a self-limiting system which stops the bacteria growing,” says Brocklehurst.

 The researchers are already working with food companies keen to see if their products can be made resistant to bacterial attack through alterations to the food’s structure. Brocklehurst believes it will be possible to make the emulsions used in salad cream, for instance, more like that in butter. The key will be to do this while keeping the salad cream liquid and not turning it into a solid lump.

 36.The significance of Brocklehurst’s research is that ________.

 A) it suggested a way to keep some foods fresh without preservatives

 B) it discovered tiny globules in both cream and butter

 C) it revealed the secret of how bacteria multiply in cream and butter

 D) it found that cream and butter share the same chemical compositionA

 37.According to the researchers, cream sours fast than butter because bacteria ________.

 A) are more evenly distributed in cream

 B) multiply more easily in cream than in butter

 C) live on less fat in cream than in butter

 D) produce less waste in cream than in butterB

 38.According to Brocklehurst, we can keep cream fresh by ________.

 A) removing its fat

 B) killing the bacteria

 C) reducing its water content

 D) altering its structureD

 39.The word “colonies” (Line 2, Para. 4) refers to ________.

 A) tiny globules

 B) watery regions

 C) bacteria communities

 D) little compartmentsC

 40.Commercial application of the research finding will be possible if salad cream can be made resistant to bacterial attack ________.

 A) by varying its chemical composition

 B) by turning it into a solid lump

 C) while keeping its structure unchanged

 D) while retaining its liquid formD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.She ought to stop work; she has a headache because she ________ too long.

 A) has been reading

 B) had read

 C) is reading

 D) readA

 42.Niagara Falls is a great tourist ________, drawing millions of visitors every year.

 A) attention

 B) attraction

 C) appointment

 D) arrangementB

 43.I don’t mind ________ the decision as long as it is not too late.

 A) you to delay making

 B) your delaying making

 C) your delaying to make

 D) you delay to makeB

 44.The hopes, goals, fears and desires ________ widely between men and women, between the rich and the poor.

 A) alter

 B) shift

 C) transfer

 D) varyD

 45.Corn originated in the New World and thus was not known in Europe until Columbus found it ________ in Cuba.

 A) being cultivated

 B) been cultivated

 C) having cultivated

 D) cultivatingA

 46.The sale usually takes place outside the house, with the audience ________ on benches, chairs or boxes.

 A) having seated

 B) seating

 C) seated

 D) having been seatedC

 47.This kind of glasses manufactured by experienced craftsmen ________ comfortably.

 A) is worn

 B) wears

 C) wearing

 D) are wornB

 48.Some diseases are ________ by certain water animals.

 A) transplanted

 B) transformed

 C) transported

 D) transmittedD

 49.Wouldn’t you rather your child ________ to bed early?

 A) go

 B) went

 C) would go

 D) goesB

 50.Although Anne is happy with her success she wonders ________ will happen to her private life.

 A) that

 B) what

 C) it

 D) thisB

 51.The words of his old teacher left a ________ impression on his mind. He is still influenced by them.

 A) staying not

 B) not to stay

 C) that he would not stay

 D) that he not stayC

 52.Mike’s uncle insists ________ in this hotel.

 A) whatever

 B) whomever

 C) whichever

 D) whoeverD

 53.We agreed to accept ________ they thought was the best tourist guide.

 A) whatever

 B) whomever

 C) whichever

 D) whoeverD

 54.It is our ________ policy that we will achieve unity through peaceful means.

 A) consistent

 B) continuous

 C) considerate

 D) continualA

 55.Between 1974 and 1997, the number of overseas visitors expanded ________27%.

 A) by

 B) for

 C) to

 D) inA

 56.Although many people view conflict as bad, conflict is sometimes useful ________ it forces people to test the relative merits of their attitudes and behaviors.

 A) by which

 B) to which

 C) in that

 D) so thatC

 57.He is ________ about his chances of winning a gold medal in the Olympics next year.

 A) optimistic

 B) optional

 C) outstanding

 D) obviousA

 58.Sometimes I wish I ________ in a different time and a different place.

 A) be living

 B) were living

 C) would live

 D) would have livedB

 59.The director was critical ________ the way we were doing the work.

 A) at

 B) in

 C) of

 D) withC

 60.In a sudden ________ of anger, the man tore up everything within reach.

 A) attack

 B) burst

 C) split

 D) blastB

 61.________ she realized it was too late to go home.

 A) No sooner it grew dark than

 B) Hardly did it grow dark that

 C) Scarcely had it grown dark than

 D) It was not until dark thatD

 62.In Britain people ________ four million tons of potatoes every year.

 A) swallow

 B) dispose

 C) consume

 D) exhaustC

 63.I’d ________ his reputation with other farmers and business people in the community, and then make a decision about whether or not to approve a loan.

 A) take into account

 B) account for

 C) make up for

 D) make outA

 64.It is essential that these application forms ________ back as early as possible.

 A) must be sent

 B) will be sent

 C) are sent

 D) be sentD

 65.She cooked the meat for a long time so as to make it ________ enough to eat.

 A) mild

 B) slight

 C) light

 D) tenderD

 66.We take our skin for granted until it is burned ________ repair.

 A) beyond

 B) for

 C) without

 D) underA

 67.The computer revolution may well change society as ________ as did the Industrial Revolution.

 A) certainly

 B) insignificantly

 C) fundamentally

 D) comparativelyC

 68.________ in this way, the situation doesn’t seem so disappointing.

 A) To look at

 B) Looking at

 C) Looked at

 D) To be looked atC

 69.A lot of ants are always invading my kitchen. They are a thorough ________.

 A) nuisance

 B) trouble

 C) worry

 D) anxietyA

 70.Some women ________ a good salary in a job instead of staying home, but they decided not to work for the sake of the family.

 A) must make

 B) should have made

 C) would make

 D) could have madeD

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 In a telephone survey of more than 2,000 adults, 21% said they believed the sun revolved (旋转) around the earth. An __71__ 7% did not know which revolved around __72__ I have no doubt that __73__ all of these people were __74__ in school that the earth revolves around the sun; __75__ may even have written it __76__ a test. But they never __77__ their incorrect mental models of planetary (行星的) __78__ because their everyday observations didn’t support __79__ their teachers told them: People see the sun “moving” __80__ the sky as morning turns to night, and the earth seems stationary (静止的) __81__ that is happening.

 Students can learn the right answers __82__ heart in class, and yet never combined them __83__ their working models of the world. The objectively correct answer the professor accepts and the __84__ personal understanding of the world can __85__ side by side, each unaffected by the other.

 Outside of class, the student continues to sue the __86__ model because it has always worked well __87__ that circumstance. Unless professors address __88__ errors in students’ personal models of the world, students are not __89__ to replace them with the __90__ one.

 71.A) excessive

 B) extra

 C) additional

 D) addedC

 72.A) what

 B) which

 C) that

 D) otherB

 73.A) virtually

 B) remarkably

 C) ideally

 D) preferablyA

 74.A) learned

 B) suggested

 C) taught

 D) advisedC

 75.A) those

 B) these

 C) who

 D) theyD

 76.A) on

 B) with

 C) under

 D) forA

 77.A) formed

 B) altered

 C) believed

 D) thoughtB

 78.A) operation

 B) position

 C) motion

 D) locationC

 79.A) how

 B) which

 C) that

 D) whatD

 80.A) around

 B) across

 C) on

 D) aboveB

 81.A) since

 B) so

 C) while

 D) forC

 82.A) to

 B) by

 C) in

 D) withB

 83.A) with

 B) into

 C) to

 D) alongA

 84.A) adult’s

 B) teacher’s

 C) scientist’s

 D) student’sD

 85.A) exist

 B) occur

 C) survive

 D) maintainA

 86.A) private

 B) individual

 C) personal

 D) ownC

 87.A) in

 B) with

 C) on

 D) forA

 88.A) general

 B) natural

 C) similar

 D) specificD

 89.A) obliged

 B) likely

 C) probable

 D) partialB

 90.A) perfect

 B) better

 C) reasonable

 D) correctD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic How I Finance My College Education. You should write at least 120 words, and base your composition on the outline (given in Chinese) below:

 1.上大学的费用(tuition and fees)可以通过多种途径解决

 2.哪种途径适合于我(说明理由)

How I Finance My College Education

20001月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.A

3.D

4.C

5.A

6.B

7.B

8.C

9.D

10.B

11.C

12.D

13.A

14.A

15.A

16.B

17.B

18.D

19.D

20.C


Part II


21.B

22.A

23.B

24.D

25.C

26.A

27.C

28.C

29.A

30.B

31.D

32.B

33.C

34.D

35.A

36.A

37.B

38.D

39.C

40.D


Part III


41.A

42.B

43.B

44.D

45.A

46.C

47.B

48.D

49.B

50.B

51.C

52.D

53.D

54.A

55.A

56.C

57.A

58.B

59.C

60.B

61.D

62.C

63.A

64.D

65.D

66.A

67.C

68.C

69.A

70.D


Part IV


71.C

72.B

73.A

74.C

75.D

76.A

77.B

78.C

79.D

80.B

81.C

82.B

83.A

84.D

85.A

86.C

87.A

88.D

89.B

90.D



20006月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) She is not interested in the article.

 B) She has given the man much trouble.

 C) She would like to have a copy of the article.

 D) She doesn’t want to take the trouble to read the article.C

 2.A) He saw the big tower he visited on TV.

 B) He has visited the TV tower twice.

 C) He has visited the TV tower once.

 D) He will visit the TV tower in June.C

 3.A) The woman regrets having taken up much of the professor’s time.

 B) The woman regrets having taken up much of the professor’s time.

 C) The woman knows the professor has been busy.

 D) The woman knows the professor has run into trouble.B

 4.A) He doesn’t enjoy business trips as much as he used to.

 B) He doesn’t think he is capable of doing the job.

 C) He thinks the pay is too low to support his family.

 D) He wants to spend more time with his family.D

 5.A) The man thought the essay was easy.

 B) They both had a hard time writing the essay.

 C) The woman thought the essay was easy.

 D) Neither of them has finished the assignment yet.B

 6.A) In the park.

 B) Between two buildings.

 C) In his apartment.

 D) Under a huge tree.D

 7.A) It’s awfully dull.

 B) It’s really exciting.

 C) It’s very exhausting.

 D) It’s quite challenging.A

 8.A) A movie.

 B) A lecture.

 C) A play.

 D) A speech.C

 9.A) The weather is mild compared to the past years.

 B) They are having the coldest winter ever.

 C) The weather will soon get warmer.

 D) The weather may get even colder.D

 10.A) A mystery story.

 B) The hiring of a shop assistant.

 C) The search for a reliable witness.

 D) An unsolved case of robbery.D

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 14 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) They want to change the way English is taught.

 B) They learn English to find well-paid jobs.

 C) They want to have an up-to-date knowledge of English.

 D) They know clearly what they want to learn.D

 12.A) Professionals.

 B) College students.

 C) Beginners.

 D) Intermediate learners.A

 13.A) Courses for doctors.

 B) Courses for businessmen.

 C) Courses for reporters.

 D) Courses for lawyers.B

 14.A) Three groups of learners.

 B) The importance of business English.

 C) English for Specific Purposes.

 D) Features of English for different purposes.C

Passage Two

Questions 15 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 15.A) To show off their wealth.

 B) To feel good.

 C) To regain their memory.

 D) To be different from others.B

 16.A) To help solve their psychological problems.

 B) To play games with them.

 C) To send them to the hospital.

 D) To make them aware of its harmfulness.A

 17.A) They need care and affection.

 B) They are fond of round-the-world trips.

 C) They are mostly form broken families.

 D) They are likely to commit crimes.A

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) Because it was too heavy.

 B) Because it did not bend easily.

 C) Because it did not shoot far.

 D) Because its string was short.C

 19.A) It went out of use 300 years ago.

 B) It was invented after the short bow.

 C) It was discovered before fire and the wheel.

 D) It’s still in use today.B

 20.A) They are accurate and easy to pull.

 B) Their shooting range is 40 yards.

 C) They are usually used indoors.

 D) They took 100 years to develop.A

Part II Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 21.As we can no longer wait for the delivery of our order, we have to ________ it.

 A) postpone

 B) refuse

 C) delay

 D) cancelD

 22.These books, which you can get at any bookshop, will give you ________ you need.

 A) all the information

 B) all the information

 C) all of information

 D) all of the informationA

 23.Not until the game had begun ________ at the sports ground.

 A) had he arrived

 B) would he have arrived

 C) did he arrive

 D) should he have arrivedC

 24.Young people are not ________ to stand and look at works of art; they want art they can participate in.

 A) conservative

 B) content

 C) confident

 D) generousB

 25.Most broadcasters maintain that TV has been unfairly criticized and argue that the power of the medium is ________.

 A) granted

 B) implied

 C) exaggerated

 D) remediedC

 26.These surveys indicate that many crimes go ________ by the police, mainly because not all victims report them.

 A) unrecorded

 B) to be unrecorded

 C) unrecording

 D) to have been unrecordedA

 27.I have no objection ________ your story again.

 A) to hear

 B) to hearing

 C) to having heard

 D) to have heardB

 28.The clothes a person wears may express his ________ or social position.

 A) curiosity

 B) status

 C) determination

 D) significanceB

 29.By law, when one makes a large purchase, he should have ________ opportunity to change his mind.

 A) accurate

 B) urgent

 C) excessive

 D) adequateD

 30.You will see this product ________ wherever you go.

 A) to be advertised

 B) advertised

 C) advertise

 D) advertisingB

 31.The early pioneers had to ________ many hardships to settle on the new land.

 A) go along with

 B) go back on

 C) go through

 D) go intoC

 32.The suggestion that the major ________ the prizes was accepted by everyone.

 A) would present

 B) present

 C) presents

 D) ought to presentB

 33.Beer is the most popular drink among male drinkers, ________ overall consumption is significantly higher than that of women.

 A) whose

 B) which

 C) that

 D) whatA

 34.Peter, who had been driving all day, suggested ________ at the next town.

 A) to stop

 B) stopping

 C) stop

 D) having stoppedB

 35.I didn’t know the word. I had to ________ a dictionary.

 A) look out

 B) make out

 C) refer to

 D) go overC

 36.The professor could hardly find sufficient grounds ________ his arguments in favour of the new theory.

 A) to be based on

 B) to base on

 C) which to base on

 D) on which to baseD

 37.There are signs ________ restaurants are becoming more popular with families.

 A) that

 B) which

 C) in which

 D) whoseA

 38.I think I was at school, ________ I was staying with a friends during the vacation when I heard the news.

 A) or else

 B) and then

 C) or so

 D) even soA

 39.It is said that the math teacher seems ________ towards bright students.

 A) partial

 B) beneficial

 C) preferable

 D) liableA

 40.In order to show his boss what a careful worker he was, he took ________ trouble over the figures.

 A) extensive

 B) spare

 C) extra

 D) supremeC

 41.—“May I speak to your manager Mr. Williams at five o’clock tonight?”

 —“I’m sorry. Mr. Williams ________ to a conference long before then.”

 A) will have gone

 B) had gone

 C) would have gone

 D) has goneA

 42.You ________ him so closely; you should have kept your distance.

 A) shouldn’t follow

 B) mustn’t follow

 C) couldn’t’ have been following

 D) shouldn’t have been followingD

 43.The growth of part-time and flexible working patterns, and of training and retraining schemes, ________ more women to take advantage of employment opportunities.

 A) have allowed

 B) allow

 C) allowing

 D) allowsD

 44.Everybody ________ in the hall where they were welcomed by the secretary.

 A) assembled

 B) accumulated

 C) piled

 D) joinedA

 45.Putting in a new window will ________ cutting away part of the roof.

 A) include

 B) involve

 C) contain

 D) compriseB

 46.Living in the western part of the country has its problems, ________ obtaining fresh water is not the least.

 A) with which

 B) for which

 C) of which

 D) whichC

 47.In the ________ of the project not being a success, the investors stand to lose up to $30 million.

 A) face

 B) time

 C) event

 D) courseC

 48.The manager would rather his daughter ________ in the same office.

 A) had not worked

 B) not to work

 C) does not work

 D) did not workD

 49.________, he does get annoyed with her sometimes.

 A) Although much he likes her

 B) Much although he likes her

 C) As he likes her much

 D) Much as he likes herD

 50.The British constitution is ________ a large extent a product of the historical events described above.

 A) within

 B) to

 C) by

 D) atB

Part III Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Long after the 1998 World Cup was won, disappointed fans were still cursing the disputed refereeing (裁判) decisions that denied victory to their team. A researcher was appointed to study the performance of some top referees.

 The researcher organized an experimental tournament (锦标赛) involving four youth teams. Each match lasted an hour, divided into three periods of 20 minutes during which different referees were in charge.

 Observers noted down the referees’ errors, of which there were 61 over the tournament. Converted to a standard match of 90 minutes, each referee made almost 23 mistakes, a remarkably high number.

 The researcher then studied the videotapes to analyse the matches in detail. Surprisingly, he found that errors were more likely when the referees were close to the incident. When the officials got it right, they were, on average, 17 meters away from the action. The average distance in the case of errors was 12 meters. The research shows the optimum (最佳的) distance is about 20 meters.

 There also seemed to be an optimum speed. Correct decisions came when the referees were moving at a speed of about 2 meters per second. The average speed for errors was 4 meters per second.

 If FIFA, football’s international ruling body, wants to improve the standard of refereeing at the next World Cup, it should encourage referees to keep their eyes on the action from a distance, rather than rushing to keep up with the ball, the researcher argues.

 He also says that FIFA’s insistence that referees should retire at age 45 may be misguided. If keeping up with the action is not so important, their physical condition is less critical.

 51.The experiment conducted by the researcher was meant to ________.

 A) review the decisions of referees at the 1998 World Cup

 B) analyse the causes of errors made by football referees

 C) set a standard for football refereeing

 D) reexamine the rules for football refereeingB

 52.The number of refereeing errors in the experimental matches was ________.

 A) slightly above average

 B) higher than in the 1998 World Cup

 C) quite unexpected

 D) as high as in a standard matchC

 53.The findings of the experiment show that ________.

 A) errors are more likely when a referee keeps close to the ball

 B) the farther the referee is from the incident, the fewer the errors

 C) the more slowly the referee runs, the more likely will errors occur

 D) errors are less likely when a referee stays in one spotA

 54.The word “officials” (Line 2, Para. 4) most probably refers to ________.

 A) the researchers involved in the experiment

 B) the inspectors of the football tournament

 C) the referees of the football tournament

 D) the observers at the site of the experimentC

 55.What is one of the possible conclusions of the experiment?

 A) The ideal retirement age for an experienced football referee is 45.

 B) Age should not be the chief consideration in choosing a football referee.

 C) A football referee should be as young and energetic as possible.

 D) An experienced football referee can do well even when in poor physical condition.B

Passage Two

Questions 56 to 60 are based on the following passage.

 While still in its early stages, welfare reform has already been judged a great success in many states—at least in getting people off welfare. It’s estimated that more than 2 million people have left the rolls since 1994.

 In the past four years, welfare rolls in Athens Country have been cut in half. But 70 percent of the people who left in the past tow years took jobs that paid less than $6 an hour. The result: The Athens County poverty rate still remains at more than 30 percent—twice the national average.

 For advocates (代言人) for the poor, that’s an indication much more needs to be done.

 “More people are getting jobs, but it’s not making their lives any better,” says Kathy Lairn, a policy analyst at the Center on Budget and Policy Priorities in Washington.

 A center analysis of US Census data nationwide found that between 1995 and 1996, a greater percentage of single, female-headed households were earning money on their own, but that average income for these households actually went down.

 But for many, the fact that poor people are able to support themselves almost as well without government aid as they did with it is in itself a huge victory.

 “Welfare was a poison. It was a toxin (毒素) that was poisoning the family,” says Robert Rector, a welfare-reform policy analyst. “The reform in changing the moral climate in low-income communities. It’s beginning to rebuild the work ethic (道德观), which is much more important.”

 Mr. Rector and others argued that once “the habit of dependency is cracked,” then the country can make other policy changes aimed at improving living standards.

 56.From the passage, it can be seen that the author ________.

 A) believes the reform has reduced the government’s burden

 B) insists that welfare reform is doing little good for the poor

 C) is overenthusiastic about the success of welfare reform

 D) considers welfare reform to be fundamentally successfulD

 57.Why aren’t people enjoying better lives when they have jobs?

 A) Because many families are divorced.

 B) Because government aid is now rare.

 C) Because their wages are low.

 D) Because the cost of living is rising.C

 58.What is worth noting from the example of Athens County is that ________.

 A) greater efforts should be made to improve people’s living standards

 B) 70 percent of the people there have been employed for two years

 C) 50 percent of the population no longer relies on welfare

 D) the living standards of most people are going downA

 59.From the passage we know that welfare reform aims at ________.

 A) saving welfare funds

 B) rebuilding the work ethic

 C) providing more jobs

 D) cutting government expensesB

 60.According to the passage before the welfare reform was carried out, ________.

 A) the poverty rate was lover

 B) average living standards were higher

 C) the average worker was paid higher wages

 D) the poor used to rely on government aidD

Passage Three

Questions 61 to 65 are based on the following passage.

 Americans are pound of their variety and individuality, yet they love and respect few things more than a uniform, whether it is the uniform of an elevator operator or the uniform of a five-star general. Why are uniforms so popular in the United States?

 Among the arguments for uniforms, one of the first is that in the eyes of most people they look more professional than civilian (百姓的) clothes. People have become conditioned to expect superior quality from a man who wears a uniform. The television repairman who wears uniform tends to inspire more trust than one who appears in civilian clothes. Faith in the skill of a garage mechanic is increased by a uniform. What easier way is there for a nurse, a policeman, a barber, or a waiter to lose professional identity (身份) than to step out of uniform?

 Uniforms also have many practical benefits. They save on other clothes. They save on laundry bills. They are tax-deductible (可减税的). They are often more comfortable and more durable than civilian clothes.

 Primary among the arguments against uniforms is their lack of variety and the consequent loss of individuality experienced by people who must wear them. Though there are many types of uniforms, the wearer of any particular type is generally stuck with it, without change, until retirement. When people look alike, they tend to think, speak, and act similarly, on the job at least.

 Uniforms also give rise to some practical problems. Though they are long-lasting, often their initial expense is greater than the cost of civilian clothes. Some uniforms are also expensive to maintain, requiring professional dry cleaning rather than the home laundering possible with many types of civilian clothes.

 61.It is surprising that Americans who worship variety and individuality ________.

 A) still judge a man by his clothes

 B) hold the uniform in such high regard

 C) enjoy having a professional identity

 D) will respect an elevator operator as much as a general in uniformB

 62.People are accustomed to think that a man in uniform ________.

 A) suggests quality work

 B) discards his social identity

 C) appears to be more practical

 D) looks superior to a person in civilian clothesA

 63.The chief function of a uniform is to ________.

 A) provide practical benefits to the wearer

 B) make the wearer catch the pubic eye

 C) inspire the wearer’s confidence in himself

 D) provide the wearer with a professional identityD

 64.According to the passage, people wearing uniforms ________.

 A) are usually helpful

 B) have little or no individual freedom

 C) tend to lose their individuality

 D) enjoy greater popularityC

 65.The best title for this passage would be ________.

 A) Uniforms and Society

 B) The Importance of Wearing a Uniform

 C) Practical Benefits of Wearing a Uniform

 D) Advantages and Disadvantages of UniformsD

Passage Four

Questions 66 to 70 are based on the following passage.

 Since we are social beings, the quality of our lives depends in large measure on our interpersonal relationships. One strength of the human condition is our tendency to give and receive support from one another under stressful circumstances. Social support consists of the exchange of resources among people based on their interpersonal ties. Those of us with strong support systems appear better able to cope with major life changes and daily hassles (困难). People with strong social ties live longer and have better health than those without such ties. Studies over a range of illnesses, from depression to heart disease, reveal that the presence of social support helps people fend off (挡开) illness, and the absence of such support makes poor health more likely.

 Social support cushions stress in a number of ways. First, friends, relatives, and co-workers may let us know that they value us. Our self-respect is strengthened when we feel accepted by others despite our faults and difficulties. Second, other people often provide us with informational support. They help us to define and understand our problems and find solutions to them. Third, we typically find social companionship supportive. Engaging in leisure-time activities with others helps us to meet our social needs while at the same time distracting (转移…注意力) us from our worries and troubles. Finally, other people may give us instrumental support—financial aid, material resources, and needed services—that reduces stress by helping us resolve and cope with our problems.

 66.Interpersonal relationships are important because ________.

 A) they are indispensable to people’s social well-being

 B) they awaken people’s desire to exchange resources

 C) they help people to cope with life in the information era

 D) they can cure a range of illnesses such as heart disease, etcA

 67.Research shows that people’s physical and mental health ________.

 A) relies on the social welfare systems which support them

 B) has much to do with the amount of support they get from others

 C) depends on their ability to deal with daily worries and troubles

 D) is closely related to their strength for coping with major changes in their livesB

 68.Which of the following is closest in meaning to the word “cushions” (Line 1, Para. 2)?

 A) Adds up to.

 B) Does away with.

 C) Lessens the effect of.

 D) Lays the foundation for.C

 69.Helping a sick neighbor with some repair work is an example of ________.

 A) instrumental support

 B) informational support

 C) social companionship

 D) the strengthening of self-respectA

 70.Social companionship is beneficial in that ________.

 A) it helps strengthen our ties with relatives

 B) it enables us to eliminate our faults and mistakes

 C) it makes our leisure-time activities more enjoyable

 D) it draws our attention away from our worries and troublesD

Part IV Translation (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part, there are four items, each consisting of one or two sentences for you to translate into Chinese. These sentences are all taken from the Reading Passages you have just read in Part Three of Test Paper One. You should refer back to the passages so as to identify their meanings in the context.

 S1.(Lines 1-2, Para. 1, Passage 1)

 Long after the 1998 World Cup was won, disappointed fans were still cursing the disputed refereeing (裁判) decisions that denied victory to their team.

 S2.(Lines 1-2, Para. 6, Passage 2)

 But for many, the fact that poor people are able to support themselves almost as well without government aid as they did with it is in itself a huge victory.

 S3.(Lines 5-6, Para. 2, Passage 3)

 What easier way is there for a nurse, a policeman, a barber, or a waiter to lose professional identity (身份) than to step out of uniform?

 S4.(Lines 3-4, Para. 1, Passage 4)

 Social support consists of the exchange of resources among people based on their inter personal ties.

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Is a Test of Spoken English Necessary? The first sentence has already been written for you. You should write at least 100 words, and base your competition on the outline given in Chinese below:

 1.很多人认为有必要举行英语口语考试,理由是…

 2.也有人持不同意见,...

 3.我的看法和打算

Is a Test of Spoken English Necessary

 A test of spoken English will be included as an optional component of the College English Test (CET)

20006月四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.C

3.B

4.D

5.B

6.D

7.A

8.C

9.D

10.D

11.D

12.A

13.B

14.C

15.B

16.A

17.A

18.C

19.B

20.A


Part II


21.D

22.A

23.C

24.B

25.C

26.A

27.B

28.B

29.D

30.B

31.C

32.B

33.A

34.B

35.C

36.D

37.A

38.A

39.A

40.C

41.A

42.D

43.D

44.A

45.B

46.C

47.C

48.D

49.D

50.B


Part III


51.B

52.C

53.A

54.C

55.B

56.D

57.C

58.A

59.B

60.D

61.B

62.A

63.D

64.C

65.D

66.A

67.B

68.C

69.A

70.D



 S1.1998年世界杯足球赛早已尘埃落定,但失望的球迷们仍在责骂那些颇有争议的判罚,声称正是那些判罚使他们的球队没能获胜。

 S2.但是穷人在没有政府救济的情况下,生活照样过得很好,对很多人来说,这一事实本身就是一个巨大的胜利。

 S3.对于一名护士、理发师或是一名侍者而言,还有什么比脱掉制服更加便利的方法能让他们失去职业身份呢?

 S4.社会资助是由人与人之间的资源交换所构成的,而这种交换乃是建立在他们的人际关系的基础之上。

20011月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) 2 hours.

 B) 3 hours.

 C) 4 hours.

 D) 5 hours.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Get some change form Jane.

 B) Use the woman’s phone.

 C) Go look for a pay phone.

 D) Pay for the phone call.B

 2.A) At a bookstore.

 B) In a workshop.

 C) At an art gallery.

 D) In a department store.C

 3.A) She’s bought the man a pair of glasses today.

 B) She will help the man to catch up.

 C) She is worried about the man’s health.

 D) She has bought the man an up-to-date map.B

 4.A) He is going to give a talk on fishing.

 B) He thinks fishing is a good way to kill time.

 C) He has the same hobby as Susan’s father.

 D) He is eager to meet Susan’s parents.C

 5.A) He finds the presentation hard to follow.

 B) He considers the presentation very dull.

 C) He thinks Professor White has chosen an interesting topic.

 D) He speaks highly of the presentation.D

 6.A) High quality paper.

 B) A typewriter.

 C) A bookshelf.

 D) Some stocks.A

 7.A) They go to the seaside.

 B) They set off early.

 C) They go sightseeing.

 D) They wait for a fine day.B

 8.A) He was late for school on the first day.

 B) He had a funny face.

 C) He was the first person she met at school.

 D) He liked to show off in class.A

 9.A) Her car can stand any crash.

 B) Her car is not as good as his.

 C) Her car is maintained as well as his.

 D) Her car is kept in good condition.D

 10.A) She is too busy to go.

 B) She doesn’t want to wait long.

 C) She’s willing to go swimming.

 D) She enjoys the wonderful weather.C

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) He was once a friend of the ruler.

 B) He was a tax collector.

 C) He was a government official.

 D) He was once a school teacher in India.D

 12.A) To declare new ways of collecting tax.

 B) To entertain those who had made great contributions to the government.

 C) To collect money from the persons invited.

 D) To reward outstanding tax collectors.C

 13.A) They tried to collect more money than the ruler asked for.

 B) They were given some silver and gold coins by the ruler.

 C) They were excused from paying income tax.

 D) They enjoyed being invited to dinner at the ruler’s palace.A

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) They liked traveling.

 B) They wanted to find a better place to live in.

 C) They were driven out of their homes.

 D) The reasons are unknown.D

 15.A) They try to put up with Gypsies.

 B) They are envious of Gypsies.

 C) They are unfriendly to Gypsies.

 D) They admire the musical talent of the Gypsies.C

 16.A) Special schools have been set up for them.

 B) Permanent homes have been built for them.

 C) They are now taught in their own language.

 D) They are now allowed to attend local schools.A

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) The causes are obvious.

 B) The causes are very complicated.

 C) The causes are familiar.

 D) The causes are not well understood.B

 18.A) Regular driver training.

 B) Improved highway design.

 C) Stricter traffic regulations.

 D) Better public transportation.B

 19.A) Highway crime.

 B) Poor traffic control.

 C) Confusing road signs.

 D) Drivers’ errors.D

 20.A) Designing better cars.

 B) Building more highways.

 C) Increasing people’s awareness of traffic problems.

 D) Enhancing drivers’ sense of responsibility.A

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Dogs are social animals and without proper training, they will behave like wild animals. They will soil your house, destroy your belongings, bark excessively, fight other dogs and even bite you. Nearly all behavior problems are perfectly normal dog activities that occur at the wrong time or place or are directed at the wrong thing. The key to preventing or treating behavior problems is learning to teach the dog to redirect its normal behavior to outlets that are acceptable in the domestic setting.

 One of the best things you can do for your dog and yourself is to obedience train it. Obedience training doesn’t solve all behavior problems, but it is the foundation for solving just about any problem. Training pens up a line of communication between you and your dog. Effective communication is necessary to instruct your dog about what you want it to do.

 Training is also an easy way to establish the social rank order. When your dog obeys a simple request of “come here, sit,” it is showing obedience and respect for you. It is not necessary to establish yourself as top dog or leader of the pack () by using extreme measure. You can teach your dog its subordinate (从属的) role by teaching it to show submission to you. Most dogs love performing tricks for you to pleasantly accept that you are in charge.

 Training should be fun and rewarding for you and your dog. It can enrich your relationship and make living together more enjoyable. A well-trained dog is more confident and can more safely be allowed a greater amount of freedom than an untrained animal.

 21.Behavior problems of dogs are believe to ________.

 A) be just part of their nature

 B) worsen in modern society

 C) occur when they go wild

 D) present a threat to the communityA

 22.The primary purpose of obedience training is to ________.

 A) teach the dog to perform clever tricks

 B) make the dog aware of its owner’s authority

 C) provide the dog with outlets for its wild behavior

 D) enable the dog to regain its normal behaviorC

 23.Effective communication between a dog and its owner is ________.

 A) essential to solving the dog’s behavior problems

 B) the foundation for dogs to perform tasks

 C) a good way to teach the dog new tricks

 D) an extreme measure in obedience trainingB

 24.Why do pet dogs love performing tricks for their masters?

 A) To avoid being punished.

 B) To show their affection for their masters.

 C) To win leadership of the dog pack.

 D) To show their willingness to obey.D

 25.When a dog has received effective obedience training, its owner ________.

 A) can give the dog more rewards

 B) will enjoy a better family life

 C) can give the dog more freedom

 D) will have more confidence in himselfC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Engineering students are supposed to be examples of practicality and rationality, but when it comes to my college education I am an idealist and a fool. In high school I wanted to be an electrical engineer and, of course, any sensible student with my aims would have chosen a college with a large engineering department, famous reputation and lots of good labs and research equipment. But that’s not what I did.

 I chose to study engineering at a small liberal-arts (文科) university that doesn’t even offer a major in electrical engineering. Obviously, this was not a practical choice; I came here for more noble reasons. I wanted a broad education that would provide me with flexibility and a value system to guide me in my career. I wanted to open my eyes and expand my vision by interacting with people who weren’t studying science or engineering. My parents, teachers and other adults praised me for such a sensible choice. They told me I was wise and mature beyond my 18 years, and I believed them.

 I headed off to college sure I was going to have an advantage over those students who went to big engineering “factories” where they didn’t care if you have values or were flexible. I was going to be a complete engineer: technical genius and sensitive humanist (人文学者) all in one.

 Now I’m not so sure. Somewhere along the way my noble ideals crashed into reality, as all noble ideals eventually do. After three years of struggling to balance math, physics and engineering courses with liberal-arts courses, I have learned there are reasons why few engineering students try to reconcile (协调) engineering with liberal-arts courses in college.

 The reality that has blocked my path to become the typical successful student is that engineering and the liberal arts simply don’t’ mix as easily as I assumed in high school. Individually they shape a person in very different ways; together they threaten to confuse. The struggle to reconcile the two fields of study is difficult.

 26.The author chose to study engineering at a small liberal-arts university because he ________.

 A) wanted to be an example of practicality and rationality

 B) intended to be a combination of engineer and humanist

 C) wanted to coordinate engineering with liberal-arts courses in college

 D) intended to be a sensible student with noble idealsB

 27.According to the author, by interacting with people who study liberal arts, engineering students can ________.

 A) balance engineering and the liberal arts

 B) receive guidance in their careers

 C) become noble idealists

 D) broaden their horizonsD

 28.In the eyes of the author, a successful engineering student is expected ________.

 A) to have an excellent academic record

 B) to be wise and mature

 C) to be imaginative with a value system to guide him

 D) to be a technical genius with a wide visionD

 29.The author’s experience shows that he was ________.

 A) creative

 B) ambitious

 C) unrealistic

 D) irrationalC

 30.The word “they” in “... together they threaten to confuse.” (Line 3, Para. 5) refers to ________.

 A) engineering and the liberal arts

 B) reality and noble ideals

 C) flexibility and a value system

 D) practicality and rationalityA

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Priscilla Ouchida’s “energy-efficient” house turned out to be a horrible dream. When she and her engineer husband married a few years ago, they built a $100,000, three-bedroom home in California. Tightly sealed to prevent air leaks, the house was equipped with small double-paned (双层玻璃的) windows and several other energy-saving features. Problems began as soon as the couple moved in, however. Priscilla’s eyes burned. Her throat was constantly dry. She suffered from headaches and could hardly sleep. It was as though she had suddenly developed a strange illness.

 Experts finally traced the cause of her illness. The level of formaldehyde (甲醛) gas in her kitchen was twice the maximum allowed by federal standards for chemical workers. The source of the gas? Her new kitchen cabinets and wall-to-wall carpeting.

 The Ouchidas are victims of indoor air pollution, which is not given sufficient attention partly because of the nation’s drive to save energy. The problem itself isn’t new. “The indoor environment was dirty long before energy conservation came along,” says Moschandreas, a pollution scientist at Geomet Technologies in Maryland. “Energy conservation has tended to accentuate the situation in some cases.”

 The problem appears to be more troublesome in newly constructed homes rather than old ones. Back in the days when energy was cheap, home builders didn’t worry much about unsealed cracks. Because of such leaks, the air in an average home was replaced by fresh outdoor air about once an hour. As a result, the pollutants generated in most households seldom build up to dangerous levels.

 31.It can be learned from the passage that the Ouchidas house ________.

 A) is well worth the money spent on its construction

 B) is almost faultless from the point of energy conservation

 C) failed to meet energy conservation standards

 D) was designed and constructed in a scientific wayB

 32.What made the Ouchidas’ new house a horrible dream?

 A) Lack of fresh air.

 B) Poor quality of building materials.

 C) Gas leakage in the kitchen.

 D) The newly painted walls.A

 33.The word “accentuate” (Line 4, Para. 3) most probably means “________”.

 A) relieve

 B) accelerate

 C) worsen

 D) improveC

 34.Why were cracks in old houses not a big concern?

 A) Because indoor cleanliness was not emphasized.

 B) Because energy used to be inexpensive.

 C) Because environmental protection was given top priority.

 D) Because they were technically unavoidable.B

 35.This passage is most probably taken from an article entitled “________”.

 A) Energy Conservation

 B) Houses Building Crisis

 C) Air Pollution Indoors

 D) Traps in Building ConstructionC

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 In 1993. New York State ordered stores to charge a deposit on beverage (饮料) containers. Within a year. Consumers had returned millions of aluminum cans and glass and plastic bottles. Plenty of companies were eager to accept the aluminum and glass as raw materials for new products. But because few could figure out what to do with the plastic, much of it wound up buried in landfills (垃圾填埋场). The problem was not limited to New York. Unfortunately, there were too few uses for second-hand plastic.

 Today, one out of five plastic soda bottles is recycled (回收利用) in the United States. The reason for the change is that now there are dozens of companies across the country buying discarded plastic soda bottles and turning them into fence posts, paint brushes, etc.

 Shrinking landfill space, and rising costs for burying and burning rubbish are forcing local governments to look more closely at recycling. In many areas, the East Coast especially, recycling is already the least expensive waste-management option. For every ton of waste recycled, a city avoids paying for its disposal, which, in parts of New York, amounts to saving of more than $100 per ton. Recycling also stimulates the local economy by creating jobs and trims the pollution control and energy costs of industries that make recycled products by giving them a more refined raw material.

 36.What regulation was issued by New York State concerning beverage containers?

 A) Beverage companies should be responsible for collecting and reusing discarded plastic soda bottles.

 B) Throwaways should be collected by the state for recycling.

 C) A fee should be charged on used containers for recycling.

 D) Consumers had to pay for beverage containers and could get their money back on returning them.D

 37.The returned plastic bottles in New York used to ________.

 A) end up somewhere underground

 B) be turned into raw materials

 C) have a second-life value

 D) be separated from other rubbishA

 38.The key problem in dealing with returned plastic beverage containers is ________.

 A) to sell them at a profitable price

 B) how to turn them into useful things

 C) how to reduce their recycling costs

 D) to lower the prices for used materialsB

 39.Recycling ahs become the first choice for the disposal of rubbish because ________.

 A) local governments find it easy to manage

 B) recycling ahs great appeal for the jobless

 C) recycling causes little pollution

 D) other methods are more expensiveD

 40.It can be concluded from the passage that ________.

 A) rubbish is a potential remedy for the shortage of raw materials

 B) local governments in the U.S. can expect big profits from recycling

 C) recycling is to be recommended both economically and environmentally

 D) landfills will still be widely used for waste disposalC

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.It is important that the hotel receptionist ________ that guests are registered correctly.

 A) has made sure

 B) made sure

 C) must make sure

 D) make sureD

 42.I suggested he should ________ himself to his new conditions.

 A) adapt

 B) adopt

 C) regulate

 D) suitA

 43.I’ll never forget ________ you for the first time.

 A) to meet

 B) meeting

 C) to have met

 D) having to be meetingB

 44.Cancellation of the flight ________ many passengers to spend the night at the airport.

 A) resulted

 B) obliged

 C) demanded

 D) recommendedB

 45.That young man still denies ________ the fire behind the store.

 A) start

 B) to start

 C) having started

 D) to have startedC

 46.________ in a recent science competition, the three students were awarded scholarships totaling $21,000.

 A) Judged the best

 B) Judging the best

 C) To be judged the best

 D) Having judged the bestA

 47.Without proper lessons, you could ________ a lot of bad habits when playing the piano.

 A) keep up

 B) pick up

 C) draw up

 D) catch upB

 48.Everything we eat and drink contains some salt; we can meet the body’s need for it from natural sources without turning ________ the salt bottle.

 A) up

 B) to

 C) on

 D) overB

 49.He always did well at school ________ having to do part-time jobs every now and then.

 A) in spite of

 B) regardless of

 C) on account of

 D) to case ofA

 50.________ receiving financial support from family, community or the government is allowed, it is never admired.

 A) As

 B) Once

 C) Although

 D) LestC

 51.All the key words in the article are printed in ________ type so as to attract readers’ attention.

 A) dark

 B) dense

 C) black

 D) boldD

 52.The basic features of the communication process are identified in one question: Who says ________ through what channel to whom?

 A) how

 B) when

 C) what

 D) suchC

 53.I didn’t ________ to take a taxi but I had to as I was late.

 A) assume

 B) suppose

 C) mean

 D) hopeC

 54.The hours ________ the children spend in their one-way relationship with television people undoubtedly affect their relationships with real-life people.

 A) in which

 B) on which

 C) when

 D) thatD

 55.I’d rather have a room of my own, however small it is, than ________ a room with someone else.

 A) share

 B) to share

 C) sharing

 D) to have sharedA

 56.In Disneyland every year, some 800,000 plants are replaced because Disney refused to ________ signs asking his “guests” not to step on them.

 A) put down

 B) put out

 C) put up

 D) put offC

 57.________ difficulties we may come across, we’ll help one another to overcome them.

 A) Wherever

 B) Whatever

 C) However

 D) WheneverB

 58.So many directors ________, the board meeting had to be put off.

 A) were absent

 B) been absent

 C) had been absent

 D) being absentD

 59.On New Year’s Eve, New York City holds an outdoor ________ which attracts a crowd of a million or more people.

 A) incident

 B) event

 C) case

 D) affairB

 60.American football and baseball are becoming known to the British public through televised ________ from the United States.

 A) transfer

 B) deliveries

 C) transportation

 D) transmissionsD

 61.He will surely finished the job on time ________ he’s left to do it in his own way.

 A) in that

 B) so long as

 C) in case

 D) as far asB

 62.If this kind of fish becomes ________, future generations may never taste it at all.

 A) minimum

 B) short

 C) seldom

 D) scarceD

 63.The bank is reported in the local newspaper ________ in broad daylight yesterday.

 A) being robbed

 B) having been robbed

 C) to have been robbed

 D) robbedC

 64.Agriculture was a step in human progress ________ which subsequently there was not anything comparable until our own machine age.

 A) in

 B) for

 C) to

 D) fromC

 65.The same factors push wages and prices up together, the one ________ the other.

 A) emphasizing

 B) reinforcing

 C) multiplying

 D) increasingB

 66.No one had told Smith about ________ a lecture the following day.

 A) there being

 B) there be

 C) there would be

 D) there wasA

 67.Operations which left patients ________ and in need of long periods of recovery time now leave them feeling relaxed and comfortable.

 A) exhausted

 B) abandoned

 C) injured

 D) desertedA

 68.I was halfway back to the cottage where my mother lived ________ Susan caught up with me.

 A) when

 B) while

 C) until

 D) thoughA

 69.________ the temperature falling so rapidly, we couldn’t go on with the experiment.

 A) Since

 B) For

 C) As

 D) WithD

 70.The bed has been ________ in the family. It was my great-grandmother’s originally.

 A) handed out

 B) handed over

 C) handed down

 D) handed roundC

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 For the past two years, I have been working on students’ evaluation of classroom teaching. I have kept a record of informal conversations __71__ some 300 students from at __72__ twenty-one colleges and universities. The students were generally __73__ and direct in their comments __74__ how course work could be better __75__. Most of their remarks were kindly __76__—with tolerance rather than bitterness—and frequently were softened by the __77__ that the students were speaking __78__ some, not all, instructors. Nevertheless, __79__ the following suggestions and comments indicate, students feel __80__ with things-as-they-are in the classroom.

 Professors should be __81__ from reading lecture notes. “It makes their __82__ monotonous (单调的).”

 If they are going to read, why not __83__ out copies of the lecture? Then we __84__ need to go to class. Professors should __85__ repeating in lectures material that is in the text-book. “__86__ we’ve read the material, we want to __87__ it or hear it elaborated on, __88__ repeated.” “A lot of students hate to buy a __89__ text that the professor has written __90__ to have his lectures repeat it.”

 71.A) involving

 B) counting

 C) covering

 D) figuringA

 72.A) best

 B) least

 C) length

 D) largeB

 73.A) reserved

 B) hard-working

 C) polite

 D) frankD

 74.A) over

 B) at

 C) on

 D) ofC

 75.A) presented

 B) submitted

 C) described

 D) writtenA

 76.A) received

 B) addressed

 C) made

 D) takenC

 77.A) occasion

 B) truth

 C) case

 D) factD

 78.A) on

 B) about

 C) at

 D) withB

 79.A) though

 B) whether

 C) as

 D) ifB

 80.A) dissatisfied

 B) unsatisfactory

 C) satisfied

 D) satisfactoryA

 81.A) interfered

 B) interrupted

 C) discouraged

 D) disturbedC

 82.A) voices

 B) sounds

 C) pronunciation

 D) gesturesA

 83.A) hold

 B) leave

 C) drop

 D) giveD

 84.A) couldn’t

 B) wouldn’t

 C) mustn’t

 D) shouldn’tB

 85.A) refuse

 B) prohibit

 C) prevent

 D) avoidD

 86.A) Once

 B) Until

 C) However

 D) UnlessA

 87.A) remember

 B) argue

 C) discuss

 D) keepC

 88.A) yet

 B) not

 C) and

 D) orB

 89.A) desired

 B) revised

 C) required

 D) deservedC

 90.A) about

 B) how

 C) but

 D) onlyD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic How to Succeed in a Job Interview? You should write at least 100 words, and base your composition on the outline given in Chinese below:

 1.面试在求职过程中的作用

 2.取得面试成功的因素:仪表、举止谈吐、能力、专业知识、自信、实事求是…

How to Succeed in a Job Interview?

20011月四级参考答案

Part I


1.B

2.C

3.B

4.C

5.D

6.A

7.B

8.A

9.D

10.C

11.D

12.C

13.A

14.D

15.C

16.A

17.B

18.B

19.D

20.A


Part II


21.A

22.C

23.B

24.D

25.C

26.B

27.D

28.D

29.C

30.A

31.B

32.A

33.C

34.B

35.C

36.D

37.A

38.B

39.D

40.C


Part II


41.D

42.A

43.B

44.B

45.C

46.A

47.B

48.B

49.A

50.C

51.D

52.C

53.C

54.D

55.A

56.C

57.B

58.D

59.B

60.D

61.B

62.D

63.C

64.C

65.B

66.A

67.A

68.A

69.D

70.C


Part IV


71.A

72.B

73.D

74.C

75.A

76.C

77.D

78.B

79.B

80.A

81.C

82.A

83.D

84.B

85.D

86.A

87.C

88.B

89.C

90.D

81.C

82.A

83.D

84.B

85.D

86.A

87.C

88.B

89.C

90.D



20016月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) A math teacher and his colleague.

 B) A teacher and his student.

 C) A librarian and a student.

 D) A student and his classmate.D

 2.A) Tony thought the experiment was well done.

 B) Tony finished the experiment last night.

 C) Tony could not continue the experiment.

 D) Tony had expected the experiment to be easier.C

 3.A) She wants to save money to buy a piano.

 B) The present apartment is too expensive.

 C) She can’t put up with the noise.

 D) She had found a job in a neighbouring area.C

 4.A) He has made great progress in his English.

 B) He is not very interested in English songs.

 C) He is a student of the music department.

 D) He is not very enthusiastic about his English lessons.D

 5.A) In a car.

 B) On the street.

 C) In a restaurant.

 D) At home.B

 6.A) His injury kept him at home.

 B) He was too weak to see the doctor.

 C) He didn’t think it necessary.

 D) He failed to make an appointment.C

 7.A) 5:10.

 B) 5:00.

 C) 4:30.

 D) 5:15.C

 8.A) The man is talking with his boss.

 B) The man needs help.

 C) The man is complaining.

 D) The man likes his job.C

 9.A) Wear a new dress.

 B) Attend a party.

 C) Go shopping.

 D) Make a silk dress.B

 10.A) He exaggerated his part.

 B) He played his part quite well.

 C) He was not dramatic enough.

 D) He performed better than the secretary.A

Section B Compound Dictation

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from S1 to S7 with the exact words you have just heard. For blanks numbered from S8 to S10 you are required to fill in the missing information. You can either use the exact words you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

 If you are a young college student, most of your concerns about your health and happiness in life are probably (S1) ________ on the present. Basically, you want to feel good physically, mentally, and (S2) ________ now. You probably don’t spend much time worrying about the (S3) ________ future, such as whether you will develop heart disease, or (S4) ________, how you will take care of yourself in your (S5) ________ years, or how long you are going to live. Such thoughts may have (S6) ________ your mind once in a while. However, if you are in your thirties, forties, fifties, or older, such health-related thoughts are likely to become (S7) ________ important to you.

 (S8) ________ that will help you feel better physically and mentally. Recently researchers have found that, even in late adulthood, exercise, strength training with weights, and better food can help elderly individuals significantly improve their health and add happiness to their life. (S9) ________, giving us the opportunity to avoid some of the health problems that have troubled them (S10) ________

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 15 are based on the following passage.

 People living on parts of the south coast of England face a serious problem. In 1993, the owners of a large hotel and of several houses discovered, to their horror, that their gardens had disappeared overnight. The sea had eaten into the soft limestone cliffs on which they had been built. While experts were studying the problem, the hotel and several houses disappeared altogether, sliding down the cliff and into the sea.

Erosion (侵蚀) of the white cliffs along the south coast of England has always been a problem but it has become more serious in recent years. Dozens of homes have had to be abandoned as the sea has crept farther and farther inland. Experts have studied the areas most affected and have drawn up a map for local people, forecasting the year in which their homes will be swallowed up by the hungry sea.

 Angry owners have called on the Government to erect sea defenses to protect their homes. Government surveyors have pointed out that in most cases, this is impossible. New sea walls would cost hundreds of millions of pounds and would merely make the waves and currents go further along the coast, shifting the problem from one area to another. The danger is likely to continue, they say, until the waves reach an inland area of hard rock which will not be eaten as limestone is. Meanwhile, if you want to buy a cheap house with an uncertain future, apply to a house agent in one of the threatened areas on the south coast of England. You can get a house for a knockdown price but it may turn out to be a knockdown home.

 11.What is the cause of the problem that people living on parts of the south coast of England face?

 A) The disappearance of hotels, houses and gardens.

 B) The experts’ lack of knowledge.

 C) The rising of the sea level.

 D) The washing-away of limestone cliffs.D

 12.The erosion of the white cliffs in the south of England ________.

 A) will soon become a problem for people living in central England

 B) has now become a threat to the local residents

 C) is quickly changing the map of England

 D) can be stopped if proper measures are takenB

 13.The experts’ study on the problem of erosion can ________.

 A) lead to its eventual solution

 B) provide an effective way to slow it down

 C) help to prevent it from worsening

 D) warn people whose homes are in dangerD

 14.It is not feasible to build sea defenses to protect against erosion because ________.

 A) it is too costly and will endanger neighbouring areas

 B) the government is too slow in taking action

 C) they will be easily knocked down by waves and currents

 D) house agents along the coast do not support the ideaA

 15.According to the author, when buying a house along the south coast of England, people should ________.

 A) be aware of the potential danger involved

 B) guard against being cheated by the house agent

 C) take the quality of the house into consideration

 D) examine the house carefully before making a decisionA

Passage Two

Questions 16 to 20 are based on the following passage.

 Sport is not only physically challenging, but it can also be mentally challenging. Criticism from coaches, parents, and other teammates, as well as pressure to win can create an excessive amount of anxiety or stress for youngathletes (运动员). Stress can be physical, emotional, or psychological, and research has indicated that it can lead to burnout. Burnout has been described as dropping or quitting of an activity that was at one time enjoyable.

 The early years of development are critical years for learning abut oneself. The sport setting is one where valuable experiences can take place. Young athletes can, for example, learn how to cooperate with others, make friends, and gain other social skills that will be used throughout their lives. Coaches and parents should be aware, at all times, that their feedback to youngsters can greatly affect their children. Youngsters may take their parents’ and coaches’ criticisms to heart and find aflaw (缺陷) in themselves.

 Coaches and parents should also be cautious that youth sport participation does not become work for children. The outcome of the game should not be more important than the process of learning the sport and other life lessons. In today’s youth sport setting, young athletes may be worrying more about who will win instead of enjoying themselves and the sport. Following a game, many parents and coaches focus on the outcome and find fault with youngsters’ performances. Positive reinforcement should be provided regardless of the outcome. Research indicates that positive reinforcement motivates and has a greater effect on learning than criticism. Again, criticism can create high levels of stress, which can lead to burnout.

 16.An effective way to prevent the burnout of young athletes is ________.

 A) to make sports less competitive

 B) to make sports more challenging

 C) to reduce their mental stress

 D) to increase their sense of successC

 17.According to the passage sport is positive for young people in that ________.

 A) it can help them learn more about society

 B) it teaches them how to set realistic goals for themselves

 C) it enables them to find flaws in themselves

 D) it can provide them with valuable experiencesD

 18.Many coaches and parents are in the habit of criticizing young athletes ________.

 A) without realizing criticism may destroy their self confidence

 B) in order to make them remember life’s lessons

 C) believing that criticism is beneficial for their early development

 D) so as to put more pressure on themA

 19.According to the passage parents and coaches should ________.

 A) help children to win every game

 B) pay more attention to letting children enjoy sports

 C) enable children to understand the positive aspect of sports

 D) train children to cope with stressB

 10.The author’s purpose in writing the passage is ________.

 A) to persuade young children not to worry about criticism

 B) to stress the importance of positive reinforcement to children

 C) to discuss the skill of combining criticism with encouragement

 D) to teach young athletes how to avoid burnoutB

Passage Three

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Humanity uses a little less than half the water available worldwide. Yet occurrences of shortages anddroughts (干旱) are causing famine and distress in some areas, and industrial and agricultural by-products are polluting water supplies. Since the world’ population is expected to double in the next 50 years, many experts think we are on the edge of a widespread water crisis.

 But that doesn’t have to be the outcome. Water shortages do not have to trouble the world—if we start valuing water more than we have in the past. Just as we began to appreciate petroleum more after the 1970s oil crises, today we must start looking at water from a fresh economic perspective. We can no longer afford to consider water a virtually free resource of which we can use as much as we like in any way we want.

 Instead, for all uses except the domestic demand of the poor, governments should price water to reflect its actual value. This means charging a fee for the water itself as well as for the supply costs.

 Governments should also protect this resource by providing water in more economically and environmentally sound ways. For example, often the cheapest way to provideirrigation (灌溉) water in the dry tropics is through small-scale projects, such as gathering rainfall indepressions (凹地) and pumping it to nearby cropland.

 No matter what steps governments take to provide water more efficiently, they must change their institutional and legal approaches to water sue. Rather than spread control among hundreds or even thousands of local, regional, and national agencies that watch various aspects of water use, countries should set up central authorities to coordinate water policy.

 21.What is the real cause of the potential water crisis?

 A) The world population is increasing faster and faster.

 B) Half of the world’s water resources have been seriously polluted.

 C) Humanity has not placed sufficient value on water resources.

 D) Only half of the world’s water can be used.C

 22.As indicated in the passage, the water problem ________.

 A) has been exaggerated by some experts in the field

 B) is underestimated by government organizations at different levels

 C) poses a challenge to the technology of building reservoirs

 D) is already serious in certain parts of the worldD

 23.According to the author, the water price should ________.

 A) correspond to its real value

 B) be reduced to the minimum

 C) stimulate domestic demand

 D) take into account the occurrences of droughtsA

 24.The author says that in some hot and dry areas it is advisable to ________.

 A) build big lakes to store water

 B) construct big pumping stations

 C) channel water from nearby rivers to cropland

 D) build small and cheap irrigation systemsD

 25.In order to raise the efficiency of the water supply, measures should be taken to ________.

 A) centralize the management of water resources

 B) increase the sense of responsibility of agencies at all levels

 C) guarantee full protection of the environment

 D) encourage local and regional control of water resourcesA

Passage Four

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 We can see how the product life cycle works by looking at the introduction of instant coffee. When it was introduced, most people did not like it as well as “regular” coffee, and it took several years to gain general acceptance (introduction stage). At one point, though, instant coffee grew rapidly in popularity, and many brands were introduced (stage of rapid growth). After a while, people became attached to one brand and sales leveled off (stage of maturity). Sales went into a slightdecline (衰退) when freeze-dried coffees were introduced (stage of decline).

 The importance of the product life cycle to marketers is this: Different stages in the product life cycle call for different strategies. The goal is to extend product life so that sales and profits do not decline. One strategy is called market modification. It means that marketing managers look for new users and market sections. Did you know, for example, that the backpacks that so many students carry today were originally designed for the military?

 Market modification also means searching for increased usage among present customers or going for a different market, such as senior citizens. A marketer may re-position the product to appeal to new market sections.

 Another product extension strategy is called product modification. It involves changing product quality, features, or style to attract new users or more usage from present users. American auto manufacturers are using quality improvement as one way to recapture world markets. Note, also, how auto manufacturers once changed styles dramatically from year to year to keep demand from falling.

 26.According to the passage, when people grow fond of one particular brand of a product, its sales will ________.

 A) decrease gradually

 B) remain at the same level

 C) become unstable

 D) improve enormouslyB

 27.The first paragraph tells us that a new product is ________.

 A) not easily accepted by the public

 B) often inferior to old ones at first

 C) often more expensive than old ones

 D) usually introduced to satisfy different tastesA

 28.Marketers need to know which of the four stages a product is in so as to ________.

 A) promote its production

 B) work out marketing policies

 C) speed up its life cycle

 D) increase its popularityB

 29.The author mentions the example of “backpacks” (Line 4, Para. 2) to show the importance of ________.

 A) pleasing the young as well as the old

 B) increasing usage among students

 C) exploring new market sections

 D) serving both military and civil needsC

 30.In order to recover their share of the world market, U.S. auto makers are ________.

 A) improving product quality

 B) increasing product features

 C) modernizing product style

 D) re-positioning their product in the marketA

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 31.By the time he arrives in Beijing, we ________ here for tow days.

 A) have been staying

 B) have stayed

 C) shall stay

 D) will have stayedD

 32.According to the American federal government, residents of Hawaii have the longest life ________: 77.2 years.

 A) scope

 B) rank

 C) span

 D) scaleC

 33.The millions of calculations involved, had they been done by hand, ________ all practical value by the time they were finished.

 A) had lost

 B) would lose

 C) would have lost

 D) should have lostC

 34.As a public relations officer, he is said ________ some very influential people.

 A) to have been knowing

 B) to be knowing

 C) to have known

 D) to knowC

 35.Our hopes ________ and fell in the same instant.

 A) aroused

 B) arose

 C) raised

 D) roseD

 36.With the development in science and technology man can make various flowers ________ before their time.

 A) be bloomed

 B) blooming

 C) bloom

 D) bloomedC

 37.A season ticket ________ the holder to make as many journeys as he wishes within the stated period of time.

 A) grants

 B) promises

 C) entitles

 D) presentsC

 38.________ in the office had made a mistake, and the firm regretted causing the customer inconvenience.

 A) Some

 B) Anyone

 C) One

 D) SomeoneD

 39.In recent years much more emphasis has been put ________ developing the students’ productive skills.

 A) over

 B) onto

 C) in

 D) onD

 40.Only a selected number of landladies in the neighbourhood have been allowed by the university to take in ________.

 A) residents

 B) inhabitants

 C) lodgers

 D) settlersC

 41.The fire was finally brought under control, but not ________ extensive damage had been caused.

 A) after

 B) before

 C) since

 D) asB

 42.Purchasing the new production line will be a ________ deal for the company.

 A) profitable

 B) tremendous

 C) forceful

 D) favoriteA

 43.Rod is determined to get a seat for the concert ________ it means standing in a queue all night.

 A) provided

 B) whatever

 C) even if

 D) as ifC

 44.We hadn’t met for 20 years, but I recognized her ________ I saw her.

 A) for the moment

 B) the moment when

 C) at the moment when

 D) the momentD

 45.Though he was born and brought up in America, he can speak ________ Chinese.

 A) smooth

 B) fluent

 C) fluid

 D) flowingB

 46.Government reports, examination compositions, legal documents and most business letters are the main situations ________ formal language is used.

 A) in which

 B) on which

 C) in that

 D) at whatA

 47.Fifty years ago, wealthy people liked hunting wild animals for fun ________ sightseeing.

 A) than to go

 B) rather than to go

 C) more than going

 D) other than goingC

 48.If the building project ________ by the end of this month is delayed, the construction company will be fined.

 A) to be completed

 B) is completed

 C) being completed

 D) completedA

 49.He wrote an article criticizing the Greek poet and won ________ and a scholarship.

 A) status

 B) fame

 C) faith

 D) courageB

 50.Jack wishes that he ________ business instead of history when he was in university.

 A) had studied

 B) study

 C) studied

 D) had been studyingA

 51.The older New England villages have changed relatively little ________ a gas station or two in recent decades.

 A) except

 B) besides

 C) in addition to

 D) except forD

 52.The Car Club couldn’t ________ to meet the demands of all its members.

 A) ensure

 B) guarantee

 C) assume

 D) confirmB

 53.Extensive reporting on television has helped to ________ interest in a wide variety of sports and activities.

 A) gather

 B) generate

 C) assemble

 D) yieldB

 54.The president promised to keep all the board members ________ of how the negotiations were going on.

 A) informed

 B) inform

 C) be informed

 D) informingA

 55.Eating too much fat can ________ heart disease and cause high blood pressure.

 A) contribute to

 B) attribute to

 C) attend to

 D) devote toA

 56.All the tasks ________ ahead of time, they decided to go on holiday for a week.

 A) had been fulfilled

 B) were fulfilled

 C) having been fulfilled

 D) been fulfilledC

 57.This article ________ more attention to the problem of cultural interference in foreign language teaching and learning.

 A) calls for

 B) applies for

 C) cares for

 D) allows forA

 58.He was punished ________ he should make the same mistake again.

 A) unless

 B) lest

 C) if

 D) providedB

 59.Petrol is refined from the ________ oil we take out of the ground.

 A) fresh

 B) original

 C) rude

 D) crudeD

 60.________ in the United States, St. Louis has now become the 24th largest city.

 A) The fourth biggest city it was

 B) Once the fourth biggest city

 C) Being the fourth biggest city

 D) It was once the fourth biggest cityB

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 More than forty thousand readers told us that they looked for in close friendships, what they expected __61__ friends, what they were willing to give in __62__, and how satisfied they were __63__ the quality of their friendships. The __64__ give little comfort to social critics.

 Friendship __65__ to be a unique form of __66__ bonding. Unlike marriage or the ties that __67__ parents and children, it is not defined or regulated by __68__. Unlike other social roles that we are expected to __69__—as citizens, employees, members of professional societies and __70__ organizations—it has its own principle, which is to promote __71__ of warmth, trust, love, and affection __72__ two people.

 The survey on friendship appeared in the March __73__ of Psychology Today. The findings __74__ that issues of trust and betrayal (背叛) are __75__ to friendship. They also suggest that our readers do not __76__ for friends only among those who are __77__ like them, but find many __78__ differ in race, religion, and ethnic (种族的) background. Arguably the most important __79__ that emerges from the data, __80__, is not something that we found—but what we did not.

 61.A) on

 B) of

 C) to

 D) forB

 62.A) addition

 B) reply

 C) turn

 D) returnD

 63.A) about

 B) of

 C) with

 D) byC

 64.A) results

 B) effects

 C) expectations

 D) consequencesA

 65.A) feels

 B) leads

 C) sounds

 D) appearsD

 66.A) human

 B) mankind

 C) individual

 D) civilA

 67.A) bind

 B) attach

 C) control

 D) attractA

 78.A) discipline

 B) law

 C) rule

 D) regulationB

 79.A) keep

 B) do

 C) show

 D) playD

 70.A) all

 B) any

 C) other

 D) thoseC

 71.A) friendship

 B) interests

 C) feelings

 D) impressionsC

 72.A) between

 B) on

 C) in

 D) forA

 73.A) print

 B) issue

 C) publication

 D) copyB

 74.A) secure

 B) assure

 C) confirm

 D) resolveC

 75.A) neutral

 B) main

 C) nuclear

 D) centralD

 76.A) ask

 B) call

 C) appeal

 D) lookD

 77.A) most

 B) more

 C) least

 D) lessA

 78.A) people

 B) who

 C) what

 D) friendsB

 79.A) conclusion

 B) summary

 C) decision

 D) claimA

 80.A) moreover

 B) however

 C) still

 D) yetB

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a letter. Suppose you are Zhang Ying. Write a letter to Xiao Wang, a schoolmate of yours who is going to visit you during the week-long holiday. You should write at least 100 words according to the suggestions given below in Chinese.

 1.表示欢迎

 2.提出对度假安排的建议

 3.提醒应注意的事项

A letter to a Schoolmate

 June 23, 2001

 Dear Xiao Wang,

 ________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________

 Yours, Zhang Ying

20016月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.C

3.C

4.D

5.B

6.C

7.C

8.C

9.B

10.A


Part II


11.D

12.B

13.D

14.A

15.A

16.C

17.D

18.A

19.B

20.B

21.C

22.D

23.A

24.D

25.A

26.B

27.A

28.B

29.C

30.A


Part III


31.D

32.C

33.C

34.C

35.D

36.C

37.C

38.D

39.D

40.C

41.B

42.A

43.C

44.D

45.B

46.A

47.C

48.A

49.B

50.A

51.D

52.B

53.B

54.A

55.A

56.C

57.A

58.B

59.D

60.B


Part IV


61.B

62.D

63.C

64.A

65.D

66.A

67.A

68.B

69.D

70.C

71.C

72.A

73.B

74.C

75.D

76.D

77.A

78.B

79.A

80.B



20021月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, D) “5 hours” is the correct answer. You should choose [D] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) She has to post a letter instead.

 B) She has to turn down the man’s request.

 C) She’s not sure if the computer is fixed.

 D) She can’t send the message right now.D

 2.A) He didn’t get the book he needed.

 B) He had no idea where the book was.

 C) The library is closed on weekends.

 D) He was not allowed to check out the book.A

 3.A) Play a tape recorder.

 B) Take a picture.

 C) Repair a typewriter.

 D) Start a car.A

 4.A) The woman rejected the man’s apology.

 B) The woman appreciated the man’s offer.

 C) The man had forgotten the whole thing.

 D) The man had hurt the woman’s feelings.D

 5.A) The woman is meeting the man at the airport.

 B) They are complaining about the poor airport service.

 C) They are discussing their plan for Christmas.

 D) The man is seeing the woman off.D

 6.A) She plans to go to graduate school.

 B) She will drop out of school.

 C) She will stop working and concentrate on her studies.

 D) She will take a part-time job.C

 7.A) He needs another job as research assistant.

 B) He asked Professor Williams for assistance.

 C) He assists Professor Williams with his teaching.

 D) He is doing research with Professor Williams.C

 8.A) She thought there were no tickets left for the show.

 B) She thought the seats on the left side were fully occupied.

 C) The show was planned a long time ago.

 D) The audience were deeply impressed by the show.A

 9.A) Mr. Long’s briefing was unnecessarily long.

 B) The woman should have been more attentive.

 C) Mr. Long’s briefing was not relevant to the mission.

 D) The woman needn’t have attended the briefing.B

 10.A) In a bank.

 B) In a school.

 C) In a clothing store.

 D) In a barbershop.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) Because the bird couldn’t repeat his master’s name.

 B) Because the bird screamed all day long.

 C) Because the bird uttered the wrong word.

 D) Because the bird failed to say the name of the town.D

 12.A) The cruel master.

 B) The man in the kitchen.

 C) The pet bird.

 D) The fourth chicken.C

 13.A) The bird bad finally understood his threat.

 B) The bird managed to escape from the chicken house.

 C) The bird had learned to scream back at him.

 D) The bird was living peacefully with the chickens.A

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) They are kept in open prisons.

 B) They are allowed out of the prison grounds.

 C) They are ordered to do cooking and cleaning.

 D) They are a small portion of the prison population.D

 15.A) Some of their prisoners are allowed to study or work outside prisons.

 B) Most of their prisoners are expected to work.

 C) Their prisoners are often sent to special centers for skill training.

 D) Their prisoners are allowed freedom to visit their families.A

 16.A) They are encouraged to do maintenance for the training centre.

 B) Most of them get paid for their work.

 C) They have to cook their own meals.

 D) They can choose to do community work.B

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) Because they have a driving license.

 B) Because they have received special training.

 C) Because the traffic conditions in London are good.

 D) Because the traffic system of the city is not very complex.B

 18.A) Two to four months.

 B) About three weeks.

 C) At least half a year.

 D) Two years or more.D

 19.A) Government officers are hard to please.

 B) The learner has to go through several tough tests.

 C) The learner usually fails several times before he passes it.

 D) The driving test usually last tow months.B

 20.A) They don’t want their present bosses to know what they’re doing.

 B) They want to earn money from both jobs.

 C) They cannot earn money as taxi drivers yet.

 D) They look forward to further promotion.C

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage one

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Some pessimistic experts feel that the automobile is bound to fall into disuse. They see a day in the not-too-distant future when all autos will be abandoned and allowed to rust. Other authorities, however, think the auto is here to stay. They hold that the car will remain a leading means of urban travel in the foreseeable future.

 The motorcar will undoubtedly change significantly over the next 30 years. It should become smaller, safer, and more economical, and should not be powered by the gasoline engine. The car of the future should be far more pollution-free than present types.

 Regardless of its power source, the auto in the future will still be the main problem in urban traffic congestion (拥挤). One proposed solution to this problem is the automated highway system.

 When the auto enters the highway system, a retractable (可伸缩的) arm will drop from the auto and make contact with a rail, which is similar to those powering subway trains electrically. Once attached to the rail, the car will become electrically powered from the system, and control of the vehicle will pass to a central computer. The computer will then monitor all of the car’s movements.

 The driver will use a telephone to dial instructions about his destination into the system. The computer will calculate the best route, and reserve space for the car all the way to the correct exit from the highway. The driver will then be free to relax and wait for the buzzer (蜂鸣器) that will warn him of his coming exit. It is estimated that an automated highway will be able to handle 10,000 vehicles per hour, compared with the 1,500 to 2,000 vehicles that can be carried by a present-day highway.

 21.One significant improvement in the future car will probably be ________.

 A) its power source

 B) its driving system

 C) its monitoring system

 D) its seating capacityA

 22.What is the author’s main concern?

 A) How to render automobiles pollution-free.

 B) How to make smaller and safer automobiles.

 C) How to solve the problem of traffic jams.

 D) How to develop an automated subway system.C

 23.What provides autos with electric power in an automated highway system?

 A) A rail.

 B) An engine.

 C) A retractable arm.

 D) A computer controller.A

 24.In an automated highway system, all the driver needs to do is ________.

 A) keep in the right lane

 B) wait to arrive at his destination

 C) keep in constant touch with the computer center

 D) inform the system of his destination by phoneD

 25.What is the author’s attitude toward the future of autos?

 A) Enthusiastic.

 B) Pessimistic.

 C) Optimistic.

 D) Cautious.C

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Foxes and farmers have never got on well. These small dog-like animals have long been accused of killing farm animals. They are officially classified as harmful and farmers try to keep their numbers down by shooting or poisoning them.

 Farmers can also call on the services of their local hunt to control the fox population. Hunting consists of pursuing a fox across the countryside, with a group of specially trained dogs, followed by men and women riding horses. When the dogs eventually catch the fox they kill it or a hunter shoots it.

 People who take part in hunting think of as a sport; they wear a special uniform of red coats and white trousers, and follow strict codes of behavior. But owning a horse and hunting regularly is expensive, so most hunters are wealthy.

 It is estimated that up to 100,000 people watch or take part in fox hunting. But over the last couple of decades the number of people opposed to fox hunting, because they think it is brutal (残酷的), has risen sharply. Nowadays it is rare for a hunt to pass off without some kind of confrontation (冲突) between hunters and hunt saboteurs (阻拦者). Sometimes these incidents lead to violence, but mostly saboteurs interfere with the hunt by misleading riders and disturbing the trail of the fox’s smell, which the dogs follow.

 Noisy confrontations between hunters and saboteurs have become so common that they are almost as much a part of hunting as the pursuit of foxes itself. But this year supporters of fox hunting face a much bigger threat to their sport. A Labour Party Member of the Parliament, Mike Foster, is trying to get Parliament to approve a new law which will make the hunting of wild animals with dogs illegal. If the law is passed, wild animals like foxes will be protected under the ban in Britain.

 26.Rich people in Britain have been hunting foxes ________.

 A) for recreation

 B) in the interests of the farmers

 C) to limit the fox population

 D) to show off their wealthA

 27.What is special about fox hunting in Britain?

 A) It involves the use of a deadly poison.

 B) It is a costly event which rarely occurs.

 C) The hunters have set rules to follow.

 D) The hunters have to go through strict training.C

 28.Fox hunting opponents often interfere in the game ________.

 A) by resorting to violence

 B) by confusing the fox hunters

 C) by taking legal action

 D) by demonstrating on the sceneB

 29.A new law may be passed by the British Parliament to ________.

 A) prohibit farmers from hunting foxes

 B) forbid hunting foxes with dogs

 C) stop hunting wild animals in the countryside

 D) prevent large-scale fox huntingB

 30.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) killing foxes with poison is illegal

 B) limiting the fox population is unnecessary

 C) hunting foxes with dogs is considered cruel and violent

 D) fox-hunting often leads to confrontation between the poor and the richC

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 For an increasing number of students at American universities, Old is suddenly in. The reason is obvious: the graying of America means jobs, coupled with the aging of the baby-boom (生育高峰) generation, a longer life span means that the nation’s elderly population is bound to expand significantly over the next 50 years. By 2050, 25 percent of all Americans will be older than 65, up from 14 percent in 1995. The change poses profound questions for government and society, of course. But it also creates career opportunities in medicine and health professions, and in law and business as well. “In addition to the doctors, we’re going to need more sociologists, biologists, urban planners and specialized lawyers,” says Professor Edward Schneider of the University of Southern California’s (USC) School of Gerontology (老年学).

 Lawyers can specialize in “elder law,” which covers everything from trusts and estates to nursing-home abuse and age discrimination (歧视). Businessmen see huge opportunities in the elder market because the baby boomers, 74 million strong, are likely to be the wealthiest group of retirees in human history. “Any student who combines an expert knowledge in gerontology with, say, an MBA or law degree will have a license to print money,” one professor says.

 Margarite Santos is a 21-year-old senior at USC. She began college as a biology major but found she was “really bored with bacteria.” So she took a class in gerontology and discovered that she lied it. She says, “I did volunteer work in retirement homes and it was very satisfying.”

 31.“... Old is suddenly in” (Line 1, Para. 1) most probably means “________”.

 A) America has suddenly become a nation of old people

 B) gerontology has suddenly become popular

 C) more elderly professors are found on American campuses

 D) American colleges have realized the need of enrolling older studentsB

 32.With the aging of America, lawyers can benefit ________.

 A) from the adoption of the “elder law”

 B) from rendering special services to the elderly

 C) by enriching their professional knowledge

 D) by winning the trust of the elderly to promote their own interestsB

 33.Why can businessmen make money in the emerging elder market?

 A) Retirees are more generous in spending money.

 B) They can employ more gerontologists.

 C) The elderly possess an enormous purchasing power.

 D) There are more elderly people working than before.C

 34.Who can make big money in the new century according to the passage?

 A) Retirees who are business-minded.

 B) The volunteer workers in retirement homes.

 C) College graduates with an MBA or law degree.

 D) Professionals with a good knowledge of gerontology.D

 35.It can be seen from the passage that the expansion of America’s elderly population ________.

 A) will provide good job opportunities in many areas

 B) will impose an unbearable burden on society

 C) may lead to nursing home abuse and age discrimination

 D) will create new fields of study in universitiesA

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 The decline in moral standards—which has long concerned social analysts—has at last captured the attention of average Americans. And Jean Bethke Elshtain, for one, is glad.

 The fact the ordinary citizens are now starting to think seriously about the nation’s moral climate, says this ethics (伦理学) professor at the University of Chicago, is reason to hope that new ideas will come forward to improve it.

 But the challenge is not to be underestimated. Materialism and individualism in American society are the biggest obstacles. “The thought that ‘I’m in it for me’ has become deeply rooted in the national consciousness,” Ms. Elshtain says.

 Some of this can be attributed to the disintegration of traditional communities, in which neighbors looked out for one another, she says. With today’s greater mobility and with so many couples working, those bonds have been weakened, replaced by a greater emphasis on self.

 In a 1996 poll of Americans, loss of morality topped the list of the biggest problems facing the U.S. and Elshtain says the public is correct to sense that: Data show that Americans are struggling with problems unheard of in the 1950s, such as classroom violence and a high rate of births to unmarried mothers.

 The desire for a higher moral standard is not a lament (挽歌) for some nonexistent “golden age,” Elshtain says, nor is it a wishful (一厢情愿的) longing for a time that denied opportunities to women and minorities. Most people, in fact, favor the lessening of prejudice.

 Moral decline will not be reversed until people find ways to counter the materialism in society, she says. “Slowly, you recognize that the things that matter are those that cant’ be bought.”

 36.Professor Elshtain is pleased to see that Americans ________.

 A) have adapted to a new set of moral standards

 B) are longing for the return of the good old days

 C) have realized the importance of material things

 D) are awakening to the lowering of their moral standardsD

 37.The moral decline of American society is caused manly by ________.

 A) its growing wealth

 B) the self-centeredness of individuals

 C) underestimating the impact of social changes

 D) the prejudice against women and minoritiesB

 38.Which of the following characterizes the traditional communities?

 A) Great mobility.

 B) Concern for one’s neighbors.

 C) Emphasis on individual effort.

 D) Ever-weakening social bonds.B

 39.In the 1950s, classroom violence ________.

 A) was something unheard of

 B) was by no means a rare occurrence

 C) attracted a lot of pubic attention

 D) began to appear in analysts’ dataA

 40.According to Elshtain, the current moral decline may be reversed ________.

 A) if people can return to the “golden age”

 B) when women and mean enjoy equal rights

 C) when people rid themselves of prejudice

 D) if less emphasis is laid on material thingsD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.By the time you get to New York, I ________ for London.

 A) would be leaving

 B) am leaving

 C) have already left

 D) shall have leftD

 42.The article suggests that when a person ________ under unusual stress he should be especially careful to have a well-balanced diet.

 A) is

 B) were

 C) be

 D) wasA

 43.The lawyer advised him to drop the ________, since he stands little chance to win.

 A) event

 B) incident

 C) case

 D) affairC

 44.Sometimes children have trouble ________ fact from fiction and may believe that such things actually exist.

 A) to separate

 B) separating

 C) for separating

 D) of separatingB

 45.He is quite sure that it’s ________ impossible for him to fulfill the task within two days.

 A) absolutely

 B) exclusively

 C) fully

 D) roughlyA

 46.There was a big hole in the road which ________ the traffic.

 A) set back

 B) stood back

 C) held up

 D) kept downC

 47.Many a delegate was in favor of his proposal that a special committee ________ to investigate the incident.

 A) were set up

 B) was set up

 C) be set up

 D) set upC

 48.In the Chinese household, grandparents and other relatives play ________ roles in raising children.

 A) incapable

 B) indispensable

 C) insensible

 D) infiniteB

 49.Eye contact is important because wrong contact may create a communication ________.

 A) tragedy

 B) vacuum

 C) question

 D) barrierD

 50.There was such a long line at the exhibition ________ we had to wait for about half an hour.

 A) as

 B) that

 C) so

 D) henceB

 51.There is no ________ to there house from the main road.

 A) access

 B) avenue

 C) exposure

 D) edgeA

 52.________ energy under the earth must be released in one form or another, for example, an earthquake.

 A) Accumulated

 B) Gathered

 C) Assembled

 D) CollectedA

 53.He wasn’t appointed chairman of the committee, ________ not very popular with all its members.

 A) to be considered

 B) considering

 C) being considered

 D) having consideredC

 54.The twentieth century has witnessed an enormous worldwide political, economic and cultural ________.

 A) tradition

 B) transportation

 C) transmission

 D) transformationD

 55.The ________ stuck on the envelope says “By Air”.

 A) diagram

 B) label

 C) signal

 D) markB

 56.Mobile telecommunications ________ is expected to double in Shanghai this year as a result of a contract signed between the two companies.

 A) capacity

 B) potential

 C) possession

 D) impactA

 57.Reading ________ the lines, I would say that the Government are more worried than they will admit.

 A) behind

 B) between

 C) along

 D) amongB

 58.My brother’s plans are very ________; he wants to master English, French and Spanish before he is sixteen.

 A) arbitrary

 B) aggressive

 C) ambitious

 D) abundantC

 59.Things might have been much worse if the mother ________ on her right to keep the baby.

 A) has been insisting

 B) had insisted

 C) would insist

 D) insistedB

 60.The statistical figures in that report are not ________. You should not refer to them.

 A) accurate

 B) fixed

 C) delicate

 D) rigidA

 61.Contrast may make something appear more beautiful than it is when ________ alone.

 A) seen

 B) is seen

 C) to be seen

 D) having been seenA

 62.The football game comes to you ________ from New York.

 A) lively

 B) alive

 C) live

 D) livingC

 63.None of us expected the chairman to ________ at the party. We thought he was still in hospital.

 A) turn in

 B) turn over

 C) turn up

 D) turn downC

 64.The mother didn’t know who ________ for the broken glass.

 A) blamed

 B) be blamed

 C) to blame

 D) would blameC

 65.He ________ to his customers and halved the price.

 A) leaked

 B) drew

 C) quoted

 D) yieldedD

 66.Tryon was extremely angry, but cool-headed enough to ________ storming into the boss’s office.

 A) prevent

 B) prohibit

 C) turn

 D) avoidD

 67.All flights ________ because of the terrible weather, they had to go there by train.

 A) having been canceled

 B) had been canceled

 C) having canceled

 D) were canceledA

 68.The author of the report is well ________ with the problems in the hospital because he has been working there for many years.

 A) informed

 B) acquainted

 C) enlightened

 D) acknowledgedB

 69.The boy spent as much time watching TV as he ________ studying.

 A) does

 B) had

 C) was

 D) didD

 70.The ships’ generator broke down, and the pumps had to be operated ________ instead of mechanically.

 A) manually

 B) artificially

 C) automatically

 D) syntheticallyA

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 One summer night, on my way home from work I decided to see a movie. I knew the theatre would be air-conditioned and I couldn’t face my __71__ apartment.

 Sitting in the theatre I had to look through the __72__ between the two tall heads in front of me. I had to keep changing the __73__ every time she learned over to talk to him, __74__ he leaned over to kiss her. Why do Americans display such __75__ in a public place?

 I thought the movie would be good for my English, but __76__ it turned out, it was an Italian move. __77__ about an hour I decided to give up on the movie and __78__ on my popcorn (爆玉米花). I’ve never understood why they give you so much popcorn! It tasted pretty good, __79__. After a while I heard __80__ more of the romantic-sounding Italians. I just heard the __81__ of the popcorn crunching (咀嚼) between my teeth. My thought stated to __82__. I remembered when I was is South Korea (韩国), I __83__ to watch Kojak on TV frequently. He spoke perfect Korean—I was really amazed. He seemed like a good friend to me, __84__ I saw him again in New York speaking __85__ English instead of perfect Korean. He didn’t even have a Korean accent and I __86__ like I had been betrayed.

 When our family moved to the United States six years ago, none of us spoke any English. __87__ we had begun to learn a few words, my mother suggested that we all should speak English at home. Everyone agreed, but our house became very __88__ and we all seemed to avoid each other. We sat at the dinner table in silence, preferring that to __89__ in a difficult language. Mother tried to say something in English but it __90__ out all wrong and we all burst into laughter and decided to forget it! We’ve been speaking Korean at home ever since.

 71.A) warm

 B) hot

 C) heated

 D) coolB

 72.A) crack

 B) blank

 C) break

 D) openingD

 73.A) aspect

 B) view

 C) space

 D) angleD

 74.A) while

 B) whenever

 C) or

 D) andC

 75.A) attraction

 B) attention

 C) affection

 D) motionC

 76.A) since

 B) when

 C) what

 D) asD

 77.A) Within

 B) After

 C) For

 D) OverB

 78.A) concentrate

 B) chew

 C) fix

 D) tasteA

 79.A) too

 B) still

 C) though

 D) certainlyC

 80.A) much

 B) any

 C) no

 D) fewC

 81.A) voice

 B) sound

 C) rhythm

 D) toneB

 82.A) wonder

 B) wander

 C) imagine

 D) departB

 83.A) enjoyed

 B) happened

 C) turned

 D) usedD

 84.A) until

 B) because

 C) then

 D) thereforeA

 85.A) artificial

 B) informal

 C) perfect

 D) practicalC

 86.A) felt

 B) looked

 C) seemed

 D) appearedA

 87.A) While

 B) If

 C) Before

 D) OnceD

 88.A) empty

 B) quiet

 C) stiff

 D) calmB

 89.A) telling

 B) uttering

 C) saying

 D) speakingD

 90.A) worked

 B) got

 C) came

 D) madeC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic: A Letter to the University President about the Canteen Service on Campus. You should write at least 100 words, and base your composition on the outline given in Chinese below:

假设你是李明,请你就本校食堂的状况给校长写一封信,内容应涉及食堂的饭菜质量、价格、环境、服务等,可以是表扬,可以是批评建议,也可以兼有而有之。

 January 12th, 2002

 Dear Mr. President,

 ________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________

20021月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.A

3.A

4.D

5.D

6.C

7.C

8.A

9.B

10.A

11.D

12.C

13.A

14.D

15.A

16.B

17.B

18.D

19.B

20.C


Part II


21.A

22.C

23.A

24.D

25.C

26.A

27.C

28.B

29.B

30.C

31.B

32.B

33.C

34.D

35.A

36.D

37.B

38.B

39.A

40.D


Part III


41.D

42.A

43.C

44.B

45.A

46.C

47.C

48.B

49.D

50.B

51.A

52.A

53.C

54.D

55.B

56.A

57.B

58.C

59.B

60.A

61.A

62.C

63.C

64.C

65.D

66.D

67.A

68.B

69.D

70.A


Part IV


71.B

72.D

73.D

74.C

75.C

76.D

77.B

78.A

79.C

80.C

81.B

82.B

83.D

84.A

85.C

86.A

87.D

88.B

89.D

90.C



20026月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) His father.

 B) His mother.

 C) His brother.

 D) His sister.D

 2.A) A job opportunity.

 B) A position as general manager.

 C) A big travel agency.

 D) An inexperienced salesman.A

 3.A) Having a break.

 B) Continuing the meeting.

 C) Moving on to the next item.

 D) Waiting a little longer.A

 4.A) The weather forecast says it will be fine.

 B) The weather doesn’t count in their plan.

 C) They will not do as planned in case of rain.

 D) They will postpone their program if it rains.D

 5.A) He wishes to have more courses like it.

 B) He finds it hard to follow the teacher.

 C) He wishes the teacher would talk more.

 D) He doesn’t like the teacher’s accent.B

 6.A) Go on with the game.

 B) Draw pictures on the computer.

 C) Review his lessons.

 D) Have a good rest.C

 7.A) She does not agree with Jack.

 B) Jack’s performance is disappointing.

 C) Most people will find basketball boring.

 D) She shares Jack’s opinion.A

 8.A) The man went to a wrong check-in counter.

 B) The man has just missed his flight.

 C) The plane will leave at 9:14.

 D) The plane’s departure time remains unknown.D

 9.A) At a newsstand.

 B) At a car dealer’s.

 C) At a publishing house.

 D) At a newspaper office.D

 10.A) He wants to get a new position.

 B) He is asking the woman for help.

 C) He has left the woman a good impression.

 D) He enjoys letter writing.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage one

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) They are interested in other kinds of reading.

 B) They are active in voluntary services.

 C) They tend to be low in education and in income.

 D) They live in isolated areas.C

 12.A) The reasons why –people don’t read newspapers are more complicated than assumed.

 B) There are more uneducated people among the wealthy than originally expected.

 C) The number of newspaper readers is steadily increasing.

 D) There are more nonreaders among young people nowadays.D

 13.A) Lowering the prices of their newspapers.

 B) Shortening their news stories.

 C) Adding variety to their newspaper content.

 D) Including more advertisements in their newspapers.C

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) A basket.

 B) A cup.

 C) A egg.

 D) An oven.B

 15.A) To let in the sunshine.

 B) To serve as its door.

 C) To keep the nest cool.

 D) For the bird to lay eggs.B

 16.A) Branches.

 B) Grasses.

 C) Mud.

 D) Straw.C

 17.A) Some are built underground.

 B) Some can be eaten.

 C) Most are sewed with grasses.

 D) Most are dried by the sun.A

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) To examine the chemical elements in the Ice Age.

 B) To look into the pattern of solar wind activity.

 C) To analyze the composition of different trees.

 D) To find out the origin of carbon-14 on Earth.A

 19.A) The lifecycle of trees.

 B) The number of trees.

 C) The intensity of solar burning.

 D) The quality of air.C

 20.A) It affects the growth of trees.

 B) It has been increasing since the Ice Age.

 C) It is determined by the chemicals in the air.

 D) It follows a certain cycle.D

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 In the 1960s, medical researchers Thomas Holmes and Richard Rahe developed a checklist of stressful events. They appreciated the tricky point that any major change can be stressful. Negative events like “serious illness of a family member” were high on the list, but so were some positive life-changing events, like marriage. When you take the Holmes-Rahe test you must remember that the score does not reflect how you deal with stress—it only shows how much you have to deal with. And we now know that the way you handle these events dramatically affects your chances of staying healthy.

 By the early 1970s, hundreds of similar studies had followed Holmes and Rahe. And millions of Americans who work and live under stress worried over the reports. Somehow, the research got boiled down to a memorable message. Women’s magazines ran headlines like “Stress causes illness!” If you want to stay physically and mentally healthy, the articles said, avoid stressful events.

 But such simplistic advice is impossible to follow. Even if stressful events are dangerous, many—like the death of a loved one—are impossible to avoid. Moreover, any warning to avoid all stressful events is a prescription (处方) for staying away from opportunities as well as trouble. Since any change can be stressful, a person who wanted to be completely free of stress would never marry, have a child, take a new job or move.

 The notion that all stress makes you sick also ignores a lot of what we know about people. It assumes we’re all vulnerable (脆弱的) and passive in the face of adversity (逆境). But what about human initiative and creativity? Many come through periods of stress with more physical and mental vigor than they had before. We also know that a long time without change or challenge can lead to boredom, and physical and metal strain.

 21.The result of Holmes-Rahe’s medical research tells us ________.

 A) the way you handle major events may cause stress

 B) what should be done to avoid stress

 C) what kind of event would cause stress

 D) how to cope with sudden changes in lifeC

 22.The studies on stress in the early 1970’s led to ________.

 A) widespread concern over its harmful effects

 B) great panic over the mental disorder it could cause

 C) an intensive research into stress-related illnesses

 D) popular avoidance of stressful jobsA

 23.The score of the Holmes-Rahe test shows ________.

 A) how much pressure you are under

 B) how positive events can change your life

 C) how stressful a major event can be

 D) how you can deal with life-changing eventsA

 24.Why is “such simplistic advice” (Line 1, Para. 3) impossible to follow?

 A) No one can stay on the same job for long.

 B) No prescription is effective in relieving stress.

 C) People have to get married someday.

 D) You could be missing opportunities as well.D

 25.According to the passage people who have experienced ups and downs may become ________.

 A) nervous when faced with difficulties

 B) physically and mentally strained

 C) more capable of coping with adversity

 D) indifferent toward what happens to themC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Most episodes of absent-mindedness—forgetting where you left something or wondering why you just entered a room—are caused by a simple lack of attention, says Schacter. “You’re supposed to remember something, but you haven’t encoded it deeply.”

 Encoding, Schacter explains, is a special way of paying attention to an event that has a major impact on recalling it later. Failure to encode properly can create annoying situations. If you put your mobile phone in a pocket, for example, and don’t pay attention to what you did because you’re involved in a conversation, you’ll probably forget that the phone is in the jacket now hanging in youwardrobe(衣柜). “Your memory itself isn’t failing you,” says Schacter. “Rather, you didn’t give your memory system the information it needed.”

 Lack of interest can also lead to absent-mindedness. “A man who can recite sports statistics from 30 years ago,” says Zelinski, “may not remember to drop a letter in the mailbox.” Women have slightly better memories than men, possibly because they pay more attention to their environment, and memory relies on just that.

 Visual cues can help prevent absent-mindedness, says Schacter. “But be sure the cue is clear and available,” he cautions. If you want to remember to take a medication (药物) with lunch, put the pill bottle on the kitchen table—don’t leave it in the medicine chest and write yourself a note that you keep in a pocket.

 Another common episode of absent-mindedness: walking into a room and wondering why you’re there. Most likely, you were thinking about something else. “Everyone does this from time to time,” says Zelinski. The best thing to do is to return to where you were before entering the room, and you’ll likely remember.

 26.Why does the author think that encoding properly is very important?

 A) It helps us understand our memory system better.

 B) It enables us to recall something form our memory.

 C) It expands our memory capacity considerably.

 D) It slows down the process of losing our memory.B

 27.One possible reason why women have better memories than men is that ________.

 A) they have a wider range of interests

 B) they are more reliant on the environment

 C) they have an unusual power of focusing their attention

 D) they are more interested in what’s happening around themD

 28.A note in the pocket can hardly serve as a reminder because ________.

 A) it will easily get lost

 B) it’s not clear enough for you to read

 C) it’s out of your sight

 D) it might get mixed up with other thingsC

 29.What do we learn from the last paragraph?

 A) If we focus our attention on one thing, we might forget another.

 B) Memory depends to a certain extent on the environment.

 C) Repetition helps improve our memory.

 D) If we keep forgetting things, we’d better return to where we were.A

 30.What is the passage mainly about?

 A) The process of gradual memory loss.

 B) The causes of absent-mindedness.

 C) The impact of the environment on memory.

 D) A way if encoding and recalling.B

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 It is hard to track the blue whale, the ocean’s largest creature, which has almost been killed off by commercial whaling and is now listed as an endangered species. Attaching radio devices to it is difficult, and visual sightings are too unreliable to give real insight into its behavior.

 So biologists were delighted early this year when, with the help of the Navy, they were able to track a particular blue whale for 43 days, monitoring its sounds. This was possible because of the Navy’s formerly top-secret system of underwater listening devices spanning the oceans.

 Tracking whales is but one example of an exciting new world just opening to civilian scientists after the cold war as the Navy starts to share and partly uncover its global network of underwater listening system built over the decades to track the ships of potential enemies.

 Earth scientists announced at a news conference recently that they had used the system for closely monitoring a deep-sea volcanic eruption (爆发) for the first time and that they plan similar studies.

 Other scientists have proposed to use the network for tracking ocean currents and measuring changes in ocean and global temperatures.

 The speed of sound in water is roughly one mile a second—slower than through land but faster than through air. What is most important, different layers of ocean water can act as channels for sounds, focusing them in the same way a stethoscope (听诊器) does when it carries faint noises from a patient’s chest to a doctor’s ear. This focusing is the main reason that even relatively weak sounds in the ocean, especially low-frequency ones, can often travel thousands of miles.

 31.The passage is chiefly about ________.

 A) an effort to protect an endangered marine species

 B) the civilian use of a military detection system

 C) the exposure of a U.S. Navy top-secret weapon

 D) a new way to look into the behavior of blue whalesB

 32.The underwater listening system was originally designed ________.

 A) to trace and locate enemy vessels

 B) to monitor deep-sea volcanic eruptions

 C) to study the movement of ocean currents

 D) to replace the global radio communications networkA

 33.The deep-sea listening system makes use of ________.

 A) the sophisticated technology of focusing sounds under water

 B) the capability of sound to travel at high speed

 C) the unique property of layers of ocean water in transmitting sound

 D) low-frequency sounds traveling across different layers of waterC

 34.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) new radio devices should be developed for tracking the endangered blue whales

 B) blue whales are no longer endangered with the use of the new listening system

 C) opinions differ as to whether civilian scientists should be allowed to use military technology

 D) military technology has great potential in civilian useD

 35.Which of the following is true about the U.S. Navy underwater listening network?

 A) It is now partly accessible to civilian scientists.

 B) It has been replaced by a more advanced system.

 C) It became useless to the military after the cold war.

 D) It is indispensable in protecting endangered species.A

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 The fitness movement that began in the late 1960s and early 1970s centered around aerobic exercise (有氧操). Millions of individuals became engaged in a variety of aerobic activities, and literally thousands of health spas developed around the country to capitalize (获利) on this emerging interest in fitness, particularly aerobic dancing for females. A number of fitness spas existed prior to this aerobic fitness movement, even a national chain with spas in most major cities. However, their focus was not on aerobics, but rather on weight-training programs designed to develop muscular mass, strength, and endurance in their primarily male enthusiasts. These fitness spas did not seem to benefit financially form the aerobic fitness movement to better health, since medical opinion suggested that weight-training programs offered few, if any, health benefits. In recent years, however, weight training has again become increasingly popular for males and for females. Many current programs focus not only on developing muscular strength and endurance but on aerobic fitness as well.

 Historically, most physical-fitness tests have usually included measures of muscular strength and endurance, not for health-related reasons, but primarily because such fitness components have been related to performance in athletics. However, in recent years, evidence has shown that training programs designed primarily to improve muscular strength and endurance might also offer some health benefits as well. The American College of Sports Medicine now recommends that weight training be part of a total fitness program for healthy Americans. Increased participation in such training is one of the specific physical activity and fitness objectives of Healthy People 2000: National Health Promotion and Disease Prevention Objectives.

 36.The word “spas” (Line 3, Para. 1) most probably refers to ________.

 A) sports activities

 B) places for physical exercise

 C) recreation centers

 D) athletic training programsB

 37.Early fitness spas were intended mainly for ________.

 A) the promotion of aerobic exercise

 B) endurance and muscular development

 C) the improvement of women’s figures

 D) better performance in aerobic dancingB

 38.What was the attitude of doctors towards weight training in health improvement?

 A) Positive.

 B) Indifferent.

 C) Negative.

 D) Cautious.C

 39.People were given physical fitness tests in order to find out ________.

 A) how ell they could do in athletics

 B) what their health condition was like

 C) what kind of fitness center was suitable for them

 D) whether they were fit for aerobic exerciseA

 40.Recent studies have suggested that weight training ________.

 A) has become an essential part of people’s life

 B) may well affect the health of the trainees

 C) will attract more people in the days to come

 D) contributes to health improvement as wellD

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 3.0. incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.You would be ________ a risk to let your child go to school by himself.

 A) omitting

 B) attaching

 C) affording

 D) runningD

 42.He is always here; it’s ________ you’ve never met him.

 A) unique

 B) strange

 C) rare

 D) peculiarB

 43.There has been a great increase in retail sales, ________?

 A) does there

 B) isn’t there

 C) hasn’t there

 D) isn’t itC

 44.We’d like to ________ a table for five for dinner this evening.

 A) preserve

 B) retain

 C) reserve

 D) sustainB

 45.Although a teenager, Fred could resist ________ what to do and what not to do.

 A) being told

 B) telling

 C) to be told

 D) to tellA

 46.The European Union countries were once worried that they would not have ________ supplies of petroleum.

 A) proficient

 B) efficient

 C) potential

 D) sufficientD

 47.In fact, Peter would rather have left for San Francisco than ________ in New York.

 A) to stay

 B) stayed

 C) staying

 D) having stayedB

 48.He soon received promotion, for his superiors realized that he was a man of considerable ________.

 A) ability

 B) future

 C) possibility

 D) opportunityA

 49.Britain ahs the highest ________ of road traffic in the world—over 60 cars for every mile of road.

 A) popularity

 B) density

 C) intensity

 D) prosperityB

 50.How is it ________ your roommate’s request and yours are identical?

 A) if

 B) so

 C) what

 D) thatD

 51.In my opinion, he’s ________ the most imaginative of all the contemporary poets.

 A) in all

 B) at best

 C) for all

 D) by farD

 52.He didn’t have time to read the report word for word: he just ________ it.

 A) skimmed

 B) observed

 C) overlooked

 D) glancedA

 53.The leader of the expedition ________ everyone to follow his example.

 A) promoted

 B) reinforced

 C) sparked

 D) inspiredD

 54.What a lovely party! It’s worth ________ all my life.

 A) remembering

 B) to remember

 C) to be remembered

 D) being rememberedA

 55.Who would you rather ________ with you, George or me?

 A) going

 B) to go

 C) have gone

 D) wentD

 56.The ________ goal of the book is to help bridge the gap between research and teaching, particularly between researchers and teachers.

 A) intensive

 B) concise

 C) joint

 D) overallD

 57.The owner and editor of the newspaper ________ the conference.

 A) were attending

 B) were to attend

 C) is to attend

 D) are to attendC

 58.We left the meeting, there obviously ________ no point in staying.

 A) were

 B) being

 C) to be

 D) havingB

 59.Their products are frequently overpriced and ________ in quality.

 A) influential

 B) inferior

 C) superior

 D) subordinateB

 60.The neighborhood boys like to play basketball on that ________ lot.

 A) valid

 B) vacant

 C) vain

 D) vagueC

 61.These people once had fame and fortune; now ________ is left to them is utter poverty.

 A) all that

 B) all what

 C) all which

 D) that allA

 62.To our ________, Geoffrey’s illness proved not to be as serious as we had feared.

 A) anxiety

 B) relief

 C) view

 D) judgmentB

 63.Many people like white color as it is a ________ of purity.

 A) symbol

 B) sign

 C) signal

 D) symptomA

 64.The residents, ________ had been damaged by the fire, were given help by the Red Cross.

 A) all of their homes

 B) all their homes

 C) whose all homes

 D) all of whose homesD

 65.This research has attracted wide ________ coverage and has featured on BBC television’s Tomorrow’s World.

 A) message

 B) information

 C) media

 D) dataC

 66.I would never have ________ a court of law if I hadn’t been so desperate.

 A) sought for

 B) accounted for

 C) turned up

 D) resorted toD

 67.Investigators agreed that passengers on the airliner ________ at the very moment of the crash.

 A) should have died

 B) must be dying

 C) must have died

 D) ought to dieC

 68.The energy ________ by the chain reaction is transformed into heat.

 A) transferred

 B) released

 C) delivered

 D) conveyedB

 69.________ their work will give us a much better feel for the wide differences between the two schools of thought.

 A) To have reviewed

 B) Having reviewed

 C) Reviewing

 D) Being reviewedC

 70.During the process, great care has to be taken to protect the ________ silk from damage.

 A) sensitive

 B) tender

 C) delicate

 D) sensibleC

Part IV Short Answer Questions (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part there is a short passage-with five questions or incomplete statements. Read the passage carefully. Then answer the questions or complete the statements in the fewest possible words (not exceeding 10 words).

 As researchers learn more about how children’s intelligence develops, they are increasingly surprised by the power of parents. The power of the school has been replaced by the home. To begin with, all the factors which are part of intelligence—the child’s understanding of language, learning patterns, curiosity—are established well before the child enters school at the age of six. Study after study has shown that even after school begins, children’s achievements have been far more influenced by parents than by teachers. This is particularly true about learning that is language-related. The school rather than the home is given credit for variations in achievement in subjects such as science.

 In view of their power, it’s sad to see so many parents not making the most of their child’s intelligence. Until recently parents had been warned by educators who asked them not to educate their children. Many teachers now realize that children cannot be educated only at school and parents are being asked to contribute both before and after the child enters school.

 Parents have been particularly afraid to teach reading at home. Of course, children shouldn’t be pushed to read by their parents, but educators have discovered that reading is best taught individually—and the easiest place to do this is at home. Many four-and five-year-olds who have been shown a few letters and taught their sounds will compose single words of their own with them even before they have been taught to read.

Questions: (注意:答题尽量简短,超过10个词要扣分。每条横线限写一个英语单词,标点符号不占格)

 S1.What have researchers found out about the influence of parents and the school on children’s intelligence?

 S2.What do researchers conclude about children’s learning patterns?

 S3.In which area may school play a more important role?

 S4.Why did many parents fail to make the most of their children’s intelligence?

 S5.The author suggests in the last paragraph that parents should be encouraged to

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic Student Use of Computers. You should write at least 120 words, and base your composition on the chart and the outline given below:

 1.上图所示为1990年、1995年、2002年某校大学生使用计算机的情况,请描述其变化;

 2.请说明发生这些变化的原因(可从计算机的用途、价格或社会发展等方面加以说明)

 3.你认为目前大学生在计算机使用中有什么困难或问题。

Student Use of Computers

20026月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.A

3.A

4.D

5.B

6.C

7.A

8.D

9.D

10.A

11.C

12.D

13.C

14.B

15.B

16.C

17.A

18.A

19.C

20.D


Part II


21.C

22.A

23.A

24.D

25.C

26.B

27.D

28.C

29.A

30.B

31.B

32.A

33.C

34.D

35.A

36.B

37.B

38.C

39.A

40.D


Part III


41.D

42.B

43.C

44.B

45.A

46.D

47.B

48.A

49.B

50.D

51.D

52.A

53.D

54.A

55.D

56.D

57.C

58.B

59.B

60.C

61.A

62.B

63.A

64.D

65.C

66.D

67.C

68.B

69.C

70.C



 S1.Parents have greater influence than the school./Parent’s influence is greater than the school’s.

 S2.They are established well before the age of six.

 S3.Science subjects.

 S4.They were told by educators not to educate their children.

 S5.teach reading at home.

20031月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the correct answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) They are both anxious to try Italian food.

 B) They are likely to have dinner together.

 C) The man will treat the woman to dinner tonight.

 D) The woman refused to have dinner with the man.B

 2.A) It’s only for rent, not for sale.

 B) It’s not as good as advertised.

 C) It’s being redecorated.

 D) It’s no longer available.D

 3.A) Colleagues.

 B) Husband and wife.

 C) Employer and employee.

 D) Mother and son.D

 4.A) She contacts her parents occasionally.

 B) She phones her parents regularly at weekends.

 C) She visits her parents at weekends when the fares are down.

 D) She often call her parents regardless of the rates.B

 5.A) The next bus is coming soon.

 B) The bus will wait a few minutes at the stop.

 C) There are only two or three passengers waiting for the bus.

 D) They can catch this bus without running.A

 6.A) The assignment looks easy but actually it’s quite difficult.

 B) The assignment is too difficult for them to complete on time.

 C) They cannot finish the assignment until Thursday.

 D) They have plenty of time to work on the assignment.D

 7.A) The man will go to meet the woman this evening.

 B) The man and the woman have an appointment at 7 o’clock.

 C) The woman can’t finish making the jam before 7 o’clock.

 D) The woman won’t be able to see the man this evening.B

 8.A) She’s learned a lot from the literature class.

 B) She’s written some books about world classics.

 C) She’s met some of the world’s best writers.

 D) She’s just back from a trip round the world.A

 9.A) The exam was easier than the previous one.

 B) Joe is sure that he will do better in the next exam.

 C) Joe probably failed in the exam.

 D) The oral part of the exam was easier than the written part.C

 10.A) She is tired of driving in heavy traffic.

 B) She doesn’t mind it as the road conditions are good.

 C) She is unhappy to have to drive such a long way every day.

 D) She enjoys it because she’s good at driving.B

Section B Compound Dictation

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from S1 to S7 with the exact words you have just heard. For blanks numbered from S8 to S10 you are required to fill in the missing information. You can either use the exact words you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

 It’s difficult to imagine the sea ever running out of fish. It’s so vast, so deep, so (S1) ________. Unfortunately, it’s not bottomless. Over-fishing, (S2) ________ with destructive fishing practices, is killing off the fish and (S3) ________ their environment.

 Destroy the fish, and you destroy the fishermen’s means of living. At least 60 (S4) ________ of the world’s commercially important fish (S5) ________ are already over-fished, or fished to the limit. As a result, governments have had to close down some areas of sea to commercial fishing.

 Big, high-tech fleets (S6) ________ that everything in their path is pulled out of water. Anything too small, or the wrong thing, is thrown back either dead or dying. That’s an (S7) ________ of more than 20 million metric tons every year. (S8) ________.

 In some parts of the world, for every kilogram of prawns (对虾) caught, up to 15 kilograms of unsuspecting fish and other marine wildlife die, simply for being in the wrong place at the wrong time.

 True, (S9) ________, then catch them in a way that doesn’t kill other innocent sea life.

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 15 are based on the following passage.

 Like many of my generation, I have a weakness for hero worship. At some point, however, we all begin to question our heroes and our need for them. This leads us to ask: What is a hero?

 Despite immense differences in cultures, heroes around the world generally share a number of characteristics that instruct and inspire people.

 A hero does something worth talking about. A hero has a story of adventure to tell and a community who will listen. But a hero goes beyond mere fame.

 Heroes serve powers or principles larger than themselves. Like high-voltage transformers, heroes take the energy of higher powers and step it down so that it can be used by ordinary people.

 The hero lives a life worthy of imitation. Those who imitate a genuine hero experience life with new depth, enthusiasm, and meaning. A sure test for would-be heroes is what or whom do they serve? What are they willing to live and die for? If the answer or evidence suggests they serve only their own fame, they may be famous persons but not heroes. Madonna and Michael Jackson are famous, but who would claim that their fans find life more abundant?

 Heroes are catalysts (催化剂) for change. They have a vision from the mountaintop. They have the skill and the charm to move the masses. They create new possibilities. Without Gandhi, India might still be part of the British Empire. Without Rosa Parks and Martin Luther King, Jr., we might still havesegregated(隔离的) buses, restaurants, and parks. It may be possible for large-scale change to occur without leaders with magnetic personalities, but the pace of change would be slow, the vision uncertain, and the committee meetings endless.

 11.Although heroes may come from different cultures, they ________.

 A) generally possess certain inspiring characteristics

 B) probably share some weaknesses of ordinary people

 C) are often influenced by previous generations

 D) all unknowingly attract a large number of fansA

 12.According to the passage, heroes are compared to high-voltage transformers in that ________.

 A) they have a vision from the mountaintop

 B) they have warm feelings and emotions

 C) they can serve as concrete examples of noble principles

 D) they can make people feel stronger and more confidentC

 13.Madonna and Michael Jackson are not considered heroes because ________.

 A) they are popular only among certain groups of people

 B) their performances do not improve their fans morally

 C) their primary concern is their own financial interests

 D) they are not clear about the principles they should followB

 14.Gandhi and Martin Luther King are typical examples of outstanding leaders who ________.

 A) are good at demonstrating their charming characters

 B) can move the masses with their forceful speeches

 C) are capable of meeting all challenges and hardships

 D) can provide an answer to the problems of their peopleB

 15.The author concludes that historical changes would ________.

 A) be delayed without leaders with inspiring personal qualities

 B) not happen without heroes making the necessary sacrifices

 C) take place ff there were heroes to lead the people

 D) produce leaders with attractive personalitiesA

Passage Two

Questions 16 to 20 are based on the following passage.

 According to a survey, which was based on the responses of over 188,000 students, today’s traditional-age college freshmen are “more materialistic and lessaltruistic(利他主义的)” than at any time in the 17 years of the poll.

 Not surprising in these hard times, the student’s major objective “is to be financially well off. Less important than ever is developing a meaningful philosophy of life.” It follows then that today the most popular course is not literature or history but accounting.

 Interest in teaching, social service and the “altruistic” fields is at a low. On the other hand, enrollment in business programs, engineering and computer science is way up.

 That’s no surprise either. A friend of mine (a sales representative for a chemical company) was making twice the salary of her college instructors her first year on the job—even before she completed her two-year associate degree.

 While it’s true that we all need a career, it is equally true that our civilization has accumulated an incredible amount of knowledge in fields far removed from our own and that we are better for our understanding of these other contributions—be they scientific or artistic. It is equally true that, in studying the diverse wisdom of others, we learn how to think. More important, perhaps, education teaches us to see the connections between things, as well as to see beyond our immediate needs.

 Weekly we read of unions who went on strike for higher wages, only to drive their employer out of business. No company; no job. How shortsighted in the long run!

 But the most important argument for a broad education is that in studying the accumulated wisdom of the ages, we improve our moral sense. I saw a cartoon recently which shows a group of businessmen looking puzzled as they sit around a conference table; one of them is talking on theintercom(对讲机): “Miss Baxter,” he says, “could you please send in someone who can distinguish right from wrong?”

 From the long-term point of view, that’s what education really ought to be about.

 16.According to the author’s observation, college students ________.

 A) have never been so materialistic as today

 B) have never been so interested in the arts

 C) have never been so financially well off as today

 D) have never attached so much importance to moral senseA

 17.The students’ criteria for selecting majors today have much to do with ________.

 A) the influences of their instructors

 B) the financial goals they seek in life

 C) their own interpretations of the courses

 D) their understanding of the contributions of othersB

 18.By saying “While it’s true that... be they scientific or artistic” (Lines 1-3, Para. 5), the author means that ________.

 A) business management should be included in educational programs

 B) human wisdom has accumulated at an extraordinarily high speed

 C) human intellectual development has reached new heights

 D) the importance of a broad education should not be overlookedD

 19.Studying the diverse wisdom of others can ________.

 A) create varying artistic interests

 B) help people see things in their right perspective

 C) help improve connections among people

 D) regulate the behavior of modern peopleB

 20.Which of the following statements is true according to the passage?

 A) Businessmen absorbed in their career are narrow-minded.

 B) Managers often find it hard to tell right from wrong.

 C) People engaged in technical jobs lead a more rewarding life.

 D) Career seekers should not focus on immediate interests only.D

Passage Three

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 New technology links the world as never before. Our planet has shrunk. It’s now a “global village” where countries are only seconds away by fax or phone or satellite link. And, of course, our ability to benefit from this high-tech communications equipment is greatly enhanced by foreign language skills.

 Deeply involved with this new technology is a breed of modern businesspeople who have a growing respect for the economic value of doing business abroad. In modern markets, success overseas often helps support domestic business efforts.

 Overseas assignments are becoming increasingly important to advancement within executive ranks. The executive stationed in another country no longer need fear being “out of sight and out of mind.” He or she can be sure that the overseas effort is central to the company’s plan for success, and that promotions often follow or accompany an assignment abroad. If an employee can succeed in a difficult assignment overseas, superiors will have greater confidence in his or her ability to cope back in the United States where cross-cultural considerations and foreign language issues are becoming more and moreprevalent(普遍的).

 Thanks to a variety of relatively inexpensive communications devices with business applications, even small businesses in the United States are able to get into international markets.

 English is still the international language of business. But there is an ever-growing need for people who can speak another language. A second language isn’t generally required to get a job in business, but having language skills gives a candidate the edge when other qualifications appear to be equal

 The employee posted abroad who speaks the country’s principal language has an opportunity to fast-forward certain negotiations, and cam have the cultural insight to know when it is better to move more slowly. The employee at the home office who can communicate well with foreign clients over the telephone or by fax machine is an obvious asset to the firm.

 21.What is the author’s attitude toward high-tech communications equipment?

 A) Critical.

 B) Prejudiced.

 C) Indifferent.

 D) Positive.D

 22.With the increased use of high-tech communications equipment, businesspeople ________.

 A) have to get familiar with modern technology

 B) are gaining more economic benefits from domestic operations

 C) are attaching more importance to their overseas business

 D) are eager to work overseasC

 23.In this passage, “out of sight and out of mind” (Lines 2-3, Para. 3) probably means ________.

 A) being unable to think properly for lack of insight

 B) being totally out of touch with business at home

 C) missing opportunities for promotion when abroad

 D) leaving all care and worry behindC

 24.According to the passage, what is an important consideration of international corporations in employing people today?

 A) Connections with businesses overseas.

 B) Ability to speak the client’s language.

 C) Technical know-how.

 D) Business experience.B

 25.The advantage of employees having foreign language skills is that they can ________.

 A) better control the whole negotiation process

 B) easily find new approaches to meet market needs

 C) fast-forward their proposals to headquarters

 D) easily make friends with businesspeople abroadA

Passage Four

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 In recent years, Israeli consumers have grown more demanding as they’ve become wealthier and more worldly-wise. Foreign travel is a national passion; this summer alone, one in 10 citizens will go abroad. Exposed to higher standards of service elsewhere, Israelis are returning home expecting the same. American firms have also begun arriving in large numbers. Chains such as KFC, McDonald’s and Pizza Hut are setting a new standard of customer service, using strict employee training and constant monitoring to ensure the friendliness of frontline staff. Even the American habit of telling departing customers to “Have a nice day” has caught on all over Israel. “Nobody wakes up in the morning and says, ‘Let’s be nicer,’” says Itsik Cohen, director of a consulting firm. “Nothing happens without competition.”

 Privatization, or the threat of it, is a motivation as well.Monopolies(垄断者) that until recently have been free to take their customers for granted now fear what Michael Perry, a marketing professor, calls “therevengeful(报复的) consumer.” When the government opened up competition with Bezaq, the phone company, its international branch lost 40% of its market share, even while offering competitive rates. Says Perry, “People wanted revenge for all the years of bad service.” The electric company, whose monopoly may be short-lived, has suddenly mopped requiring users to wait half a day for a repairman. Now, appointments are scheduled to the half-hour. The graceless El Al Airlines, which is already atauction(拍卖), has retrained its employees to emphasize service and is boasting about the results in an ad campaign with the slogan, “You can feel the change in the air.” For the first time, praise outnumbers complaints on customer survey sheets.

 26.It may be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) customer service in Israel is now improving

 B) wealthy Israeli customers are hard to please

 C) the tourist industry has brought chain stores to Israel

 D) Israeli customers prefer foreign products to domestic onesA

 27.In the author’s view, higher service standards are impossible in Israel ________.

 A) if customer complaints go unnoticed by the management

 B) unless foreign companies are introduced in greater numbers

 C) if there’s no competition among companies

 D) without strict routine training of employeesC

 28.If someone in Israel today needs a repairman in case of a power failure, ________.

 A) they can have it fixed in no time

 B) it’s no longer necessary to make an appointment

 C) the appointment takes only half a day to make

 D) they only have to wait half an hour at mostD

 29.The example of El A1 Airlines shows that ________.

 A) revengeful customers are a threat to the monopoly of enterprises

 B) an ad campaign is a way out for enterprises in financial difficulty

 C) a good slogan has great potential for improving service

 D) staff retraining is essential for better serviceD

 30.Why did Bezaq’s international branch lose 40% of its market share?

 A) Because the rates it offered were not competitive enough.

 B) Because customers were dissatisfied with its past service.

 C) Because the service offered by its competitors was far better.

 D) Because it no longer received any support from the government.B

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 3.0. incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 31.Such crimes may be so complex that months or years go by before anyone ________ them.

 A) discovered

 B) will discover

 C) would have discovered

 D) discoversD

 32.Though ________ in a big city, Peter always prefers to paint the primitive scenes of country life.

 A) grown

 B) raised

 C) tended

 D) cultivatedB

 33.The careless man received a ticket for speeding. He ________ have driven so fast.

 A) can’t

 B) wouldn’t

 C) shouldn’t

 D) mustn’tC

 34.If people feel hopeless, they don’t bother to ________ the skills they need to succeed.

 A) adopt

 B) acquire

 C) accumulate

 D) assembleB

 35.If I ________ harder at school, I would be sitting in a comfortable office now.

 A) worked

 B) were to work

 C) had worked

 D) were workingC

 36.The shop assistant was dismissed as she was ________ of cheating customers.

 A) accused

 B) charged

 C) scolded

 D) cursedA

 37.All her energies are ________ upon her children and she seems to have little time for anything else.

 A) guided

 B) aimed

 C) directed

 D) focusedD

 38.While crossing the mountain area, all the men carried guns lest they ________ by wild animals.

 A) should be attacked

 B) had been attacked

 C) must be attacked

 D) would be attackedA

 39.Everyone should be ________ to a decent standard of living and an opportunity to be educated.

 A) attributed

 B) entitled

 C) identified

 D) justifiedB

 40.His wife is constantly funding ________ with him, which makes him very angry.

 A) errors

 B) shortcomings

 C) fault

 D) flawC

 41.Vitamins are complex ________ that the body requires in very small mounts.

 A) matters

 B) materials

 C) particles

 D) substancesD

 42.Apart from caring for her children, she has to take on such heavy ________ housework as carrying water and firewood.

 A) time-consumed

 B) timely-consumed

 C) time-consuming

 D) timely-consumingC

 43.Anna was reading a piece of science fiction, completely ________ to the outside world.

 A) having been lost

 B) to be lost

 C) losing

 D) lostD

 44.The police are trying to find out the ________ of the woman killed in the traffic accident.

 A) evidence

 B) recognition

 C) status

 D) identityD

 45.All human beings have a comfortable zone regulating the ________ they keep from someone they talk with.

 A) distance

 B) scope

 C) range

 D) boundaryA

 46.We have planned an exciting publicity ________ with our advertisers.

 A) struggle

 B) campaign

 C) battle

 D) conflictB

 47.________ the help of their group, we would not have succeeded in the investigation.

 A) Besides

 B) Regardless of

 C) But for

 D) DespiteC

 48.________ much is known about what occurs during sleep, the precise function of sleep and its different stages remains largely in the realm of assumption.

 A) Because

 B) For

 C) Since

 D) WhileD

 49.John doesn’t believe in ________ medicine; he has some remedies of his own.

 A) standard

 B) regular

 C) routine

 D) conventionalD

 50.Owing to ________ competition among the airlines, travel expenses have been reduced considerably.

 A) fierce

 B) strained

 C) eager

 D) criticalA

 51.They always give the vacant seats to ________ comes first.

 A) whoever

 B) whomever

 C) who

 D) whomA

 52.In Africa, educational costs are very low for those who are ________ enough to get into universities.

 A) ambitious

 B) fortunate

 C) aggressive

 D) substantialB

 53.Professor Wang, ________ for his informative lectures, was warmly received by his students.

 A) knowing

 B) known

 C) to be known

 D) having knownB

 54.Our manager is ________ an important customer now and he will be back this afternoon.

 A) calling on

 B) calling in

 C) calling up

 D) calling forA

 55.A fire engine must have priority as it usually has to deal with some kind of ________.

 A) precaution

 B) crisis

 C) emergency

 D) urgencyC

 56.He said that the driver must have had an accident; otherwise he ________ by then.

 A) would have arrived

 B) must have arrived

 C) should arrive

 D) would arriveA

 57.The film provides a deep ________ into a wide range of human qualifies and feelings.

 A) insight

 B) imagination

 C) fancy

 D) outlookA

 58.It is high time that such practices ________.

 A) are ended

 B) be ended

 C) were ended

 D) must be endedC

 59.Urban crowdedness would be greatly relieved if only the ________ charged on public transport were more reasonable.

 A) fees

 B) fares

 C) payments

 D) costsB

 60.The doctor had almost lost hope at one point, but the patient finally ________.

 A) pulled out

 B) pulled through

 C) pulled up

 D) pulled overB

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 A language is a signaling system which operates with symbolic vocal sounds (语声), and which is used by a group of people for the purpose of communication.

 Let’s look at this __61__ in more detail because it is language, more than anything else, __62__ distinguishes man from the rest of the __63__ world.

 Other animals, it is true, communicate with one another by __64__ of cries: for example, many birds utter __65__ calls at the approach of danger; monkeys utter __66__ cries, such as expressions of anger, fear and pleasure. __67__ these various means of communication differ in important ways __68__ human language. For instance, animals’ cries do not __69__ thoughts and feelings clearly. This means, basically, that they lack structure. They lack the kind of structure that __70__ us to divide a human utterance into __71__.

 We can change an utterance by __72__ one word in it with __73__: a good illustration of this is a soldier who can say, e.g., “tanks approaching from the north“, __74__ who can change one word and say aircraft approaching from the north” or “tanks approaching from the west”; but a bird has a single alarm cry, __75__ means “danger!”

 This is why the number of __76__ that an animal can make is very limited: the great tit (山雀) is a case __77__ point; it has about twenty different calls, __78__ in human language the number of possible utterances is __79__. It also explains why animal cries are very __80__ in meaning.

 61.A) classification

 B) definition

 C) function

 D) perceptionC

 62.A) that

 B) it

 C) as

 D) whatA

 63.A) native

 B) human

 C) physical

 D) animalD

 64.A) ways

 B) means

 C) methods

 D) approachesB

 65.A) mating

 B) exciting

 C) warning

 D) boringC

 66.A) identical

 B) similar

 C) different

 D) unfamiliarC

 67.A) But

 B) Therefore

 C) Afterwards

 D) FurthermoreA

 68.A) about

 B) with

 C) from

 D) inC

 69.A) infer

 B) explain

 C) interpret

 D) expressD

 70.A) encourages

 B) enables

 C) enforces

 D) ensuresB

 71.A) speeches

 B) sounds

 C) words

 D) voicesC

 72.A) replacing

 B) spelling

 C) pronouncing

 D) sayingA

 73.A) ours

 B) theirs

 C) another

 D) othersC

 74.A) so

 B) and

 C) but

 D) orB

 75.A) this

 B) that

 C) which

 D) itC

 76.A) signs

 B) gestures

 C) signals

 D) marksC

 77.A) in

 B) at

 C) of

 D) forA

 78.A) whereas

 B) since

 C) anyhow

 D) somehowA

 79.A) boundless

 B) changeable

 C) limitless

 D) ceaselessC

 80.A) ordinary

 B) alike

 C) common

 D) generalD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write a composition on the topic It Pays to Be Honest. You should write at least 120 words according to the outline given below in Chinese.

 1.当前社会上存在许多不诚实的现象

 2.诚实利人利已,做人应该诚实

It Pays to Be Honest

20031月四级参考答案

Part I


1.B

2.D

3.D

4.B

5.A

6.D

7.B

8.A

9.C

10.B


Part II


11.A

12.C

13.B

14.B

15.A

16.A

17.B

18.D

19.B

20.D

21.D

22.C

23.C

24.B

25.A

26.A

27.C

28.D

29.D

30.B


Part III


31.D

32.B

33.C

34.B

35.C

36.A

37.D

38.A

39.B

40.C

41.D

42.C

43.D

44.D

45.A

46.B

47.C

48.D

49.D

50.A

51.A

52.B

53.B

54.A

55.C

56.A

57.A

58.C

59.B

60.B


Part IV


61.C

62.A

63.D

64.B

65.C

66.C

67.A

68.C

69.D

70.B

71.C

72.A

73.C

74.B

75.C

76.C

77.A

78.A

79.C

80.D



 S1.mysterious

 S2.coupled

 S3.ruining

 S4.percent

 S5.species

 S6.ensure

 S7.average

 S8.When you consider that equals a quarter of the world catch, you begin to see the size of the problem.

 S9.True, some countries are beginning to deal with this problem, but it’s vital we find a rational way of fishing

 S10.Before every ocean becomes a dead sea, it would make sense to give the fish enough time to recover, grow to full size and reproduce

20036月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This is most likely to have taken place at the office. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) At a theatre.

 B) At a booking office.

 C) At a railway station.

 D) At a restaurant.D

 2.A) The man is inviting the woman to dinner.

 B) The woman is too busy to join the man for dinner.

 C) The woman is a friend of the Stevensons.

 D) The man is going to visit the Stevensons.A

 3.A) The professor’s presentation was not convincing enough.

 B) The professor’s lecture notes were too complicated.

 C) The professor spoke with a strong accent.

 D) The professor spoke too fast.D

 4.A) The furnished apartment was inexpensive.

 B) The apartment was provided with some old furniture.

 C) The furniture in the market was on sale every Sunday.

 D) The furniture he bought was very cheap.D

 5.A) The man is thinking about taking a new job.

 B) The man likes a job that enables him to travel.

 C) The man is sure that he will gain more by taking the job.

 D) The man doesn’t want to stay home and take care of their child.A

 6.A) Take the GRE test again in 8 weeks.

 B) Call to check his scores.

 C) Be patient and wait.

 D) Inquire when the test scores are released.C

 7.A) She read it selectively.

 B) She went over it chapter by chapter.

 C) She read it slowly.

 D) She finished it at a stretch.A

 8.A) He was kept in hospital for a long time.

 B) He was slightly injured in a traffic accident.

 C) He was seriously wounded in a mine explosion.

 D) He was fined for speeding.B

 9.A) Wait for a taxi.

 B) Buy some food.

 C) Go on a trip.

 D) Book train tickets.C

 10.A) It’s not as hard as expected.

 B) It’s too tough for some students.

 C) It’s much more difficult than people think.

 D) It’s believed to be the hardest optional course.C

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choice marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) Anxious and worried.

 B) Proud and excited.

 C) Nervous and confused.

 D) Inspired and confident.B

 12.A) His father scolded him severely.

 B) His father took back the six dollars.

 C) His father made him do the cutting again.

 D) His father cut the leaves himself.C

 13.A) One can benefit a lot from working with his father.

 B) Manual labourers shouldn’t be looked down upon.

 C) One should always do his job earnestly.

 D) Teenagers tend to be careless.C

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) He ran a village shop.

 B) He worked on a farm.

 C) He worked in an advertising agency.

 D) He was a gardener.C

 15.A) It was stressful.

 B) It was colorful.

 C) It was peaceful.

 D) It was boring.A

 16.A) His desire to start Iris own business.

 B) The crisis in his family life.

 C) The decline in his health.

 D) His dream of living in the countryside.B

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) Because there are no signs to direct them.

 B) Because no tour guides are available.

 C) Because all the buildings in the city look alike.

 D) Because the university is everywhere in the city.D

 18.A) They set their own exams.

 B) They select their own students.

 C) They award their own degrees.

 D) They organize their own laboratory work.B

 19.A) Most of them have a long history.

 B) Many of them are specialized libraries.

 C) They house more books than any other university library.

 D) They each have a copy of every book published in Britain.B

 20.A) Very few of them are engaged in research.

 B) They were not awarded degrees until 1948.

 C) They have outnumbered male students.

 D) They were not treated equally until 1881.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 On average, American kids ages 3 to 12 spent 29 hours a week in school, eight hours more that they did in 1981. They also did more household work and participated in more of such organized activities as soccer and ballet (芭蕾舞). Involvement in sports, in particular, rose almost 50% from 1981 to 1997: boys now spend an average of four hours a week playing sports; girls log hall that time. All in all, however, children’s leisure time dropped from 40% of the day in 1981 to 25%

 “Children are affected by the same time crunch (危机) that affects their parents,” says Sandra Hofferth, who headed the recent study of children’s timetable. A chief reason, she says, is that more mothers are working outside the home. (Nevertheless, children in both double-income and “male breadwinner” households spent comparable amounts of time interacting with their parents 19 hours and 22 hours respectively. In contrast, children spent only 9 hours with their single mothers.)

 All work and no play could make for some very messed-up kids. “Play is the most powerful way a child explores the world and learns about himself,” says T. Berry Brazelton, professor at Harvard Medical School Unstructured play encourages independent thinking and allows the young to negotiate their relationships with their peers, but kids ages 3 to 12 spent only 12 hours a week engaged in it.

 The children sampled spent a quarter of their rapidly decreasing “free time” watching television. But that, believe it or not, was one of the findings parents might regard as good news. If they’re spending less time in front of the TV set, however, kids aren’t replacing it with reading. Despite efforts to get kids more interested in books, the children spent just over an hour a week reading. Let’s face it, who’s got the time?

 21.By mentioning “the same time crunch” (Line 1, Para. 2) Sandra Hofferth means ________.

 A) children have little time to play with their parents

 B) children are not taken good care of by their working parents

 C) both parents and children suffer from lack of leisure time

 D) both parents and children have trouble managing their timeD

 22.According to the author, the reason given by Sandra Hofferth for the time crunch is ________.

 A) quite convincing

 B) partially true

 C) totally groundless

 D) rather confusingB

 23.According to the author a child develops better if ________.

 A) he has plenty of time reading and studying

 B) he is left to play with his peers in his own way

 C) he has more time participating in school activities

 D) he is free to interact with his working parentsD

 24.The author is concerned about the fact that American kids ________.

 A) are engaged in more and more structured activities

 B) are increasingly neglected by their working mothers

 C) are spending more and more time watching TV

 D) are involved less and less in household workA

 25.We can infer from the passage that ________.

 A) extracurricular activities promote children’s intelligence

 B) most children will turn to reading with TV sets switched off

 C) efforts to get kids interested in reading have been fruitful

 D) most parents believe reading to be beneficial to childrenC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Henry Ford, the famous U.S. inventor and car manufacturer, once said, “The business of America is business.” By this he meant that the U.S. way of life is based on the values of the business world.

 Few would argue with Ford’s statement. A brief glimpse at a daily newspaper vividly shows how much people in the United States think about business. For example, nearly every newspaper has a business section, in which the deals and projects, finances and management, stock prices and labor problems of corporations are reported daily. In addition, business news can appear in every other section. Most national news has an important financial aspect to it. Welfare, foreign aid, the federal budget, and the policies of the Federal Reserve Bank are all heavily affected by business. Moreover, business news appears in some of the unlikeliest places. The world of arts and entertainment is often referred to as “the entertainment industry” or “show business.”

 The positive side of Henry Ford’s statement can be seen in the prosperity that business has brought to U.S. life. One of the most important reasons so many people from all over the world come to live in the United States is the dream of a better job. Jobs are produced in abundance (大量地) because the U.S. economic system is driven by competition. People believe that this system crates more wealth, more jobs, and a materially better way of life.

 The negative side of Henry Ford’s statement, however, can be seen when the word business is taken to mean big business. And the term big business—referring to the biggest companies, is seen in opposition to labor. Throughout U.S. history working people have had to fight hard for higher wages, better working conditions, and the fight to form unions. Today, many of the old labor disputes are over, but there is still some employee anxiety. Downsizing—the laying off of thousands of workers to keep expenses low and profits high—creates feelings of insecurity for many.

 26.The United States is a typical country ________.

 A) which encourages free trade at home and abroad

 B) where people’s chief concern is how to make money

 C) where all businesses are managed scientifically

 D) which normally works according to the federal budgetD

 27.The influence of business in the U.S. is evidenced by the fact that ________.

 A) most newspapers are run by big businesses

 B) even public organizations concentrate on working for profits

 C) Americans of all professions know how to do business

 D) even arts and entertainment are regarded as businessC

 28.According to the passage, immigrants choose to settle in the U.S., dreaming that ________.

 A) they can start profitable businesses there

 B) they can be more competitive in business

 C) they will make a fortune overnight there

 D) they will find better chances of employmentB

 29.Henry Ford’s statement can be taken negatively because ________.

 A) working people are discouraged to fight for their fights

 B) there are many industries controlled by a few big capitalists

 C) there is a conflicting relationship between big corporations and labor

 D) public services are not run by the federal governmentC

 30.A company’s efforts to keep expenses low and profits high may result in ________.

 A) reduction in the number of employees

 B) improvement of working conditions

 C) fewer disputes between labor and management

 D) a rise in workers’ wagesD

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Professor Smith recently persuaded 35 people, 23 of them women, to keep a diary of all their absent-minded actions for a fortnight. When he came to analyse their embarrassing lapses (差错) in a scientific report, he was surprised to find that nearly all of them fell into a few groupings, Nor did the lapses appear to be entirely random (随机的).

 One of the women, for instance, on leaving her house for work one morning threw her dog her earrings and tried to fix a dog biscuit on her ear. “the explanation for this is that the brain is like a computer,” explains the professor. “People programme themselves to do certain activities regularly. It was the woman’s custom every morning to throw her dog two biscuits and then put on her earrings. But somehow the action got reversed in the programme,” About one in twenty of the incidents the volunteers reported were these “programme assembly failures.”

 Altogether the volunteers logged 433 unintentional actions that they found themselves doing—an average of twelve each, There appear to be peak periods in the day when we are at our zaniest (荒谬可笑的). These are two hours some time between eight a.m. and noon, between four and six p.m. with a smaller peak between eight and ten p.m. “Among men the peak seems to be when a changeover in brain ‘programmes’ occurs, as for instance between going to and from work.” Women on average reported slightly more lapses—12.5 compared with 10.9 for men—probably because they were more reliable reporters.

 A startling finding of the research is that the absent-minded activity is a hazard of doing things in which we are skilled. Normally, you would expect that skill reduces the number of errors we make. But trying to avoid silly slips by concentrating more could make things a lot worse—even dangerous.

 31.In his study Professor Smith asked the subjects ________.

 A) to keep track of people who tend to forget things

 B) to report their embarrassing lapses at random

 C) to analyse their awkward experiences scientifically

 D) to keep a record of what they did unintentionallyB

 32.Professor Smith discovered that ________.

 A) certain patterns can be identified in the recorded incidents

 B) many people were too embarrassed to admit their absent-mindedness

 C) men tend to be more absent-minded than women

 D) absent-mindedness is an excusable human weaknessD

 33.“Programme assembly failures” (Line 6, Para. 2) refers to the phenomenon that people ________.

 A) often fail to programme their routines beforehand

 B) tend to make mistakes when they are in a hurry

 C) unconsciously change the sequence of doing things

 D) are likely to mess things up if they are too tiredD

 34.We learn from the third paragraph that ________.

 A) absent-mindedness tends to occur during certain hours of the day

 B) women are very careful to perform actions during peak periods

 C) women experience more peak periods of absent-mindedness

 D) men’s absent-mindedness often results in funny situationsA

 35.It can be concluded from the passage that ________.

 A) people should avoid doing important things during peak periods of lapses

 B) hazards can be avoided when people do things they are good at

 C) people should be careful when programming their actions

 D) lapses cannot always be attributed to lack of concentrationA

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 It’s no secret that many children would be healthier and happier with adoptive parents than with the parents that nature dealt them. That’s especially true of children who remain in abusive homes because the law blindly favors biological parents. It’s also true of children who suffer for years in foster homes (收养孩子的家庭) because of parents who can’t or won’t care for them but refuse to give up custody (监护) rights.

 Fourteen-year-old Kimberly Mays fits neither description, but her recent court victory could eventually help children who do. Kimberly has been the object of an angry custody baffle between the man who raised her and her biological parents, with whom she has never lived. A Florida judge ruled that the teenager can remain with the only father she’s ever known and that her biological parents have “no legal claim” on her.

 The ruling, though it may yet be reversed, sets aside the principle that biology is the primary determinant of parentage. That’s an important development, one that’s long overdue.

 Shortly after birth in December 1978, Kimberly Mays and another infant were mistakenly switched and sent home with the wrong parents. Kimberly’s biological parents, Ernest and Regina Twigg, received a child who died of a heart disease in 1988. Medical tests showed that the child wasn’t the Twiggs’ own daughter, but Kimt only was, thus sparking a custody battle with Robert Mays. In 1989, the two families agreed that Mr. Mays would maintain custody with the Twiggs getting visiting fights. Those rights were ended when Mr. Mays decided that Kimberly was being harmed.

 The decision to leave Kimberly with Mr. Mays rendered her suit debated. But the judge made clear that Kimberly did have standing to sue (起诉) on her own behalf. Thus he made clear that she was more than just property to be handled as adults saw fit.

 Certainly, the biological link between parent and child is fundamental. But biological parents aren’t always preferable to adoptive ones, and biological parentage does not convey an absolute ownership that cancels all the rights of children.

 36.What was the primary consideration in the Florida judge’s ruling?

 A) The biological link.

 B) The child’s benefits.

 C) The traditional practice.

 D) The parents’ feelings.B

 37.We can learn from the Kimberly case that ________.

 A) children are more than just personal possessions of their parents

 B) the biological link between parent and child should be emphasized

 C) foster homes bring children more pain and suffering than care

 D) biological parents shouldn’t claim custody rights after their child is adoptedD

 38.The Twiggs claimed custody rights to Kimberly because ________.

 A) they found her unhappy in Mr. Mays’ custody

 B) they regarded her as their property

 C) they were her biological parents

 D) they felt guilty about their past mistakeC

 39.Kimberly had been given to Mr. Mays ________.

 A) by sheer accident

 B) out of charity

 C) at his request

 D) for better careC

 40.The author’s attitude towards the judge’s ruling could be described as ________.

 A) doubtful

 B) critical

 C) cautious

 D) supportiveA

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minute)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are for choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 41.She her trip to New York because she was ill.

 A) called off

 B) closed down

 C) put up

 D) went offD

 42.________ the storm, the ship would have reached its destination on time.

 A) But for

 B) In case of

 C) In spite of

 D) Because ofA

 43.We should concentrate on sharply reducing interest rates to pull the economy out of ________.

 A) rejection

 B) restriction

 C) retreat

 D) recessionA

 44.The of finding gold in California attracted a lot of people to settle down there.

 A) prospects

 B) speculations

 C) stakes

 D) provisionsB

 45.I suffered from mental because of stress from my job.

 A) damage

 B) release

 C) relief

 D) fatigueD

 46.The rest of the day was entirely at his for reading or recreation.

 A) dismissal

 B) survival

 C) disposal

 D) arrivalA

 47.You will not be about your food in time of great hunger.

 A) special

 B) particular

 C) peculiar

 D) specificB

 48.Crime is increasing worldwide, and there is every reason to believe the will continue into the next decade.

 A) emergency

 B) trend

 C) pace

 D) scheduleC

 49.You shouldn’t have written in the ________ since the book belongs to the library.

 A) interval

 B) border

 C) margin

 D) edgeA

 50.The of airplane engines announced a coming air raid.

 A) roar

 B) exclamation

 C) whistle

 D) screamC

 51.This ticket you to a free boat tour on the lake.

 A) entities

 B) appoints

 C) grants

 D) creditsB

 52.This is the nurse who to me when I was ill in hospital.

 A) accompanied

 B) attended

 C) entertained

 D) shieldedD

 53.I was about to a match when I remembered Tom’s warning.

 A) rub

 B) hit

 C) scrape

 D) strikeB

 54.The advertisement says this material doesn’t in the wash, but it has.

 A) contract

 B) shrink

 C) slim

 D) dissolveC

 55.He was proud of being chosen to participate in the game and he ________ us that he would try as hard as possible.

 A) insured

 B) guaranteed

 C) assumed

 D) assuredC

 56.Not only the professionals but also the amateurs will from the new training facilities.

 A) derive

 B) acquire

 C) benefit

 D) rewardB

 57.The work was almost complete when we received orders to ________ no further with it.

 A) progress

 B) proceed

 C) march

 D) promoteD

 58.I waited for him half an hour, but he never ________.

 A) turned in

 B) turned down

 C) turned off

 D) turned upC

 59.A house with a dangerous gas can be broken into immediately.

 A) leak

 B) split

 C) mess

 D) crackA

 60.A dark suit is to a light one for evening wear.

 A) favourable

 B) suitable

 C) preferable

 D) properB

 61.It was in the United States that I made the of Professor Jones.

 A) acknowledgement

 B) acquaintance

 C) recognition

 D) associationA

 62.Could you take a sheet of paper and write your name at the top?

 A) bare

 B) vacant

 C) hollow

 D) blankC

 63.A culture in which the citizens share similar religious beliefs and values is more likely to have laws that represent the wishes of its people than is a culture where citizens come from backgrounds.

 A) extensive

 B) influential

 C) diverse

 D) identicalC

 64.Areas where students have particular difficulty have been treated particular care.

 A) by

 B) in

 C) under

 D) withA

 65.He gave a to handle the affairs in a friendly manner.

 A) pledge

 B) mission

 C) plunge

 D) motionD

 66.Don’t let the child play with scissors he cuts himself.

 A) in case

 B) so that

 C) now that

 D) only ifB

 67.________ the danger from enemy action, people had to cope with a severe shortage of food, clothing, fuel, and almost everything.

 A) As far as

 B) As long as

 C) As well as

 D) As soon asD

 68.Many people lost their jobs during the business ________.

 A) desperation

 B) decrease

 C) despair

 D) depressionA

 69.Whenever a big company a small one, the product almost always gets worse.

 A) gets on with

 B) cuts down

 C) takes over

 D) puts up withD

 70.Mr. Smith was the only witness who said that the fire was ________.

 A) mature

 B) deliberate

 C) meaningful

 D) innocentC

Part IV Short Answer Questions (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part there is a short passage with 8 questions or incomplete statements. Read the passage carefully. Then answer the questions or complete the statements in the fewest possible words. Write your answers in the spaces provided on the right of the page.

 What personal qualities are desirable in a teacher? I think the following would be generally accepted.

 First, the teacher’s personality should be lively and attractive. This does not rule out people who are plain-looking, or even ugly, because many such people have great personal charm. But it does rule out such types as the over-excitable, sad, cold, and frustrated.

 Secondly, it is not merely desirable but essential for a teacher to have a genuine capacity for sympathy, a capacity to understand the minds and feelings of other people, especially, since most teachers are school teachers, the minds and feelings of children. Closely related with this is the capacity to be tolerant—not, indeed, of what is wrong, but of the weaknesses and immaturity of human nature which induce (i)~) people, and again especially children, to make mistakes.

 Thirdly, I hold it essential for a teacher to be both intellectually and morally honest. This means that he will be aware of his intellectual strengths and limitations, and will have thought about and decided upon the moral principles by which his life shall be guided. There is no contradiction in my going on to say that a teacher should be a bit of an actor. That is part of the technique of teaching, which demands that every now and then a teacher should be able to put on an act to enliven (使生动) a lesson, correct a fault, or award praise. Children, especially young children, live in a world that is rather larger than life.

 A teacher must be capable of infinite patience. This, I may say, is largely a matter of self-discipline and self-training, for we are none of us born like that.

 Finally, I think a teacher should have the kind of mind which always wants to go on learning. Teaching is a job at which one will never be perfect; there is always something more to learn about it. There are three principal objects of study: the subjects which the teacher is teaching; the methods by which the subjects can best be taught to the particular pupils in the classes he is teaching; and—by far the most important—the children, young people, or adults to whom the subjects are to be taught. The two fundamental principles of British education today are that education is education of the whole person, and that it is best acquired through full and active co-operation between two persons, the teacher and the learner.

 S1.Plain-looking teachers can also be admired by their students if they have S1.

 S2.The author says it is S2 that teachers be sympathetic with their students.

 S3.A teacher should be tolerant because humans tend to have S3(1) and to be S3(2).

 S4.A teacher who is S4 will be able to make his lessons more lively.

 S5.How can a teacher acquire infinite patience? S5

 S6.Since teaching is a job no one can be perfect at, it is necessary for teachers to keep improving their knowledge of the subjects they teach and their S6

 S7.Teachers’ most important object of study is S7.

 S8.Education cannot be best acquired without S8 between the teacher and the learner

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed thirty minutes to write an eye-witness account of a traffic accident. You should write at least 120 words according to the outline given below in Chinese:

假设你在某日某时某地目击一起车祸,就此写一份见证书。见证书须包括以下几点:

 1.车祸发生的时间及地点

 2.你所见到的车祸情况

 3.你对车祸原因的分析

An Eye-Witness Account of a Traffic Accident

20036月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.A

3.D

4.D

5.A

6.C

7.A

8.B

9.C

10.C


Part II


11.B

12.C

13.C

14.C

15.A

16.B

17.D

18.B

19.B

20.B

21.D

22.B

23.D

24.A

25.C

26.D

27.C

28.B

29.C

30.D


Part III


31.B

32.D

33.D

34.A

35.A

36.B

37.D

38.C

39.C

40.A

41.D

42.A

43.A

44.B

45.D

46.A

47.B

48.C

49.A

50.C

51.B

52.D

53.B

54.C

55.C

56.B

57.D

58.C

59.A

60.B


Part IV


61.A

62.C

63.C

64.A

65.D

66.B

67.D

68.A

69.D

70.C



 S1.great personal charm

 S2.essential personal charm

 S3.(1) weaknesses (2) immature

 S4.a bit of an actor

 S5.by/through self-discipline and self-training

 S6.teaching methods

 S7.those to whom subjects are taught

 S8.full and active cooperation

20039月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversation. At the end of each conversation, a question wilt be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). and decide which is the best answer Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At thee office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From tile conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This conversation is most likely to have taken place at the office. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) Give Bob a phone call.

 B) Go and pick Bob up.

 C) Go look for Bob.

 D) Wait for Bob.D

 2.A) She is working in the city.

 B) Life in the suburbs is lonely.

 C) Jobs are easier to find in the city.

 D) It’s less expensive living in the city.A

 3.A) In a printing shop.

 B) At a publishing house.

 C) At a bookstore.

 D) In a library.C

 4.A) The woman be more careful next time.

 B) They try to think of a solution.

 C) The woman find a spare key.

 D) They come downstairs.B

 5.A) Sending an e-mail.

 B) Working in an office.

 C) Talking on the phone.

 D) Doing spelling practice.C

 6.A) Buy something for the picnic.

 B) Go shopping with the man.

 C) Go for a ride around town.

 D) Have a picnic.A

 7.A) The woman misplaced her class permit for biology.

 B) The woman arrived for registration too early.

 C) The woman missed registration for the biology course.

 D) The woman got a wrong class permit.B

 8.A) The woman likes the weather in New York very much.

 B) The woman will stay in New York a long time.

 C) The man is planning to visit New York.

 D) It’s quite cold in New York now.C

 9.A) The old lady sitting next to the couple likes toys very much.

 B) An old lady took the couple’s suitcase for her own.

 C) The couple’s suitcase was stolen in the restaurant.

 D) The man forgot to put the toys in their suitcase.B

 10.A) She’s flying to Hong Kong.

 B) She’s going to buy an air ticket.

 C) She’s going to say good-bye to Bill.

 D) She’s leaving for Hong Kong with Bill.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) They him only retired workers.

 B) They each do jobs they are good at.

 C) They close the hotel during low seasons.

 D) They employ as few workers as possible.D

 12.A) Staff training.

 B) Book-keeping.

 C) Cleaning and washing up.

 D) Gardening and flower arranging.C

 13.A) They have their hotel beautifully decorated.

 B) They provide delicious food.

 C) They make their guests feel at home.

 D) They give parties regularly for their visitors.C

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) To withdraw his deposit.

 B) To cash a cheek.

 C) To rob the bank.

 D) To get his prize.D

 15.A) A radio announcer

 B) A bank employee.

 C) A car mechanic.

 D) A movie actor.C

 16.A) They let him do what he wanted to.

 B) They helped him find large bills.

 C) They pressed the alarm.

 D) They called the police.A

 17.A) He was afraid that be would be caught on the spot.

 B) Large bills were not within his reach.

 C) The maximum sum allowed was 55,000.

 D) He was limited by time and the size of his pockets.D

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 18.A) A rescuer on the Golden Gate Bridge.

 B) A professional diver.

 C) A telephone operator.

 D) A guard on the Golden Gate Bridge.A

 19.A) Someone ham fallen off the bridge.

 B) Someone on the bridge is being attacked.

 C) Someone is threatening to destroy the bridge.

 D) Someone on the bridge is attempting to kill himself.D

 20.A) Call the mother to come fight away.

 B) Try to communicate with them first.

 C) Help them to get out of their misty.

 D) Remind them that they have children to take care of.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single ling through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 A recent study, published in last week’s Journal of the American Medical Association, offers a picture of how risky it is to get a lift from a teenage driver, Indeed, a 16-year-old driver with three or more passengers is three times as likely to have a fatal accident as a teenager driving alone, By contrast, the risk of death for drivers between 30 and 59 decreases with each additional passenger.

 The authors also found that the death rates for teenage drivers increased dramatically after 10 p.m., and especially after midnight, with passengers in the car, the driver was even more likely to die in a late-night accident.

 Robert Foss, a scientist at the University of North Carolina Highway Safety Research Center, says the higher death rates for teenage drivers have less to do with “really stupid behavior” than with just a lack of driving experience. “The basic issue.” Be says, “is that adults who are responsible for issuing licenses fail to recognize how complex and skilled a task driving is.”

 Both he and the author of the study believe that the way to mitigate (使…缓解) the problem is to have states institute so-called graduated licensing systems, in which getting a license is a multistage process. A graduated license requires that a teenager first prove himself capable of driving in the presence of an adult, followed by a period of driving with night of passenger restrictions, before graduating to full driving privileges.

 Graduated licensing systems have reduced teenage driver crashes, according to recent studies. About half of the states now have some sort of graduated licensing system in place, but only 10 of those states have restrictions on passengers, California is the strictest, with a novice (新手) driver prohibited from carrying any passenger under 20 (without the presence of an adult over 25) for the first six months.

 21.Which of the following situations is most dangerous according to the passage?

 A) Adults giving a lift to teenagers on the highway after 10 p.m.

 B) A teenager driving after midnight with passengers in the car.

 C) Adults driving with three or more teenage passengers late at night.

 D) A teenager getting a lift from a stranger on the highway at midnight.B

 22.According to Robert Foss. The high death rate of teenage drivers is mainly due to ________.

 A) their frequent driving at night

 B) their improper way of driving

 C) their lack of driving experience

 D) their driving with passengersC

 23.According to Paragraph 3. which of the following statements is TRUE?

 A) Teenagers should spend more time learning to drive.

 B) Driving is a skill too complicated for teenagers to learn.

 C) Restrictions should be imposed on teenagers applying to take driving lessons.

 D) The licensing authorities are partly responsible for teenagers’ driving accidents.D

 24.A suggested measure to be taken to reduce teenagers’ driving accidents is that ________.

 A) driving in the presence of an adult should be made a rule

 B) they should be prohibited from taking on passengers

 C) they should not be allowed to drive after 10 p.m.

 D) the licensing system should be improvedD

 25.The present situation in about half of the states is that the graduated licensing system ________.

 A) is under discussion

 B) is about to be set up

 C) has been put into effect

 D) has been perfectedC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 If you know exactly what you want, the best route to a job is to get specialized training. A recent survey shows that companies like graduates in such fields as business and health care who can go to work immediately with very little on-the-job training.

 That’s especially true of booming fields that are challenging for workers. At Cornell’s School of Hotel Administration, for example, bachelor’s degree graduates get an average of four or five job offers with salaries ranging from the high teens to the low 20s and plenty of chances for rapid advancement. Large companies, especially, like a background of formal education coupled with work experience.

 But in the long run, too much specialization doesn’t pay off. Business, which has been flooded with MBAs, no longer considers the degree an automatic stamp of approval. The MBA may open doors and command a higher salary initially, but the impact of a degree washes out after five years.

 As further evidence of the erosion (销蚀) of corporate (公司的) faith in specialized degrees, Michigan State’s Scheetz cites a pattern in corporate hiring practices, although companies tend to take on specialists as new hires, they often seek out generalists for middle and upper-level management. “They want someone who isn’t constrained (限制) by nuts and bolts to look at the big picture, “says Scheetz.

 This sounds suspiciously like a formal statement that you approve of the liberal-arts graduate. Time and again labor-market analysts mention a need for talents that liberal-arts majors are assumed to have: writing and communication skills, organizational skills, open-mindedness and adaptability, and the ability to analyze and solve problems, David Birch claims he does not hire anybody with an MBA or an engineering degree, “I hire only liberal-arts people because they have a less-than-canned way of doing things,” says Birch. Liberal-arts means an academically thorough and strict program that includes literature, history, mathematics, economics, science, human behavior—plus a computer course or two. With that under your belt, you can feel free to specialize, “A liberal-arts degree coupled with an MBA or some other technical training is a very good combination in the marketplace,” says Scheetz.

 26.What kinds of people are in high demand on the job market?

 A) Students with a bachelor’s degree in humanities.

 B) People with an MBA degree front top universities.

 C) People with formal schooling plus work experience.

 D) People with special training in engineering.C

 27.By saying “... but the impact of a degree washes out after five years” (Line 3, Para, 3), the author means ________.

 A) most MBA programs fail to provide students with a solid foundation

 B) an MBA degree does not help promotion to managerial positions

 C) MBA programs will not be as popular in five years’ time as they are now

 D) in five people will forget about the degree the MBA graduates have gotB

 28.According to Scheetz’s statement (Lines 4-5. Para. 4), companies prefer ________.

 A) people who have a strategic mind

 B) people who are talented in fine arts

 C) people who are ambitious and aggressive

 D) people who have received training in mechanicsA

 29.David Birch claims that he only hires liberal-arts people because ________.

 A) they are more capable of handling changing situations

 B) they can stick to established ways of solving problems

 C) they are thoroughly trained in a variety of specialized fields

 D) they have attended special programs in managementA

 30.Which of the following statements does the author support?

 A) Specialists are more expensive to hire than generalists.

 B) Formal schooling is less important than job training.

 C) On-the-job training is, in the long run, less costly.

 D) Generalists will outdo specialists in management.D

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 About six years ago I was eating lunch in a restaurant in New York City when a woman and a young boy sat down at the next table, I couldn’t help overhearing parts of their conversation. At one point the woman asked: “So, how have you been?” And the boy—who could not have been more than seven or eight years old—replied. “Frankly, I’ve been feeling a little depressed lately.”

 This incident stuck in my mind because it confirmed my growing belief that children are changing. As far as I can remember, my friends and I didn’t find out we were “depressed” until we were in high school.

 The evidence of a change in children has increased steadily in recent years. Children don’t seem childlike anymore. Children speak more like adults, dress more like adults and behave more like adults than they used to.

 Whether this is good or bad is difficult to say, but it certainly is different. Childhood as it once was no longer exists, Why?

 Human development is based not only on innate (天生的) biological states, but also on patterns of access to social knowledge. Movement from one social rote to another usually involves learning the secrets of the new status. Children have always been taught adult secrets, but slowly and in stages: traditionally, we tell sixth graders things we keep hidden from fifth graders.

 In the last 30 years, however, a secret-revelation (揭示) machine has been installed in 98 percent of American homes. It is called television, Television passes information, and indiscriminately(不加区分地), to all viewers alike, be they children or adults. Unable to resist the temptation, many children turn their attention from printed texts to the less challenging, more vivid moving pictures.

 Communication through print, as a matter of fact, allows for a great deal of control over the social information to which children have access. Reading and writing involve a complex code of symbols that must be memorized and practices. Children must read simple books before they can read complex materials.

 31.According to the author, feeling depressed is ________.

 A) a sure sign of a psychological problem in a child

 B) something hardly to be expected in a young child

 C) an inevitable has of children’s mental development

 D) a mental scale present in all humans, including childrenB

 32.Traditionally, a child is supposed to learn about the adult world ________.

 A) through contact with society

 B) gradually and under guidance

 C) naturally and by biological instinct

 D) through exposure to social informationB

 33.The phenomenon that today’s children seem adult like is attributed by the author to ________.

 A) the widespread influence of television

 B) the poor arrangement of teaching content

 C) the fast pace of human intellectual development

 D) the constantly rising standard of livingA

 34.Why is the author in favor of communication through print for children?

 A) It enables children to gain more social information.

 B) It develops children’s interest in reading and writing.

 C) It helps children to memorize and practice more.

 D) It can control what children are to learn.D

 35.What does the author think of the change in today’s children?

 A) He feels amused by chair premature behavior.

 B) He thinks it is a phenomenon worthy of note.

 C) He considers it a positive development.

 D) He seems to be upset about it.B

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 “Opinion” is a word that is used carelessly today. It is used to refer to matters of taste, belief, and judgment. This casual use would probably cause little confusion if people didn’t attach too much importance to opinion. Unfortunately, most to attach great importance to it. “I have as much right to my opinion as you to yours,” and “Everyone’s entitled to his opinion,” are common expressions. In fact, anyone who would challenge another’s opinion is likely to be branded intolerant.

 Is that label accurate? Is it intolerant to challenge another’s opinion? It depends on what definition of opinion you have in mind. For example, you may ask a friend “What do you think of the new Ford cars?” And he may reply, “In my opinion, they’re ugly.” In this case, it would not only be intolerant to challenge his statement, but foolish. For it’s obvious that by opinion he means his personal preference, a matter of taste. And as the old saying goes, “It’s pointless to argue about matters of taste.”

 But consider this very different use of the term, a newspaper reports that the Supreme Court has delivered its opinion in a controversial case. Obviously the justices did not shale their personal preferences, their mere likes and dislikes, they stated their considered judgment, painstakingly arrived at after thorough inquiry and deliberation.

 Most of what is referred to as opinion falls somewhere between these two extremes. It is not an expression of taste. Nor is it careful judgment. Yet it may contain elements of both. It is a view or belief more or less casually arrived at, with or without examining the evidence.

 Is everyone entitled to his opinion? Of course, this is not only permitted, but guaranteed. We are free to act on our opinions only so long as, in doing so, we do not harm others.

 36.Which of the following statements is TRUE, according to the author?

 A) Everyone has a right to hold his own opinion.

 B) Free expression of opinions often leads to confusion.

 C) Most people tend to be careless in forming their opinions.

 D) Casual use of the word “opinion” often brings about quarrels.A

 37.According to the author, who of the following would be labored as intolerant?

 A) Someone who turns a deaf ear to others’ opinions.

 B) Someone who can’t put up with others’ tastes.

 C) Someone who values only their own opinions.

 D) Someone whose opinion harms other people.B

 38.The new Ford cars are cited as an example to show that ________.

 A) it is foolish to criticize a famous brand

 B) one should not always agree to others’ opinions

 C) personal tastes are not something to be challenged

 D) it is unwise to express one’s likes and dislikes in publicC

 39.Considered judgment is different from personal preference in that ________.

 A) it is stated by judges in the court

 B) it reflects public like and dislikes

 C) it is a result of a lot of controversy

 D) it is based on careful thoughtD

 40.As indicated in the passage, being free to act on one’s opinion ________.

 A) means that one can ignore other people’s criticism

 B) means that one can impose his preferences on others

 C) doesn’t mean that one has the right to do things at will

 D) doesn’t mean that one has the right to charge others without evidenceC

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences it: this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose cite ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the Corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 41.The beam that is ________ by a laser differs in several ways from the light that comes out of a flashlight.

 A) emitted

 B) transported

 C) motivated

 D) translatedA

 42.We booked rooms at the hotel ________ we should find no vacancies on our arrival.

 A) whenever

 B) if

 C) since

 D) lestD

 43.Modern forms of transportation and communication have done much to ________ the isolation of life in Alaska.

 A) break through

 B) break down

 C) break into

 D) break outA

 44.We know through painful experience that freedom is never by the oppressor; it must be ________ by the oppressed.

 A) demanded

 B) commanded

 C) required

 D) requestedA

 45.Color and sex are not relevant ________ whether a person is suitable for the job.

 A) on

 B) for

 C) to

 D) withC

 46.________ the enormous flow of food from the entire globe, these countries have for many years not felt any population pressure.

 A) Thanks to

 B) By means of

 C) In line with

 D) With regard toA

 47.Research universities have to keep up with the latest computer and scientific hardware ________ price.

 A) on account of

 B) regardless of

 C) in addition to

 D) not to mentionB

 48.Three university departments have been ________ $600,000 to develop good practice in teaching and learning.

 A) promoted

 B) included

 C) secured

 D) awardedD

 49.The rapid development of communications technology is transforming the ________ in which people communicate across time and space.

 A) mood

 B) mission

 C) manner

 D) visionC

 50.Mr. Jones holds strong views against video games and ________ the closing of all recreation facilities for such games.

 A) assists

 B) acknowledges

 C) advocates

 D) admitsC

 51.Workers in the fine arts ________ thoughts and feelings through their creative works.

 A) transmit

 B) elaborate

 C) convey

 D) contributeC

 52.Small as it is, the ant is as much a creature as ________ all other animals on earth.

 A) are

 B) do

 C) is

 D) haveA

 53.The policeman declared that the blow on the victim’s head ________ from behind.

 A) should have been made

 B) must have been made

 C) would have been made

 D) ought to have been madeB

 54.Finding a job can be ________ and disappointing, and therefore it is important that you are prepared.

 A) exploiting

 B) frustrating

 C) profiting

 D) misleadingB

 55.It British government often says that furnishing children with ________ to the information superhighway is a top priority.

 A) procedure

 B) protection

 C) allowance

 D) accessD

 56.Louis Herman, at the University of Hawaii, has ________ a series of new experiments in which some animals have learned to understand sentences.

 A) installed

 B) equipped

 C) devised

 D) formattedC

 57.Researchers at the University of Illinois determined that the ________ of a father can help improve a child’s grades.

 A) involvement

 B) interaction

 C) association

 D) communicationA

 58.We can accept your order ________ payment is made in advance.

 A) in the belief that

 B) in order that

 C) on the excuse that

 D) on condition thatD

 59.Many in the credit industry expect that credit cards will eventually ________ paper money for almost every purchase.

 A) exchange

 B) reduce

 C) replace

 D) tradeC

 60.Any donation you can give will help us ________ the suffering and isolation of the homeless this New Year.

 A) lift

 B) patch

 C) comfort

 D) easeD

 61.In India more than one hundred languages are spoken, ________ which only fourteen are recognized as official.

 A) of

 B) in

 C) with

 D) withinA

 62.Techniques for ________ sleep would involve learning to control both mind and body so that sleep can occur.

 A) cultivating

 B) promoting

 C) pushing

 D) strengtheningB

 63.It is important to ________ between the rules of grammar and the conventions of written language.

 A) determine

 B) identify

 C) explore

 D) distinguishD

 64.It is too early to say whether IBM’s competitors will be able to ________ their products to the new hardware at an affordable cost.

 A) adapt

 B) stick

 C) yield

 D) adoptA

 65.This research has attracted wide coverage in the ________ and has featured on BBC television’s Tomorrow’s World.

 A) data

 B) source

 C) message

 D) mediaD

 66.I had just posted the letter when I remembered that hadn’t ________ the cheque.

 A) imposed

 B) involved

 C) enclosed

 D) containedC

 67.She had a tense expression on her face, ________ she were expecting trouble.

 A) even though

 B) as though

 C) even as

 D) now thatB

 68.They were ________ admission to the military exhibition because they were foreigners.

 A) denied

 B) declined

 C) deprived

 D) rejectedA

 69.It gave me a strange feeling of excitement to see my name in ________.

 A) prospect

 B) print

 C) process

 D) pressB

 70.Residents were cutting their lawns, washing their cars and otherwise ________ a pleasant, sunny day.

 A) idling away

 B) taking away

 C) chasing away

 D) driving awayA

Part IV Short Answer Questions (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part there is a short passage with 8 questions or incomplete statements. R the passage carefully. Then answer the questions or complete the statements in fewest possible words. Your answer may be a word, a phrase, or a short sentence. Fewest possible words. Your answer may be a word, a phrase, or a short sentence. Write your answers in the spaces provided on the right of the page.

 Sport is one of the world’s largest industries, and most athletes are professionals who are paid for their efforts. Because an athlete succeeds by achievement only—not by economic ground or family connections—sports can be a fast route to wealth, and many athletes play only for money than for love.

 This has not always been true. In the ancient Olympics the winner got only a wreath of olive leaves (橄榄叶花环). Even though the winners became national heroes, the games remained amateur for centuries. Athletes won fame, but no money. As time passed, however, the contests became increasingly less amateur and cities began to hire athletes to represent them. By the fourth century A.D., the Olympics were ruined, and they were soon ended.

 In 1896, the Olympic games were revived (使再度兴起) with the same goal of pure amateur competition. The rules bar athletes who have ever received a $50 prize or an athletic scholars or who have spent four weeks in a training camp. At least one competitor in the 1896 games met these qualifications. He was Spiridon Loues, a water carrier who won the marathon race, after race, a rich Athenian offered him anything he wanted. A true amateur, Loues accepted only a cart and a horse. Then he gave up running forever. But Loues was an exception and now, as the Chairman of the German Olympic Committee said, “Nobody pays any attention to these rules.” Many countries pay their athletes to train year-round, and Olympic athletes are eager to sell their names to companies that make everything from ski equipment to fast food.

 Even the games themselves have become a huge business. Countries fight to hold the Olympics not only for honor, but for money. The 1972 games in Munich cost the Germans 545 million dollars, but by selling medal symbols, TV rights, food, drink, hotel rooms, and souvenirs (纪念品), they managed to make a profit. Appropriately, the symbol of victory in the Olympic games is no longer a simple olive wreath—it is a gold medal.

 S1.To many people, sports today is nothing but S1.

 S2.What do most athletes of today go after? S2.

 S3.What reward could an ancient Greek athlete expect? S3.

 S4.By the fourth century A.D., Olympic contests became increasingly more S4 thus ruining the Olympics.

 S5.When the Olympic games were revived in 1896, athletes who had received special training in camps would be S5.

 S6.What did Spiridon Loues do after he accepted the Athenian’s gift? S6.

 S7.According to the author, some athletes are even willing to advertise for businesses which sell things like S7.

 S8.The 1972 Munich games managed to make a big profit mainly by S8(1) services and selling S8(2).

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition on the topic The Day My Classmate Fell Ill (or Got Injured). You should write at least 120 words according to the outline given below in Chinese:

 1.简单叙述一下这位同学生病(或受伤)的情况

 2.同学、老师和我是如何帮助他/她的

 3.人与人之间的这种相互关爱给我的感受是…

The Day My Classmate Fell Ill (or Got Injured)

20039月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.D

2.A

3.C

4.B

5.C

6.A

7.B

8.C

9.B

10.A

11.D

12.C

13.C

14.D

15.C

16.A

17.D

18.A

19.D

20.B


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.B

22.C

23.D

24.D

25.C

26.C

27.B

28.A

29.A

30.D

31.B

32.B

33.A

34.D

35.B

36.A

37.B

38.C

39.D

40.C


Part III Vocabulary and Structure


41.A

42.D

43.A

44.A

45.C

46.A

47.B

48.D

49.C

50.C

51.C

52.A

53.B

54.B

55.D

56.C

57.A

58.D

59.C

60.D

61.A

62.B

63.D

64.A

65.D

66.C

67.B

68.A

69.B

70.A


Part IV Short Answer Questions

 S1.a fast route to wealth

 S2.money

 S3.a wreath of olive leaves/olive wreath

 S4.professional

 S5.barred

 S6.He gave up running forever./Giving up running forever.

 S7.Ski equipment and fast food

 S8.(1) hotel (2) medal symbols, TV rights, souvenirs, food and drinks

200312月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This conversation is most likely to have taken place at the office. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) The man could come some time later.

 B) The size the man wants will arrive soon.

 C) The size of the skirt is ail right for the man.

 D) The man could buy a shirt of a different color.A

 2.A) The woman is filming the lake.

 B) The woman is running toward the lake.

 C) The woman can’t take a photo of the man.

 D) The woman is watching an exciting film with the man.B

 3.A) It’s quiet in the restaurant.

 B) The restaurant is too far from their school.

 C) The price is high in the restaurant.

 D) The restaurant serves good food.A

 4.A) On a busy street.

 B) In a Hong Kong hotel.

 C) At an airport.

 D) At a booking office.D

 5.A) The woman should confirm her appointment with the doctor.

 B) The woman should have seen the doctor earlier.

 C) The woman’s headache will go away by itself.

 D) The woman has been complaining too much.C

 6.A) Put off his appointment with Mr. Johnson.

 B) Help move things to Mr. Johnson’s office.

 C) Help the woman move the items.

 D) Hurry to Mr. Johnson’s office.B

 7.A) The man didn’t practice hard enough.

 B) The man should find a new partner.

 C) The man should not give up.

 D) The man should not dream of being a superstar.D

 8.A) It doesn’t appeal to her.

 B) It’s incredibly delicious.

 C) She has already tasted it.

 D) There is no more left.B

 9.A) The man is a diligent student.

 B) The man has bad study habits.

 C) The man has made a mess of his midterm exam.

 D) The man is usually the last to hand in his test paper.C

 10.A) The man has finished Ms assignment.

 B) The man is willing to help the woman.

 C) The man will drive the woman to school.

 D) The man is losing patience with the woman.D

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) The importance of good manners.

 B) The art of saying thank you.

 C) The secret of staying pretty.

 D) The difference between elegance and good manners.C

 12.A) They were willing to spend more money on clothes.

 B) They paid more attention to their appearance.

 C) They were more aware of changes in fashion.

 D) They were nicer and gentler.A

 13.A) By putting on a little make-up.

 B) By decorating our homes.

 C) By being kind and generous.

 D) By wearing fashionable clothes.B

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) Children don’t get enough education in safety.

 B) The playgrounds are in poor condition.

 C) The playgrounds are overcrowded.

 D) Children are keen on dangerous games.C

 15.A) They should help maintain the equipment.

 B) They should teach their children how to use the equipment.

 C) They should stop their children from climbing ladders.

 D) They should keep a watchful eye on their children.B

 16.A) They can be creative when they feel secure.

 B) They may panic in front of high playground equipment.

 C) They should be aware of the potential risks in the playground.

 D) They tend to stay within shouting or running distance of their parents.D

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) It’s admired worldwide.

 B) It takes skill.

 C) It pays well.

 D) It’s a full-time job.A

 18.A) An old lady carrying a handbag on the left.

 B) A mother with a baby in her arms.

 C) A woman whose bag is hanging in front.

 D) A lone female with a handbag at her right side.C

 19.A) A side pocket of his jacket.

 B) The top pocket of his jacket.

 C) A side pocket of his trousers.

 D) The back pocket of his tight trousers.A

 20.A) Clothing stores where people are relaxed and off guard.

 B) Hotels and restaurants in southeast London.

 C) Airports where people carry a lot of luggage.

 D) Theater lobbies with uniformed security guards.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 I’m usually fairly skeptical about any research that concludes that people are either happier or unhappier or more or less certain of themselves than they were 50 years ago. While any of these statements might be true, they are practically impossible to prove scientifically. Still, I was struck by a report which concluded that today’s children are significantly more anxious than children in the 1950s. In fact, the analysis showed, normal children ages 9 to 17 exhibit a higher level of anxiety today than children who were treated for mental illness 50 years ago.

 Why are America’s kids so stressed? The report cites two main causes: increasing physical isolation—brought on by high divorce rates and less involvement in community, among other things—and a growing perception that the world is a more dangerous place.

 Given that we can’t turn the clock back, adults can still do plenty to help the next generation cope.

 At the top of the list is nurturing (培育) a better appreciation of the limits of individualism. No child is an island. Strengthening social ties helps build communities and protect individuals against stress.

 To help kids build stronger connections with others, you can pull the plug on TVs and computers. Your family will thank you later. They will have more time for face-to-face relationships, and they will get more sleep.

 Limit the amount of virtual (虚拟的) violence your children are exposed to. It’s not just video games and movies; children see a lot of murder and crime on the local news.

 Keep your expectations for your children reasonable. Many highly successful people never attended Harvard or Yale.

 Make exercise part of your daily routine. It will help you cope with your own anxieties and provide a good model for your kids. Sometimes anxiety is unavoidable. But it doesn’t have to ruin your life.

 21.The author thinks that the conclusions of any research about people’s state of mind are ________.

 A) surprising

 B) confusing

 C) illogical

 D) questionableD

 22.What does the author mean when he says, “we can’t turn the clock back” (Line 1, Para. 3)?

 A) It’s impossible to slow down the pace of change.

 B) The social reality children are facing cannot be changed.

 C) Lessons learned from the past should not be forgotten.

 D) It’s impossible to forget the past.B

 23.According to an analysis, compared with normal children today, children treated as mentally ill 50 years ago ________.

 A) were less isolated physically

 B) were probably less self-centered

 C) probably suffered less from anxiety

 D) were considered less individualisticC

 24.The first and most important thing parents should do to help their children is ________.

 A) to provide them with a safer environment

 B) to lower their expectations for them

 C) to get them more involved socially

 D) to set a good model for them to followC

 25.What conclusion can be drawn from the passage?

 A) Anxiety, though unavoidable, can be coped with.

 B) Children’s anxiety has been enormously exaggerated.

 C) Children’s anxiety can be eliminated with more parental care.

 D) Anxiety, if properly controlled, may help children become mature.C

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 It is easier to negotiate initial salary requirement because once you are inside, the organizational constraints (约束) influence wage increases. One thing, however, is certain: your chances of getting the raise you feel you deserve are less if you don’t at least ask for it. Men tend to ask for more, and they get more, and this holds true with other resources, not just pay increases. Consider Beth’s story:

 I did not get what I wanted when I did not ask for it. We had cubicle (小隔间) offices and window offices. I sat in the cubicles with several male colleagues. One by one they were moved into window offices, while I remained in the cubicles, several males who were hired after me also went to offices. One in particular told me he was next in line for an office and that it had been part of his negotiations for the job. I guess they thought me content to stay in the cubicles since I did not voice my opinion either way.

 It would be nice if we all received automatic pay increases equal to our merit, but “nice” isn’t a quality attributed to most organizations. If you feel you deserve a significant raise in pay, you’ll probably have to ask for it.

 Performance is your best bargaining chip (筹码) when you are seeking a raise. You must be able to demonstrate that you deserve a raise. Timing is also a good bargaining chip. If you can give your boss something he or she needs (a new client or a sizable contract, for example) just before merit pay decisions are being made, you are more likely to get the raise you want.

 Use information as a bargaining chip too. Find out what you are worth on the open market.

 What will someone else pay for your services?

 Go into the negotiations prepared to place your chips on the table at the appropriate time and prepared to use communication style to guide the direction of the interaction.

 26.According to the passage, before taking a job, a person should ________.

 A) demonstrate his capability

 B) give his boss a good impression

 C) ask for as much money as he can

 D) ask for the salary he hopes to getD

 27.What can be inferred from Beth’s story?

 A) Prejudice against women still exists in some organizations.

 B) If people want what they deserve, they have to ask for it.

 C) People should not be content with what they have got.

 D) People should be careful when negotiating for a job.B

 28.We can learn from the passage that ________.

 A) unfairness exists in salary increases

 B) most people are overworked and underpaid

 C) one should avoid overstating one’s performance

 D) most organizations give their staff automatic pay raisesA

 29.To get a pay raise, a person should ________.

 A) advertise himself on the job market

 B) persuade his boss to sign a long-term contract

 C) try to get inside information about the organization

 D) do something to impress his boss just before merit pay decisionsD

 30.To be successful in negotiations, one must ________.

 A) meet his boss at the appropriate time

 B) arrive at the negotiation table punctually

 C) be good at influencing the outcome of the interaction

 D) be familiar with what the boss likes and dislikesC

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 When families gather for Christmas dinner, some will stick to formal traditions dating back to Grandma’s generation. Their tables will be set with the good dishes and silver, and the dress code will be Sunday-best.

 But in many other homes, this china-and-silver elegance has given way to a stoneware (粗陶)-and-stainless informality, with dresses assuming an equally casual-Friday look. For hosts and guests, the change means greater simplicity and comfort. For makers of fine china in Britain, it spells economic hard times.

 Last week Royal Doulton, the largest employer in Stoke-on-Trent, announced that it is eliminating 1,000 jobs—one-fifth of its total workforce. That brings to more than 4,000 the number of positions lost in 18 months in the pottery (陶瓷) region. Wedgwood and other pottery factories made cuts earlier.

 Although a strong pound and weak markets in Asia play a role in the downsizing, the layoffs in Stoke have their roots in earthshaking social shifts. A spokesman for Royal Doulton admitted that the company “has been somewhat slow in catching up with the trend” toward casual dining. Families eat together less often, he explained, and more people eat alone, either because they are single or they eat in front of television;

 Even dinner parties, if they happen at all, have gone casual. In a time of long work hours and demanding family schedules, busy hosts insist, rightly, that it’s better to share a takeout pizza on paper plates in the family room than to wait for the perfect moment or a “real” dinner party. Too often, the perfect moment never comes. Iron a fine-patterned tablecloth? Forget it. Polish the silver? Who has time?

 Yet the loss of formality has its down side. The fine points of etiquette (礼节) that children might once have learned at the table by observation or instruction from parents and grandparents (“Chew with your mouth closed.” “Keep your elbows off the table.”) must be picked up elsewhere. Some companies now offer etiquette seminars for employees who may be competent professionally but clueless socially.

 31.The trend toward casual dining has resulted in ________.

 A) bankruptcy of fine china manufacturers

 B) shrinking of the pottery industry

 C) restructuring of large enterprises

 D) economic recession in Great BritainB

 32.Which of the following may be the best reason for casual dining?

 A) Family members need more time to relax.

 B) Busy schedules leave people no time for formality.

 C) People want to practice economy in times of scarcity.

 D) Young people won’t follow the etiquette of the older generation.B

 33.It can be learned from the passage that Royal Doulton is ________.

 A) a retailer of stainless steel tableware

 B) a dealer in stoneware

 C) a pottery chain store

 D) a producer of fine chinaD

 34.The main cause of the layoffs in the pottery industry is ________.

 A) the increased value of the pound

 B) the economic recession in Asia

 C) the change in people’s way of life

 D) the fierce competition at home and abroadC

 35.Refined table manners, though less popular than before in current social life ________.

 A) are still a must on certain occasions

 B) axe bound to return sooner or later

 C) are still being taught by parents at home

 D) can help improve personal relationshipsA

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 Some houses are designed to be smart. Others have smart designs. An example of the second type of house won an Award of Excellence from the American Institute of Architects.

 Located on the shore of Sullivan’s Island off the coast of South Carolina, the award-winning cube-shaped beach house was built to replace one smashed to pieces by Hurricane (飓风) Hugo 10 years ago. In September 1989, Hugo struck South Carolina, killing 18 people and damaging or destroying 36,000 homes in the state.

 Before Hugo, many new houses built along South Carolina’s shoreline were poorly constructed, and enforcement of building codes wasn’t strict, according to architect Ray Huff, who created the cleverly-designed beach house. In Hugo’s wake, all new shoreline houses are required to meet stricter, better-enforced codes. The new beach house on Sullivan’s Island should be able to withstand a Category 3 hurricane with peak winds of 179 to 209 kilometers per hour.

 At first sight, the house on Sullivan’s Island looks anything but hurricane-proof. Its redwood shell makes it resemble “a large party lantern (灯笼)” at night, according to one observer. But looks can be deceiving. The house’s wooden frame is reinforced with long steel rods to give it extra strength.

 To further protect the house from hurricane damage, Huff raised it 2.7 meters off the ground on timber pilings—long, slender columns of wood anchored deep in the sand. Pilings might appear insecure, but they are strong enough to support the weight of the house. They also elevate the house above storm surges. The pilings allow the surges to run under the house instead of running into it. “These swells of water come ashore at tremendous speeds and cause most of the damage done to beach-front buildings,” said Huff.

 Huff designed the timber pilings to be partially concealed by the house’s ground-to-roof shell. “The shell masks the pilings so that the house doesn’t look like it’s standing with its pant legs pulled up,” said Huff. In the event of a storm surge, the shell should break apart and let the waves rush under the house, the architect explained.

 36.After the tragedy caused by Hurricane Hugo, new houses built along South Carolina’s shore line are required ________.

 A) to be easily reinforced

 B) to look smarter in design

 C) to meet stricter building standards

 D) to be designed in the shape of cubesC

 37.The award-winning beach house is quite strong because ________.

 A) it is strengthened by steel rods

 B) it is made of redwood

 C) it is in the shape of a shell

 D) it is built with timber and concreteA

 38.Huff raised the house 2.7 meters off the ground on timber pilings in order to ________.

 A) withstand peak winds of about 200 km/hr

 B) anchor stronger pilings deep in the sand

 C) break huge sea waves into smaller ones

 D) prevent water from rushing into the houseD

 39.The main function of the shell is ________.

 A) to strengthen the pilings of the house

 B) to give the house a better appearance

 C) to protect the wooden frame of the house

 D) to slow down the speed of the swelling waterB

 40.It can be inferred from the passage that the shell should be ________.

 A) fancy-looking

 B) waterproof

 C) easily breakable

 D) extremely strongC

Part III Vocabulary (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 41.He asked us to ________ them in carrying through their plan.

 A) provide

 B) arouse

 C) assist

 D) persistC

 42.A good many proposals were raised by the delegates, ________ was to be expected.

 A) that

 B) what

 C) so

 D) asD

 43.He was such a ________ speaker that he held our attention every minute of the three-hour lecture.

 A) specific

 B) dynamic

 C) heroic

 D) diplomaticB

 44.Arriving home, the boy told his parents about all the ________ which occurred in his dormitory.

 A) occasions

 B) matters

 C) incidents

 D) issuesC

 45.The opening between the rocks was very narrow, but the boys managed to ________ through.

 A) press

 B) squeeze

 C) stretch

 D) leapB

 46.They are trying to ________ the waste discharged by the factory for profit.

 A) expose

 B) exhaust

 C) exhibit

 D) exploitD

 47.The manager urged his staff not to ________ the splendid opportunity.

 A) drop

 B) miss

 C) escape

 D) slideB

 48.________ I admire David as a poet, I do not like him as a man.

 A) Much as

 B) Only if

 C) If only

 D) As muchA

 49.Because of a ________ engagement, Lora couldn’t attend my birthday party last Saturday.

 A) pioneer

 B) premature

 C) prior

 D) pastC

 50.The continuous rain ________ the harvesting of the wheat crop by two weeks.

 A) set back

 B) set off

 C) set out

 D) set asideA

 51.Not having a good command of English can be a serious ________ preventing you from achieving your goals.

 A) obstacle

 B) fault

 C) offense

 D) distressA

 52.It’s very ________ of you not to talk aloud while the baby is asleep.

 A) concerned

 B) careful

 C) considerable

 D) considerateD

 53.Many a player who had been highly thought of has ________ from the tennis scene.

 A) disposed

 B) disappeared

 C) discouraged

 D) discardedB

 54.She’s fainted. Throw some water on her face and she’ll ________.

 A) come round

 B) come along

 C) come on

 D) come outA

 55.All their attempts to ________ the child from the burning building were in vain.

 A) regain

 B) recover

 C) rescue

 D) reserveC

 56.Computer technology will ________ a revolution in business administration.

 A) bring around

 B) bring about

 C) bring out

 D) bring upB

 57.The university has launched a research center to develop new ways of ________ bacteria which have become resistant to drug treatments.

 A) regulating

 B) halting

 C) interrupting

 D) combatingD

 58.The ________ goal of the book is to help bridge the gap between research and teaching, particularly the gap between researchers and teachers.

 A) joint

 B) intensive

 C) overall

 D) decisiveC

 59.The rapid development of communications technology is transforming the ________ in which people communicate across time and space.

 A) route

 B) transmission

 C) vision

 D) mannerB

 60.When I go out in the evening I use the bike ________ the car if I can.

 A) rather than

 B) regardless of

 C) in spite of

 D) other thanA

 61.There is no ________ evidence that people can control their dreams, at least in experimental situations in a lab.

 A) rigid

 B) solid

 C) smooth

 D) harshB

 62.Every culture has developed ________ for certain kinds of food and drink, and equally strong negative attitudes toward others.

 A) preferences

 B) expectations

 C) fantasies

 D) fashionsA

 63.It is reported that Uruguay understands and ________ China on human rights issues.

 A) grants

 B) changes

 C) abandons

 D) backsD

 64.Only a few people have ________ to the full facts of the incident.

 A) access

 B) resort

 C) contact

 D) pathA

 65.His trousers ________ when he tried to jump over the fence.

 A) cracked

 B) split

 C) broke

 D) burstB

 66.So far, ________ winds and currents have kept the thick patch of oil southeast of the Atlantic coast.

 A) governing

 B) blowing

 C) prevailing

 D) rulingC

 67.The author was required to submit an ________ of about 200 words together with his research paper.

 A) edition

 B) editorial

 C) article

 D) abstractD

 68.As the old empires were broken up and new states were formed, new official tongues began to ________ at an increasing rate.

 A) bring up

 B) build up

 C) spring up

 D) strike upC

 69.Many patients insist on having watches with them in hospital, ________ they have no schedules to keep.

 A) even though

 B) for

 C) as if

 D) sinceA

 70.Some plants are very ________ to light; they prefer the shade.

 A) sensible

 B) flexible

 C) objective

 D) sensitiveD

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 It’s an annual back-to-school routine. One morning you wave goodbye, and that __71__ evening you’re burning the late-night oil in sympathy. In the race to improve educational standards, __72__ are throwing the books at kids. __73__ elementary school students are complaining of homework __74__. What’s a well-meaning parent to do?

 As hard as __75__ may be, sit back and chill, experts advise. Though you’ve got to get them to do it, __76__ helping too much, or even examining __77__ too carefully, you may keep them __78__ doing it by themselves. “I wouldn’t advise a parent to check every __79__ assignment,” says psychologist John Rosemond, author Of Ending the Tough Homework. “There’s a __80__ of appreciation for trial and error. Let your children __81__ the grade they deserve.”

 Many experts believe parents should gently look over the work of younger children and ask them to rethink their __82__. But “you don’t want them to feel it has to be __83__,” she says.

 That’s not to say parents should __84__ homework—first, they should monitor how much homework their kids __85__. Thirty minutes a day in the early elementary years and an hour in __86__ four, five, and six is standard, says Rosemond. For junior-high students it should be “__87__ mom than an hour and a half,” and two for high-school students. If your child __88__ has mom homework than this, you may want to check __89__ other parents and then talk to the teacher about __90__ assignment

 71.A) very

 B) exact

 C) right

 D) usualA

 72.A) officials

 B) parents

 C) experts

 D) schoolsB

 73.A) Also

 B) Even

 C) Then

 D) HoweverB

 74.A) fatigue

 B) confusion

 C) duty

 D) puzzleA

 75.A) there

 B) we

 C) they

 D) itD

 76.A) via

 B) under

 C) by

 D) forC

 77.A) questions

 B) answers

 C) standards

 D) rulesB

 78.A) off

 B) without

 C) beyond

 D) fromD

 79.A) single

 B) piece

 C) page

 D) otherA

 80.A) drop

 B) short

 C) cut

 D) lackD

 81.A) acquire

 B) earn

 C) gather

 D) reachB

 82.A) exercises

 B) defects

 C) mistakes

 D) testsC

 83.A) perfect

 B) better

 C) unusual

 D) completeA

 84.A) forget

 B) refuse

 C) miss

 D) ignoreD

 85.A) have

 B) prepare

 C) make

 D) performA

 86.A) classes

 B) groups

 C) grades

 D) termsC

 87.A) about

 B) no

 C) much

 D) fewB

 88.A) previously

 B) rarely

 C) merely

 D) consistentlyD

 89.A) with

 B) in

 C) out

 D) upA

 90.A) finishing

 B) lowering

 C) reducing

 D) decliningC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a letter in reply to a friend’s inquiry about applying for admission to your college or university. You should write at least 120 words according to the outline given below in Chinese:

 1.建议报考的专业及理由

 2.报考该专业的基本条件

 3.应当如何备考

A Letter in Reply to a Friend

 December 27th, 2003

 Dear,

 ________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________

200312月四级参考答案

Part I


1.A

2.B

3.A

4.D

5.C

6.B

7.D

8.B

9.C

10.D

11.C

12.A

13.B

14.C

15.B

16.D

17.A

18.C

19.A

20.B


Part II


21.D

22.B

23.C

24.C

25.C

26.D

27.B

28.A

29.D

30.C

31.B

32.B

33.D

34.C

35.A

36.C

37.A

38.D

39.B

40.C


Part III


41.C

42.D

43.B

44.C

45.B

46.D

47.B

48.A

49.C

50.A

51.A

52.D

53.B

54.A

55.C

56.B

57.D

58.C

59.D

60.A

61.B

62.A

63.D

64.A

65.B

66.C

67.D

68.C

69.A

70.D


Part IV


71.A

72.B

73.B

74.A

75.D

76.C

77.B

78.D

79.A

80.D

81.B

82.C

83.A

84.D

85.A

86.C

87.B

88.D

89.A

90.C



2004619日大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the correct answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) The man saw Mark on the street two months ago.

 B) The woman had forgotten Mark’s phone number.

 C) The woman made a phone call to Mark yesterday.

 D) Mark and the woman had not been in touch for some time.D

 2.A) The man is late for the trip because he is busy.

 B) The woman is glad to meet Mr. Brown in person.

 C) The man is meeting the woman on behalf of Mr. Brown.

 D) The woman feels sorry that Mr. Brown is unable to come.C

 3.A) At 10:30.

 B) At 10:25.

 C) At 10:40.

 D) At 10:45.C

 4.A) The man no longer smokes.

 B) The man is under pressure from his wife.

 C) The man usually follows his wife’s advice.

 D) The man refuses to listen to his doctor’s advice.A

 5.A) Move to a big city.

 B) Become a teacher.

 C) Go back to school.

 D) Work in New York.C

 6.A) Quit delivering flowers.

 B) Work at a restaurant.

 C) Bring her flowers every day.

 D) Leave his job to work for her.D

 7.A) She can find the right person to help the man.

 B) She can help the man out.

 C) She’s also in need of a textbook.

 D) She picked up the book from the bus floor.B

 8.A) The man was confused about the date of the appointment.

 B) The man wants to change the date of the appointment.

 C) The man is glad he’s got in touch with the doctor.

 D) The man can’t come for the appointment at 4:15.A

 9.A) The two speakers are at a loss what to do.

 B) The man is worried about his future.

 C) The two speakers are seniors at college.

 D) The woman regrets spending her time idly.C

 10.A) She has learned a lot from the novel.

 B) She also found the plot difficult to follow.

 C) She usually has difficulty remembering names.

 D) She can recall the names of most characters in the novel.C

Section B Compound Dictation

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from SI to S7 with the exact words you have just heard. For blanks numbered from S8 to S10 you are required to fill in the missing information. You can either use the exact words you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

 The Library of Congress is America’s national library. It has millions of books and other objects. It has newspapers, (S1) ________ publications as well as letters of (S2) ________ interest. It also has maps, photographs, art (S3) ________, movies, sound recordings and musical (S4) ________. All together, it has more than 100 million objects.

 The Library of Congress is open to the public Monday through Saturday, except for public holidays. Anyone may go there and read anything in the collection. But no one is (S5) ________ to take books out of the building.

 The Library of Congress was (S6) ________ in 1800. It started with eleven boxes of books in one room of the Capitol building. By 1814, the collection had increased to about 3,000 books. They were all (S7) ________ that year when the Capitol was burned down during America’s war with Britain.

 To help re-build the library, Congress bought the books of President Thomas Jefferson. Mr. Jefferson’s collection included 7,000 books in seven languages.

 (S8) ________. Today, three buildings hold the library’s collection.

 (S9) ________. It buys some of its books and gets others as gifts. It also gets materials through its copyright office. (S10) ________. This means the Library of Congress receives almost everything that is published in the United States.

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 15 are based on the following passage.

 A is for always getting to work on time.

 B is for being extremely busy.

 C is for the conscientious (勤勤恳恳的) way you do your job.

 You may be all these things at the office, and more. But when it comes to getting ahead, experts say, the ABCs of business should include a P, for politics, as in office politics.

 Dale Carnegie suggested as much more than 50 years ago: Hard work alone doesn’t ensure career advancement. You have to be able to sell yourself and your ideas, both publicly and behind the scenes. Yet, despite the obvious rewards of engaging in office politics—a better job, a raise, praise—many people are still unable—or unwilling—to “play the game.”

 “People assume that office politics involves some manipulative (工于心计的) behavior,” says Deborah Comer, an assistant professor of management at Hofstra University. “But politics derives from the word ‘polite’. It can mean lobbying and forming associations. It can mean being kind and helpful, or even trying to please your superior, and then expecting something in return.”

 In fact, today, experts define office politics as proper behavior used to pursue one’s own self-interest in the workplace. In many cases, this involves some form Of Socializing within the office environment—not just in large companies, but in small workplaces as well.

 “The first thing people are usually judged on is their ability to perform well on a consistent basis,’” says Neil P Lewis, a management psychologist. “But if two or three candidates are up for a promotion, each of whom has reasonably similar ability, a manager is going to promote the person he or she likes best. It’s simple human nature.”

 Yet, psychologists say, many employees and employers have trouble with the concept of politics in the office. Some people, they say, have an idealistic vision of work and what it takes to succeed. Still others associate politics with flattery (奉承), fearful that, if they speak up for themselves, they may appear to be flattering their boss for favors.

 Experts suggest altering this negative picture by recognizing the need for some self-promotion.

 11.“Office politics” (Line 2, Para. 4) is used in the passage to refer to ________.

 A) the code of behavior for company staff

 B) the political views and beliefs of office workers

 C) the interpersonal relationships within a company

 D) the various qualities required for a successful careerC

 12.To get promoted, one must not only be competent but ________.

 A) give his boss a good impression

 B) honest and loyal to his company

 C) get along well with his colleagues

 D) avoid being too outstandingD

 13.Why are many people unwilling to “play the game” (Line 4, Para. 5)?

 A) They believe that doing so is impractical.

 B) They feel that such behavior is unprincipled.

 C) They are not good at manipulating colleagues.

 D) They think the effort will get them nowhere.B

 14.The author considers office politics to be ________.

 A) unwelcome at the workplace

 B) bad for interpersonal relationships

 C) indispensable to the development of company culture

 D) an important factor for personal advancementD

 15.It is the author’s view that ________.

 A) speaking up for oneself is part of human nature

 B) self-promotion does not necessarily mean flattery

 C) hard work contributes very little to one’s promotion

 D) many employees fail to recognize the need of flatteryB

Passage Two

Questions 16 to 20 are based on the following passage.

 As soon as it was revealed that a reporter for Progressive magazine had discovered how to make a hydrogen bomb, a group of firearm (火器) fans formed the National Hydrogen Bomb Association, and they are now lobbying against any legislation to stop Americans from owning one.

 “The Constitution,” said the association’s spokesman, “gives everyone the right to own arms. It doesn’t spell out what kind of arms. But since anyone can now make a hydrogen bomb, the public should be able to buy it to protect themselves.”

 “Don’t you think it’s dangerous to have one in the house, particularly where there are children around?”

 “The National Hydrogen Bomb Association hopes to educate people in the safe handling of this type of weapon. We are instructing owners to keep the bomb in a locked cabinet and thefuse(导火索) separately in a drawer.”

 “Some people consider the hydrogen bomb a very fatal weapon which could kill somebody.”

 The spokesman said, “Hydrogen bombs don’t kill people—people kill people. The bomb is for self-protection and it also has a deterrent effect. If somebody knows you have a nuclear weapon in your house, they’re going to think twice about breaking in.”

 “But those who want to ban the bomb for American citizens claim that if you have one locked in the cabinet, with the fuse in a drawer, you would never be able to assemble it in time to stop an intruder (侵入者).”

 “Another argument against allowing people to own a bomb is that at the moment it is very expensive to build one. So what your association is backing is a program which would allow the middle and upper classes to acquire a bomb while poor people will be left defenseless with just handguns.”

 16.According to the passage, some people started a national association so as to ________.

 A) block any legislation to ban the private possession of the bomb

 B) coordinate the mass production of the destructive weapon

 C) instruct people how to keep the bomb safe at home

 D) promote the large-scale sale of this newly invented weaponA

 17.Some people oppose the ownership of H-bombs by individuals on the grounds that ________.

 A) the size of the bomb makes it difficult to keep in a drawer

 B) most people don’t know how to handle the weapon

 C) people’s lives will be threatened by the weapon

 D) they may fall into the hands of criminalsC

 18.By saying that the bomb also has a deterrent effect the spokesman means that it ________.

 A) will frighten away any possible intruders

 B) can show the special status of its owners

 C) will threaten the safety of the owners as well

 D) can kill those entering others’ houses by forceA

 19.According to the passage, opponents of the private ownership of H-bombs are very much worried that ________.

 A) the influence of the association is too powerful for the less privileged to overcome

 B) poorly-educated Americans will find it difficult to make use of the weapon

 C) the wide use of the weapon will push up living expenses tremendously

 D) the cost of the weapon will put citizens on an unequal basisD

 20.From the tone of the passage we know that the author is ________.

 A) doubtful about the necessity of keeping H-bombs at home for safety

 B) unhappy with those who vote against the ownership of H-bombs

 C) not serious about the private ownership of H-bombs

 D) concerned about the spread of nuclear weaponsA

Passage Three

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Sign has become a scientific hot button. Only in the past 20 years have specialists in language study realized that signed languages are unique—a speech of the hand. They offer a new way to probe how the brain generates and understands language, and throw new light on an old scientific controversy: whether language, complete with grammar, is something that we are born With, or whether it is a learned behavior. The current interest in sign language has roots in the pioneering work of one rebel teacher at Gallaudet University in Washington, D. C., the world’s only liberal arts university for deaf people.

 When Bill Stokoe went to Gallaudet to teach English, the school enrolled him in a course in signing. But Stokoe noticed something odd: among themselves, students signed differently from his classroom teacher.

 Stokoe had been taught a sort of gestural code, each movement of the hands representing a word in English. At the time, American Sign Language (ASL) was thought to be no more than a form of pidgin English (混杂英语). But Stokoe believed the “hand talk” his students used looked richer. He wondered: Might deaf people actually: have a genuine language? And could that language be unlike any other on Earth? It was 1955, when even deaf people dismissed their signing as “substandard”. Stokoe’s idea was academic heresy (异端邪说).

 It is 37 years later. Stokoe—now devoting his time to writing and editing books and journals and to producing video materials on ASL and the deaf culture—is having lunch at a cafe near the Gallaudet campus and explaining how he started a revolution. For decades educators fought his idea that signed languages are natural languages like English, French and Japanese. They assumed language must be based on speech, the modulation (调节) of sound. But sign language is based on the movement of hands, the modulation of space. “What I said,” Stokoe explains, “is that language is not mouth stuff—it’s brain stuff.”

 21.The study of sign language is thought to be ________.

 A) a new way to look at the learning of language

 B) a challenge to traditional, views on the nature of language

 C) an approach: to simplifying the grammatical structure of a language

 D) an attempt to clarify misunderstanding about the origin of languageC

 22.The, present growing interest in sign language was stimulated by ________.

 A) a famous scholar in the study of the human brain

 B) a leading specialist in the study of liberal arts

 C) an English teacher in a university for the deaf

 D) some senior experts in American Sign LanguageC

 23.According to Stokoe, sign language is ________.

 A) a Substandard language

 B) a genuine language

 C) an artificial language

 D) an international languageB

 24.Most educators objected to Stokoe’s idea because they thought ________.

 A) sign language was not extensively used even by deaf people

 B) sign language was too artificial to be widely accepted

 C) a language should be easy to use and understand

 D) a language could only exist in the form of speech soundsD

 25.Stokoe’s argument is based on his belief that ________.

 A) sign language is as efficient as any other language

 B) sign language is derived from natural language

 C) language is a system of meaningful codes

 D) language is a product of the brainD

Passage Four

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 It came as something of a surprise when Diana, Princess of Wales, made a trip to Angola in 1997, to support the Red Cross’s campaign for a total ban on all anti-personnel landmines. Within hours of arriving in Angola, television screens around the World were filled with images of her comforting victims injured in explosions caused by landmines. “I knew the statistics,” she said. “But putting a face to those figures brought the reality home to me; like When I met Sandra, a 13-year-old girl who had lost her leg, and people like her.”

 The Princess concluded, with a simple message: “We must stop landmines”. And she used every opportunity during her visit to repeat this message.

 But, back in London, her views were not shared by some members of the British government, which refused to support a ban on these weapons. Angry politicians launched an, attack on the Princess in the press. They described her as “very ill-informed” and a “loose cannon (乱放炮的人).”

 The Princess responded by brushing aside the criticisms: “This is a distraction (干扰) we do not need. All I’m trying to do is help.”

 Opposition parties, the media and the Public immediately voiced their support for the Princess. To make matters worse for the government, it soon emerged that the Princess’s trip had been approved by the Foreign Office, and that she was in fact very well-informed about both the situation in Angola and the British government’s policy regarding landmines. The result was a severe embarrassment for the government.

 To try and limit the damage, the Foreign Secretary, Malcolm Rifkind, claimed that the Princess’s views on landmines were not very different from government policy, and that it was “working towards” a worldwide ban. The Defense Secretary, Michael Portillo, claimed the matter was “a misinterpretation or misunderstanding.”

 For the Princess, the trip to this war-torn country was an excellent opportunity to use her popularity to show the world how much destruction and suffering landmines can cause. She said that the experience had also given her the Chance to get closer to people and their problems.

 26.Princess Diana paid a visit to Angola in 1997 ________.

 A) to voice her support for a total ban of landmines

 B) to clarify the British government’s stand on landmines

 C) to investigate the sufferings of landmine victims there

 D) to establish her image as a friend of landmine victimsA

 27.What did Diana mean when she said “... putting a face to those figures brought the reality home to me” (Line 5, Para. 1)?

 A) She just couldn’t bear to meet the landmine victims face to face.

 B) The actual situation in Angola made her feel like going back home.

 C) Meeting the landmine victims in person made her believe the statistics.

 D) Seeing the pain of the victims made her realize the seriousness of the situation.D

 28.Some members of the British government criticized Diana because ________.

 A) she was ill-informed of the government’s policy

 B) they were actually opposed to banning landmines

 C) she had not consulted the government before the visit

 D) they believed that she had misinterpreted the situation in AngolaB

 29.How did Diana respond to the criticisms?

 A) She paid no attention to them.

 B) She made more appearances on TV.

 C) She met the 13-year-old girl as planned.

 D) She rose to argue with her opponents.A

 30.What did Princess Diana think of her visit to Angola?

 A) It had caused embarrassment to the British government.

 B) It had brought her closer to the ordinary people.

 C) It had greatly promoted her popularity.

 D) It had affected her relations with the British government.B

Part III Vocabulary and Structure (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 31.I went along thinking of nothing ________, only looking at things around me,

 A) in particular

 B) in harmony

 C) in doubt

 D) in briefA

 32.Critics believe that the control of television by mass advertising has ________ the quality of the programs.

 A) lessened

 B) declined

 C) affected

 D) effectedC

 33.I must congratulate you ________ the excellent design of the new bridge.

 A) with

 B) of

 C) at

 D) onD

 34.There is a fully ________ health center on the ground floor of the main office building.

 A) installed

 B) equipped

 C) provided

 D) projectedB

 35.For more than 20 years, we’ve been supporting educational programs that ________ from kindergartens to colleges.

 A) move

 B) shift

 C) range

 D) spreadC

 36.The ________ at the military academy is so rigid that students can hardly bear it.

 A) convention

 B) confinement

 C) principle

 D) disciplineD

 37.The test results are beyond ________; they have been repeated in labs all over the world.

 A) negotiation

 B) conflict

 C) bargain

 D) disputeD

 38.I was so ________ in today’s history lesson. I didn’t understand a thing.

 A) amazed

 B) neglected

 C) confused

 D) amusedC

 39.It ________ you to at least 50% off the regular price of either frames or lenses when you buy both.

 A) presents

 B) entitles

 C) credits

 D) tipsB

 40.Deserts and high mountains have always been a ________ to the movement of people from place to place.

 A) barrier

 B) fence

 C) prevention

 D) jamA

 41.In order to make things convenient for the people, the department is planning to set up some ________ shops in the residential area.

 A) flowing

 B) drifting

 C) mobile

 D) unstableC

 42.Mr. Smith says: “The media are very good at sensing a mood and then ________ it.”

 A) overtaking

 B) enlarging

 C) widening

 D) exaggeratingD

 43.This is not an economical way to get more water; ________, it is very expensive.

 A) on the other hand

 B) on the contrary

 C) in short

 D) or elseB

 44.It was the first time that such a ________ had to be taken at a British nuclear power station.

 A) presentation

 B) precaution

 C) preparation

 D) predictionB

 45.________ that he wasn’t happy with the arrangements, I tried to book a different hotel.

 A) Perceiving

 B) Penetrating

 C) Puzzling

 D) PreservingA

 46.The board of the company has decided to ________ its operations to include all aspects of the clothing business.

 A) multiply

 B) lengthen

 C) expand

 D) stretchC

 47.His business was very successful, but it was at the ________ of his family life.

 A) consumption

 B) credit

 C) exhaustion

 D) expenseD

 48.First published in 1927, the charts remain an ________ source for researchers.

 A) identical

 B) indispensable

 C) intelligent

 D) inevitableB

 49.Joe is not good at sports, but when it ________ mathematics, he is the ‘best in the class.

 A) comes to

 B) comes up to

 C) comes on to

 D) comes around toA

 50.Doctors warned against chewing tobacco as a ________ for smoking.

 A) relief

 B) revival

 C) substitute

 D) successionC

 51.When carbon is added to iron in proper ________ the result is steel.

 A) rates

 B) thicknesses

 C) proportions

 D) densitiesC

 52.You should try to ________ your ambition and be more realistic.

 A) reserve

 B) restrain

 C) retain

 D) replaceB

 53.Nancy is only a sort of ________ of her husband’s opinion and has no ideas of her own.

 A) sample

 B) reproduction

 C) shadow

 D) echoD

 54.Now that spring is here, you can ________ these fur coats till you need them again next winter.

 A) put over

 B) put away

 C) put off

 D) put downB

 55.There is a ________ of impatience in the tone of his voice.

 A) hint

 B) notion

 C) dot

 D) phraseA

 56.Please ________ dictionaries when you are not sure of word spelling or meaning.

 A) seek

 B) inquire

 C) search

 D) consultD

 57.At yesterday’s party, Elizabeth’s boyfriend amused us by ________ Charlie Chaplin.

 A) copying

 B) following

 C) imitating

 D) modelingC

 58.She keeps a supply of candles in the house in case of power ________.

 A) failure

 B) lack

 C) absence

 D) dropA

 59.The group of technicians are engaged in a study which ________ all aspects of urban planning.

 A) inserts

 B) grips

 C) performs

 D) embracesD

 60.The lecture which lasted about three hours was so ________ that the audience couldn’t help yawning.

 A) tedious

 B) bored

 C) clumsy

 D) tiredA

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Historians tend to tell the same joke when they are describing history education in America. It’s the one __61__ the teacher standing in the schoolroom door __62__ goodbye to students for the summer and calling __63__ them, “By the way, we won World War II.”

 The problem with the joke, of course, is that it’s __64__ funny. The recent surveys on __65__ illiteracy (无知) are beginning to numb (令人震惊): nearly one third of American 17-year-olds cannot even __66__ which countries the United States __67__ against in that war. One third have no __68__ when the Declaration of Independence was __69__. One third thought Columbus reached the New World after 1750. Two thirds cannot correctly __70__ the Civil War between 1850 and 1900. __71__ when they get the answers right, some are __72__ guessing.

 Unlike math or science, ignorance of history cannot be __73__ connected to loss of international __74__. But it does affect our future __75__ a democratic nation and as individuals.

 The __76__ news is that there is growing agreement __77__ what is wrong with the __78__ of history and what needs to be __79__ to fix it. The steps are tentative (尝试性) __80__ yet to be felt in most classrooms.

 61.A) about

 B) in

 C) for

 D) byA

 62.A) shaking

 B) waving

 C) nodding

 D) speakingB

 63.A) in

 B) after

 C) for

 D) upB

 64.A) rarely

 B) so

 C) too

 D) notD

 65.A) historical

 B) educational

 C) cultural

 D) politicalA

 66.A) distinguish

 B) acknowledge

 C) identify

 D) conveyC

 67.A) defeated

 B) attacked

 C) fought

 D) struckC

 68.A) sense

 B) doubt

 C) reason

 D) ideaD

 69.A) printed

 B) signed

 C) marked

 D) editedB

 70.A) place

 B) judge

 C) get

 D) lockB

 71.A) Even

 B) Though

 C) Thus

 D) SoA

 72.A) hardly

 B) just

 C) still

 D) everB

 73.A) exclusively

 B) practically

 C) shortly

 D) directlyD

 74.A) competitiveness

 B) comprehension

 C) community

 D) commitmentC

 75.A) of

 B) for

 C) with

 D) asD

 76.A) fine

 B) nice

 C) surprising

 D) goodD

 77.A) to

 B) with

 C) on

 D) ofC

 78.A) consulting

 B) coaching

 C) teaching

 D) instructingC

 79.A) done

 B) dealt

 C) met

 D) reachedA

 80.A) therefore

 B) or

 C) and

 D) asB

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a composition entitled A BriefIntroduction to a Tourist Attraction. You should write at least 120 words according to the following guidelines:

 Your role: a tour guide

 Your audience: a group of foreign tourists

 Your introduction should include:

  some welcoming words

  the schedule for the day

  a description of the place the tourists will be visiting (e.g. a scenic spot or a historical site, etc.)

 You should make the introduction interesting and the arrangements for the day clear to everybody.

A Brief Introduction to a Tourist Attraction

2004619日四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.C

3.C

4.A

5.C

6.D

7.B

8.A

9.C

10.C


Part II


11.C

12.D

13.B

14.D

15.B

16.A

17.C

18.A

19.D

20.A

21.C

22.C

23.B

24.D

25.D

26.A

27.D

28.B

29.A

30.B


Part III


31.A

32.C

33.D

34.B

35.C

36.D

37.D

38.C

39.B

40.A

41.C

42.D

43.B

44.B

45.A

46.C

47.D

48.B

49.A

50.C

51.C

52.B

53.D

54.B

55.A

56.D

57.C

58.A

59.D

60.A


Part IV


61.A

62.B

63.B

64.D

65.A

66.C

67.C

68.D

69.B

70.B

71.A

72.B

73.D

74.C

75.D

76.D

77.C

78.C

79.A

80.B



 S1.popular S2 historical S3 prints S4 instruments

 S5.permitted S6 established S7 destroyed

 S8.In 1897, the library moved into its own building across the street from the Capitol.

 S9.The library provides books and materials to the US Congress and also lends books to other American libraries, government agencies and foreign libraries.

 S10.Anyone who wants copyright protection for a publication in the US must send two copies to the library.

20051月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they will start at 9 o’clock in the morning and have to finish at 2 in the afternoon. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the center.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) The man enjoys traveling by car.

 B) The man lives far from the subway.

 C) The man is good at driving.

 D) The man used to own a car.D

 2.A) Tony should continue taking the course.

 B) She approves of Tony’s decision.

 C) Tony can choose another science course.

 D) She can’t meet Tony so early in the morning.A

 3.A) She has to study for the exam.

 B) She is particularly interested in plays.

 C) She’s eager to watch the new play.

 D) She can lend her notes to the man.A

 4.A) They will be replaced by on-line education sooner or later.

 B) They will attract fewer kids as on-line education expands.

 C) They will continue to exist along with on-line education.

 D) They will limit their teaching to certain subjects only.C

 5.A) Most students would like to work for a newspaper.

 B) Most students find a job by reading advertisements.

 C) Most students find it hard to get a job after they graduate.

 D) Most students don’t want jobs advertised in the newspapers.B

 6.A) Move the washing machine to the basement.

 B) Turn the basement into a workshop.

 C) Repair the washing machine.

 D) Finish his assignment.D

 7.A) Some students at the back cannot hear the professor.

 B) The professor has changed his reading assignment.

 C) Some of the students are not on the professor’s list.

 D) The professor has brought extra copies of his assignment.C

 8.A) She doesn’t want to talk about the contest.

 B) She’s modest about her success in the contest.

 C) She’s spent two years studying English in Canada.

 D) She’s very proud of her success in the speech contest.B

 9.A) Talking about sports.

 B) Writing up local news.

 C) Reading newspapers.

 D) Putting up advertisements.C

 10.A) They shouldn’t change their plan.

 B) They’d better change their mind.

 C) The tennis game won’t last long.

 D) Weather forecasts are not reliable.A

Section B Compound Dictation

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from SI to S7 with the exact words you have just heard. For blanks numbered from S8 to S10 you are required to fill in the missing information. You can either use the exact words you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

 There are a lot of good cameras available at the moment—most of these are made in Japan but there are also good (S1) ________ models from Germany and the USA. We have (S2) ________ a range of different models to see which is the best (S3) ________ for money. After a number of different tests and interviews with people who are (S4) ________ with the different cameras being assessed, our researchers (S5) ________ the Olympic BY model as the best auto-focus camera available at the moment. It costs $200 although you may well want to spend more—(S6) ________ as much as another $200—on buying (S7) ________ lenses and other equipment. It is a good Japanese camera, easy to use. (S8) ________ whereas the American versions are considerably more expensive.

 The Olympic BY model weighs only 320 grams which is quite a bit less than other cameras of a similar type. Indeed one of the other models we looked at weighed almost twice as much. (S9) ________. All the people we interviewed expressed almost total satisfaction with it. (S10) ________.

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 15 are based on the following passage.

 Scratchy throats, stuffy noses and body aches all spell misery, but being able to tell if the cause is a cold or flu (流感) may make a difference in how long the misery lasts.

 The American Lung Association (ALA) has issued new guidelines on combating colds and the flu, and one of the keys is being able to quickly tell the two apart. That’s because the prescription drugs available for the flu need to be taken soon after the illness sets in. As for colds, the sooner a person starts taking over-the-counter remedy, the sooner relief will come.

 The common cold and the flu are both caused by viruses. More than 200 viruses can cause cold symptoms, while the flu is caused by three viruses—flu A, B and C. There is no cure for either illness, but the flu can be prevented by the flu vaccine (疫苗), which is, for most people, the best way to fight the flu, according to the ALA.

 But if the flu does strike, quick action can help. Although the flu and common cold have many similarities, there are some obvious signs to look for.

 Cold symptoms such as stuffy nose, runny nose and scratchy throat typically develop gradually, and adults and teens often do not get a fever. On the other hand, fever is one of the characteristic features of the flu for all ages. And in general, flu symptoms including fever and chills, sore throat and body aches come on suddenly and are more severe than cold symptoms.

 The ALA notes that it may be particularly difficult to tell when infants and preschool age children have the flu. It advises parents to call the doctor if their small children have flu-like symptoms.

 Both cold and flu symptoms can be eased with over-the-counter medications as well. However, children and teens with a cold or flu should not take aspirin for pain relief because of the risk of Reye syndrome (综合症)a rare but serious condition of the liver and central nervous system.

 There is, of course, no vaccine for the common cold. But frequent hand washing and avoiding close contact with people who have colds can reduce the likelihood of catching one.

 11.According to the author, knowing the cause of the misery will help ________.

 A) shorten the duration of the illness

 B) the patient buy medicine over the counter

 C) the patient obtain cheaper prescription drugs

 D) prevent people from catching colds and the fluA

 12.We learn from the passage that ________.

 A) one doesn’t need to take any medicine if he has a cold or the flu

 B) aspirin should not be included in over-the-counter medicines for the flu

 C) delayed treatment of the flu will harm the liver and central nervous system

 D) over-the-counter drugs can be taken to ease the misery caused by a cold or the fluD

 13.According to the passage, to combat the flu effectively, ________.

 A) one should identify the virus which causes it

 B) one should consult a doctor as soon as possible

 C) one should take medicine upon catching the disease

 D) one should remain alert when the disease is spreadingC

 14.Which of the following symptoms will distinguish the flu from a cold?

 A) A stuffy nose.

 B) A high temperature.

 C) A sore throat.

 D) A dry cough.B

 15.If children have flu-like symptoms, their parents ________.

 A) are advised not to give them aspirin

 B) should watch out for signs of Reye syndrome

 C) are encouraged to take them to hospital for vaccination

 D) should prevent them from mixing with people running a feverA

Passage Two

Questions 16 to 20 are based on the following passage.

 In a time of low academic achievement by children in the United States, many Americans are turning to Japan, a country of high academic achievement and economic success, for possible answers. However, the answers provided by Japanese preschools are not the ones Americans expected to find. In most Japanese preschools, surprisingly little emphasis is put on academic instruction. In one investigation, 300 Japanese and 210 American preschool teachers, child development specialists, and parents were asked about various aspects of early childhood education. Only 2 percent of the Japanese respondents (答问卷者) listed “to give children a good start academically” as one of their top three reasons for a society to have preschools. In contrast, over half the American respondents chose this as one of their top three choices. To prepare children for successful careers in first grade and beyond, Japanese schools do not teach reading, writing, and mathematics, but rather skills such as persistence, concentration, and the ability to function as a member of a group. The vast majority of young Japanese children are taught to read at home by their parents.

 In the recent comparison of Japanese and American preschool education, 91 percent of Japanese respondents chose providing children with a group experience as one of their top three reasons for a society to have preschools. Sixty-two percent of the more individually oriented (强调个性发展的) Americans listed group experience as one of their top three choices. An emphasis on the importance of the group seen in Japanese early childhood education continues into elementary school education.

 Like in America, there is diversity in Japanese early childhood education. Some Japanese kindergartens have specific aims, such as early musical training or potential development. In large cities, some kindergartens are attached to universities that have elementary and secondary schools. Some Japanese parents believe that if their young children attend a university-based program, it will increase the children’s chances of eventually being admitted to top-rated schools and universities. Several more progressive programs have introduced free play as a way out for the heavy intellectualizing in some Japanese kindergartens.

 16.We learn from the first paragraph that many Americans believe ________.

 A) Japanese parents are more involved in preschool education than American parents

 B) Japan’s economic success is a result of its scientific achievements

 C) Japanese preschool education emphasizes academic instruction

 D) Japan’s higher education is superior to theirsC

 17.Most Americans surveyed believe that preschools should also attach importance to ________.

 A) problem solving

 B) group experience

 C) parental guidance

 D) individually-oriented developmentB

 18.In Japan’s preschool education, the focus is on ________.

 A) preparing children academically

 B) developing children’s artistic interests

 C) tapping children’s potential

 D) shaping children’s characterD

 19.Free play has been introduced in some Japanese kindergartens in order to ________.

 A) broaden children’s horizon

 B) cultivate children’s creativity

 C) lighten children’s study load

 D) enrich children’s knowledgeC

 20.Why do some Japanese parents send their children to university-based kindergartens?

 A) They can do better in their future studies.

 B) They can accumulate more group experience there.

 C) They can be individually oriented when they grow up.

 D) They can have better chances of getting a first-rate education.D

Passage Three

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Lead deposits, which accumulated in soil and snow during the 1960’s and 70’s, were primarily the result of leaded gasoline emissions originating in the United States. In the twenty years that the Clean Air Act has mandated unleaded gas use in the United States, the lead accumulation worldwide has decreased significantly.

 A study published recently in the journal Nature shows that air-borne leaded gas emissions from the United States were the leading contributor to the high concentration of lead in the snow in Greenland. The new study is a result of the continued research led by Dr. Charles Boutron, an expert on the impact of heavy metals on the environment at the National Center for Scientific Research in France. A study by Dr. Boutron published in 1991 showed that lead levels in arctic (北极的) snow were declining.

 In his new study, Dr. Boutron found the ratios of the different forms of lead in the leaded gasoline used in the United States were different from the ratios of European, Asian and Canadian gasolines and thus enabled scientists to differentiate (区分) the lead sources. The dominant lead ratio found in Greenland snow matched that found in gasoline from the United States.

 In a study published in the journal Ambio, scientists found that lead levels in soil in the Northeastern United States had decreased markedly since the introduction of unleaded gasoline.

 Many scientists had believed that the lead would stay in soil and snow for a longer period.

 The authors of the Ambio study examined samples of the upper layers of soil taken from the same sites of 30 forest floors in New England, New York and Pennsylvania in 1980 and in 1990. The forest environment processed and redistributed the lead faster than the scientists had expected.

 Scientists say both studies demonstrate that certain parts of the ecosystem (生态系统) respond rapidly to reductions in atmospheric pollution, but that these findings should not be used as a license to pollute.

 21.The study published in the journal Nature indicates that ________.

 A) the Clean Air Act has not produced the desired results

 B) lead deposits in arctic snow are on the increase

 C) lead will stay in soil and snow longer than expected

 D) the US is the major source of lead pollution in arctic snowD

 22.Lead accumulation worldwide decreased significantly after the use of unleaded gas in the US ________.

 A) was discouraged

 B) was enforced by law

 C) was prohibited by law

 D) was introducedB

 23.How did scientists discover the source of lead pollution in Greenland?

 A) By analyzing the data published in journals like Nature and Ambio.

 B) By observing the lead accumulations in different parts of the arctic area.

 C) By studying the chemical elements of soil and snow in Northeastern America.

 D) By comparing the chemical compositions of leaded gasoline used in various countries.D

 24.The authors of the Ambio study have found that ________.

 A) forests get rid of lead pollution faster than expected

 B) lead accumulations in forests are more difficult to deal with

 C) lead deposits are widely distributed in the forests of the US

 D) the upper layers of soil in forests are easily polluted by lead emissionsA

 25.It can be inferred from the last paragraph that scientists ________.

 A) are puzzled by the mystery of forest pollution

 B) feel relieved by the use of unleaded gasoline

 C) still consider lead pollution a problem

 D) lack sufficient means to combat lead pollutionC

Passage Four

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 Exercise is one of the few factors with a positive role in long-term maintenance of body weight. Unfortunately, that message has not gotten through to the average American, who would rather try switching to “light” beer and low-calorie bread than increase physical exertion. The Centers for Disease Control, for example, found that fewer than one-fourth of overweight adults who were trying to shed pounds said they were combining exercise with their diet.

 In rejecting exercise, some people may be discouraged too much by caloric-expenditure charts: for example, one would have to briskly walk three miles just to work off the 275 calories in one delicious Danish pastry (小甜饼). Even exercise professionals concede half a point here. “Exercise by itself is a very tough way to lose weight,” says York Onnen, program director of the President’s Council on Physical Fitness and Sports.

 Still, exercise’s supporting role in weight reduction is vital. A study at the Boston University Medical Center of overweight police officers and other public employees confirmed that those who dieted without exercise regained almost all their old weight, while those who worked exercise into their daily routine maintained their new weight.

 If you have been sedentary (极少活动的) and decide to start walking one mile a day, the added exercise could burn an extra 100 calories daily. In a year’s time, assuming no increase in food intake, you could lose ten pounds. By increasing the distance of your walks gradually and making other dietary adjustments, you may lose even more weight.

 26.What is said about the average American in the passage?

 A) They tend to exaggerate the healthful effect of “light” beer.

 B) They usually ignore the effect of exercise on losing weight.

 C) They prefer “light” beer and low-calorie bread to other drinks and food.

 D) They know the factors that play a positive role in keeping down body weight.B

 27.Some people dislike exercise because ________.

 A) they think it is physically exhausting

 B) they find it hard to exercise while on a diet

 C) they don’t think it possible to walk 3 miles every day

 D) they find consulting caloric-expenditure charts troublesomeB

 28.“Even exercise professionals concede half a point here” (Line 3, Para. 2) means “They ________”.

 A) agree that the calories in a small piece of pastry can be difficult to work off by exercise

 B) partially believe diet plays a supporting role in weight reduction

 C) are not fully convinced that dieting can help maintain one’s new weight

 D) are not sufficiently informed of the positive role of exercise in losing weightB

 29.What was confirmed by the Boston University Medical Center’s study?

 A) Controlling one’s calorie intake is more important than doing exercise.

 B) Even occasional exercise can help reduce weight.

 C) Weight reduction is impossible without exercise.

 D) One could lose ten pounds in a year’s time if there’s no increase in food intake.C

 30.What is the author’s purpose in writing this article?

 A) To justify the study of the Boston University Medical Center.

 B) To stress the importance of maintaining proper weight.

 C) To support the statement made by York Onnen.

 D) To show the most effective way to lose weight.D

Part III Vocabulary (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences in this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose the ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 31.The machine looked like a large, ________, old-fashioned typewriter.

 A) forceful

 B) clumsy

 C) intense

 D) trickyB

 32.Though she began her ________ by singing in a local pop group, she is now a famous Hollywood movie star.

 A) employment

 B) career

 C) occupation

 D) professionB

 33.Within two weeks of arrival, all foreigners had to ________ with the local police.

 A) inquire

 B) consult

 C) register

 D) resolveC

 34.Considering your salary, you should be able to ________ at least twenty dollars a week.

 A) put forward

 B) put up

 C) put out

 D) put asideD

 35.As he has ________ our patience, we’ll not wait for him any longer.

 A) torn

 B) wasted

 C) exhausted

 D) consumedC

 36.These teachers try to be objective when they ________ the integrated ability of their students.

 A) justify

 B) evaluate

 C) indicate

 D) reckonB

 37.Mrs. Morris’s daughter is pretty and ________, and many girls envy her.

 A) slender

 B) light

 C) faint

 D) minorA

 38.Tomorrow the mayor is to ________ a group of Canadian businessmen on a tour of the city.

 A) coordinate

 B) cooperate

 C) accompany

 D) associateC

 39.I’m ________ enough to know it is going to be a very difficult situation to compete against three strong teams.

 A) realistic

 B) conscious

 C) aware

 D) radicalB

 40.Can you give me even the ________ clue as to where her son might be?

 A) simplest

 B) slightest

 C) least

 D) utmostB

 41.Norman Davis will be remembered by many with ________ not only as a great scholar but also as a most delightful and faithful friend.

 A) kindness

 B) friendliness

 C) warmth

 D) affectionD

 42.Salaries for ________ positions seem to be higher than for permanent ones.

 A) legal

 B) optional

 C) voluntary

 D) temporaryD

 43.Most people agree that the present role of women has already affected U.S. society. ________, it has affected the traditional role of men.

 A) Above all

 B) In all

 C) At most

 D) At lastA

 44.Science and technology have ________ in important ways to the improvement of agricultural production.

 A) attached

 B) assisted

 C) contributed

 D) witnessedC

 45.As an actor he could communicate a whole ________ of emotions.

 A) frame

 B) range

 C) number

 D) scaleB

 46.This is what you should bear in mind: Don’t ________ a salary increase before you actually get it.

 A) hang on

 B) draw on

 C) wait on

 D) count onD

 47.The ship’s generator broke down, and the pumps had to be operated ________ instead of mechanically.

 A) artificially

 B) automatically

 C) manually

 D) syntheticallyC

 48.The little girl was so frightened that she just wouldn’t ________ her grip on my arm.

 A) loosen

 B) remove

 C) relieve

 D) dismissA

 49.He never arrives on time and my ________ is that he feels the meetings are useless.

 A) preference

 B) conference

 C) inference

 D) referenceC

 50.Mrs. Smith was so ________ about everything that no servants could please her.

 A) specific

 B) special

 C) precise

 D) particularD

 51.Last night he saw two dark ________ enter the building, and then there was the explosion.

 A) features

 B) figures

 C) sketches

 D) imagesB

 52.It is obvious that this new rule is applicable to everyone without ________.

 A) exception

 B) exclusion

 C) modification

 D) substitutionA

 53.His temper and personally show that he can become a soldier of the top ________.

 A) circle

 B) rank

 C) category

 D) gradeB

 54.During the lecture, the speaker occasionally ________ his point by relating his own experiences.

 A) illustrated

 B) hinted

 C) cited

 D) displayedA

 55.Only those who can ________ to lose their money should make high-risk investments.

 A) maintain

 B) sustain

 C) endure

 D) affordD

 56.He found the ________ media attention intolerable and decided to go abroad.

 A) sufficient

 B) constant

 C) steady

 D) plentyB

 57.There has been a collision ________ a number of cars on the main road to town.

 A) composing

 B) consisting

 C) involving

 D) engagingC

 58.________ elephants are different from wild elephants in many aspects, including their tempers.

 A) Cultivated

 B) Regulated

 C) Civil

 D) TameD

 59.Ten days ago the young man informed his boss of his intention to ________.

 A) resign

 B) reject

 C) retreat

 D) replaceA

 60.As one of the world’s highest paid models, she had her face ________ for five million dollars.

 A) deposited

 B) assured

 C) measured

 D) insuredD

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 Wise buying is a positive way in which you can make your money go further. The __61__ you go about purchasing an article or a service can actually __62__ you money or can add __63__ the cost.

 Take the __64__ example of a hairdryer. If you are buying a hairdryer, you might __65__ that you are making the __66__ buy if you choose one __67__ look you like and which is also the cheapest __68__ price. But when you get it home you may find that it __69__ twice as long as a more expensive __70__ to dry your hair. The cost of the electricity plus the cost of your time could well __71__ your hairdryer the most expensive one of all.

 So what principles should you __72__ when you go out shopping?

 If you __73__ your home, your car or any valuable __74__ in excellent condition, you’ll be saving money in the long __75__.

 Before you buy a new __76__, talk to someone who owns one. If you can, use it or borrow it to check it suits your particular __77__.

 Before you buy an expensive __78__, or a service, do check the price and __79__ is on offer. If possible, choose __80__ three items or three estimates.

 61.A) form

 B) fashion

 C) way

 D) methodC

 62.A) save

 B) preserve

 C) raise

 D) retainA

 63.A) up

 B) to

 C) in

 D) onB

 64.A) easy

 B) single

 C) simple

 D) similarC

 65.A) convince

 B) accept

 C) examine

 D) thinkD

 66.A) proper

 B) best

 C) reasonable

 D) mostB

 67.A) its

 B) which

 C) whose

 D) whatB

 68.A) for

 B) with

 C) in

 D) onC

 69.A) spends

 B) takes

 C) lasts

 D) consumesB

 70.A) mode

 B) copy

 C) sample

 D) modelD

 71.A) cause

 B) make

 C) leave

 D) proveB

 72.A) adopt

 B) lay

 C) stick

 D) adaptA

 73.A) reserve

 B) decorate

 C) store

 D) keepD

 74.A) products

 B) possession

 C) material

 D) ownershipB

 75.A) run

 B) interval

 C) period

 D) timeA

 76.A) appliance

 B) equipment

 C) utility

 D) facilityA

 77.A) function

 B) purpose

 C) goal

 D) taskB

 78.A) component

 B) element

 C) item

 D) particleC

 79.A) what

 B) which

 C) that

 D) thisA

 80.A) of

 B) in

 C) by

 D) fromD

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a campaign speech in support of your election to the post of chairman of the student union. You should write at least 120 words following the outline given below in Chinese:

 1.你认为自己具备了什么条件(能力、性格、爱好等)可以胜任学生会主席的工作

 2.如果当选,你将为本校同学做些什么

A Campaign Speech

20051月四级参考答案

Part I


1.D

2.A

3.A

4.C

5.B

6.D

7.C

8.B

9.C

10.A


 S1.quality

 S2.investigated

 S3.value

 S4.familiar

 S5.recommend

 S6.perhaps

 S7.additional

 S8.Equivalent German models tend to be heavier and slightly less easy to use.

 S9.Similarly, it is smaller than most of its competitors, thus fitting easily into a pocket or a handbag.

 S10.The only problem was slight awkwardness in loading the film.

Part II Reading Comprehension


11.A

12.D

13.C

14.B

15.A

16.C

17.B

18.D

19.C

20.D

21.D

22.B

23.D

24.A

25.C

26.B

27.B

28.B

29.C

30.D


Part III Vocabulary


31.B

32.B

33.C

34.D

35.C

36.B

37.A

38.C

39.B

40.B

41.D

42.D

43.A

44.C

45.B

46.D

47.C

48.A

49.C

50.D

51.B

52.A

53.B

54.A

55.D

56.B

57.C

58.D

59.A

60.D


Part IV Cloze


61.C

62.A

63.B

64.C

65.D

66.B

67.B

68.C

69.B

70.D

71.B

72.A

73.D

74.B

75.A

76.A

77.B

78.C

79.A

80.D



20056月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) The man hates to lend his tools to other people.

 B) The man hasn’t finished working on the bookshelf.

 C) The tools have already been returned to the woman.

 D) The tools the man borrowed from the woman are missing.D

 2.A) Give the ring to a policeman.

 B) Wait for the owner of the ring in the rest room.

 C) Hand in the ring to the security office.

 D) Take the ring to the administration building.C

 3.A) Save time by using a computer.

 B) Buy her own computer.

 C) Borrow Martha’s computer.

 D) Stay home and complete her paper.B

 4.A) The man doesn’t have money for his daughter’s graduate studies.

 B) The man doesn’t think his daughter will get a business degree.

 C) The man insists that his daughter should pursue her studies in science.

 D) The man advises his daughter to think carefully before making her decision.D

 5.A) The cinema is some distance away from where they are.

 B) He would like to read the film review in the newspaper.

 C) They should wait to see the movie at a later time.

 D) He’ll find his way to the cinema.A

 6.A) He’s been to Seattle many times.

 B) He has chaired a lot of conferences.

 C) He has a high position in his company.

 D) He lived in Seattle for many years.A

 7.A) Teacher and student.

 B) Doctor and patient.

 C) Manager and office worker.

 D) Travel agent and customer.C

 8.A) She knows the guy who will give the lecture.

 B) She thinks the lecture might be informative.

 C) She wants to add something to her lecture.

 D) She’ll finished her report this weekend.B

 9.A) An art museum.

 B) A beautiful park.

 C) A college campus.

 D) An architectural exhibition.C

 10.A) The houses for sale are of poor quality.

 B) The houses are too expensive for the couple to buy.

 C) The housing developers provide free trips for potential buyers.

 D) The man is unwilling to take a look at the houses for sale.D

Section B

Passage 1

 11.A) Synthetic fuel

 B) Solar energy

 C) Alcohol

 D) ElectricityD

 12.A) Air traffic conditions

 B) Traffic jams on highways

 C) Road conditions

 D) New traffic rulesA

 13.A) Go through a health check

 B) Carry little luggage

 C) Arrive early for boarding

 D) Undergo security checksB

Passage 2

 14.A) In a fast-food restaurant

 B) At a shopping center

 C) At a county fair

 D) In a bakeryC

 15.A) Avoid eating any food

 B) Prepare the right type of pie to eat

 C) Wash his hands thoroughly

 D) Practice eating a pie quicklyA

 16.A) On the table

 B) Behind his back

 C) Under his bottom

 D) On his lapB

 17.A) Looking sideways to see how fast your neighbor eats.

 B) Eating from the outside toward the middle.

 C) Swallowing the pie with water.

 D) Holding the pie in the right position.B

Passage 3

 18.A) Beauty

 B) Loyalty

 C) Luck

 D) DurabilityA

 19.A) He wanted to follow the tradition of his country.

 B) He believed that it symbolized an everlasting marriage.

 C) It was thought a blood vessel in that finger led directly to the heart.

 D) It was supposed that the diamond on that finger would bring good luck.C

 20.A) The two people can learn about each other’s likes and dislikes.

 B) The two people can have time to decide if they are a good match.

 C) The two people can have time to shop for their new home.

 D) The two people can earn enough money for their wedding.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage 1

 Is there enough oil beneath the Arctic National Wildlife Refuge (保护区) (ANWR) to help secure America’s energy future? President Bush certainly thinks so. He has argued that tapping ANWR’s oil would help ease California’s electricity crisis and provide a major boost to the country’s energy independence. But no one knows for sure how much crude oil lies buried beneath the frozen earth with the last government survey, conducted in 1998, projecting output anywhere from 3 billion to 16 billion barrels.

 The oil industry goes with the high end of the range, which could equal as much as 10% of U.S. consumption for as long as six years. By pumping more than 1 million barrels a day from the reserve for the next two three decades, lobbyists claim, the nation could cut back on imports equivalent to all shipments to the U.S. from Saudi Arabia. Sounds good. An oil boom would also mean a multibillion-dollar windfall (意外之财) in tax revenues, royalties (开采权使用费) and leasing fees for Alaska and the Federal Government. Best of all, advocates of drilling say, damage to the environment would be insignificant. “We’ve never had a document case of oil rig chasing deer out onto the pack ice.” says Alaska State Representative Scott Ogan.

 Not so far, say environmentalists. Sticking to the low end of government estimates, the National Resources Defense Council says there may be no more than 3.2 billion barrels of economically recoverable oil in the coastal plain of ANWR, a drop in the bucket that would do virtually nothing to ease America’s energy problems. And consumers would wait up to a decade to gain any benefits, because drilling could begin only after much bargaining over leases, environmental permits and regulatory review. As for ANWR’s impact on the California power crisis, environmentalists point out that oil is responsible for only 1% of the Golden State’s electricity output—and just 3% of the nation’s.

 21.What does President Bush think of tapping oil in ANWR?

 A) It will exhaust the nation’s oil reserves.

 B) It will help secure the future of ANWR.

 C) It will help reduce the nation’s oil imports.

 D) It will increase America’s energy consumption.C

 22.We learn from the second paragraph that the American oil industry ________.

 A) believes that drilling for oil in ANWR will produce high yields

 B) tends to exaggerate America’s reliance on foreign oil

 C) shows little interest in tapping oil in ANWR

 D) expects to stop oil imports from Saudi ArabiaA

 23.Those against oil drilling in ANWR argue that ________.

 A) it can cause serious damage to the environment

 B) it can do little to solve U.S. energy problems

 C) it will drain the oil reserves in the Alaskan region

 D) it will not have much commercial valueB

 24.What do the environmentalists mean by saying “Not so fast” (Line 1, Para. 3)?

 A) Oil exploitation takes a long time

 B) The oil drilling should be delayed

 C) Don’t be too optimistic

 D) Don’t expect fast returnsC

 25.It can be learned from the passage that oil exploitation beneath ANWR’s frozen earth ________.

 A) remains a controversial issue

 B) is expected to get under way soon

 C) involves a lot of technological problems

 D) will enable the U.S. to be oil independentA

Passage 2

 “Tear ‘em apart!” “Kill the fool!” “Murder the referee (裁判)!”

 These are common remarks one may hear at various sporting events. At the time they are made, they may seem innocent enough. But let’s not kid ourselves. They have been known to influence behavior in such a way as to lead to real bloodshed. Volumes have been written about the way words affect us. It has been shown that words having certain connotations (含义) may cause us to react in ways quite foreign to what we consider to be our usual humanistic behavior. I see the term “opponent” as one of those words. Perhaps the time has come to delete it from sports terms.

 The dictionary meaning of the term “opponent “is “adversary “: “enemy “; “one who opposes your interests.” “Thus, when a player meets an opponent, he or she may tend to treat that opponent as an enemy. At such times, winning may dominate one’s intellect, and every action, no matter how gross, may be considered justifiable. I recall an incident in a handball game when a referee refused a player’s request for a time out for a glove change because he did not considered then wet enough. The player proceeded to rub his gloves across his wet T-shirt and then exclaimed. “Are they wet enough now?”

 In the heat of battle, players have been observed to throw themselves across the court without considering the consequences that such a move might have on anyone in their way. I have also witnessed a player reacting to his opponent’s international and illegal blocking by deliberately hitting him with the ball as hard as he could during the course of play. Off the court, they are good friends. Does that make any sense? It certainly gives proof of a court attitude which departs from normal behavior.

 Therefore, I believe it is time we elevated (提升) the game to the level where it belongs thereby setting an example to the rest of the sporting world. Replacing the term “opponent” with “associate” could be an ideal way to start.

 The dictionary meaning of the term “associate” is “colleague”; “friend”; “companion.” Reflect a moment! You may soon see and possibly feel the difference in your reaction to the term “associate” rather than “opponent.”

 26.Which of the following statements best expresses the author’s view?

 A) Aggressive behavior in sports can have serious consequences.

 B) The words people use can influence their behavior.

 C) Unpleasant words in sports are often used by foreign athletes.

 D) Unfair judgments by referees will lead to violence on the sports field.B

 27.Harsh words are spoken during games because the players ________.

 A) are too eager to win

 B) are usually short-tempered and easily offended

 C) cannot afford to be polite in fierce competition

 D) treat their rivals as enemiesD

 28.What did the handball player do when he was not allowed a time out to change his gloves?

 A) He refused to continue the game.

 B) He angrily hit the referee with a ball.

 C) He claimed that the referee was unfair.

 D) He wet his gloves by rubbing them across his T-shirt.D

 29.According to the passage, players, in a game, may ________.

 A) deliberately throw the ball at anyone illegally blocking their way

 B) keep on screaming and shouting throughout the game

 C) lie down on the ground as an act of protest

 D) kick the ball across the court with forceA

 30.The author hopes to have the current situation in sports improved by ________.

 A) calling on players to use clean language on the court

 B) raising the referee’s sense of responsibility

 C) changing the attitude of players on the sports field

 D) regulating the relationship between players and refereesC

Passage 3

 Consumers are being confused and misled by the hodge-podge (大杂烩) of environmental claims made by household products, according to a “green labeling” study published by Consumers International Friday.

 Among the report’s more outrageous (令人无法容忍的) findings-a German fertilizer described itself as “earthworm friendly” a brand of flour said it was “non-polluting” and a British toilet paper claimed to be “environmentally friendlier”

 The study was written and researched by Britain’s National Consumer Council (NCC) for lobby group Consumer International. It was funded by the German and Dutch governments and the European Commission.

 “ While many good and useful claims are being made, it is clear there is a long way to go in ensuring shoppers are adequately informed about the environmental impact of products they buy,” said Consumers International director Anna Fielder.

 The 10-country study surveyed product packaging in Britain, Western Europe, Scandinavia and the United States. It found that products sold in Germany and the United Kingdom made the most environmental claims on average.

 The report focused on claims made by specific products, such as detergent (洗涤剂) insect sprays and by some garden products. It did not test the claims, but compared them to labeling guidelines set by the International Standards Organization (ISO) in September, 1999.

 Researchers documented claims of environmental friendliness made by about 2,000 products and found many too vague or too misleading to meet ISO standards.

 “Many products had specially-designed labels to make them seem environmentally friendly, but in fact many of these symbols mean nothing,” said report researcher Philip Page.

 “Laundry detergents made the most number of claims with 158. Household cleaners were second with 145 separate claims, while paints were third on our list with 73. The high numbers show how very confusing it must be for consumers to sort the true from the misleading.” he said.

 The ISO labeling standards ban vague or misleading claims on product packaging, because terms such as “environmentally friendly” and “non-polluting” cannot be verified. “What we are now pushing for is to have multinational corporations meet the standards set by the ISO.” said Page.

 31.According to the passage, the NCC found it outrageous that ________.

 A) all the products surveyed claim to meet ISO standards

 B) the claims made by products are often unclear or deceiving

 C) consumers would believe many of the manufactures’ claim

 D) few products actually prove to be environment friendlyB

 32.As indicated in this passage, with so many good claims, the consumers ________.

 A) are becoming more cautious about the products they are going to buy

 B) are still not willing to pay more for products with green labeling

 C) are becoming more aware of the effects different products have on the environment

 D) still do not know the exact impact of different products on the environmentD

 33.A study was carried out by Britain’s NCC to ________.

 A) find out how many claims made by products fail to meet environmental standards

 B) inform the consumers of the environmental impact of the products they buy

 C) examine claims made by products against ISO standards

 D) revise the guidelines set by the International Standards OrganizationC

 34.What is one of the consequences caused by the many claims of household products?

 A) They are likely to lead to serious environmental problems.

 B) Consumers find it difficult to tell the true from the false.

 C) They could arouse widespread anger among consumer.

 D) Consumers will be tempted to buy products they don’t need.B

 35.It can be inferred from the passage that the lobby group Consumer International wants to ________.

 A) make product labeling satisfy ISO requirements

 B) see all household products meet environmental standards

 C) warn consumers of the danger of so-called green products

 D) verify the efforts of non-polluting productsA

Passage 4

 Two hours from the tall buildings of Manhattan and Philadelphia live some of the world’s largest black bears. They are in northern Pennsylvania’s Pocono Mountains, a home they share with an abundance of other wildlife.

 The streams, lakes, meadows (草地), mountain ridges and forests that make the Poconos an ideal place for black bears have also attracted more people to the region. Open spaces are threatened by plans for housing estates and important habitats (栖息地) are endangered by highway construction. To protect the Poconos natural beauty from irresponsible development, the Nature Conservancy (大自然保护协会) named the area one of America’s “Last Great Places”.

 Operating out of a century-old schoolhouse in the village of Long Pond, Pennsylvania, the conservancy’s bud Cook is working with local people and business leaders to balance economic growth with environmental protection. By forging partnerships with people like Francis Altemose, the Conservancy has been able to protect more than 14,000 acres of environmentally important land in the area.

 Altemose’s family has farmed in the Pocono area for generations. Two years ago Francis worked with the Conservancy to include his farm in a county farmland protection program. As a result, his family’s land can be protected from development and the Altemoses will be better able to provide a secure financial future for their 7-year-old grandson.

 Cook attributes the Conservancy’s success in the Poconos to having a local presence and a commitment to working with local residents

 “The key to protecting these remarkable lands is connecting with the local community,” Cook said. “The people who live there respect the land. They value quiet forests, clear streams and abundant wildlife. They are eager to help with conservation effort.

 For more information on how you can help the Nature Conservancy protect the Poconos and the world’s other “Last Great Places,” please call 1-888-564 6864 or visit us on the World Wide Web at www.tnc.org.

 36.The purpose in naming the Poconos as one of America’s “Last Great Places” is to ________.

 A) gain support from the local community

 B) protect it from irresponsible development

 C) make it a better home for black bears

 D) provide financial security for future generationsB

 37.We learn from the passage that ________.

 A) the population in the Pocono area is growing

 B) wildlife in the Pocono area is dying out rapidly

 C) the security of the Pocono residents is being threatened

 D) farmlands in the Pocono area are shrinking fastA

 38.What is important in protecting the Poconos according to Cook?

 A) The setting up of an environmental protection website

 B) Support from organizations like The Nature Conservancy

 C) Cooperation with the local residents and business leaders

 D) Inclusion of farmlands in the region’s protection programC

 39.What does Bud Cook mean by “having a local presence” (Line 1, Para. 5)?

 A) Financial contributions from local business leaders

 B) Consideration of the interests of the local residents

 C) The establishment of a wildlife protection foundation in the area

 D) The setting up of a local Nature Conservancy branch in the Pocono areaD

 40.The passage most probably is ________.

 A) an official document

 B) a news story

 C) an advertisement

 D) a research reportD

Part III Vocabulary (20 minutes)

 41.A word processor is much better than a typewriter in that it enables you to enter and ________ your text more easily.

 A) register

 B) edit

 C) propose

 D) dischargeB

 42.We don’t know why so many people in that region like to wear dresses of such ________ colors.

 A) low

 B) humble

 C) mild

 D) dullD

 43.The news has just ________ that the president is going to visit China next month.

 A) come down

 B) come up

 C) come out

 D) come aboutC

 44.The ________ that exists among nations could certainly be lessened if misunderstanding and mistrust were removed.

 A) tension

 B) strain

 C) stress

 D) intensityA

 45.The other day, Mum and I went to St. James’s Hospital, and they did lots and lots of tests on me, most of them ________ and frightening.

 A) cheerful

 B) horrible

 C) hostile

 D) friendlyB

 46.In the Mediterranean seaweed is so abundant and so easily harvested that it is never of great ________.

 A) fare

 B) payment

 C) worth

 D) expenseC

 47.The writer was so ________ in her work that she didn’t notice him enter the room.

 A) absorbed

 B) abandoned

 C) focused

 D) centeredA

 48.Actually, information technology can ________ the gap between the poor and the rich.

 A) link

 B) break

 C) ally

 D) bridgeD

 49.Some research workers completely ________ all those facts as though they never existed.

 A) ignore

 B) leave

 C) refuse

 D) missA

 50.Computer power now allows automatic searches of fingerprint files to match a print at a crime ________.

 A) stage

 B) scene

 C) location

 D) occasionB

 51.The most basic reason why dialects should be preserved is that language helps to ________ a culture.

 A) retain

 B) relate

 C) remark

 D) reviewA

 52.Companies are struggling to find the right ________ between supply and demand, but it is no easy task.

 A) equation

 B) formula

 C) balance

 D) patternC

 53.Mass advertising helped to ________ the emphasis from the production of goods to their consumption.

 A) vary

 B) shift

 C) lay

 D) moderateB

 54.Because of his excellent administration, people lived in peace and ________ and all previously neglected matters were taken care of.

 A) conviction

 B) contest

 C) consent

 D) contentD

 55.I know you’ve got a smooth tongue, so don’t talk me ________ buying it.

 A) away

 B) down

 C) out

 D) intoD

 56.Showing some sense of humor can be a(n) ________ way to deal with some stressful situation.

 A) effective

 B) efficient

 C) favorable

 D) favoriteA

 57.The situation described in the report ________ terrible, but it may not happen.

 A) inclines

 B) maintains

 C) sounds

 D) remainsC

 58.The company is trying every means to ________ the wholesale price of its products.

 A) pull down

 B) put down

 C) set down

 D) bring downD

 59.The mayor ________ the police officer a medal of honor for his heroic deed in rescuing the earthquake victims.

 A) rewarded

 B) awarded

 C) credited

 D) prizedB

 60.The native Canadians lived in ________ with nature, for they respected nature as a provider of life.

 A) coordination

 B) acquaintance

 C) contact

 D) harmonyD

 61.Many people are asking whether traditional research universities in fact have any future ________.

 A) at all

 B) so far

 C) in all

 D) on endA

 62.I was impressed ________ the efficiency of the work done in the company.

 A) in

 B) about

 C) with

 D) forC

 63.Now in Britain, wines take up four times as much ________ in the storehouse as both beer and spirits.

 A) block

 B) land

 C) patch

 D) spaceD

 64.His hand shook a little as he ________ the key in the lock.

 A) squeezed

 B) inserted

 C) stuffed

 D) piercedB

 65.For professional athletes, ________ to the Olympics means that they have a chance to enter the history books.

 A) access

 B) attachment

 C) appeal

 D) approachA

 66.In the long ________, the new information technologies may fundamentally alter our way of life.

 A) view

 B) distance

 C) jump

 D) runD

 67.All the arrangements should be completed ________ your departure.

 A) prior to

 B) superior to

 C) contrary to

 D) parallel toA

 68.We need to create education standards that prepare our next generation who will be ________ with an even more competitive market.

 A) tackled

 B) encountered

 C) dealt

 D) confrontedD

 69.In the late seventies, the amount of fixed assets required to produce one vehicle in Japan was ________ equivalent to that in the United States.

 A) rudely

 B) roughly

 C) readily

 D) coarselyB

 70.Many people believe we are heading for environmental disaster ________ we radically change way we live.

 A) but

 B) although

 C) unless

 D) lestC

Part IV Short Answer Questions (15 minutes)

 We commonly think of sportsmanship in connection with athletic contests, but it also applies to individual outdoor sports. Not everyone who picks up a fishing rod or goes out with a gun is a sportsman. The sportsman first of all obeys the fish and game laws, not because he is liable to be punished as a violator, but because he knows that in the main these laws are made for his best interests.

 The following are some of the things that those who would qualify for membership in the sportsmanship fraternity (圈内人) will do.

 1. Take no more game than the bag limit provided for by the fish and game laws. The person who comes back from a trip boasting about the large number of fish or game taken is not a sportsman but a game hog (贪得无厌的捕猎者).

 2. Observe the unwritten rules of fair play. This means shooting game birds only when the birds are “on the wing”. For the same reason, do not use a shotgun to shoot a rabbit or similar animal while it is sitting or standing still.

 3. Be careful in removing illegal or undersized fish from the hook. This should be done only after wetting the hands. This is necessary because the body of the fish is covered with a thin, protective film which will stick to your dry hands. If the hands are dry when the fish is handled, the film is torn from the body of the fish. Without the protective film, the fish is more easily attacked by diseases. If you wish to release a fish that is hooked in such a way that it will be impossible to be close to the hook as convenient. In a remarkably short time, the hook will break down and the fish will remain almost unharmed. Fish have been known to feed successfully while hooks were still in their lips.

 4. Be sure of the identity of your target before you shoot. Many useful and harmless species of wildlife are thoughtlessly killed by the uninformed person who is out with a gun to kill whatever flies within range.

 S1.In what respect does the author think individual outdoor sports are similar to athletic contests?

 S2.A person who goes out fishing with a fishing rod or hunting with a gun is not necessarily ________.

 S3.What’s the most important thing a true sportsman should bear in mind when he goes fishing or hunting ________.

 S4.Those who violate the fish and game laws will not be ________ for membership in the sportsmanship fraternity.

 S5.What are people called when they break the bag limit and boast about their big catch?

 S6.A true sportsman will not shoot an animal which is not ________.

 S7.What are people advised to do before they remove illegal or undersized fish from the hook?

 S8.What should sportsman do to avoid killing rare species of wildlife?

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a short essay in honor of teachers on the occasion of Teacher’s Day. You should write at least 120 words following the outline given below:

 1.向老师致以节日祝贺

 2.从一件难忘的事回忆老师的教诲和无私的奉献

 3.我如何回报老师的关爱

20056月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension


1.D

2.C

3.B

4.D

5.A

6.A

7.C

8.B

9.C

10.D

11.D

12.A

13.B

14.C

15.A

16.B

17.B

18.A

19.C

20.B


Part II Reading Comprehension


21.C

22.A

23.B

24.C

25.A

26.B

27.D

28.D

29.A

30.C

31.B

32.D

33.C

34.B

35.A

36.B

37.A

38.C

39.D

40.D


Part III


41.B

42.D

43.C

44.A

45.B

46.C

47.A

48.D

49.A

50.B

51.A

52.C

53.B

54.D

55.D

56.A

57.C

58.D

59.B

60.D

61.A

62.C

63.D

64.B

65.A

66.D

67.A

68.D

69.B

70.C


Part IV Short Answer Questions

 S1.Both of them are in common with sportsmanship

 S2.a sportsman

 S3.To obey the law.

 S4.qualified

 S5.A game hog.

 S6.moving

 S7.To wet their hands.

 S8.They should know the identity of the target.

200512月大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

 1.A) See a doctor.

 B) Stay in bed for a few days.

 C) Get treatment in a better hospital.

 D) Make a phone call to the doctor.A

 2.A) The 2:00 train will arrive earlier.

 B) The 2:30 train has a dining car.

 C) The woman prefers to take the 2:30 train.

 D) they are gong to have some fast food on the trainC

 3.A) She has been longing to attend Harvard University.

 B) She’ll consider the man’s suggestion carefully.

 C) She has finished her project with Dr. Garcia’s help.

 D) She’ll consult Dr. Garcia about entering graduate school.D

 4.A) Alice didn’t seem to be nervous during her speech.

 B) Alice needs more training in making public speeches.

 C) The man can hardly understand Alice’s presentation.

 D) The man didn’t think highly of Alice’s presentation.A

 5.A) It’s worse than 30 years ago.

 B) It remains almost the same as before.

 C) There are more extremes in the weather.

 D) There has been a significant rise in temperature.C

 6.A) At a publishing house.

 B) At a bookstore.

 C) In a reading room.

 D) In Prof. Jordan’s office.B

 7.A) The man can stay in her brother’s apartment.

 B) Her brother can help the man find a cheaper hotel.

 C) Her brother can find an apartment for the man.

 D) The man should have booked a less expensive hotel.A

 8.A) Priority should be given to listening.

 B) It’s most helpful to read English newspapers every day.

 C) It’s more effective to combine listening with reading.

 D) Reading should come before listening.C

 9.A) It can help solve complex problems.

 B) It will most likely prove ineffective.

 C) It is a new weapon against terrorists.

 D) It will help detect all kinds of liars.B

 10.A) Help the company recruit graduate students.

 B) Visit the electronics company next week.

 C) Get apart-time job on campus before graduation.

 D) Apply for a job in the electronics company.D

Section B

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) It ha been proven to be the best pain-killer.

 B) It is a possible cure for heart disease.

 C) It can help lower high body temperature effectively.

 D) It reduces the chance of death for heart surgery patients.D

 12.A) It keeps blood vessels from being blocked.

 B) It speeds up their recovery after surgery.

 C) It in creases the blood flow to the heart.

 D) It adjusts their blood pressure.A

 13.A) It is harmful to heart surgery patients with stomach bleeding.

 B) It should not be taken by heart surgery patients before the operation.

 C) It will have considerable side effects if taken in large doses.

 D) It should not be given to patients immediately after the operation.A

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 16 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) They strongly believe in family rules.

 B) They are very likely to succeed in life.

 C) They tend to take responsibility for themselves.

 D) They are in the habit of obeying their parents.B

 15.A) They grow up to be funny and charming.

 B) They often have a poor sense of direction.

 C) They get less attention from their parents.

 D) They tend to be smart and strong-willed.C

 16.A) They usually don’t follow family rules.

 B) They don’t like to take chances in their lives.

 C) They are less likely to be successful in life.

 D) They tend to believe in their parent’s ideas.A

Passage Three

Questions 17 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) They wanted to follow his example.

 B) They fully supported his undertaking.

 C) They were puzzled by his decision.

 D) They were afraid he wasn’t fully prepared.C

 18.A) It is more exciting than space travel.

 B) It is much cheaper than space travel.

 C) It is much safer than space travel.

 D) It is less time-consuming than space travel.B

 19.A) They both attract scientists’ attention.

 B) They can both be quite challenging.

 C) They are both thought-provoking.

 D) They may both lead to surprising findings.B

 20.A) To show how simple the mechanical aids for diving can be.

 B) To provide an excuse for his changeable character.

 C) To explore the philosophical issues of space travel.

 D) To explain why he took up underwater exploration.D

Part II Reading comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage One

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Just five one-hundredths of an inch thick, light golden in color and with a perfect “saddle curl,” the Lay’s potato chip seems an unlikely weapon for global domination. But its maker. Frito-Lay. Thinks otherwise. “Potato chips are a snack food for the world,” said Salman Amin, the company’s head of global marketing. Amin believes there is no corner of the world that can resist the charms of a Frito-Lay potato chip.

 Frito-Lay is the biggest snack maker in America, owned by PepsiCo. And accounts for over half of the parent company’s $3 billion annual profits. But the U.S. snack food market is largely saturated, and to grow, the company has to look overseas.

 Its strategy rests on two beliefs: first a global product offers economies of scale with which local brands cannot compete. And second, consumers in the 21st century are drawn to “global” as a concept. “Global” does not mean products that are consciously identified as American, but ones than consumes-especially young people-see as part of a modem, innovative (创新的) world in which people are linked across cultures by shared beliefs and tastes. Potato chips are an American invention, but most Chinese, for instance, do not know than Frito-Lay is an American company. Instead, Riskey, the company’s research and development head, would hope they associate the brand with the new world of global communications and business.

 With brand perception a crucial factor, Riskey ordered a redesign of the Frito-Lay logo (标识). The logo, along with the company’s long-held marketing image of the “irresistibility” of its chips, would help facilitate the company’s global expansion.

 The executives acknowledge that they try to swing national eating habits to a food created in America, but they deny that amounts to economic imperialism. Rater, they see Frito-Lay as spreading the benefits of free enterprise across the world. “We’re making products in those countries, we’re adapting them to the tastes of those countries, building businesses and employing people and changing lives,” said Steve Reinemund, PepsiCo’s chief executive.

 21.It is the belief of Frito-Lay’s head of global marking that ________.

 A) potato chips can hardly be used as a weapon to dominate the world market

 B) their company must find new ways to promote domestic sales

 C) the light golden color enhances the charm of their company’s potato chips

 D) people the world over enjoy eating their company’s potato chipsD

 22.What do we learn about Frito-Lay from Paragraph 2?

 A) Its products use to be popular among overseas consumers.

 B) Its expansion has caused fierce competition in the snack marker.

 C) It gives half of its annual profits to its parent company.

 D) It needs to turn to the word market for development.D

 23.One of the assumptions on which Frito-Lay bases its development strategy is that ________.

 A) consumers worldwide today are attracted by global brands

 B) local brands cannot compete successfully with American brands

 C) products suiting Chinese consumers’ needs bring more profits

 D) products identified as American will have promising market valueA

 24.Why did Riskey have the Frito-Lay logo redesigned?

 A) To suit changing tastes of young consumers.

 B) To promote the company’s strategy of globalization.

 C) To change the company’s long-held marketing image.

 D) To compete with other American chip producers.B

 25.Frito-Lay’s executives claim that the promoting of American food in the international market ________.

 A) won’t affect the eating habits of the local people

 B) will lead to economic imperialism

 C) will be in the interest of the local people

 D) won’t spoil the taste of their chipsC

Passage Two

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

 In communities north of Denver, residents are pitching in to help teachers and administrators as the Vrain school District tries to solve a $13.8 million budget shortage blamed on mismanagement. “We’re worried about our teachers and principals, and we really don’t want to lose them because of this,” one parent sail. “If we can help ease their financial burden, we will. “

 Teachers are grateful, but know it may be years before the district is solvent (有综合能力的). They feel really good about the parent support, but they realize it’s impossible for then to solve this problem.

 The 22,000-student district discovered the shortage last month. “It’s extraordinary. Nobody would have imagined something happening like this at this level,” said State Treasurer Mike Coffman.

 Coffman and district officials last week agreed on a state emergency plan freeing yp a $9.8 million loan that enabled the payroll (工资单) to be met for 2,700 teachers and staff in time for the holidays.

 District officials also took $1.7 million from student-activity accounts its 38 schools.

 At Coffman’s request, the District Attorney has begun investigating the district’s finances. Coffman says he wants to know whether district officials hid the budget shortage until after the November election, when voters approved a $212 million bond issue for schools.

 In Frederick, students’ parents are buying classroom supplies and offering to pay for groceries and utilities to keep first-year teachers and principals in their jobs.

 Some $36,000 has been raised in donations from Safeway. A Chevrolet dealership donated $10,000 and forgave the district’s $10,750 bill for renting the driver educating cars. IBM contributed 4,500 packs of paper.

 “We employ thousands of people in this community,” said Mitch Carson, a hospital chief executive, who helped raise funds. “We have children in the school, and we see how they could be affected.”

 At Creek High School, three students started a website that displays newspaper articles, district information and an email forum (论坛)。 “Rumors about what’s happening to the district are moving at lighting speed,” said a student. “We wanted to know the truth, and spread that around instead.”

 26.What has happened to the Vrain School District?

 A) A huge financial problem has arisen.

 B) Many schools there are mismanaged.

 C) Lots of teachers in the district are planning to quit.

 D) Many administrative personnel have been laid off.A

 27.How did the residents in the Vrain School District respond to the budget shortage?

 A) They felt somewhat helpless about it.

 B) They accused those responsible for it.

 C) They pooled their efforts to help solve it.

 D) They demanded a through investigation.C

 28.In the view of State Treasurer Mike Coffman, the educational budget shortage is ________.

 A) unavoidable

 B) unthinkable

 C) insolvable

 D) irreversibleB

 29.Why did Coffman request an investigation?

 A) To see if there was a deliberate cover-up of the problem.

 B) To find out the extent of the consequences of the case.

 C) To make sure that the school principals were innocent.

 D) To stop the voters approving the $212 million bong issue.A

 30.Three high school students started a website in order to ________.

 A) attract greater public attention to their needs

 B) appeal to the public for contributions and donations

 C) expose officials who neglected their duties

 D) keep people properly informed of the crisisD

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 “Humans should not try to avoid stress any more than they would shun food, love or exercise.” Said Dr. Hans Selye, the first physician to document the effects of stress on the body. While here’s on question that continuous stress is harmful, several studies suggest that challenging situations in which you’re able to rise to the occasion can be good for you.

 In a 2001 study of 158 hospital nurses, those who faced considerable work demands but coped with the challenge were more likely to say they were in good health than those who felt they stress that you can manage also boost immune (免疫的) function. In a study at the Academic Center for Dentistry in Amsterdam, researchers put volunteers through two stressful experiences. In the first, a timed task that required memorizing a list followed by a short test, subjects through a gory (血淋淋的) video on surgical procedures. Those who did well on the memory test had an increase in levels of immunoglobulin A, an antibody that’s the body’s first line of defense against germs. The video-watchers experienced a downturn in the antibody.

 Stress prompts the body to produce certain stress hormones. In short bursts these hormones have a positive effect, including improved memory function. “They can help nerve cells handle information and put it into storage,” says Dr. Bruce McEwen of Rockefeller University in New York. But in the long run these hormones can have a harmful effect on the body and brain.

 “Sustained stress is not good for you,” says Richard Morimoto, a researcher at Northwestern University in Illinois studying the effects of stress on longevity, “It’s the occasional burst of stress or brief exposure to stress that could be protective.”

 31.The passage is mainly about ________.

 A) the benefits of manageable stress

 B) stay away from

 C) run out of

 D) put up withD

 32.The word “shun” (Line 1, Para. 1) most probably means ________.

 A) cut down on

 B) stay away from

 C) run out of

 D) put up withB

 33.We can conclude from the study of the 158 nurses in 2001 that ________.

 A) people under stress tend to have a poor memory

 B) people who can’t get their job done experience more stress

 C) doing challenging work may be good for one’s health

 D) stress will weaken the body’s defense against germsC

 34.In the experiment described in Paragraph 3, the video-watchers experienced a downturn in the antibody because ________.

 A) the video was not enjoyable at all

 B) the outcome was beyond their control

 C) they knew little about surgical procedures

 D) they felt no pressure while watching the videoB

 35.Dr. Bruce McEwen of Rockefeller University believes that ________.

 A) a person’s memory is determined by the level of hormones in his body

 B) stress hormones have lasting positive effects on the brain

 C) short bursts of stress hormones enhance memory function

 D) a person’s memory improves with continued experience of stressC

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

 If you want to teach your children how to say sorry, you must be good at saying it yourself, especially to your own children. But how you say it can be quite tricky.

 If you say to your children “I’m sorry I got angry with you, but ...” what follows that “but” can render the apology ineffective: “I had a bad day” or “your noise was giving me a headache” leaves the person who has been injured feeling that he should be apologizing for his bad behavior in expecting an apology.

 Another method by which people appear to apologize without actually doing so is to say “I’m sorry you’re upset”; this suggests that you are somehow at fault for allowing yourself to get upset by what the other person has done.

 Then there is the general, all covering apology, which avoids the necessity of identifying a specific act that was particularly hurtful or insulting, and which the person who is apologizing should promise never to do again. Saying “I’m useless as a parent” does not commit a person to any specific improvement.

 These pseudo-apologies are used by people who believe saying sorry shows weakness, Parents who wish to teach their children to apologize should see it as a sign of strength, and therefore not resort to these pseudo-apologies.

 But even when presented with examples of genuine contrition, children still need help to become a ware of the complexities of saying sorry. A three-year-old might need help in understanding that other children feel pain just as he does, and that hitting a playmate over the head with a heavy toy requires an apology. A six-year-old might need reminding that spoiling other children’s expectations can require an apology. A 12-year-old might need to be shown that raiding the biscuit tin without asking permission is acceptable, but that borrowing a parent’s clothes without permission is not.

 36.If a mother adds “but” to an apology, ________.

 A) she doesn’t feel that she should have apologized

 B) she does not realize that the child has been hurt

 C) the child may find the apology easier to accept

 D) the child may feel that he owes her an apologyD

 37.According to the author, saying “I’m sorry you’re upset” most probably means “________”.

 A) You have good reason to get upset

 B) I’m aware you’re upset, but I’m not to blame

 C) I apologize for hurting your feelings

 D) I’m at fault for making you upsetB

 38.It is not advisable to use the general, all-covering apology because ________.

 A) it gets one into the habit of making empty promises

 B) it may make the other person feel guilty

 C) it is vague and ineffective

 D) it is hurtful and insultingC

 39.We learn from the last paragraph that in teaching children to say sorry ________.

 A) the complexities involved should be ignored

 B) their ages should be taken into account

 C) parents need to set them a good example

 D) parents should be patient and tolerantB

 40.It can be inferred from the passage that apologizing properly is ________.

 A) a social issue calling for immediate attention

 B) not necessary among family members

 C) a sign of social progress

 D) not as simple as it seemsD

Part III Vocabulary (20 minutes)

 41.Some people believe that since oil is scarce, the ________ of the motor industry is uncertain.

 A) terminal

 B) benefit

 C) fate

 D) estimateC

 42.To speed up the ________ of letters, the Post Office introduced automatic sorting.

 A) treatment

 B) delivery

 C) transmission

 D) departureB

 43.These overseas students show great ________ for learning a new language.

 A) enthusiasm

 B) authority

 C) convention

 D) faithA

 44.The defense lawyer was questioning the old man who was one of the ________ of the murder committed last month.

 A) observers

 B) witnesses

 C) audiences

 D) viewersB

 45.Politically these nations tend to be ________, with very high birth rates but poor education and very low levels of literacy.

 A) unstable

 B) reluctant

 C) rational

 D) unsteadyA

 46.The chairman was blamed for letting his secretary ________ too much work last week.

 A) take to

 B) take out

 C) take away

 D) take onD

 47.“You try to get some sleep. I’ll ________ the patient’s breakfast, “said the nurse.

 A) see to

 B) stick to

 C) get to

 D) lead toA

 48.The London Marathon is a difficult race.________, thousands of runners participate every year.

 A) Therefore

 B) Furthermore

 C) Accordingly

 D) NeverthelessD

 49.The bank refused to ________ him any money, so he had to postpone buying a house.

 A) credit

 B) borrow

 C) loan

 D) leaseC

 50.The more a nation’s companies ________ factories abroad, the smaller that country’s recorded exports will be.

 A) lie

 B) spot

 C) stand

 D) locateD

 51.Being ignorant of the law is not accepted as an ________ for breaking the law.

 A) excuse

 B) intention

 C) option

 D) approvalA

 52.Within two days, the army fired more than two hundred rockets and missiles at military ________ in the coastal city.

 A) goals

 B) aims

 C) targets

 D) destinationsC

 53.It is said in some parts of the world, goats, rather than cows, serve as a vital ________ of milk.

 A) storage

 B) source

 C) reserve

 D) resourceB

 54.“This light is too ________ for me to read by. Don’t we have a brighter bulb some where”; said the elderly man.

 A) mild

 B) dim

 C) minute

 D) slightB

 55.We have arranged to go to the cinema on Friday, but we can be ________ and go another day.

 A) reliable

 B) probable

 C) feasible

 D) flexibleD

 56.We are quite sure that we can ________ our present difficulties and finish the task according to schedule.

 A) get across

 B) get over

 C) get away

 D) get offB

 57.________ recent developments we do not think your scheme is practical.

 A) In view of

 B) In favor of

 C) In case of

 D) In memory ofA

 58.Jessica was ________ from the warehouse to the accounting office, which was considered a promotion.

 A) delivered

 B) exchanged

 C) transferred

 D) transformedC

 59.Mr. Smith asked his secretary to ________ a new paragraph in the annual report she was typing.

 A) inject

 B) install

 C) invade

 D) insertD

 60.There’s the living room still to be ________, so that’s my next project.

 A) abandoned

 B) decorated

 C) dissolved

 D) assessedB

 61.The old paper mill has been ________ to make way for a new shopping centre.

 A) held down

 B) kept down

 C) cut down

 D) turn downD

 62.It may be necessary to stop ________ in the learning process and go back to the difficult points in the lessons.

 A) at a distance

 B) at intervals

 C) at case

 D) at lengthB

 63.You can hire a bicycle in many places. Usually you’ll have to pay a ________.

 A) deposit

 B) deal

 C) fare

 D) fondA

 64.My grandfather had always taken a ________ interest in my work, and I had an equal admiration for the stories of his time.

 A) splendid

 B) weighty

 C) vague

 D) keenD

 65.________ quantities of water are being used nowadays with the rapid development of industry and agriculture.

 A) Excessive

 B) Extensive

 C) Extreme

 D) ExclusiveA

 66.John cannot afford to go to university, ________ going abroad.

 A) nothing but

 B) anything but

 C) not to speak of

 D) nothing to speak ofC

 67.Most laboratory and field studies of human behavior ________ taking a situational photograph at a given time and in a given place.

 A) involve

 B) compose

 C) enclose

 D) attachA

 68.If you don’t like to swim, you ________ as well stay at home.

 A) should

 B) may

 C) can

 D) wouldB

 69.Dr. Smith was always ________ the poor and the sick, often providing them with free medical care.

 A) reminded of

 B) absorbed in

 C) tended by

 D) concerned aboutD

 70.Thomas Jefferson and John Adams died on July 4, 1826, the fiftieth ________ of American Independence.

 A) ceremony

 B) occasion

 C) occurrence

 D) anniversaryD

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

 As a physician who travels quite a lot, I spend a lot of time on planes listening for that dreaded “Is there a doctor on board?” announcement. I’ve been __71__ only once—for a woman who had merely fainted. But the __72__ made me quite curious about how __73__ this kind of thing happens I wondered what I would do if __74__ with a real midair medical emergency-with out access __75__ a hospital staff and the usual emergency equipment. So __76__ the New England Journal of Medicine last week __77__ a study about in –flight medical events. I read it __78__ interest.

 The study estimated that there are a(n) __79__ of 30 in-flight medical emergencies on U.S. flights every day. Most of them are not __80__; fainting and dizziness are the most frequent complaints. __81__ 13% of them –roughly four a day—are serious enough to __82__ a pilot to change course. The most common of the serious emergencies __83__ heart trouble, strokes, and difficulty breathing.

 Let’s face it: plane rides are __84__. For starters, cabin pressures at high altitudes are set at roughly __85__ they would be if you lived at 5,000 to 8,000 feet above sea level. Most people can tolerate these pressures pretty __86__, but passengers with heart disease __87__ experience chest pains as result of the reduced amount of oxygen flowing through their blood. __88__ common in-flight problem is deep venous thrombosis—the so-called economy class syndrome (综合症).__89__ happens, don’t panic. Things are getting better on the in-flight-emergency front. Thanks to more recent legislation, flights with at __90__ one attendant are starting to install emergency medical kits to treat heart attacks.

 71.A) called

 B) addressed

 C) informed

 D) surveyedA

 72.A) Accident

 B) condition

 C) incident

 D) disasterA

 73.A) soon

 B) long

 C) many

 D) oftenD

 74.A) confronted

 B) treated

 C) identified

 D) providedA

 75.A) for

 B) to

 C) by

 D) throughB

 76.A) before

 B) since

 C) when

 D) whileC

 77.A) collected

 B) conducted

 C) discovered

 D) publishedD

 78.A) by

 B) of

 C) with

 D) inC

 79.A) amount

 B) average

 C) sum

 D) numberB

 80.A) significant

 B) heavy

 C) common

 D) seriousD

 81.A) For

 B) On

 C) But

 D) SoC

 82.A) require

 B) inspire

 C) engage

 D) commandD

 83.A) include

 B) confine

 C) imply

 D) containA

 84.A) enjoyable

 B) stimulating

 C) tedious

 D) stressfulD

 85.A) who

 B) what

 C) which

 D) thatA

 86.A) harshly

 B) reluctantly

 C) easily

 D) casuallyC

 87.A) ought to

 B) may

 C) used to

 D) needC

 88.A) Any

 B) One

 C) Other

 D) AnotherB

 89.A) Whatever

 B) Whichever

 C) Whenever

 D) WhereverC

 90.A) most

 B) worst

 C) least

 D) bestC

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a short essay entitled Should the University Campus Be Open to Tourists? You should write at Least 120 words following the outline given below:

 1.名校校园正成为旅游新热点

 2.校园是否应对游客开放,人们看法不同

 3.我认为…

Should the University Campus Be Open to Tourists?

200512月四级参考答案

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)


1.A

2.C

3.D

4.A

5.C

6.B

7.A

8.C

9.B

10.D

11.D

12.A

13.A

14.B

15.C

16.A

17.C

18.B

19.B

20.D


Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)


21.D

22.D

23.A

24.B

25.C

26.A

27.C

28.B

29.A

30.D

31.D

32.B

33.C

34.B

35.C

36.D

37.B

38.C

39.B

40.D


Part III Vocabulary (20 minutes)


41.C

42.B

43.A

44.B

45.A

46.D

47.A

48.D

49.C

50.D

51.A

52.C

53.B

54.B

55.D

56.B

57.A

58.C

59.D

60.B

61.D

62.B

63.A

64.D

65.A

66.C

67.A

68.B

69.D

70.D


Part IV Close (15 minutes)


71.A

72.A

73.D

74.A

75.B

76.C

77.D

78.C

79.B

80.D

81.C

82.D

83.A

84.D

85.A

86.C

87.C

88.B

89.C

90.C


Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a short essay entitled Should the University Campus Be Open to Tourists? You should write at Least 120 words following the outline given below:

 1.名校校园正成为旅游新热点

 2.校园是否应对游客开放,人们看法不同

 3.我认为…

 Should the University Campus Be Open to tourism?

 Nowadays, many famous university campuses have become one of the popular tourist attraction. It has been shown on TV and on the radio that every year thousands and thousands of middle school students visit Tsing Hua University and Peking University and other famous universities in China. In the place far away from the capital city, the local students also visit the universities famous in their own province.

 So far as the present situation is concerned, is it a good or bad thing to open the university campus for tourists? Different people have different opinions. On one hand, some people argued that it is a good thing for the students to visit the famous university campus in that it can enable the middle students to get more information about the university and they can have enough time and opportunity to prepare themselves with the chance to get into the university. On the other hand, some people hold a negative view about this phenomenon. In their opinion, the public tourism will have negative effect on the universities because it will not only do harm to the environment but also to the intellectual atmosphere.

In my opinion, the tourism to the universities is not a good thing. The campus is mainly a place for study. With the increasing tourism on the campus, it will ruin the spiritual atmosphere in this learning field.

2006617日大学英语四级(CET-4)真题试卷

试卷一

密封条由考生亲自启封

注意事项

一、将自己的校名、姓名、学校代号、准考证号写在答题纸和试卷二上。将本试卷代号划在答题纸上。

二、试卷一、答题纸和试卷二均不得带出考场。考试结束,监考人员收卷后考生才可离开。

三、仔细读懂题目的说明。

四、在90分钟内做完试卷一上的Part IPart III和试卷二上的Part IV 90分钟后,监考人员收取答题纸和试卷一,然后考生再做试卷二上的作文题。作文题答题时间为30分钟。全部考试时间为120分钟,不得拖延时间。

五、多项选择题的答案一定要划在答题纸上,凡是写在试卷上的答案一律无效。试卷二上的题目答案直接写在试卷二上。

六、多项选择题每题只能选一个答案;如多选,则该题无分。选定答案后,用HB浓度以上的铅笔在相应字母的中部划一条横线。正确的方法是:[A] [B] [C] [D]

使用其它符号答题者不给分。划线要有一定粗度,浓度要盖过字母底色。

七、如果要改动答案,必须先用橡皮擦净原来选定的答案,然后再按上面的规定重新答题。

八、在考试过程中要注意对自己的答案保密,若被他人抄袭,一经发现,后果自负。

全国大学英语四、六级考试委员会

Part I Listening Comprehension (20 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 10 short conversations. At the end of each conversation, a question will be asked about what war said. Both the conversation and the question will be spoken only once: After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you maxi read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is, the best answer. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 Example:

You will hear:

You will read:

 A) At the office.

 B) In the waiting room.

 C) At the airport.

 D) In a restaurant.

 From the conversation we know that the two were talking about some work they had to finish in the evening. This conversation is most likely to have taken place at the office. Therefore, A) “At the office” is the best answer. You should choose [A] on the Answer Sheet and mark it with a single line through the centre.

Sample Answer [A] [B] [C] [D]

 1.A) They went a long way to attend the party.

 B) They didn’t think much of the food and drinks.

 C) They knew none of the other guests at the party.

 D) They enjoyed the party better than the other guests.C

 2.A) To the bookstore.

 B) To the dentist’s.

 C) To the market.

 D) To the post office.B

 3.A) Dr. Andrews has been promoted for his thoroughness.

 B) She disagrees with Dr. Andrews on many occasions.

 C) Dr. Andrews used to keep his patients waiting.

 D) She dislikes Dr. Andrews as much as the new physician.C

 4.A) Tom is usually talkative.

 B) Tom has a very bad temper.

 C) Tom has dozens of things to attend to.

 D) Tom is disliked by his colleagues.A

 5.A) To pickup the woman from the library.

 B) To make a copy of the schedule for his friend.

 C) To find out more about the topic for the seminar.

 D) To get the seminar schedule for the woman.D

 6.A) The woman has to get the textbooks in other ways.

 B) The woman has sold her used textbooks to the bookstore.

 C) The man is going to buy his textbooks from a bookstore.

 D) The man doesn’t want to sell his textbooks to the woman.A

 7.A) Attend a conference.

 B) Give a speech.

 C) Meet his lawyer.

 D) Make a business trip.B

 8.A) Jessie always says what she thinks.

 B) Jessie seems to have a lot on her mind.

 C) Jessie is wrong to find fault with her boss.

 D) Jessie should know the marketing director better.A

 9.A) Helen is talkative.

 B) Helen is active.

 C) Helen is sociable.

 D) Helen is quiet.D

 10.A) Jimmy will regret marrying a Frenchwoman.

 B) Jimmy is rich enough to buy a big house.

 C) Jimmy is not serious in making decisions.

 D) Jimmy’s words are often not reliable.D

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 11 to 13 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 11.A) It can be used by farmers to protect large buildings.

 B) It was brought to the northern USA by Asian farmers.

 C) It has done more harm than good in the southern USA.

 D) It was introduced into the USA to kill harmful weeds.C

 12.A) People will have to rely on kudzu for a living.

 B) They will soon be overgrown with kudzu.

 C) They will become too hard to plough.

 D) People will find it hard to protect the soil.B

 13.A) The farmers there have brought it under control.

 B) The factories there have found a good use for it.

 C) The climate there is unfavorable to its growth.

 D) The soil there is not so suitable for the plant.C

Passage Two

Questions 14 to 17 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 14.A) A business corporation.

 B) The universe as a whole.

 C) A society of legal professionals.

 D) An association of teachers and scholars.D

 15.A) Its largest expansion took place during that period.

 B) Its role in society went through a dramatic change.

 C) Small universities combined to form bigger ones.

 D) Provincial colleges were taken over by larger universities.A

 16.A) Private donations.

 B) Government funding.

 C) Grants from corporations.

 D) Fees paid by students.B

Passage Three

Questions 18 to 20 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 17.A) He was wounded in the Spanish civil war.

 B) He was interested in the study of wild animals.

 C) He started the organization Heifer International.

 D) He sold his cows to many countries in the world.C

 18.A) To help starving families to become self-supporting.

 B) To make plans for the development of poor communities.

 C) To teach people how to use new skills to raise animals.

 D) To distribute food to the poor around the world.A

 19.A) They should help other families the way they have been helped.

 B) They should offer all baby animals to their poor neighbors.

 C) They should submit a report of their needs and goals.

 D) They should provide food for the local communities.A

 20.A) It has improved animal breeding skills all over the world.

 B) It has helped relieve hunger in some developing countries.

 C) It has promoted international exchange of farming technology.

 D) It has bridged the gap between the rich and the poor in America.B

Part II Reading Comprehension (35 minutes)

Passage one

Directions:There are 4 passages in this part, Each passage is followed by some questions at unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

Questions 21 to 25 are based on the following passage.

 Interest in pursuing international careers has soared in recent years, enhanced by chronic (长久的) personnel shortages that are causing companies to search beyond their home borders for talent.

 Professionals seek career experience outside of their home countries for a variety of reasons. They may feel the need to recharge their batteries with a new challenge. They may want a position with more responsibility that encourages creativity and initiative. Or they may wish to expose their children to another culture, and the opportunity to learn a second language.

 When applying for a job, one usually has to submit a resume or curriculum vitae (CV). The two terms generally mean the same thing: a one-or two-page document describing one’s educational qualifications and professional experience. However, guidelines for preparing a resume are constantly changing. The best advice is to find out what is appropriate regarding the corporate (公司) culture, the country culture, and the culture of the person making the hiring decision. The challenge will be to embrace two or more cultures in one document. The following list is a good place to start.

 ● “Educational requirements differ from country to country. In almost every case of ‘cross-border’ job hunting, just stating the title of your degree will not bean adequate description. Provide the reader with details about your studies and any related experience.”

 ● Pay attention to the resume format you use-chronological or reverse-chronological order. Chronological order means listing your ‘oldest’ work experience first. Reverse-chronological order means listing your current or most recent experience first. Most countries have preferences about which format is most acceptable. If you find no specific guidelines, the general preference is for the reverse-chronological format.”

 ● If you are submitting your resume in English, find out if the recipient (收件人) uses British English or American English because there are variations between the two versions. For example, university education is often referred to as ‘tertiary education’ in the United Kingdom, but this term is almost never used in the United States. A reader who is unfamiliar with these variations may assume that your resume contains errors.

 21.Companies are hiring more foreign employees because ________.

 A) they find foreign employees are usually more talented

 B) they need original ideas from employees hired overseas

 C) they want to expand their business beyond home borders

 D) they have difficulty finding qualified personnel at homeD

 22.The author believes that an individual who applies to work overseas ________.

 A) is usually creative and full of initiative

 B) aims to improve his foreign language skills

 C) is dissatisfied with his own life at home

 D) seeks either his own or his children’s developmentD

 23.When it comes to resume writing, it is best to ________.

 A) take cultural factors into consideration

 B) learn about the company’s hiring process

 C) follow appropriate guidelines for job hunting

 D) know the employer’s personal likes and dislikesA

 24.When writing about qualifications, applicants are advised to ________.

 A) stress their academic potential to impress the decision maker

 B) give the title of the university degree they have earned at home

 C) provide a detailed description of their study and work experiences

 D) highlight their keen interest in pursuing a ‘cross-border’ careerC

 25.According to the author’s last piece of advice, the applicants should be aware of ________.

 A) the different educational systems in the US and the UK

 B) the differences between the varieties of English

 C) the recipient’s preference with regard to the format

 D) the distinctive features of American and British culturesB

Questions 26 to 30 are based on the following passage.

Passage Two

 Educating girls quite possibly yields a higher rate of return than any other investment available in the developing world. Women’s education may be unusual territory for economists, but enhancing women’s contribution to development is actually as much an economic as a social issue. And economics, with its emphasis on incentives (激励), provides guideposts that point to an explanation for why so many girls are deprived of an education.

 Parents in low-income countries fail to invest in their daughters because they do not expect them to make an economic contribution to the family: girls grow up only to marry into somebody else’s family and bear children. Girls are thus seen as less valuable than boys and art kept at home to do housework while their brothers are sent to school-the prophecy (预言) becomes self-fulfilling, trapping women in a vicious circle (恶性循环) of neglect.

 An educated mother, on the other hand, has greater earning abilities outside the home and faces an entirely different set of choices. She is likely to have fewer but healthier children and can insist on the development of all her children, ensuring that her daughters are given a fair chance. The education of her daughters then makes it much more likely that the next generation of girls, as well as of boys, will be educated and healthy. The vicious circle is thus transformed into a virtuous circle.

 Few will dispute that educating women has great social benefits. But it has enormous economic advantages as well. Most obviously, there is the direct effect of education on the wages of female workers. Wages rise by 10 to 20 per cent for each additional year of schooling. Such big returns are impressive by the standard of other available investments, but they are just the beginning. Educating women also has a significant impact on health practices, including family planning.

 26.The author argues that educating girls in developing countries is ________.

 A) troublesome

 B) labor-saving

 C) rewarding

 D) expensiveC

 27.By saying “... the prophecy becomes self-fulfilling...” (Lines 45, Para. 2). the author means that ________.

 A) girls will turn out to be less valuable than boys

 B) girls will be capable of realizing their own dreams

 C) girls will eventually find their goals in life beyond reach

 D) girls will be increasingly discontented with their life at homeA

 28.The author believes that a vicious circle can turn into a virtuous circle when ________.

 A) women care more about education

 B) girls can gain equal access to education

 C) a family has fewer but healthier children

 D) parents can afford their daughters’ educationB

 29.What does the author say about women’s education?

 A) It deserves greater attention than other social issues.

 B) It is now given top priority in many developing countries.

 C) It will yield greater returns than other known investments.

 D) It has aroused the interest of a growing number of economists.C

 30.The passage mainly discusses ________.

 A) unequal treatment of boys and girls in developing countries

 B) the potential earning power of well-educated women

 C) the major contributions of educated women to society

 D) the economic and social benefits of educating womenD

Passage Three

Questions 31 to 35 are based on the following passage.

 Speeding off in a stolen car, the thief thinks he has got a great catch. But he is in for an unwelcome surprise. The car is fitted with a remote immobiliser (锁止器), and a radio signal from a control centre miles away will ensure that once the thief switches the engine off, he will not be able to start it again.

 The idea goes like this. A control box fitted to the car contains a mini-cellphone, a micro-processor and memory, and a GPS (全球定位系统) satellite positioning receiver. If the car is stolen, a coded cellphone signal will tell the control centre to block the vehicle’s engine management system and prevent the engine being restarted.

 In the UK, a set of technical fixes is already making life harder for car thieves. ‘The pattern of vehicle crime has changed,’ says Martyn Randall, a security expert. He says it would only take him a few minutes to teach a person how to steal a car, using a bare minimum of tools. But only if the car is more than 10 years old.

 Modern cars are far tougher to steal, as their engine management computer won’t allow them to start unless they receive a unique ID code beamed out by the ignition (点火) key. In the UK, technologies like this have helped achieve a 31% drop in vehicle-related crime since 1997.

 But determined criminals are still managing to find other ways to steal cars, often by getting bold of the owner’s keys. And key theft is responsible for 40% of the thefts of vehicles fitted with a tracking system.

 If the car travels 100 metres without the driver confirming their ID, the system will send a signal to an operations centre that it has been stolen. The hundred metres minimum avoids false alarms due to inaccuracies in the GPS signal.

 Staff at the centre will then contact the owner to confirm that the car really is missing, and keep police informed of the vehicle’s movements via the car’s GPS unit.

 31.What’s the function of the remote immobilizer fitted to a car?

 A) To help the police make a surprise attack on the car thief.

 B) To allow the car to lock automatically when stolen.

 C) To prevent the car thief from restarting it once it stops.

 D) To prevent car theft by sending a radio signal to the car owner.C

 32.By saying “The pattern of vehicle crime has changed” (Lines 1-2. Para. 3), Martyn Randall suggests that ________.

 A) it takes a longer time for the car thief to do the stealing

 B) self-prepared tools are no longer enough for car theft

 C) the thief has to make use of computer technology

 D) the thief has lost interest in stealing cars over 10 years oldB

 33.What is essential in making a modem car tougher to steal?

 A) A coded ignition key.

 B) A unique ID card.

 C) A special cellphone signal.

 D) A GPS satellite positioning receiver.A

 34.Why does the tracking system set a 100-metre minimum before sending an alarm to the operations centre?

 A) To leave time for the operations centre to give an alarm.

 B) To keep police informed of the car’s movements.

 C) To give the driver time to contact the operations centre.

 D) To allow for possible errors in the GPS system.D

 35.What will the operations centre do first after receiving an alarm?

 A) Start the tracking system.

 B) Contact the car owner.

 C) Block the car engine.

 D) Locate the missing car.B

Passage Four

Questions 36 to 40 are based on the following passage.

Psychiatrists (精神病专家) who work with older parents say that maturity can be an asset in child rearing-older parents are more thoughtful, use less physical discipline and spend more time with their children. But raising kids takes money and energy. Many older parents find themselves balancing their limited financial resources, declining energy and failing health against the growing demands of an active child. Dying and leaving young children is probably the older parents’ biggest, and often unspoken, fear. Having late-life children, says an economics professor, often means parents, particularly fathers, “end up retiring much later.” For many, retirement becomes an unobtainable dream.

 Henry Metcalf, a 54-year-old journalist, knows it takes money to raise kids. But he’s also worried that his energy will give out first. Sure, he can still ride bikes with his athletic fifth grader, but he’s learned that young at heart doesn’t mean young. Lately he’s been taking afternoon naps (午睡) to keep up his energy. “My body is aging,” says Metcalf. “You can’t get away from that.”

 Often, older parents hear the ticking of another kind of biological clock. Therapists who work with middle-aged and older parents say fears about aging are nothing to laugh at. “They worry they’ll be mistaken for grandparents, or that they’ll need help getting up out of those little chairs in nursery school,” says Joann Galst, a New York psychologist. But at the core of those little fears there is often a much bigger one: “that they won’t be alive long enough to support and protect their child,” she says.

 Many late-life parents, though, say their children came at just the right time. After marrying late and undergoing years offertility(受孕) treatment, Marilyn Nolen and her husband. Randy, had twins. “We both wanted children,” says Marilyn, who was 55 when she gave birth. The twins have given the couple what they desired for years, “a sense of family.” Kids of older dads are often smarter, happier and more sociable because their fathers are more involved in their lives. “The dads are older, more mature,” says Dr. Silber, “and more ready to focus on parenting.”

 36.Why do psychiatrists regard maturity as an asset in child rearing?

 A) Older parents are often better prepared financially.

 B) Older parents can take better care of their children.

 C) Older parents are usually more experienced in bringing up their children.

 D) Older parents can better balance their resources against children’s demands.C

 37.What does the author mean by saying “For many, retirement becomes an unobtainable dream” (Lines 7-8, Para. 1)?

 A) They are reluctant to retire when they reach their retirement age.

 B) They can’t obtain the retirement benefits they have dreamed of.

 C) They can’t get full pension unless they work some extra years.

 D) They have to go on working beyond their retirement age.D

 38.The author gives the example of Henry Metcalf to show that ________.

 A) older parents should exercise more to keep up with their athletic children

 B) many people are young in spirit despite their advanced age

 C) older parents tend to be concerned about their aging bodies

 D) taking afternoon naps is a good way to maintain energyC

 39.What’s the biggest fear of older parents according to New York psychologist Joan Galst?

 A) Approaching of death.

 B) Slowing down of their pace of life.

 C) Being laughed at by other people.

 D) Being mistaken for grandparents.A

 40.What do we learn about Marilyn and Randy Nolen?

 A) They thought they were an example of successful fertility treatment.

 B) Not until they reached middle age did they think of having children.

 C) Not until they had the twins did they feel they had formed a family.

 D) They believed that children born of older parents would be smarter.C

Part III Vocabulary (20 minutes)

Directions:There are 30 incomplete sentences it: this part. For each sentence there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Choose cite ONE answer that best completes the sentence. Then mark the Corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the center.

 41.People’s expectations about the future may have more influence on their sense of well-being than their ________ state does.

 A) current

 B) initial

 C) modern

 D) primitiveA

 42.After working all day, he was so tired that he was in no ________ to go to the party with us.

 A) taste

 B) mood

 C) sense

 D) emotionB

 43.There is already ________ clear to show that plants and animals are being affected by climate change.

 A) witness

 B) certification

 C) identity

 D) evidenceD

 44.Many women still feel that they are being ________ by a male culture, particularly in the professional services sector.

 A) held back

 B) held forth

 C) held on

 D) held outA

 45.The findings paint a unique picture of the shopping habits of customers, plus their motivation and ________.

 A) privileges

 B) possibilities

 C) possessions

 D) preferencesD

 46.It’s good to know that quite a few popular English expressions actually ________ from the Bible.

 A) acquire

 B) obtain

 C) derive

 D) resultC

 47.Tom, did it ever ________ to you that you would be punished for cheating on exams?

 A) happen

 B) occur

 C) reflect

 D) strikeB

 48.In the U.S. 88 percent of smokers had started before they were 18, despite the fact that it is ________ to sell cigarettes to anyone under that age.

 A) liable

 B) liberal

 C) irrational

 D) illegalD

 49.According to the key witnesses, a peculiarly big nose is the criminal’s most memorable facial ________.

 A) feature

 B) hint

 C) spot

 D) signatureA

 50.Brazil’s constitution ________ the military use of nuclear energy.

 A) withdraws

 B) forbids

 C) interrupts

 D) objectsB

 51.Some people argue that the death ________ does not necessarily reduce the number of murders.

 A) plot

 B) practice

 C) penalty

 D) patternC

 52.Many personnel managers say it is getting harder and harder to ________ honest applicants from the growing number of dishonest ones.

 A) distinguish

 B) disguise

 C) dissolve

 D) discountA

 53.A study shows that students living in non-smoking dorms are less likely to ________ the habit of smoking.

 A) make up

 B) turn up

 C) draw up

 D) pickupD

 54.Almost all job applicants are determined to leave a good ________ on a potential employer.

 A) illusion

 B) reputation

 C) impression

 D) reflectionC

 55.A special feature of education at MIT is the opportunity for students and faculty to ________ together in research activities.

 A) specialize

 B) participate

 C) consist

 D) involveB

 56.Although they lost their jobs, savings and unemployment benefits allow the couple to ________ their comfortable home.

 A) come in for

 B) catch up with

 C) look forward to

 D) hold on toD

 57.Although many experts agree that more children are overweight, there is debate over the best ways to ________ the problem.

 A) relate

 B) tackle

 C) file

 D) attachB

 58.An important factor in determining how well you perform in an examination is the ________ of your mind.

 A) state

 B) case

 C) situation

 D) circumstanceA

 59.Research shows that there is no ________ relationship between how much a person earns and whether he feels good about life.

 A) successive

 B) subsequent

 C) significant

 D) sincereC

 60.Sadly, as spending on private gardens has ________, spending on public parks has generally declined.

 A) heightened

 B) lifted

 C) flown

 D) soaredD

 61.Lung cancer, like some other cancers, often doesn’t produce ________ until it is too late and has spread beyond the chest to the brain, liver or bones.

 A) trails

 B) therapies

 C) symptoms

 D) symbolsC

 62.With the increasing unemployment rate, workers who are 50 to 60 years old are usually the first to be ________.

 A) laid off

 B) laid aside

 C) laid out

 D) laid upA

 63.The physical differences between men and women can be ________ directly to our basic roles as hunters and child-bearers.

 A) pursued

 B) traced

 C) switched

 D) followedB

 64.It is clear that the dog has a much greater ________ of its brain devoted to smell than is the case with humans.

 A) composition

 B) compound

 C) percent

 D) proportionD

 65.American college students are increasingly ________ with credit card debt and the consequences can be rather serious.

 A) boosted

 B) burdened

 C) discharged

 D) dominatedB

 66.Numerous studies already link the first meal of the day to better classroom ________.

 A) performance

 B) function

 C) behavior

 D) displayA

 67.The most successful post-career athletes are those who can take the identity and fife skills the learned in sports and ________ them to another area of life.

 A) utilize

 B) employ

 C) apply

 D) exertC

 68.The technological advances made it possible for the middle classes to enjoy what had once been ________ only to the very rich.

 A) manageable

 B) measurable

 C) acceptable

 D) affordableD

 69.Being out of work, lane can no longer ________ friends to dinners and movies as she used to.

 A) urge

 B) treat

 C) appeal

 D) compelB

 70.________ by the superstars on television, the young athletes trained hard and played intensely.

 A) Imitated

 B) Imposed

 C) Insured

 D) InspiredD

Part IV Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are jour choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet with a single line through the centre.

 The part of the environmental movement that draws my firm’s attention is the design of cities’ buildings and products. When we designed America’s first so-called “green” office building in New York two decades __71__, we felt very alone. But today, thousands of people come to green building conferences, and the __72__ that buildings can be good for people and the environment will be increasingly influential in years to __73__.

 Back in 1984 we discovered that most manufactured products for decoration weren’t designed for __74__ use. The “energy-efficient” sealed commercial buildings constructed after the 1970s energy crisis __75__ indoor air quality problems caused by materials such as paint, wall covering and carpet. So far 20 years, we’ve been focusing on these materials __76__ to the molecules, looking for ways to make them __77__ for people and the planet.

 Home builders can now use materials-such as paints that release significantly __78__ amounts of organic compounds-that don’t __79__ the quality of the air, water, or soil. Ultimately, __80__, our basic design strategy is focused not simply on being “less bad” but on creating __81__ healthful materials that can be either safely returned to the soil __82__ reused by industry again and again. As a matter of __83__, the world’s largest carpet manufacturer has already __84__ a carpet that is fully and safely recyclable (可循环用的).

 Look at it this way: No one __85__ out to create a building that destroys the planet. But our current industrial systems are __86__ causing these conditions, whether we like it or not. So __87__ of simply trying to reduce the damage, we are __88__ a positive approach. We’re giving people high-quality, healthful products and an opportunity to make choices that have a __89__ effect on the world. It’s not just the building industry, either. __90__ cities are taking these environmentally positive approaches to design, planning and building. Portland, Seattle and Boston have said they want to be green cities. Chicago wants to be the greenest city in the world.

 71.A) ago

 B) off

 C) before

 D) awayA

 72.A) practice

 B) outlook

 C) idea

 D) schemeC

 73.A) go

 B) come

 C) arrive

 D) continueB

 74.A) indoor

 B) inward

 C) relevant

 D) flexibleA

 75.A) displayed

 B) discovered

 C) exhibited

 D) revealedD

 76.A) back

 B) down

 C) next

 D) nearB

 77.A) comfortable

 B) cautious

 C) safe

 D) stableC

 78.A) reduced

 B) revised

 C) descended

 D) delayedA

 79.A) deny

 B) depress

 C) dissolve

 D) destroyD

 80.A) besides

 B) however

 C) anyhow

 D) anywayB

 81.A) partially

 B) exactly

 C) completely

 D) superficiallyC

 82.A) or

 B) and

 C) but

 D) norA

 83.A) interest

 B) fact

 C) principle

 D) courseB

 84.A) sketched

 B) constructed

 C) researched

 D) developedD

 85.A) starts

 B) pulls

 C) looks

 D) makesA

 86.A) basically

 B) originally

 C) traditionally

 D) inevitablyD

 87.A) because

 B) out

 C) instead

 D) regardlessC

 88.A) adjusting

 B) admitting

 C) adopting

 D) adaptingC

 89.A) functional

 B) beneficial

 C) precious

 D) sensibleB

 90.A) Entire

 B) Total

 C) Full

 D) CompleteA

Part V Writing (30 minutes)

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minutes to write a poster recruiting volunteers. You should write at Least 120 words following the outline given below:

 1.校学生会将组织一次暑假志愿者活动,现招募志愿者

 2.本次志愿者活动的目的、活动安排等

 3.报名条件及联系方式

Volunteers Needed

2006617日四级参考答案

Part I


1.C

2.B

3.C

4.A

5.D

6.A

7.B

8.A

9.D

10.D

11.C

12.B

13.C

14.D

15.A

16.B

17.C

18.A

19.A

20.B


Part II


21.D

22.D

23.A

24.C

25.B

26.C

27.A

28.B

29.C

30.D

31.C

32.B

33.A

34.D

35.B

36.C

37.D

38.C

39.A

40.C


Part III


41.A

42.B

43.D

44.A

45.D

46.C

47.B

48.D

49.A

50.B

51.C

52.A

53.D

54.C

55.B

56.D

57.B

58.A

59.C

60.D

61.C

62.A

63.B

64.D

65.B

66.A

67.C

68.D

69.B

70.D


Part IV


71.A

72.C

73.B

74.A

75.D

76.B

77.C

78.A

79.D

80.B

81.C

82.A

83.B

84.D

85.A

86.D

87.C

88.C

89.B

90.A


2006617日四级听力原文

Section A

 1.M: I think the hostess really went out of her way to make the party a success.

 W: Yes, the food and drinks were great, but if only we had known a few of the other guests.

 Q: What did the two speakers say about the party?

 2.M: Can you stop by the post office and get me some envelopes and 39 cents’ stamps?

 W: Well, I am not going to stop by the post office, but I can buy you some at the bookstore after I see the dentist on Market street.

 Q: Where will the woman go first?

 3.M: How do you like the new physician who replaced Dr. Andrews?

 W: He may not seem as agreeable or as thorough as Dr. Andrews, but at least he doesn’t keep patients waiting for hours.

 Q: What can we infer from the woman’s answer?

 4.W: Tom must be in a bad mood today. He hasn’t said half a dozen words all afternoon.

 M: Oh, really? That’s not like the Tom we know.

 Q: What does the man imply?

 5.W: Do you have the seminar schedule with you? I’d like to find out the topic for Friday.

 M: I gave it to my friend, but there should be copies available in the library. I can pick one up for you.

 Q: What does the man promise to do?

 6.W: I wonder if you could sell me the Psychology textbooks. You took the course last semester, didn’t you?

 M: As a matter of fact, I already sold them back to the school bookstore.

 Q: What do we learn from the conversation?

 7.W: Here is this week’s schedule, Tony. On Monday, there is the board meeting. Your speech to the lion’s club is on Tuesday afternoon. Then on Wednesday you have an appointment with your lawyer and…

 M: Wait, you mean the business conference on Tuesday is cancelled?

 Q: What will the man do this Tuesday?

 8.M: Can you believe it? Jessie told her boss he was wrong to have fired his marketing director

 W: Yeah, but you know Jessie. If she has something in mind, everyone will know about it.

 Q: What does the woman mean?

 9.M: We’ve got three women researchers in our group: Mary, Betty and Helen. Do you know them?

 W: Sure. Mary is active and sociable. Betty is the most talkative woman I’ve ever met. But guess what? Helen’s just the opposite.

 Q: What do we learn from the woman’s remark about Helen?

 10.W: Jimmy said that he was going to marry a rich French businesswoman.

 M: Don’t be so sure. He once told me that he had bought a big house. Yet he’s still sharing an apartment with Mark.

 Q: What does the man imply?

Section B

 Passage 1

 Unless you have visited the southern United States, you probably have never heard of Kudzu. Kudzu, as any farmer in the south will sadly tell you, is a super-powered weed. It is a strong climbing plant. Once it gets started, Kudzu is almost impossible to stop. It climbs to the tops of the tallest trees. It can cover large buildings. Whole barns and farm houses have been known to disappear from view. Wherever it grows, its thick twisting stems are extremely hard to remove. Kudzu was once thought to be a helpful plant. Originally found in Asia, it was brought to America to help protect the land from being swallowed by the sea. It was planted where its tough roots which grow up to five feet long could help hold back the soil. But the plant soon spread to places where it wasn’t wanted. Farmers now have to fight to keep it from killing other plants. In a way, Kudzu is a sign of labor shortage in the south. Where there is no one to work the fields, Kudzu soon takes over. The northern United States faces no threat from Kudzu. Harsh winters kill it off. The plant loves the warmth of the south, but the south surely doesn’t love it. If someone could invent some use for Kudzu and remove it from southern farmland, his or her fortune would be assured.

 11.What do we learn about “Kudzu” from the passage?

 12.What will happen if the fields are neglected in the southern United States?

 13.Why isn’t Kudzu a threat to the northern United States?

 Passage 2

 The word “university” comes from the Latin word “universitas”, meaning “the whole”. Later, in Latin legal language, “universitas” meant a society or corporation. In the Middle Ages, the word meant “ an association of teachers and scholars”. The origins of universities can be traced back to the 12th to14th centuries. In the early 12th century, long before universities were organized in the modern sense, students gathered together for higher studies at certain centers of learning. The earliest centers in the Europe were at Bolonia in Italy, founded in 1088. Other early centers were set up in France, the Czech Republic, Austria and Germany from 1150 to 1386. The first universities in Britain were Oxford and Cambridge. They were established in 1185 and 1209 respectively. The famous London University was founded in 1836. This was followed by the foundation of several universities such as Manchester and Birmingham, which developed from provincial colleges. It was in the 1960’s that the largest expansion of higher education took place in Britain. This expansion took 3 basic forms: existing universities were enlarged, new universities were developed from existing colleges and completely new universities were set up. In Britain, finance for universities comes from three source: the first, and the largest source, is grants from the government, the second source is fees paid by students and the third one is private donations. All the British universities except one receive some government funding. The exception is Buckingham, which is Britain’s only independent university.

 14.What did the word “Universitas” mean in the Middle Ages?

 15.Why was the 1960s so significant for British Higher Education?

 16.What is the main financial source for British universities?

 Passage 3

 One of the biggest problems in developing countries is hunger. An organization called Heifer International is working to improve the situation. The organization sends farm animals to families and communities around the world. An American farmer, Dan West, developed the idea for Heifer International in the 1930s. Mr. West was working in Spain where he discovered a need for cows. Many families were starving because of the civil war in that county. So Mr. West asked his friends in the United States to send some cows. The first Heifer animals were sent in 1944. Since that time, more than 4,000,000 people in 115 countries have had better lives because of Heifer animals. To receive a Heifer animal, families must first explain their needs and goals. They must also make a plan which will allow them to become self-supporting. Local experts usually provide training. The organization says that animals must have food, water, shelter, health care and the ability to reproduce. Without them, the animals will not remain healthy and productive. Heifer International also believes that families must pass on some of their success to others in need. This belief guarantees that each person who takes part in the program also becomes a giver. Every family that receives a Heifer animal must agree to give that animal’s first female baby to other people in need . Families must also agree to pass on the skills and training they receive from Heifer International. This concept helps communities become self-supporting.

 17.What does the speaker tell us about Mr. West?

 18.What is the ultimate goal of Heifer International?

 19.What are families required to do after they receive support from Heifer International?

 20.What is the major achievement of Heifer International?

2006624日大学英语新四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Writing (30 minute)

注意:此部分试题在答题卡1上。

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minute to write a short essay on the topic of students selecting their lectures. You should write at least 120 words following the outline given bellow:

 1.有些大学允许学生自由选择某些课程的任课教师

 2.学生选择教师时所考虑的主要因素

 3.学生自选任课教师的益处和可能产生的问题

On Students Selecting Lecturers

Part II Reading comprehension (skimming and scanning) (15 minute)

Directions:In this part, you will have 15 minute to go over the passage quickly and answer the questions on Answer Sheet1.

 For questions 1-7, mark

Y (for YES)if the statement agrees with the information given in the passage;

N (for NO)if statement contradicts the information given in the passage;

NG (for NOT GIVEN)if the information is not given in the passage.

 For question 8-10, complete the sentences with the information given in the passage.

 Highways

 Early in the 20th century, most of the streets and roads in the U.S. were made of dirt, brick, and cedar wood blocks. Built for horse, carriage, and foot traffic, they were usually poorly cared for and too narrow to accommodate (容纳) automobiles.

 With the increase in auto production, private turnpike (收费公路) companies under local authorities began to spring up, and by 1921 there were 387,000 miles of paved roads. Many were built using specifications of 19th century Scottish engineers Thomas Telford and John MacAdam (for whom the macadam surface is named), whose specifications stressed the importance of adequate drainage. Beyond that, there were no national standards for size, weight restrictions, or commercial signs. During World War I, roads throughout the country were nearly destroyed by the weight of trucks. When General Eisenhower returned from Germany in 1919, after serving in the U.S. army’s first transcontinental motor convoy (车队), he noted: “The old convoy had started me thinking about good, two-lane highways, but Germany’s Autobahn or motorway had made me see the wisdom of broader ribbons across the land.”

 It would take another war before the federal government would act on a national highway system. During World War II, a tremendous increase in trucks and new roads were required. The war demonstrated how critical highways were to the defense effort. Thirteen per cent of defense plants received all their supplies by truck, and almost all other plants shipped more than half of their products by vehicle. The war also revealed that local control of highways had led to a confusing variety of design standards. Even federal and state highways did not follow basic standards. Some states allowed trucks up to 36,000 pounds, while others restricted anything over 7,000 pounds.

 A government study recommended a national highway system of 33,920 miles, and congress soon passed the Federal-Aid Highway Act of 1944, which called for strict, centrally controlled design criteria.

 The interstate highway system was finally launched in 1956 and has been hailed as one of the greatest public works projects of the century. To build its 44,000-mile web of highways, bridge, and tunnels, hundreds of unique engineering designs and solutions had to be worked out. Consider the many geographic features of the country: mountains, steep grades, wetlands, rivers, deserts and plains. Variables included the slope of the land, the ability of the pavement to support the load, the intensity of road use, and the nature of the underlying soil. Urban areas were another problem. Innovative designs of roadways, tunnels, bridges, overpasses, and interchanges that could run through or bypass urban areas soon began to weave their way across the country, forever altering the face of America.

 Today, the interstate system links every major city in the U.S., and the U.S. with Canada and Mexico. Built with safety in mind, the highways have wide lanes and shoulders, dividing medians, or barriers, long entry and exit lanes, curves engineered for safe turns, and limited access. The death rate on highways is half that of all other U.S. roads (0.86 deaths per 100 million passenger miles compared to 1.99 deaths per 100 million on all other roads).

 By opening the North American continent, highways have enabled consumer goods and services to reach people in remote and rural areas of the country, spurred the growth of suburbs, and provided people with greater options in term of jobs, access to cultural programs, health care, and other benefits. Above all, the interstate system provides individuals with what they cherish most: personal freedom of mobility.

 The interstate system has been an essential element of the nation’s economic growth in terms of shipping and job creation: more than 75 percent of the nation’s freight deliveries arrive by truck; and most products that arrive by rail or air use interstates for the last leg of the journey by vehicle. Not only has the highway system affected the American economy by providing shipping routes, it has led to the growth of spin-off industries like service stations, motels, restaurants, and shopping centers. It has allowed the relocation of manufacturing plants and other industries from urban areas to rural.

 By the end of the century there was an immense network of paved roads, residential streets, expressways, and freeways built to support millions of vehicles. The highway system was officially renamed for Eisenhower to honor his vision and leadership. The year construction began he said: “Together, the united forces of our communication and transportation systems are dynamic elements in the very name we bear—United States. Without them, we would be a mere alliance of many separate parts.”

注意:此部分试题请在答题卡1上作答。

 1.National standards for paved roads were in place by 1921.

 2.General Eisenhower felt that the broad German motorways made more sense than the two-lane highways of America.

 3.It was in the 1950s that the American government finally took action to build a national highway system.

 4.Many of the problems presented by the country’s geographical features found solutions in innovative engineering projects.

 5.In spite of safety considerations, the death rate on interstate highways is still higher than that of other American roads.

 6.The interstate highway system provides access between major military installations in America.

 7.Service stations, motels and restaurants promoted the development of the interstate highway system.

[附:答题卡1]

 1.[Y] [N] [NG]

 2.[Y] [N] [NG]

 3.[Y] [N] [NG]

 4.[Y] [N] [NG]

 5.[Y] [N] [NG]

 6.[Y] [N] [NG]

 7.[Y] [N] [NG]

8-10题请见答题卡1

[附:答题卡1]

 8.The greatest benefit brought about by the interstate system was ________.

 9.Trucks using the interstate highways deliver more than ________.

 10.The interstate system was renamed after Eisenhower in recognition of ________.

Part III Listening Comprehension

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 8 short conversations and 2 long conversations. At the end of each conversation, one or more questions will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the questions will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer, then mark the corresponding letter on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line though the centre.

注意:此部分答题在答题卡2上作答。

 11.A) The girls got on well with each other.

 B) It’s understandable that girls don’t get along.

 C) She was angry with the other young stars.

 D) The girls lacked the courage to fight.A

 12.A) The woman does her own housework.

 B) The woman needs a housekeeper.

 C) The woman’s house is in a mess.

 D) The woman works as a housekeeper.A

 13.A) The Edwards are quite well-off.

 B) The Edwards should cut down on their living expenses.

 C) It’ll be unwise for the Edwards to buy another house.

 D) It’s too expensive for the Edwards to live in their present house.C

 14.A) The woman didn’t expect it to be so warm at noon.

 B) The woman is sensitive to weather changes.

 C) The weather forecast was unreliable.

 D) The weather turned cold all of a sudden.D

 15.A) At a clinic.

 B) In a supermarket.

 C) At a restaurant.

 D) In an ice cream shop.C

 16.A) The woman did not feel any danger growing up in the Bronx.

 B) The man thinks it was quite safe living in the Bronx district.

 C) The woman started working at an early age to support her family.

 D) The man doesn’t think it safe to send an 8-year-old to buy things.A

 17.A) The man has never seen the woman before.

 B) The two speakers work for the same company.

 C) The two speakers work on the same floor.

 D) The woman is interested in market research.B

 18.A) The woman can’t tolerate any noise.

 B) The man is looking for an apartment.

 C) The man has missed his appointment.

 D) The woman is going to take a train trip.B

Questions 19 to 21 are based on the conversation you have just heard.

 19.A) To make a business report to the woman.

 B) To be interviewed for a job in the woman’s company.

 C) To resign from his position in the woman’s company.

 D) To exchange stock market information with the woman.B

 20.A) He is head of a small trading company.

 B) He works in an international insurance company.

 C) He leads a team of brokers in a big company.

 D) He is a public relations officer in a small company.C

 21.A) The woman thinks Mr. Saunders is asking for more than they can offer.

 B) Mr. Saunders will share one third of the woman’s responsibilities.

 C) Mr. Saunders believes that he deserves more paid vacations.

 D) The woman seems to be satisfied with Mr. Saunders’ past experience.D

Questions 22 to 25 are based on the conversation you have just heard.

 22.A) She’s worried about the seminar.

 B) The man keeps interrupting her.

 C) She finds it too hard.

 D) She lacks interest in it.D

 23.A) The lecturers are boring.

 B) The course is poorly designed.

 C) She prefers Philosophy to English.

 D) She enjoys literature more.C

 24.A) Karen’s friend.

 B) Karen’s parents.

 C) Karen’s lecturers.

 D) Karen’s herself.B

 25.A) Changing her major.

 B) Spending less of her parents’ money.

 C) Getting transferred to the English Department.

 D) Leaving the university.D

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre.

注意: 此部分试题请在答题卡2上作答.

Passage One

Questions 26 to 29 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 26.A) Rent a grave.

 B) Burn the body.

 C) Bury the dead near a church.

 D) Buy a piece of land for a grave.D

 27.A) To solve the problem of lack of land.

 B) To see whether they have decayed.

 C) To follow the Greek religious practice.

 D) To move them to a multi-storey graveyard.A

 28.A) They should be buried lying down.

 B) They should be buried standing up.

 C) They should be buried after being washed.

 D) They should be buried when partially decayed.B

 29.A) Burning dead bodies to ashes.

 B) Storing dead bodies in a remote place.

 C) Placing dead bodies in a bone room.

 D) Digging up dead bodies after three years.A

Passage Two

Questions 30 to 32 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 30.A) Many foreign tourist visit the Unite States every year.

 B) Americans enjoy eating out with their friends.

 C) The United States is a country of immigrants.

 D) Americans prefer foreign foods to their own food.C

 31.A) They can make friends with people from other countries.

 B) They can get to know people of other cultures and their lifestyles.

 C) They can practise speaking foreign languages there.

 D) They can meet with businessmen from all over the world.B

 32.A) The couple cook the dishes and the children help them.

 B) The husband does the cooking and the wife serves as the waitress.

 C) The mother does the cooking while the father and children serving the guests.

 D) A hired cook prepares the dishes and the family members serve the guests.C

Passage Three

Questions 33 to 35 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 33.A) He took them to watch a basketball game.

 B) He trained them to play European football.

 C) He let them compete in getting balls out of a basket.

 D) He taught them to play an exciting new game.D

 34.A) The players found the basket too high to reach.

 B) The players had trouble getting the ball out of the basket.

 C) The players had difficulty understanding the complex rules.

 D) The players soon found the game boring.B

 35.A) By removing the bottom of the basket.

 B) By lowering the position of the basket.

 C) By simplifying the complex rules.

 D) By altering the size of the basket.A

Section C

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from 36 to 43 with the exact words you have just heard. For blanks numbered from 44 to 46 you are required to fill in the missing information. For these blanks, you can either use the exact words you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

注意:此部分试题在答题卡2上;请在答题卡2上作答。

 For Americans, time is money. They say, “you only get so much time in this life; you’d better use it wisely.” The (36) ________ will not be better than the past or present, as American are (37) ________ to see things, unless people use their time for constructive activity. Thus Americans (38) ________ a “well-organized” person, one who has a written list of thins to do and a (39) ________ for doing them. The ideal person is punctual and is (40) ________ of other people’s time. They do not (41) ________ people’s time with conversation or other activity that has no (42) ________ beneficial outcome.

 The American attitude toward time is not (43) ________ shared by others, especially non-Europeans. They are more likely to regard time as (44) ________________________________. One of the more difficult things many students must adjust to in the states is the notion that time must be saved whenever possible and used wisely every day.

 In the contest (45) ________________________________, McDonald’s, KFC, and other fast food establishments are successful in a country where many people want to spend the least amount of time preparing and eating meals. As McDonald’s restaurants (46) ________________________________, bringing not just hamburgers but an emphasis on speed, efficiency, and shiny cleanliness.

Part IV Reading comprehension (reading in depth) (25 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, there is a passage with ten blanks. You are required to select one word for each blank from a list of choices given in a word bank following the passage. Read the passage through carefully before making your choices. Each choice in bank is identified by a letter. Please mark the corresponding letter for each item on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre. You may not use any of the words in the bank more than once.

Questions 47 to 56 are based on the following passage.

 El Nino is name given to the mysterious and often unpredictable change in the climate of the world. This strange __47__ happens every five to eight years. It starts in the Pacific Ocean and is thought to be caused by a failure in the trade winds (信风)which affects the ocean currents driven by these winds. As the trade winds lessen in __48__, the ocean temperatures rise, causing the Peru current flowing in from the east to warm up by as much as 5℃.

 The warming of the ocean has far-reaching effects. The hot, humid (潮湿的) air over the ocean causes severe __49__ thunderstorms. The rainfall is increased across South America. __50__ floods to Peru. In the West pacific, there are droughts affecting Australia and Indonesia. So while some parts of the world prepare for heavy rains and floods, other parts face drought, poor crops and __51__.

 El Nino usually lasts for about 18 months. The 1982-83 El Nino brought the most __52__ weather in modern history. Its effect was worldwide and it left more than 2,000 people dead and caused over eight billion pounds __53__ of damage. The 1990 El Nino lasted until June 1995. Scientists __54__ this to be the longest El Nino for 2,000 years.

 Nowadays, weather experts are able to forecast when an El Nino will __55__, but they are still not __56__ sure what leads to it or what affects how strong it will be.

注意:此部分试题请在答题卡2上作答。


A)estimate

I)completely

B)strength

J)destructive

C)deliberately

K)starvation

D)notify

L)bringing

E)tropical

M)exhaustion

F)phenomenon

N)worth

G)stable

O)strike

H)attraction



Section B

Directions:There are 2 passages in this section. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 57 to 61 are based on the following passage.

 Communications technologies are far from equal when it comes to conveying the truth. The first study to compare honesty across a range of communication media has fund that people are twice as likely to tell lies in phone conversations as they are in emails. The fact that emails are automatically recorded—and can come back to haunt (困扰) you—appears to be the key to the finding.

 Jeff Hancock of Cornell University in Ithaca, New York, asked 30 students to keep a communications diary for a week. In it they noted the number of conversations or email exchanges they had lasting more than 10 minutes, and confessed to how many lies they told. Hancock then worked out the number of lies per conversation for each medium. He found that lies made up 14 per cent of emails, 21 per cent of instant messages, 27 per cent of face-to-face interactions and an astonishing 37 per cent of phone calls.

 His results to be presented at the conference on human-computer interaction in Vienna, Austria, in April, have surprised psychologists. Some expected emailers to be the biggest liars, reasoning that because deception makes people uncomfortable, the detachment(非直接接触) of emailing would make it easier to lie. Others expected people to lie more in face-to-face exchanges because we are most practised at that form of communication.

 But Hancock says it is also crucial whether a conversation is being recorded and could be reread, and whether it occurs in real time. People appear to be afraid to lie when they know the communication could later be used to hold them to account, he says. This is why fewer lies appear in email than on the phone.

 People are also more likely to lie in real time—in a instant message or phone call, say—than if they have time to think of a response, says Hancock. He found many lies are spontaneous (脱口而出的) responses to an unexpected demand, such as: “Do you like my dress?”

 Hancock hopes his research will help companies work our the best ways for their employees to communicate. For instance, the phone might be the best medium foe sales where employees are encouraged to stretch the truth. But, given his result, work assessment where honesty is a priority, might be best done using email.

注意:此部分试题请在答题卡2上作答。

 57.Hancock’s study focuses on ________.

 A) the consequences of lying in various communications media

 B) the success of communications technologies in conveying ideas

 C) people are less likely to lie in instant messages

 D) people’s honesty levels across a range of communications mediaD

 58.Hancock’s research finding surprised those who believed that ________.

 A) people are less likely to lie in instant messages

 B) people are unlikely to lie in face-to-face interactions

 C) people are most likely to lie in email communication

 D) people are twice as likely to lie in phone conversationsA

 59.According to the passage, why are people more likely to tell the truth through certain media of communication?

 A) They are afraid of leaving behind traces of their lies.

 B) They believe that honesty is the best policy.

 C) They tend to be relaxed when using those media.

 D) They are most practised at those forms of communication.A

 60.According to Hancock the telephone is a preferable medium for promoting sales because ________.

 A) salesmen can talk directly to their customers

 B) salesmen may feel less restrained to exaggerate

 C) salesmen can impress customers as being trustworthy

 D) salesmen may pass on instant messages effectivelyB

 61.It can be inferred from the passage that ________.

 A) honesty should be encouraged in interpersonal communications

 B) more employers will use emails to communicate with their employees

 C) suitable media should be chosen for different communication purposes

 D) email is now the dominant medium of communication within a companyC

Passage Two

Questions 62 to 66 are based on the following passage.

 In a country that defines itself by ideals, not by shared blood, who should be allowed to come work and live here? In the wake of the Sept. 11 attacks these questions have never seemed more pressing.

 On Dec. 11, 2001, as part of the effort to increase homeland security, federal and local authorities in 14 states staged “Operation Safe Travel”—raids on airports to arrest employees with false identification (身份证明). In Salt Lake City there were 69 arrests. But those captured were anything but terrorists, most of them illegal immigrants from Central or South America. Authorities said the undocumented workers’ illegal status made them open to blackmail (讹诈) by terrorists.

 Many immigrants in Salt Lake City were angered by the arrests and said they felt as if they were being treated like disposable goods.

 Mayor Anderson said those feelings were justified to a certain extent. “We’re saying we want you to work in these places, we’re going to look the other way in terms of what our laws are, and then when it’s convenient for us, or when we can try to make a point in terms of national security, especially after Sept. 11, then you’re disposable. There are whole families being uprooted for all of the wrong reasons,” Anderson said.

 If Sept. 11 had never happened, the airport workers would not have been arrested and could have gone on quietly living in America, probably indefinitely. Ana Castro, a manager at a Ben & Jerry’s ice cream shop at the airport had been working 10 years with the same false Social Security card when she was arrested in the December airport raid. Now she and her family are living under the threat of deportation (驱逐出境). Castro’s case is currently waiting to be settled. While she awaits the outcome, the government has granted her permission to work here and she has returned to her job at Ben & Jerry’s.

 62.According to the author, the United States claims to be a nation ________.

 A) composed of people having different values

 B) encouraging individual pursuits

 C) sharing common interests

 D) founded on shared idealsD

 63.How did the immigrants in Salt Lake City feel about “Operation Safe Travel”?

 A) Guilty.

 B) Offended.

 C) Disappointed.

 D) Discouraged.B

 64.Undocumented workers became the target of “Operation Safe Travel” because ________.

 A) evidence was found that they were potential terrorists

 B) most of them worked at airports under threat of terrorists

 C) terrorists might take advantage of their illegal status

 D) they were reportedly helping hide terrorists around the airportC

 65.By saying “... we’re going to look the other way in terms of what our laws are” (Line 2, Para. 4), Mayor Anderson means “________”.

 A) we will turn a blind eye to your illegal status

 B) we will examine the laws in a different way

 C) there are other ways of enforcing the law

 D) the existing laws must not be ignoredC

 66.What do we learn about Ana Castro from the last paragraph?

 A) She will be deported sooner or later.

 B) She is allowed to stay permanently.

 C) Her case has been dropped.

 D) Her fate remains uncertain.D

Part V Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre.

 Do you wake up every day feeling too tired, or even upset? If so, then a new alarm clock could be just for you.

 The clock, called SleepSmart, measures your sleep cycle, and waits __67__ you to be in your lightest phase of sleep __68__ rousing you. Its makers say that should __69__ you wake up feeling refreshed every morning.

 As you sleep you pass __70__ a sequence of sleep states—light sleep, deep sleep and REM (rapid eye movement) sleep—that __71__ approximately every 90 minutes. The point in that cycle at which you wake can __72__ how you feel later, and may __73__ have a greater impact than how much or little you have slept. Being roused during a light phase __74__ you are more likely to wake up energetic.

 SleepSmart __75__ the distinct pattern of brain waves __76__ during each phase of sleep, via a headband equipped __77__ electrodes (电极) and a microprocessor. This measures the electrical activity of the wearer’s brain, in much the __78__ way as some machines used for medical and research __79__, and communicates wirelessly with a clock unit near the bed. You __80__ the clock with the latest time at __81__ you want to be wakened, and it __82__ duly (适时地) wakes you during the last light sleep phase before that.

 The __83__ was invented by a group of students at Brown University in Rhode Island __84__ a friend complained of waking up tired and performing poorly on a test. “__85__ sleep-deprived people ourselves, we started thinking of __86__ to do about it,” says Eric Shashoua, a recent college graduate and now chief executive officer of Axon Sleep Research Laboratories, a company created by the students to develop their idea.

 67.A) beside

 B) near

 C) for

 D) aroundC

 68.A) upon

 B) before

 C) towards

 D) tillB

 69.A) ensure

 B) assure

 C) require

 D) requestA

 70.A) through

 B) into

 C) about

 D) onA

 71.A) reveals

 B) reverses

 C) resumes

 D) repeatsD

 72.A) effect

 B) affect

 C) reflect

 D) perfectB

 73.A) already

 B) ever

 C) never

 D) evenD

 74.A) means

 B) marks

 C) says

 D) dictatesA

 75.A) removes

 B) relieves

 C) records

 D) recallsC

 76.A) proceeded

 B) produced

 C) pronounced

 D) progressedB

 77.A) by

 B) of

 C) with

 D) overC

 78.A) familiar

 B) similar

 C) identical

 D) sameD

 79.A) findings

 B) prospects

 C) proposals

 D) purposesD

 80.A) prompt

 B) program

 C) plug

 D) planB

 81.A) where

 B) this

 C) which

 D) thatC

 82.A) then

 B) also

 C) almost

 D) yetA

 83.A) claim

 B) conclusion

 C) concept

 D) explanationC

 84.A) once

 B) after

 C) since

 D) whileB

 85.A) Besides

 B) Despite

 C) To

 D) AsD

 86.A) what

 B) how

 C) whether

 D) whenA

Part VI Translation (5 minutes)

Directions:Complete the sentences on Answer Sheet 2 by translating into English the Chinese given in brackets.

 87.Having spent some time in the city, he had no trouble ________ (找到去历史博物馆的路).

 88.________ (为了挣钱供我上学)Mother often takes on more work than is good for her.

 89.The professor required that ________ (我们交研究报告)

 90.The more you explain, ________ (我愈糊涂).

 91.Though a skilled worker, ________ (他被公司解雇了) last week because of the economic crisis.

2006624日新四级参考答案

范文:

On Students Choosing Lecturers

 Nowadays, some universities give students the right to choose who teaches some of their classes. This has led to some debate over whether students should be given this much power.

 There are several factors that students consider when choosing a lecturer, including the teaching style of the lecturer, the lecturer’s academic background, and the lecturer’s reputation among students. The ideal lecturer is one who has an interesting teaching style, a diverse academic background, and a good reputation among students.

 There are both positive and negative aspects to allowing students to choose their lecturers. Giving students the choice encourages them to take ownership for their classes, and also puts pressure on teachers to improve their teaching quality.

 However, the factors that students consider might not be the ones that lead to the highest quality of education. Schools might end up with lecturers who teach interesting classes without much content.

 1.N

 2.Y

 3.Y

 4.Y

 5.N

 6.NG

 7.N

 8.The greatest benefit brought about by the interstate system was personal freedom of mobility

 9.Trucks using the interstate highways deliver more than 75 percent

 10.The interstate system was renamed after Eisenhower in recognition his vision and leadership


11.A

12.A

13.C

14.D

15.C

16.A

17.B

18.B

19.B

20.C

21.D

22.D

23.C

24.B

25.D

26.D

27.A

28.B

29.A

30.C

31.B

32.C

33.D

34.B

35.A


 36.future

 37.trained

 38.admire

 39.schedule

 40.considerate

 41.waste

 42.visible

 43.necessarily

 44.something that is simply there around them, not something they can use

 45.the fast food industry can be seen as a clear example of American cultural product

 46.spread around the world, they have been viewed as symbols of American society and culture

 47.F phenomenon

 48.B strength

 49.E tropical

 50.L bringing

 51.K starvation

 52.J destructive

 53.N worth

 54.A estimate

 55.O strike

 56.I completely



57.D

58.C

59.A

60.B

61.C

62.D

63.B

64.C

65.C

66.D

67.C

68.B

69.A

70.A

71.D

72.B

73.D

74.A

75.C

76.B

77.C

78.D

79.D

80.B

81.C

82.A

83.C

84.B

85.D

86.A





 87.finding the way to the history museum

 88.In order to support my university studies (to finance my education)

 89.we hand in our research report(s)

 90.the more confused I am

 91.he was fired by the company

2006624日新四级听力原文

Section A

 11.M: What was it like working with those young stars?

 W: It was a great group, I always got mad when people said that we didn’t get along, just because we’re girls, there was never a fight. We had a great time.

 Q: What does the woman mean?

 12.M: Are you telling me you don’t have a housekeeper?

 W: No, we don’t. if you make a mess, you clean up yourself.

 Q: What do we learn from this conversation?

 13.M: I hear that the Edwards are thinking of buying another house.

 W: Should they be doing that with all the other expenses they have o pay? Anyhow, they are over 70 now, their present house is not too bad.

 Q: What does the man imply?

 14.W: You look like you are freezing to death. Why don’t you put this on?

 M: Thank you, it was so warm at noon, I didn’t expect the weather to change so quickly.

 Q: What do we learn from the conversation?

 15.W: I’ll have the steak, French fries, and let’s see, chocolate ice cream for dissert.

 M: Oh, oh, you know these things will ruin your health, too much fat and sugar, how about ordering some vegetables and fruit instead?

 Q: Where does the conversation most probably take place?

 16.W: What was it like growing up in New York’s Bronx District? Was it safe?

 M: To me it was, it was all I knew. My mom would send me to the shop and I’d go and buy things when I was about 8 years old.

 Q: What do we learn from the conversation?

 17.W: Nice weather, isn’t it? Oh, I’ve seen you around the office, but I don’t think we’ve met, I am Henry Smith, I work in the Market Research Section.

 M: Nice to meet you, Henry, I am Helen Grant, I am in the Advertising Section on the ninth floor.

 Q: What can we infer from the conversation?

 18.M: Ma’am, I hear you have an apartment for rent, can I take a look at it?

 W: Sure, you’re welcome any time by appointment, but I have to tell you the building is close to a railways. And if you can’t put up with the noise you might as well save the trip.

 Q: What do we learn from the conversation?

 Conversation 1

 W: Please have a seat, Mr. Saunders. I received your job resume last week, and it was very impressed.

 M: Thank you!

 W: We are a small financial company trading mostly stocks and bonds may I ask why you are so interested in working for us?

 M: Your company has an impressive reputation and I’ve always wanted to work for a smaller company.

 W: That’s good to hear. Would you mind telling me a little bit about your present job?

 M: I’m currently working in a large international company in charge of a team of 8 brokers. We buy and sell stocks for major clients worldwide.

 W: Why do you think you are the right candidate for this position?

 M: As a head broker, I have a lot of experiences in the stock market, I deal with the clients on the daily bases, and I enjoy working with people.

 W: Well, you might just be the person we’ve been looking for. Do you have any questions?

 M: Aha, if I were hired, how many accounts would I be handling?

 W: you will be working with two other head brokers, in another words, you will be handling about a third of our clients.

 M: And who would I report to?

 W: Directly to me.

 M: I see. What kind of benefits package do you offer?

 W: Two weeks of paid vacation in your first year employment, you are also been entitled to medical and dental insurance, but this is something you should discuss with our Personnel Department. Do you have any other questions?

 M: No not at the moment.

 W: Well, I have to discuss you application with my colleagues and we’ll get back to you early next week.

 M: OK, thanks, it’s been nice meeting you!

 W: Nice meeting you too! And thanks for coming in today.

 19.What’s the purpose of Mr. Saunders’ visit?

 20.What is Mr. Saunders’ current job?

 21.What can we conclude from the conversation?

 Conversation 2

 M: Hey, Karen, you are not really reading it, are you?

 W: Pardon?

 M: The book! You haven’t turned the page in the last ten minutes.

 W: No, Jim, I suppose I haven’t. I need to get through it, though, but I keep drifting away.

 M: So it doesn’t really hold your interest?

 W: No, not really. I wouldn’t bother with it, to be honest, but I have to read it for a seminar. I’m at a university.

 M: It’s a labor of labor then rather than a labor of love.

 W: I should say, I don’t like Dickens at all really, the author, indeed, I am starting to like the whole course less and less.

 M: It’s not just the book,, it’s the curse as well?

 W: Yeah, in a way, although the curse itself isn’t really that bad, a lot of it is pretty good, in fact, and the lecturer is fine, as to me, I suppose, you see, I want to do philosophy rather than English, but my parents took me out of it.

 M: So the courses are OK as such, it’s just that had if been left to you, you would choose a different one.

 W: Oh, they had my best interest and heart of course, my parents, they always do, don’t they? They believe that my job prospect would be pretty limited with the degree of philosophy. Plus, they give me a really generous allowance, but I am beginning to feel that I’m wasting my time and their money. They would be so disappointed though if I told them I was quitting.

 22.Why can’t Karen concentrate on the book?

 23.Why is Karen starting to like the course less and less?

 24.Who thinks Philosophy graduates have limited job opportunities?

 25.What is Karen thinking of doing?

Section B

 Passage One

 In Greece, only rich people will rest in peace for ever when they die. Most of the population, however, will be undisturbed for only three years, then they will be dug up, washed, compressed into a small tin box, and placed in a bone room. If the body has only partially decayed, it is reburied in a smaller cheaper grave, but not for long, the body will be dug up again some time later when it has fully decayed. Buying a piece of land for a grave is the only way to avoid this process. The cost of the grave is so great that most p0eople choose to rent the grave for three years and even after it has been dug up, lasting peace is still not guaranteed. If no one pays for renting space in the bone room, the skeleton is removed and stored in a building in a poor part of the town. Lack of space in Athens is the main reason why the dead are dug up after the three years. The city is so overcrowded that sometimes dead bodies are kept in the hospitals for over a week until a grave is found. Athens’ city council wants to introduce cremation, that is burning dead bodies as a means of dealing with the problems. But the Greek church resists this practice, they believe the only place where people burn is hell, so burning dead bodies is against the Greek concept of life after death. To save space, the church suggested burying the bodies standing up instead of lying down. Some people proposed building multi-storey underground grave yards.

 26.What must Greeks do to keep the dead resting in ever-lasting peace?

 27.Why are most dead bodies in Athens dug up after three years?

 28.What suggestions does the church give about the burying of dead bodies?

 29.What practice does the Greek church object to?

 Passage Two

 If you visit a big city anywhere in the world, you will probably find a restaurant would serve the food of your own native country. Most large cities in the United States offer international sample of foods. Many people enjoy eating the food of other nations. This is probably one reason why there are so many different kinds of restaurants in the United States. A second reason is that many Americans come from other part of the world. They enjoy tasting the foods of their native lands. In the city of Detroit, for example, there are many people from western Europe, Greece, Latin America, and the Far East. There are many restaurants in Detroit which serve the foods of these areas. There are many other international restaurants too. Americans enjoy the foods in these restaurants as well as the opportunity to better understand the people and their way of life. One of the most common international restaurants to be found in the United States is the Italian restaurant. The restaurant may be a small business run by a single family. The mother of the family cooks all of the dishes, and the father and children serve the people who come to eat there. Or it may be a large restaurant owned by several different people who worked together in the business. Many Italian dishes that Americans enjoy are made with meats, tomatoes and cheese, they are very delicious and tasty.

 30.Why are there so many international restaurants in the United States?

 31.Why do Americans like to go to international restaurants apart from enjoying the foods there?

 32.How is a typical Italian family restaurant run in the United States?

 Passage Three

 One winter day in 1891, a class at a training school in Massachusetts, U.S.A, went into the gym for their daily exercises. Since the football season had ended, most of the young man felt they were in for a boring time.

 But their teacher, James Nasmith had other ideas. He had been working for a long time on a new game that would have the excitement of the American football. Nasmith showed the men a basket he had hung at the each end of the gym, and explained that they were going to sue a round European football, at first everybody tried to throw the ball into the basket no matter where he was standing. “Pass! Pass!” Nasmith kept shouting, blowing his whistle to stop the excited players. Slowly, they began to understand what was wanted of them. The problem with the new game, which was soon called “basketball”, was getting the ball out of the basket. They used ordinary food baskets with bottoms and the ball, of course, stayed inside. At first, someone had to climb up every time a basket was scored. It was several years before someone came up with the idea of removing the bottom of the basket and letting the ball fall through. There have been many changes in the rules since then, and basketball has become one of the world’s most popular sports.

 33.What did Nasmith do to entertain his students one winter day?

 34.According the speaker, what was the problem with the new game?

 35.How was the problem with the new game solved?

20061223日大学英语新四级(CET-4)真题试卷

Part I Writing (30 minutes)

注意:此部分试题在答题卡1上。

Directions:For this part, you are allowed 30 minute to write a short essay on the topic of students selecting their lectures. You should write at least 120 words following the outline given bellow:

 1.许多人喜欢在除夕夜看春节晚会

 2.但有些人提出取消春节晚会

 3.我的看法

Part II Reading Comprehension (Skimming and Scanning) (15 minutes)

Directions:In this part, you will have 15 minute to go over the passage quickly and answer the questions on Answer Sheet1.

For questions 1-7, mark

Y (for YES)if the statement agrees with the information given in the passage;

N (for NO)if statement contradicts the information given in the passage;

NG (for NOTGIVEN)if the information is not given in the passage.

For question 8-10, complete the sentences with the information given in the passage.

Six Secrets of High-Energy People

 There’s an energy crisis in America, and it has nothing to do with fossil fuels. Millions of us get up each morning already weary over the day holds. “I just can’t get started,” people say. But it’s not physical energy that most of us lack. Sure, we could all use extra sleep and a better diet. But in truth, people are healthier today than at any time in history. I can almost guarantee that if you long for more energy, the problem is not with your body.

 What you’re seeking is not physical energy. It’s emotional energy. Yet, sad to say, life sometimes seems designed to exhaust our supply. We work too hard. We have family obligations. We encounter emergencies and personal crises. No wonder so many of us suffer from emotional fatigue, a kind of utter exhaustion of the spirit.

 And yet we all know people who are filled with joy, despite the unpleasant circumstances of their lives. Even as a child, I observed people who were poor, or disabled, or ill, but who nonetheless faced life with optimism and vigor. Consider Laura Hillenbrand, who despite an extremely weak body, wrote the best-seller Seabiscuit. Hillenbrand barely had enough physical energy to drag herself out of bed to write. But she was fueled by having a story she wanted to share. It was emotional energy that helped her succeed.

 Unlike physical energy, which is finite and diminishes with age, emotional energy is unlimited and has nothing to do with genes or upbringing. So how do you get it? You can’t simply tell yourself to be positive. You must take action. Here are six practical strategies that work.

1. Do something new.

 Very little that’s new occurs in our lives. The impact of this sameness on our emotional energy is gradual, but huge: It’s like a tire with a slow leak. You don’t notice it at first, but eventually you’ll get a flat. It’s up to you to plug the leak—even though there are always a dozen reasons to stay stuck in your dull routines of life. That’s where Maura, 36, a waitress, found herself a year ago.

 Fortunately, Maura had a lifeline—a group of women friends who meet regularly to discuss their lives. Their lively discussions spurred Maura to make small but nevertheless life altering changes. She joined a gym in the next town. She changed her look with a short haircut and new black T-shirts. Eventually, Maura gathered the courage to quit her job and start her own business.

 Here’s a challenge: If it’s something you wouldn’t ordinarily do, do it. Try a dish you’ve never eaten. Listen to music you’d ordinarily tune out. You’ll discover these small things add to your emotional energy.

2. Reclaim life’s meaning.

 So many of my patients tell me that their lives used to have meaning, but that somewhere along the line things went stale.

 The first step in solving this meaning shortage is to figure out what you really care about, and then do something about it. A case in point is Ivy, 57, a pioneer in investment banking. “I mistakenly believed that all the money I made would mean something,” she says. “But I feel lost, like a 22-year-old wondering what to do with her life.” Ivy’s solution? She started a program that shows Wall Streeters how to donate time and money to poor children. In the process, Ivy filled her life with meaning.

3. Put yourself in the fun zone.

 Most of us grown-ups are seriously fun-deprived. High-energy people have the same day-to-day work as the rest of us, but they manage to find something enjoyable in every situation. A real estate broker I know keeps herself amused on the job by mentally redecorating the houses she shows to clients. “I love imagining what even the most run-down house could look like with a little tender loving care,” she says. “It’s a challenge—and the least desirable properties are usually the most fun.”

 We all define fun differently, of course, but I can guarantee this: If you put just a bit of it into your day, you energy will increase quickly.

4. Bid farewell to guilt and regret.

 Everyone’s past is filled with regrets that still cause pain. But from an emotional energy point of view, they are dead weights that keep us from moving forward. While they can’t merely be willed away, I do recommend you remind yourself that whatever happened is in the past, and nothing can change that. Holding on to the memory only allows the damage to continue into the present.

5. Make up your mind.

 Say you’ve been thinking about cutting your hair short. Will it look stylish—or too extreme?

 You endlessly think it over. Having the decision hanging over your head is a huge energy drain.

 Every time you can’t decide, you burden yourself with alternatives. Quit thinking that you have to make the right decision; instead, make a choice and don’t look back.

6. Give to get.

 Emotional energy has a kind of magical quality; the more you give, the more you get back. This is the difference between emotional and physical energy. With the latter, you have to get it to be able to give it. With the former, however, you get it by giving it.

 Start by asking everyone you meet, “How are you?” as if you really want to know, then listen to the reply. Be the one who hears. Most of us also need to smile more often. If you don’t smile at the person you love first thing in the morning, you’re sucking energy out of your relationship. Finally, help another person—and make the help real, concrete. Give a massage (按摩) to someone you love, or cook her dinner. Then, expand the circle to work. Try asking yourself what you’d do if your goal were to be helpful rather than efficient.

 After all, if it’s true that what goes around comes around, why not make sure that what’s circulating around you is the good stuff?

注意:此部分试题请在答题卡1上作答。

 1.The energy crisis in America discussed here mainly refers to a shortage of fossil fuels.

 2.People these days tend to lack physical energy.

 3.Laura Hillenbrand is an example cited to show how emotional energy can contribute to one’s success in life.

 4.The author believes emotional energy is inherited and genetically determined.

 5.Even small changes people make in their lives can help increase their emotional energy.

 6.Ivy filled her life with meaning by launching a program to help poor children.

 7.The real-estate broker the author knows is talented in home redecoration.

 8.People holding on to sad memories of the past will find it difficult to ________.

 9.When it comes to decision-making, one should make a quick choice without ________.

 10.Emotional energy is in a way different from physical energy in that the more you give, ________.

Part III Listing Comprehension (35 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, you will hear 8 short conversations and 2 long conversations. At the end of each conversation, one or more questions will be asked about what was said. Both the conversation and the questions will be spoken only once. After each question there will be a pause. During the pause, you must read the four choices marked A), B), C) and D), and decide which is the best answer, then mark the corresponding letter on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line though the centre.

注意:此部分答题在答题卡2上作答。

 11.A) Plan his budget carefully.

 B) Give her more information.

 C) Ask someone else for advice.

 D) Buy a gift for his girlfriend.B

 12.A) She’ll have some chocolate cake.

 B) She’ll take a look at the menu.

 C) She’ll go without dessert.

 D) She’ll prepare the dinner.C

 13.A) The man can speak a foreign language.

 B) The woman hopes to improve her English.

 C) The woman knows many different languages.

 D) The man wishes to visit many more countries.A

 14.A) Go to the library.

 B) Meet the woman.

 C) See Professor Smith.

 D) Have a drink in the bar.C

 15.A) She isn’t sure when Professor Bloom will be back.

 B) The man shouldn’t be late for his class.

 C) The man can come back sometime later.

 D) She can pass on the message for the man.D

 16.A) He has a strange personality.

 B) He’s got emotional problems.

 C) His illness is beyond cure.

 D) His behavior is hard to explain.B

 17.A) The tickets are more expensive than expected.

 B) The tickets are sold in advance at half price.

 C) It’s difficult to buy the tickets on the spot.

 D) It’s better to buy the tickets beforehand.D

 18.A) He turned suddenly and ran into a tree.

 B) He was hit by a fallen box from a truck.

 C) He drove too fast and crashed into a truck.

 D) He was trying to overtake the truck ahead of him.A

Questions 19 to 21 are based on the conversation you have just heard.

 19.A) To go boating on the St. Lawrence River.

 B) To go sightseeing in Quebec Province.

 C) To call on a friend in Quebec City.

 D) To attend a wedding in Montreal.D

 20.A) Study the map of Quebec Province.

 B) Find more about Quebec Province.

 C) Brush up on her French.

 D) Learn more about the local customs.C

 21.A) It’s most beautiful in summer.

 B) It has many historical buildings.

 C) It was greatly expanded in the 18th century.

 D) It’s the only French-speaking city in Canada.B

Questions 22 to 25 are based on the conversation you have just heard.

 22.A) It was about a little animal.

 B) It took her six years to write.

 C) It was adapted from a fairy tale.

 D) It was about a little girl and her pet.A

 23.A) She knows how to write best-selling novels.

 B) She can earn a lot of money by writing for adults.

 C) She is able to win enough support from publishers.

 D) She can make a living by doing what she likes.D

 24.A) The characters.

 B) The readers.

 C) Her ideas.

 D) Her life experiences.B

 25.A) She doesn’t really know where they originated.

 B) She mainly drew on stories of ancient saints.

 C) They popped out of her childhood dreams.

 D) They grew out of her long hours of thinking.A

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on the Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

 26.A) Monitor students’ sleep patterns.

 B) Help students concentrate in class.

 C) Record students’ weekly performance.

 D) Ask students to complete a sleep report.C

 27.A) Declining health.

 B) Lack of attention.

 C) Loss of motivation.

 D) Improper behavior.B

 28.A) They should make sure their children are always punctual for school.

 B) They should ensure their children grow up in a healthy environment.

 C) They should help their children accomplish high-quality work.

 D) They should see to it that their children have adequate sleep.D

Passage Two

Questions 29 to 32 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 29.A) She stopped being a homemaker.

 B) She became a famous educator.

 C) She became a public figure.

 D) She quit driving altogether.C

 30.A) A motorist’s speeding.

 B) Her running a stop sign.

 C) Her lack of driving experience.

 D) A motorist’s failure to concentrate.D

 31.A) Nervous and unsure of herself.

 B) Calm and confident of herself.

 C) Courageous and forceful.

 D) Distracted and reluctant.A

 32.A) More strict training of women drivers.

 B) Restrictions on cell phone use while driving.

 C) Improved traffic conditions in cities.

 D) New regulations to ensure children’s safety.B

Passage Three

Questions 33 to 35 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 33.A) They haven’t devoted as much energy to medicine as to space travel.

 B) Three are too many kinds of cold viruses for them to identify.

 C) It is not economical to find a cure for each type of cold.

 D) They believe people can recover without treatment.B

 34.A) They reveal the seriousness of the problem.

 B) They indicate how fast the virus spreads.

 C) They tell us what kind of medicine to take.

 D) They show our body is fighting the virus.D

 35.A) It actually does more harm than good.

 B) It causes damage to some organs of our body.

 C) It works better when combined with other remedies.

 D) It helps us to recover much sooner.A

Section C

Directions:In this section, you will hear a passage three times. When the passage is read for the first time, you should listen carefully for its general idea. When the passage is read for the second time, you are required to fill in the blanks numbered from 36 to 43 with the exact words you have just heard. For blanks numbered from 44 to 46 you are required to fill in the missing information. For these blanks, you can either use the exact words you have just heard or write down the main points in your own words. Finally, when the passage is read for the third time, you should check what you have written.

注意:此部分试题在答题卡2上;请在答题卡2上作答。

 You probably have noticed that people express similar ideas in different ways depending on the situation they are in. This is very (36) ________. All languages have two general levels of (37) ________: a formal level and an informal level. English is no (38) ________. The difference in these two levels is the situation in which you use a (39) ________ level. Formal language is the kind of language you find in textbooks, (40) ________ books and in business letters. You would also use formal English in compositions and (41) ________ that you write in school. Informal language is used in conversation with (42) ________, family members and friends, and when we write (43) ________ notes or letters to close friends.

 Formal language is different from informal language in several ways. First, formal language tends to be more polite. (44) ________________________________. For example, I might say to a friend or a family member “Close the door, please,” (45) ________________________________.

 Another difference between formal and informal language is some of the vocabulary. (46) ________________________________. Let’s say that I really like soccer. If I am talking to my friend I might say “I am just crazy about soccer!” But if I were talking to my boss, I would probably say “I really enjoy soccer.”

Part IV Reading Comprehension (reading in depth) (25 minutes)

Section A

Directions:In this section, there is a passage with ten blanks. You are required to select one word for each blank from a list of choices given in a word bank following the passage. Read the passage through carefully before making your choices. Each choice in bank is identified by a letter. Please mark the corresponding letter for each item on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre. You may not use any of the words in the bank more than once.

Questions 47 to 56 are based on the following passage.

 The flood of women into the job market boosted economic growth and changed U.S. society in many ways. Many in-home jobs that used to be done __47__ by women—ranging from family shopping to preparing meals to doing __48__ work—still need to be done by someone. Husbands and children now do some of these jobs, a __49__ that has changed the target market for many products. Or a working woman may face a crushing “poverty of time” and look for help elsewhere, creating opportunities for producers of frozen meals, child care centers, dry cleaners, financial services, and the like.

 Although there is still a big wage __50__ between men and women, the income working women __51__ gives them new independence and buying power. For example, women now __52__ about half of all cars. Not long ago, many cars dealers __53__ women shoppers by ignoring them or suggesting that they come back with their husbands. Now car companies have realized that women are __54__ customers. It’s interesting that some leading Japanese car dealers were the first to __55__ pay attention to women customers. In Japan, fewer women have jobs or buy cars—the Japanese society is still very much male-oriented. Perhaps it was the __56__ contrast with Japanese society that prompted American firms to pay more attention to women buyers.

注意:此部分试题请在答题卡2上作答


A)scale

I)potential

B)retailed

J)gap

C)generate

K)voluntary

D)extreme

L)excessive

E)technically

M)insulted

F)affordable

N)purchase

G)situation

O)primarily

H)really



Section B

Directions:There are 2 passages in this section. Each passage is followed by some questions or unfinished statements. For each of them there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D). You should decide on the best choice and mark the corresponding letter on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre.

Passage One

Questions 57 to 61 are based on the following passage.

 Reaching new peaks of popularity in North America is Iceberg Water, which is harvested from icebergs off the coast of Newfoundland, Canada.

 Arthur von Wiesenberger, who carries the title Water Master, is one of the few water critics in North America. As a boy, he spent time in the larger cities of Italy, France and Switzerland, where bottled water is consumed daily. Even then, he kept a water journal, noting the brands he liked best. “My dog could tell the difference between bottled and tap water,” He says.

 But is plain tap water all that bad? Not at all. In fact, New York’s municipal water for more than a century was called the champagne of tap water and until recently considered among the best in the world in terms of both taste and purity. Similarly, a magazine in England found that tap water from the Thames River tasted better than several leading brands of bottled water that were 400 times more expensive.

 Nevertheless, soft-drink companies view bottled water as the next battle-ground for market share—this despite the fact that over 25 percent of bottled water comes from tap water: PepsiCo’s Aquafina and Coca-Cola’s Dasani are both purified tap water rather than spring water.

 As diners thirst for leading brands, bottlers and restaurateurs salivate (垂涎) over the profits. A restaurant’s typical mark-up on wine is 100 to 150 percent, whereas on bottled water it’s often 300 to 500 percent. But since water is much cheaper than wine, and many of the fancier brands aren’t available in stores, most diners don’t notice or care.

 As a result, some restaurants are turning up the pressure to sell bottled water. According to an article in The Street Journal, some of the more shameless tactics include placing attractive bottles on the table for a visual sell, listing brands on the menu without prices, and pouring bottled water without even asking the diners if they want it.

 Regardless of how it’s sold, the popularity of bottled water taps into our desire for better health, our wish to appear cultivated, and even a longing for lost purity.

注意:此部分试题请在答题卡2上作答。

 57.What do we know about Iceberg Water from the passage?

 A) It is a kind of iced water.

 B) It is just plain tap water.

 C) It is a kind of bottled water.

 D) It is a kind of mineral water.C

 58.By saying “My dog could tell the difference between bottled and tap water” (Line 4 Para. 2), von Wiesenberger wants to convey the message that ________.

 A) plain tap water is certainly unfit for drinking

 B) bottled water is clearly superior to tap water

 C) bottled water often appeals more to dogs taste

 D) dogs can usually detect a fine difference in tasteB

 59.The “fancier brands” (Line 3 Para. 5) refers to ________.

 A) tap water from the Thames River

 B) famous wines not sold in ordinary stores

 C) PepsiCo’s Aquafina and Coca-Cola’s Dasani

 D) expensive bottled water with impressive namesD

 60.Why are some restaurants turning up the pressure to sell bottled water?

 A) Bottled water brings in huge profits.

 B) Competition from the wine industry is intense.

 C) Most diners find bottled water affordable.

 D) Bottled water satisfied diners’ desire to fashionable.A

 61.According to passage, why is bottled water so popular?

 A) It is much cheaper than wine.

 B) It is considered healthier.

 C) It appeals to more cultivated people.

 D) It is more widely promoted in the market.B

Passage Two

 As we have seen, the focus of medical care in our society has been shifting from curing disease to preventing disease—especially in terms of changing our many unhealthy behaviors, such as poor eating habits, smoking, and failure to exercise. The line of thought involved in this shift can be pursued further. Imagine a person who is about the right weight, but does not eat verynutritious (有营养的) foods, who feels OK but exercises only occasionally, who goes to work every day, but is not an outstanding worker, who drinks a few beers at home most nights but does not drive while drunk, and who has no chest pains or abnormal blood counts, but sleeps a lot and often feels tired. This person is not ill. He may not even be at risk for any particular disease. But we can imagine that this person could be a lot healthier.

 The field of medicine has not traditionally distinguished between someone who is merely “not ill” and someone who is in excellent health and pays attention to the body’s special needs. Both types have simply been called “well.” In recent years, however, some health specialists have begun to apply the terms “well” and “wellness” only to those who are actively striving to maintain and improve their health. People who are well are concerned with nutrition and exercise, and they make a point of monitoring their body’s condition. Most important, perhaps, people who are well take active responsibility for all matters related to their health. Even people who have a physical disease or handicap (缺陷) may be “well,” in this new sense, if they make an effort to maintain the best possible health they can in the face of their physical limitations. “Wellness” may perhaps best be viewed not as a state that people can achieve, but as an ideal that people can strive for. People who are well are likely to be better able to resist disease and to fight disease when it strikes. And by focusing attention on healthy ways of living, the concept of wellness can have a beneficial impact on the ways in which people face the challenges of daily life.

 62.Today medical care is placing more stress on ________.

 A) keeping people in a healthy physical condition

 B) monitoring patients’ body functions

 C) removing people’s bad living habits

 D) ensuring people’s psychological well-beingC

 63.In the first paragraph, people are reminded that ________.

 A) good health is more than not being ill

 B) drinking, even if not to excess, could be harmful

 C) regular health checks are essential to keeping fit

 D) prevention is more difficult than cureB

 64.Traditionally, a person is considered “well” if he ________.

 A) does not have any unhealthy living habits

 B) does not have any physical handicaps

 C) is able to handle his daily routines

 D) is free from any kind of diseaseD

 65.According to the author, the true meaning of “wellness” is for people ________.

 A) to best satisfy their body’s special needs

 B) to strive to maintain the best possible health

 C) to meet the strictest standards of bodily health

 D) to keep a proper balance between work and leisureB

 66.According to what the author advocates, which of the following groups of people would be considered healthy?

 A) People who have strong muscles as well as slim figures.

 B) People who are not presently experiencing any symptoms of disease.

 C) People who try to be as possible, regardless of their limitations.

 D) People who can recover from illness even without seeking medical care.C

Part V Cloze (15 minutes)

Directions:There are 20 blanks in the following passage. For each blank there are four choices marked A), B), C) and D) on the right side of the paper. You should choose the ONE that best fits into the passage. Then mark the corresponding letter on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre.

 Language is the most astonishing behavior in the animal kingdom. It is the species-typical behavior that sets humans completely __67__ from all other animals. Language is a means of communication, __68__ it is much more than that. Many animals can __69__. The dance of the honeybee communicates the location of flowers __70__ other members of thehive (蜂群). But human language permits communication about anything, __71__ things like unicorn (独角兽) that have never existed. The key __72__ in the fact that the units of meaning, words, can be __73__ together in different ways, according to __74__, to communicate different meanings.

 Language is the most important learning we do. Nothing __75__ humans so much as our ability to communicate abstract thoughts, __76__ about the universe, the mind, love, dreams, or ordering a drink. It is an immensely complex __77__ that we take for granted. Indeed, we are not aware of most __78__ of our speech and understanding. Consider what happens when one person is speaking to __79__. The speaker has to translate thoughts into __80__ language. Brain imaging studies suggest that the time from thoughts to the __81__ of speech is extremely fast, only 0.04 seconds! The listener must hear the sounds to __82__ out what the speaker means. He must use the sounds of speech to __83__ the words spoken, understand the pattern of __84__ of the words (sentences), and finally __85__ the meaning. This takes somewhat longer, a minimum of about 0.5 seconds. But __86__ started, it is of course a continuous process.

 67.A) apart

 B) off

 C) up

 D) downA

 68.A) so

 B) but

 C) or

 D) forB

 69.A) transfer

 B) transmit

 C) convey

 D) communicateD

 70.A) to

 B) from

 C) over

 D) onA

 71.A) only

 B) almost

 C) even

 D) justC

 72.A) stays

 B) situates

 C) hides

 D) liesD

 73.A) stuck

 B) strung

 C) rung

 D) consistedB

 74.A) rules

 B) scales

 C) laws

 D) standardsA

 75.A) combines

 B) contains

 C) defines

 D) declaresC

 76.A) what

 B) whether

 C) while

 D) ifB

 77.A) prospect

 B) progress

 C) process

 D) produceC

 78.A) aspects

 B) abstracts

 C) angles

 D) assumptionsA

 79.A) anybody

 B) another

 C) other

 D) everybodyB

 80.A) body

 B) gesture

 C) written

 D) spokenD

 81.A) growing

 B) fixing

 C) beginning

 D) buildingC

 82.A) put

 B) take

 C) draw

 D) figureD

 83.A) identify

 B) locate

 C) reveal

 D) discoverA

 84.A) performance

 B) organization

 C) design

 D) layoutB

 85.A) prescribe

 B) justify

 C) utter

 D) interpretD

 86.A) since

 B) after

 C) once

 D) untilC

Part VI Translation (5 minutes)

Directions:Complete the sentences by translating into English the Chinese given in brackets. Please write you translation on Answer Sheet 2.

 87.Specialists in intercultural studies say that it is not easy to ________ (适应不同文化中的生活).

 88.Since my childhood I have found that ________ (没有什么比读书对我更有吸引力).

 89.The victim ________ (本来会有机会活下来) if he had been taken to hospital in time.

 90.Some psychologists claim that people ________ (出门在外时可能会感到孤独).

 91.The nation’s population continues to rise ________ (以每年1200万人的速度).

20061223日新四级参考答案

Part I Writing

四级英语参考范文:

 The approach of the Chinese Lunar New Year poses a national issue concerning the necessity of holding the CCTV Spring Festival Gala. Its established status is being challenged by a growing number of people, especially by younger generations. It is increasingly difficult to cater for all tastes.

 Some individuals deem that it should be canceled or replaced by other programs. These young people focus their attention on other forms of celebration instead of immersing themselves in TV. Despite that, the majority of mid-aged people and senior citizens uphold the importance of the traditional performance. The most striking feature of this gala is its traditionally close link with ordinary people’s lives. Most of people view this gala as an annual staple on the traditional Chinese Spring Festival Eve. They all have a restless night and glue their eyes on the television.

 I am not supportive of the view that the grand gala should be abandoned. Undoubtedly, it plays a vital role in the celebration of Chinese New Year. To increase its appeal and meet young adults’ need, the upcoming performance should invite some big names including super stars from Hong Kong and Taiwan. We are all eagerly anticipating this unforgettable evening show.

Part II Reading Comprehension (Skimming and Scanning)

 1.N

 2.N

 3.Y

 4.N

 5.Y

 6.Y

 7.NG

 8.move forward

 9.looking back

 10.the more you get back

Part III Listening Comprehension


11.B

12.C

13.A

14.C

15.D

16.B

17.D

18.A

19.D

20.C

21.B

22.A

23.D

24.B

25.A

26.C

27.B

28.D

29.C

30.D

31.A

32.B

33.B

34.D

35.A


 36.natural

 37.usage

 38.exception

 39.particular

 40.reference

 41.essays

 42.colleagues

 43.personal

 44.What we may find interesting is that it usually takes more words to be polite

 45.but to a stranger, I probably would say “would you mind closing the door?”

 46.There are bound to be some words and phrases that belong in formal language and others that are informal.

Part IV Reading Comprehension (Reading in Depth)



47.O

48.K

49.G

50.J

51.C

52.N

53.M

54.I

55.H

56.D







57.C

58.B

59.D

60.A

61.B

62.C

63.B

64.D

65.B

66.C






Part V Cloze



67.A

68.B

69.D

70.A

71.C

72.D

73.B

74.A

75.C

76.B

77.C

78.A

79.B

80.D

81.C

82.D

83.A

84.B

85.D

86.C






 87.adapt to lives in different cultures/adapt (oneself) to living in different cultures

 88.nothing is more attractive/appealing to me than reading

 89.would have a chance to survive

 90.might feel lonely when they are away from home/might feel lonely when away from home

 91.at the rate of 12 million people per year/at the speed of 12 million people every year

20061223日新四级听力原文

Section B

 11.M: Christmas is around the corner. And I’m looking for a gift for my girlfriend. Any suggestions?

 W: Well you have to tell me something about your girlfriend first. Also, what’s your budget?

 Q: What does the woman want the man to do?

 12.M: What would you like for dessert? I think I’ll have apple pie and ice cream.

 W: The chocolate cake looks great, but I have to watch my weight. You go ahead and get yours.

 Q: What would the woman most probably do?

 13.W: Having visited so many countries, you must be able to speak several different languages.

 M: I wish I could. But Japanese and, of course English are the only languages I can speak.

 Q: What do we learn from the conversation?

 14.M: Professor Smith asked me to go to his office after class. So it’s impossible for me to make it to the bar at ten.

 W: Then it seems that we’ll have to meet an hour later at the library.

 Q: What will the man do first after class?

 15.M: It’s already 11 now. Do you mean I ought to wait until Mr. Bloom comes back from the class?

 W: Not really. You can just leave a note. I’ll give it to her later.

 Q: What does the woman mean?

 16.M: How is John now? Is he feeling any better?

 W: Not yet. It still seems impossible to make him smile. Talking to him is really difficult and he gets upset easily over little things.

 Q: What do we learn about John from the conversation?

 17.M: Do we have to get the opera tickets in advance?

 W: Certainly. Tickets at the door are usually sold at a higher price.

 Q: What does the woman imply?

 18.M: The taxi driver must have been speeding.

 W: Well, not really. He crashed into the tree because he was trying not to hit a box that had fallen off the truck ahead of him.

 Q: What do we learn about the taxi driver?

Questions 19 to 21 are based on the conversation you have just heard.

 W: Hey, Bob, guess what? I’m going to visit Quebec next summer. I’m invited to go to a friend’s wedding.

 But while I’m there I’d also like to do some sightseeing.

 M: That’s nice, Shelly. But do you mean the province of Quebec, or Quebec City?

 W: I mean the province. My friend’s wedding is in Montreal. I’m going there first. I’ll stay for five days. Is Montreal the capital city of the province?

 M: Well, Many people think so because it’s the biggest city. But it’s not the capital. Quebec City is. But Montreal is great. The Saint Royal River runs right through the middle of the city. It’s beautiful in summer.

 W: Wow, and do you think I can get by in English? My French is OK, but not that good. I know most people there speak French, but can I also use English?

 M: Well, People speak both French and English there. But you’ll hear French most of the time. And all the street signs are in French. In fact, Montreal is the third largest French speaking city in the world. So you’d better practice your French before you go.

 W: Good advice. What about Quebec City? I’ll visit a friend from college who lives there now. What’s it like?

 M: It’s a beautiful city, very old. Many old buildings have been nicely restored. Some of them were built in the 17th or 18th centuries. You’ll love there.

 W: Fantastic. I can’t wait to go.

 19.What’s the woman’s main purpose of visiting Quebec?

 20.What does the man advise the woman to do before the trip?

 21.What does the man say about the Quebec City?

Questions 22 to 25 are based on the conversation you have just heard.

 M: Hi, Miss Rowling, how old were you when you started to write? And what was your first book?

 W: I wrote my first Finnish (finished) story when I was about six. It was about a small animal, a rabbit, I mean. And I’ve been writing ever since?

 M: Why did you choose to be an author?

 W: If someone asked me how to achieve happiness. Step One would be finding out what you love doing most. Step two would be finding someone to pay you to do this. I consider myself very lucky indeed to be able to support myself by writing

 M: Do you have any plans to write books for adults?

 W: My first two novels were for adults. I suppose I might write another one. But I never really imagine a target audience when I’m writing. The ideas come first. So it really depends on the ideas that grasp me next.

 M: where did the ideas for the “Harry Potter” books come from?

 W: I’ve no ideas where the ideas came from. And I hope I’ll never find out. It would spoil my excitement if it turned out I just have a funny wrinkle on the surface of my brain, which makes me think about the invisible train platform.

 M: How did you come up with the names of your characters?

 W: I invented some of them. But I also collected strange names. I’ve got one from ancient saints, maps, dictionaries, plants, war memoirs and people I met.

 M: Oh, you are really resourceful.

 22.What do we learn from the conversation about Miss Rowling’s first book?

 23.Why does Miss Rowling consider her so very lucky?

 24.What dictates Miss Rowling’s writing?

 25.According to Miss Rowling where did she get the ideas for the Harry Porter books?

Section B

Directions:In this section, you will hear 3 short passages. At the end of each passage, you will hear some questions. Both the passage and the questions will be spoken only once. After you hear a question, you must choose the best answer from the four choices marked A), B), C) and D). Then mark the corresponding letter on Answer Sheet 2 with a single line through the centre.

 Passage One

 Reducing the amount of sleep students get at night has a direct impact on their performance at school during the day. According to classroom teachers, elementary and middle school students who stay up late exhibit more learning and attention problems. This has been shown by Brown Medical School and Bradley Hospital research. In the study, teachers were not told the amount of sleep students received when completing weekly performance reports, yet they rated the students who had received eight hours or less as having the most trouble recalling all the material, learning new lessons and completing high-quality work. Teachers also reported that these students had more difficulty paying attention. The experiment is the first to ask teachers to report on the effects of sleep deficiency in children. Just staying up late can cause increased academic difficulty and attention problems for otherwise healthy, well-functioning kids, said Garharn Forlone, the study’s lead author. So the results provide professionals and parents with a clear message: when a child is having learning and attention problems, the issue of sleep has to be taken into consideration. “If we don’t ask about sleep, and try to improve sleep patterns in kids’ struggling academically, then we aren’t doing our job”, Forlone said. For parents, he said, the message is simple, “getting kids to bed on time is as important as getting them to school on time”.

 26.What were teachers told to do in the experiment?

 27.According to the experiment, what problem can insufficient sleep cause in students?

 28.What message did the researcher intend to convey to parents?

 Passage Two

Questions 29 to 32 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 Patricia Pania never wanted to be a public figure. All she wanted to be was a mother and home-maker. But her life was turned upside down when a motorist, distracted by his cell phone, ran a stop sign and crashed into the side of her car. The impact killed her 2-year-old daughter. Four months later, Pania reluctantly but courageously decided to try to educate the public and to fight for laws to ban drivers from using cell phones while a car is moving. She wanted to save other children from what happened to her daughter. In her first speech, Pania got off to a shaky start. She was visibly trembling and her voice was soft and uncertain. But as she got into her speech, a dramatic transformation took place. She stopped shaking and spoke with a strong voice. For the rest of her talk, she was a forceful and compelling speaker. She wanted everyone in the audience to know what she knew without having to learn it from a personal tragedy. Many in the audience were moved to tears and to action. In subsequent presentations, Pania gained reputation as a highly effective speaker. Her appearance on a talk show was broadcast three times, transmitting her message to over 40 million people. Her campaign increased public awareness of the problem, and prompted over 300 cities and several states to consider restrictions on cell phone use.

 29.What was the significant change in Patricia Pania’s life?

 30.What had led to Pania’s personal tragedy?

 31.How did Pania feel when she began her first speech?

 32.What could be expected as a result of Pania’s efforts?

 Passage Three

Questions 33 to 35 are based on the passage you have just heard.

 Many people catch a cold in the spring time or fall. It makes us wonder if scientists can send a man to the moon. Why can’t they find a cure for the common cold? The answer is easy. There’re actually hundreds of kinds of cold viruses out there. You never know which one you will get, so there isn’t a cure for each one. When a virus attacks your body, your body works hard to get rid of it. Blood rushes to your nose and causes a blockade in it. You feel terrible because you can’t breathe well, but your body is actually eating the virus. Your temperature rises and you get a fever, but the heat of your body is killing the virus. You also have a running nose to stop the virus from getting into your cells. You may feel miserable, but actually your wonderful body is doing everything it can to kill the cold. Different people have different remedies for colds. In the United States and some other countries, for example, people might eat chicken soup to feel better. Some people take hot bath and drink warm liquids. Other people take medicines to relieve various symptoms of colds. There was one interesting thing to note. Some scientists say taking medicines when you have a cold is actually bad for you. The virus stays in you longer, because your body doesn’t develop a way to fight it and kill it.

 33.According to the passage, why haven’t scientists found a cure for the common cold?

 34.What does the speaker say about the symptoms of the common cold?

 35.What do some scientists say about taking medicines for the common cold, according to the passage?